Fix MI output for multi-location breakpoints
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1274 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1275 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1276 interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
3877 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
3878 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
3879 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
3880 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
3881 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
3882
3883 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3884 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3885 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3886 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3887 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3888 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3889
3890 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3891 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3892 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3893 classes.
3894
3895 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3896 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3897 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3901 @end smallexample
3902
3903 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3904 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3905 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3906 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3907 every function in a given file:
3908
3909 @smallexample
3910 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3911 @end smallexample
3912
3913 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3914 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3915
3916 @kindex info breakpoints
3917 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3918 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3919 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3920 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3921 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3922 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3923 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3924
3925 @table @emph
3926 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3927 @item Type
3928 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3929 @item Disposition
3930 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3931 @item Enabled or Disabled
3932 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3933 that are not enabled.
3934 @item Address
3935 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3936 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3937 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3938 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3939 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3940 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3941 @item What
3942 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3943 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3944 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3945 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3946 @end table
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3950 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3951 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3952 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3953 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3954 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3955
3956 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3957 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3958 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3959 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3963 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3964 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3965 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3966 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3967
3968 @noindent
3969 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3970 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3971 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3972 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3973 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3974 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3975
3976 @noindent
3977 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3978 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3979
3980 @end table
3981
3982 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3983 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3984 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3985 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3986
3987 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3988 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3989 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3990 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item
3994 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3995
3996 @item
3997 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3998 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3999
4000 @item
4001 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4002 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4003
4004 @item
4005 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4006 several places where that function is inlined.
4007 @end itemize
4008
4009 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4010 the relevant locations.
4011
4012 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4013 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4014 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4015 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4016 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4017 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4018 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4019
4020 For example:
4021
4022 @smallexample
4023 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4024 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4025 stop only if i==1
4026 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4027 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4028 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4029 @end smallexample
4030
4031 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4032 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4033 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4034 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4035 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4036 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4037 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4038 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4039 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4040 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4041 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4042
4043 @cindex pending breakpoints
4044 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4045 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4046 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4047 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4048 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4049 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4050 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4051 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4052 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4053 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4054 is not yet resolved.
4055
4056 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4057 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4058 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4059 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4060 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4061 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4062
4063 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4064 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4065 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4066 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4067
4068 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4069 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4070 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4071
4072 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4073 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4074 address specification to an address:
4075
4076 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4077 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4080 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4081 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4082
4083 @item set breakpoint pending on
4084 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4085 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4086
4087 @item set breakpoint pending off
4088 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4089 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4090 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4091
4092 @item show breakpoint pending
4093 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4094 @end table
4095
4096 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4097 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4098 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4099
4100 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4101 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4102 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4103 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4104 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4105 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4106 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4107 breakpoints.
4108
4109 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4110
4111 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4112 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4113 @table @code
4114 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4115 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4116 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4117 breakpoint must be used.
4118
4119 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4120 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4121 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4122 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4123 @end table
4124
4125 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4126 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4127 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4128 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4129 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4130 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4131 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4132 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4133 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4134
4135 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4136 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4137 @table @code
4138 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4139 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4140 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4141 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4142
4143 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4144 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4145 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4146 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4147 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4151 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4152 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4153
4154 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4155 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4156
4157 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4158
4159 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4160 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4161 @table @code
4162 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4163 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4164 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4165 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4166 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4167
4168 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4169 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4170 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4171 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4172 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4173 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4174 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4175 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4176 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4177 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4178 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4179 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4180 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4181
4182 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4183 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4184 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4185 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4186 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4187 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4188 @end table
4189
4190
4191 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4192 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4193 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4194 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4195 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4196 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4197 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4198 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4199
4200
4201 @node Set Watchpoints
4202 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4203
4204 @cindex setting watchpoints
4205 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4206 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4207 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4208 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4209 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4210
4211 @itemize @bullet
4212 @item
4213 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4214
4215 @item
4216 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4217 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4218 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4219
4220 @item
4221 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4222 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4223 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4224 @end itemize
4225
4226 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4227 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4228 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4229 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4230 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4231 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4232 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4233 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4234 the expression changes.
4235
4236 @cindex software watchpoints
4237 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4238 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4239 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4240 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4241 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4242 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4243 culprit.)
4244
4245 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4246 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4247 slow down the running of your program.
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @kindex watch
4251 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4252 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4253 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4254 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4255 to watch the value of a single variable:
4256
4257 @smallexample
4258 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4259 @end smallexample
4260
4261 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4262 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4263 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4264 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4265 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4266 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4267
4268 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4269 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4270 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4271 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4272 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4273 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4274 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4275 error.
4276
4277 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4278 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4279 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4280 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4281 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4282 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4283 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4284 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4285 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4286 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4287 Examples:
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4291 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4292 @end smallexample
4293
4294 @kindex rwatch
4295 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4296 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4297 by the program.
4298
4299 @kindex awatch
4300 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4301 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4302 or written into by the program.
4303
4304 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4305 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4306 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4307 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4308 @end table
4309
4310 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4311 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4312 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4313 a never-changing value:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4317 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4318 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4319 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4320 @end smallexample
4321
4322 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4323 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4324 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4325 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4326 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4327 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4328
4329 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4330 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4331 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4332 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4333 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4334 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4335 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4336 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4337
4338 @table @code
4339 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4340 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4341 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4342
4343 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4344 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4345 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4346 @end table
4347
4348 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4349 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4350 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4351
4352 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4356 @end smallexample
4357
4358 @noindent
4359 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4360
4361 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4362 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4363 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4364 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4365 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4366 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4367 will print a message like this:
4368
4369 @smallexample
4370 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4371 @end smallexample
4372
4373 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4374 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4375 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4376 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4377 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4378 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4379 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4380 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4381
4382 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4383 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4384 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4385 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4386 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4387 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4391 @end smallexample
4392
4393 @noindent
4394 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4395
4396 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4397 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4398 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4399 expression with separately allocated resources.
4400
4401 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4402 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4403 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4404
4405 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4406 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4407 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4408 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4409 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4410 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4411 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4412 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4413 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4414
4415 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4416 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4417 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4418 watched expression from every thread.
4419
4420 @quotation
4421 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4422 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4423 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4424 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4425 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4426 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4427 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4428 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4429 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4430 @end quotation
4431
4432 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4433
4434 @node Set Catchpoints
4435 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4436 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4437 @cindex exception handlers
4438 @cindex event handling
4439
4440 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4441 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4442 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4443
4444 @table @code
4445 @kindex catch
4446 @item catch @var{event}
4447 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4451 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4452 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4453 @kindex catch throw
4454 @kindex catch rethrow
4455 @kindex catch catch
4456 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4457 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4458
4459 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4460 regular expression will be caught.
4461
4462 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4463 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4464 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4465 exception being thrown.
4466
4467 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4468 @value{GDBN}:
4469
4470 @itemize @bullet
4471 @item
4472 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4473 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4474 supported.
4475
4476 @item
4477 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4478 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4479 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4480 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4481 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4482 built.
4483
4484 @item
4485 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4486 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4487
4488 @item
4489 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4490 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4491 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4492 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4493
4494 @item
4495 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4496 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4497 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4498 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4499 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4500 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4501 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4502 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4503 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4504
4505 @item
4506 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4507
4508 @item
4509 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4510 @end itemize
4511
4512 @item exception
4513 @kindex catch exception
4514 @cindex Ada exception catching
4515 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4516 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4517 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4518 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4519 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4520
4521 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4522 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4523 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4524 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4525 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4526 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4527 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4528 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4529
4530 @item handlers
4531 @kindex catch handlers
4532 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4533 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4534 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4535 specified at the end of the command
4536 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4537 only when this specific exception is handled.
4538 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4539
4540 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4541 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4542 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4543 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4544 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4545 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4546 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4547 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4548 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4549
4550 @item exception unhandled
4551 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4552 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4553
4554 @item assert
4555 @kindex catch assert
4556 A failed Ada assertion.
4557
4558 @item exec
4559 @kindex catch exec
4560 @cindex break on fork/exec
4561 A call to @code{exec}.
4562
4563 @anchor{catch syscall}
4564 @item syscall
4565 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4566 @kindex catch syscall
4567 @cindex break on a system call.
4568 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4569 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4570 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4571 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4572 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4573 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4574 will be caught.
4575
4576 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4577 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4578 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4579 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4580
4581 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4582 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4583 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4584 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4585
4586 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4587 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4588 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4589 available choices.
4590
4591 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4592 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4593 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4594 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4595 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4596 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4597 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4598 behind the OS upgrades).
4599
4600 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4601 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4602 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4603 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4604 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4605 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4606 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4607 syscall groups available on your environment.
4608
4609 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4610 arguments to it:
4611
4612 @smallexample
4613 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4614 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4615 (@value{GDBP}) r
4616 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4617
4618 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4619 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4620 (@value{GDBP}) c
4621 Continuing.
4622
4623 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4624 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4625 (@value{GDBP})
4626 @end smallexample
4627
4628 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4632 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4633 (@value{GDBP}) r
4634 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4635
4636 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4637 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4638 (@value{GDBP}) c
4639 Continuing.
4640
4641 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4642 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4643 (@value{GDBP})
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4647 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4648 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4652 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4653 (@value{GDBP}) r
4654 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4655
4656 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4657 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4658 (@value{GDBP}) c
4659 Continuing.
4660
4661 Program exited normally.
4662 (@value{GDBP})
4663 @end smallexample
4664
4665 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4666
4667 @smallexample
4668 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4669 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4670 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4671 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4672 (@value{GDBP}) r
4673 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4674
4675 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4676 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4677
4678 (@value{GDBP}) c
4679 Continuing.
4680 @end smallexample
4681
4682 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4683 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4684 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4685 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4689 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4690 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4691 (@value{GDBP})
4692 @end smallexample
4693
4694 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4695 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4696 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4697 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4698 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4699 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4703 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4704 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4705 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4706 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4707 (@value{GDBP})
4708 @end smallexample
4709
4710 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4711
4712 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4713 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4714
4715 @smallexample
4716 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4717 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4718 @end smallexample
4719
4720 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4721
4722 @item fork
4723 @kindex catch fork
4724 A call to @code{fork}.
4725
4726 @item vfork
4727 @kindex catch vfork
4728 A call to @code{vfork}.
4729
4730 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4731 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4732 @kindex catch load
4733 @kindex catch unload
4734 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4735 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4736 matches one of the affected libraries.
4737
4738 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4739 @kindex catch signal
4740 The delivery of a signal.
4741
4742 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4743 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4744 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4745
4746 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4747 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4748 signal names.
4749
4750 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4751 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4752 will be caught.
4753
4754 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4755 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4756 catchpoint.
4757
4758 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4759 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4760 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4761 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4762 commands.
4763
4764 @end table
4765
4766 @item tcatch @var{event}
4767 @kindex tcatch
4768 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4769 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4770
4771 @end table
4772
4773 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4774
4775
4776 @node Delete Breaks
4777 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4778
4779 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4780 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4781 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4782 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4783 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4784 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4785
4786 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4787 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4788 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4789 their breakpoint numbers.
4790
4791 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4792 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4793 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4794
4795 @table @code
4796 @kindex clear
4797 @item clear
4798 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4799 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4800 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4801 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4802
4803 @item clear @var{location}
4804 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4805 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4806 most useful ones are listed below:
4807
4808 @table @code
4809 @item clear @var{function}
4810 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4811 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4812
4813 @item clear @var{linenum}
4814 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4815 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4816 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4817 @end table
4818
4819 @cindex delete breakpoints
4820 @kindex delete
4821 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4822 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4823 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4824 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4825 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4826 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4827 @end table
4828
4829 @node Disabling
4830 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4831
4832 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4833 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4834 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4835 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4836 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4837
4838 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4839 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4840 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4841 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4842 do not know which numbers to use.
4843
4844 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4845 affects all of its locations.
4846
4847 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4848 different states of enablement:
4849
4850 @itemize @bullet
4851 @item
4852 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4853 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4854 @item
4855 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4856 @item
4857 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4858 disabled.
4859 @item
4860 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4861 N times, then becomes disabled.
4862 @item
4863 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4864 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4865 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4866 @end itemize
4867
4868 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4869 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4870
4871 @table @code
4872 @kindex disable
4873 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4874 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4876 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4877 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4878 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4879 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4880
4881 @kindex enable
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4884 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4885
4886 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4887 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4888 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4892 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4893 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4894 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4895 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4896 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4897
4898 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4899 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4900 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4901 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4902 @end table
4903
4904 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4905 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4906 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4907 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4908 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4909 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4910 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4911 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4912 Stepping}.)
4913
4914 @node Conditions
4915 @subsection Break Conditions
4916 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4917 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4918
4919 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4920 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4921 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4922 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4923 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4924 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4925 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4926 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4927
4928 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4929 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4930 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4931 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4932 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4933
4934 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4935 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4936 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4937 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4938 one.
4939
4940 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4941 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4942 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4943 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4944 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4945 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4946 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4947 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4948 conditions for the
4949 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4950 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4951
4952 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4953 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4954 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4955 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4956 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4957 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4958
4959 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4960 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4961 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4962 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4963 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4964
4965 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4966 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4967 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4968 with the @code{condition} command.
4969
4970 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4971 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4972 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4973 catchpoint.
4974
4975 @table @code
4976 @kindex condition
4977 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4978 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4979 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4980 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4981 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4982 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4983 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4984 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4985 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4986 prints an error message:
4987
4988 @smallexample
4989 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4990 @end smallexample
4991
4992 @noindent
4993 @value{GDBN} does
4994 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4995 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4996 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4997
4998 @item condition @var{bnum}
4999 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5000 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5001 @end table
5002
5003 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5004 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5005 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5006 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5007 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5008 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5009 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5010 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5011 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5012 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5013 your program reaches it.
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex ignore
5017 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5018 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5019 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5020 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5021 takes no action.
5022
5023 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5024 a count of zero.
5025
5026 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5027 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5028 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5029 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5030
5031 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5032 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5033 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5034
5035 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5036 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5037 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5038 Variables}.
5039 @end table
5040
5041 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5042
5043
5044 @node Break Commands
5045 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5046
5047 @cindex breakpoint commands
5048 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5049 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5050 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5051 enable other breakpoints.
5052
5053 @table @code
5054 @kindex commands
5055 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5056 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5057 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5058 @itemx end
5059 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5060 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5061 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5062
5063 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5064 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5065
5066 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5067 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5068 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5069 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5070 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5071 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5072 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5073 Expressions}).
5074 @end table
5075
5076 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5077 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5078
5079 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5080 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5081 that resumes execution.
5082
5083 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5084 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5085 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5086 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5087 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5088
5089 @kindex silent
5090 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5091 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5092 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5093 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5094 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5095 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5096
5097 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5098 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5099 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5100
5101 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5102 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5103
5104 @smallexample
5105 break foo if x>0
5106 commands
5107 silent
5108 printf "x is %d\n",x
5109 cont
5110 end
5111 @end smallexample
5112
5113 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5114 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5115 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5116 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5117 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5118 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5119 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 break 403
5123 commands
5124 silent
5125 set x = y + 4
5126 cont
5127 end
5128 @end smallexample
5129
5130 @node Dynamic Printf
5131 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5132
5133 @cindex dynamic printf
5134 @cindex dprintf
5135 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5136 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5137 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5138 having to recompile it.
5139
5140 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5141 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5142 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5143 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5144 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5145 redirects to files and so forth.
5146
5147 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5148 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5149 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5150 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5151 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5152 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5153 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @kindex dprintf
5157 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5158 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5159 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5160 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5161
5162 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5163 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5164 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5165 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5166 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5167 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @item gdb
5171 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5172 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5173
5174 @item call
5175 @kindex dprintf-style call
5176 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5177 @code{printf}).
5178
5179 @item agent
5180 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5181 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5182 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5183 support running commands on the target.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5187 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5188 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5189 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5190 command.
5191
5192 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5193 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5194 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5195 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5196 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5197 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5198
5199 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5200 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5201 you could do the following:
5202
5203 @example
5204 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5205 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5206 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5207 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5208 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5209 (gdb) info break
5210 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5211 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5212 continue
5213 (gdb)
5214 @end example
5215
5216 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5217 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5218 the variable settings.
5219
5220 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5221 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5222 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5223 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5224 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5225 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5226
5227 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5228 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5229 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5230
5231 @end table
5232
5233 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5234 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5235 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5236 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5237 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5238 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5239
5240 @node Save Breakpoints
5241 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5242
5243 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5244 breakpoints}} command.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @kindex save breakpoints
5248 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5249 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5250 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5251 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5252 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5253 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5254 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5255 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5256 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5257 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5258 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5259 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5260 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5261 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5262 that can no longer be recreated.
5263 @end table
5264
5265 @node Static Probe Points
5266 @subsection Static Probe Points
5267
5268 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5269 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5270 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5271 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5272 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5273
5274 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5275 ELF-compatible systems:
5276
5277 @itemize @bullet
5278
5279 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5280 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5281 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5282 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5283 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5284 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5285 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5286 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5287
5288 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5289 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5290 C@t{++} languages.
5291 @end itemize
5292
5293 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5294 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5295 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5296 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5297 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5298 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5299 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5300 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5301 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5302
5303 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5304 probes}, with optional arguments:
5305
5306 @table @code
5307 @kindex info probes
5308 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5309 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5310 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5311 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5312
5313 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5314 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5315 probes from all providers are listed.
5316
5317 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5318 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5319 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5320
5321 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5322 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5323 given, all object files are considered.
5324
5325 @item info probes all
5326 List the available static probes, from all types.
5327 @end table
5328
5329 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5330 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5331 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5332 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5333 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5334
5335 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5336 commands, with optional arguments:
5337
5338 @table @code
5339 @kindex enable probes
5340 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5342 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5343 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5344
5345 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5346 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5347 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5348
5349 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5350 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5351 given, all object files are considered.
5352
5353 @kindex disable probes
5354 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5355 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5356 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5357 @end table
5358
5359 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5360 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5361 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5362 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5363 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5364 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5365 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5366 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5367 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5368 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5369 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5370 at the current probe point.
5371
5372 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5373 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5374 an error message.
5375
5376
5377 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5378 @node Error in Breakpoints
5379 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5380
5381 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5382 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5383
5384 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5385 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5386 @smallexample
5387 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5388 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 @noindent
5392 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5393 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5394 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5395
5396 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5397 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5398
5399 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5400 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5401 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5402
5403 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5404 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5405 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5406 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5407
5408 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5409 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5410 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5411 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5412 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5413 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5414 first in the bundle.
5415
5416 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5417 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5418 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5419 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5420 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5421 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5422 is hit.
5423
5424 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5425 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5426
5427 @smallexample
5428 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5429 @end smallexample
5430
5431 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5432 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5433 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5434 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5435 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5436 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5437 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5438 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5439
5440 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5441 adjusted breakpoints:
5442
5443 @smallexample
5444 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5445 to 0x00010410.
5446 @end smallexample
5447
5448 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5449 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5450 frequently than expected.
5451
5452 @node Continuing and Stepping
5453 @section Continuing and Stepping
5454
5455 @cindex stepping
5456 @cindex continuing
5457 @cindex resuming execution
5458 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5459 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5460 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5461 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5462 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5463 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5464 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5465 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5466 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5467 handlers}).)
5468
5469 @table @code
5470 @kindex continue
5471 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5472 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5473 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5474 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5475 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5476 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5477 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5478 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5479 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5480 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5481
5482 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5483 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5484 @code{continue} is ignored.
5485
5486 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5487 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5488 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5489 @code{continue}.
5490 @end table
5491
5492 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5493 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5494 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5495 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5496
5497 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5498 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5499 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5500 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5501 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5502 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5503
5504 @table @code
5505 @kindex step
5506 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5507 @item step
5508 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5509 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5510 abbreviated @code{s}.
5511
5512 @quotation
5513 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5514 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5515 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5516 @c distinction here.
5517 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5518 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5519 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5520 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5521 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5522 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5523 below.
5524 @end quotation
5525
5526 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5527 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5528 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5529 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5530 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5531 called within the line.
5532
5533 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5534 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5535 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5536 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5537 was any debugging information about the routine.
5538
5539 @item step @var{count}
5540 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5541 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5542 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5543
5544 @kindex next
5545 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5546 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5547 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5548 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5549 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5550 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5551 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5552 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5553
5554 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5555
5556
5557 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5558 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5559 @c
5560 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5561 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5562 @c function are executed without stopping.
5563
5564 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5565 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5566 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5567
5568 @kindex set step-mode
5569 @item set step-mode
5570 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5571 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5572 @itemx set step-mode on
5573 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5574 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5575 information rather than stepping over it.
5576
5577 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5578 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5579 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5580
5581 @item set step-mode off
5582 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5583 debug information. This is the default.
5584
5585 @item show step-mode
5586 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5587 source line debug information.
5588
5589 @kindex finish
5590 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5591 @item finish
5592 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5593 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5594 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5595
5596 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5597 ,Returning from a Function}).
5598
5599 @kindex until
5600 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5601 @cindex run until specified location
5602 @item until
5603 @itemx u
5604 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5605 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5606 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5607 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5608 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5609 than the address of the jump.
5610
5611 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5612 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5613 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5614 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5615 through the next iteration.
5616
5617 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5618 stack frame.
5619
5620 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5621 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5622 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5623 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5624 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5625
5626 @smallexample
5627 (@value{GDBP}) f
5628 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5629 206 expand_input();
5630 (@value{GDBP}) until
5631 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5632 @end smallexample
5633
5634 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5635 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5636 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5637 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5638 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5639 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5640 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5641
5642 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5643 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5644 argument.
5645
5646 @item until @var{location}
5647 @itemx u @var{location}
5648 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5649 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5650 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5651 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5652 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5653 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5654 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5655 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5656 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5657 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5658 invocations have returned.
5659
5660 @smallexample
5661 94 int factorial (int value)
5662 95 @{
5663 96 if (value > 1) @{
5664 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5665 98 @}
5666 99 return (value);
5667 100 @}
5668 @end smallexample
5669
5670
5671 @kindex advance @var{location}
5672 @item advance @var{location}
5673 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5674 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5675 @ref{Specify Location}.
5676 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5677 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5678 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5679 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5680
5681
5682 @kindex stepi
5683 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5684 @item stepi
5685 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5686 @itemx si
5687 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5688
5689 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5690 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5691 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5692 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5693
5694 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5695
5696 @need 750
5697 @kindex nexti
5698 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5699 @item nexti
5700 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5701 @itemx ni
5702 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5703 proceed until the function returns.
5704
5705 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5706
5707 @end table
5708
5709 @anchor{range stepping}
5710 @cindex range stepping
5711 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5712 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5713 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5714 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5715 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5716 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5717 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5718 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5719 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5720 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5721 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5722 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5723 if necessary:
5724
5725 @table @code
5726 @kindex set range-stepping
5727 @kindex show range-stepping
5728 @item set range-stepping
5729 @itemx show range-stepping
5730 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5731
5732 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5733 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5734 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5735 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5736 default is @code{on}.
5737
5738 @end table
5739
5740 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5741 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5742 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5743
5744 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5745 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5746 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5747 a particular file when stepping.
5748
5749 For example, consider the following C function:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 101 int func()
5753 102 @{
5754 103 foo(boring());
5755 104 bar(boring());
5756 105 @}
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 @noindent
5760 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5761 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5762 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5763 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5764
5765 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5766 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5767 is called from many places.
5768
5769 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5770 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5771 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5772 @code{foo}.
5773
5774 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5775 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5776 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5777
5778 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5779 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5780 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5781 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5782 the underlying system.
5783 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5784 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5785
5786 @table @code
5787 @kindex skip
5788 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5789 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5790 that specify what to skip.
5791 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5792
5793 @table @code
5794 @item -file @var{file}
5795 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5796 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5797
5798 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5799 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5800 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5801 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5802 over when stepping.
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5806 @end smallexample
5807
5808 @item -function @var{linespec}
5809 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5810 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5811 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5812 @xref{Specify Location}.
5813
5814 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5815 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5816 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5817 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5818
5819 This form is useful for complex function names.
5820 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5821 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5822 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5823 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5824 regular expression makes this easier.
5825
5826 @smallexample
5827 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5831 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5832
5833 @smallexample
5834 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5835 @end smallexample
5836 @end table
5837
5838 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5839 will be skipped.
5840
5841 @kindex skip function
5842 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5843 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5844 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5845 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5846
5847 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5848 will be skipped.
5849
5850 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5851 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5852
5853 @kindex skip file
5854 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5855 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5856 will be skipped over when stepping.
5857
5858 @smallexample
5859 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5860 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5864 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5865 @end table
5866
5867 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5868 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex info skip
5872 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5873 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5874 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5875 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5876
5877 @table @emph
5878 @item Identifier
5879 A number identifying this skip.
5880 @item Enabled or Disabled
5881 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5882 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5883 @item Glob
5884 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5885 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5886 @item File
5887 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5888 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5889 @item RE
5890 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5891 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5892 @item Function
5893 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5894 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5895 @end table
5896
5897 @kindex skip delete
5898 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5899 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5900 skips.
5901
5902 @kindex skip enable
5903 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5904 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5905 skips.
5906
5907 @kindex skip disable
5908 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5909 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5910 skips.
5911
5912 @kindex set debug skip
5913 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5914 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5915
5916 @kindex show debug skip
5917 @item show debug skip
5918 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5919
5920 @end table
5921
5922 @node Signals
5923 @section Signals
5924 @cindex signals
5925
5926 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5927 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5928 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5929 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5930 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5931 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5932 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5933 requested an alarm).
5934
5935 @cindex fatal signals
5936 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5937 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5938 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5939 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5940 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5941 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5942
5943 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5944 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5945 signal.
5946
5947 @cindex handling signals
5948 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5949 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5950 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5951 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5952 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5953
5954 @table @code
5955 @kindex info signals
5956 @kindex info handle
5957 @item info signals
5958 @itemx info handle
5959 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5960 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5961 the defined types of signals.
5962
5963 @item info signals @var{sig}
5964 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5965
5966 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5967
5968 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5969 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5970 for details about this command.
5971
5972 @kindex handle
5973 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5974 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5975 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5976 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5977 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5978 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5979 say what change to make.
5980 @end table
5981
5982 @c @group
5983 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5984 Their full names are:
5985
5986 @table @code
5987 @item nostop
5988 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5989 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5990
5991 @item stop
5992 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5993 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5994
5995 @item print
5996 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5997
5998 @item noprint
5999 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6000 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6001
6002 @item pass
6003 @itemx noignore
6004 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6005 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6006 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6007
6008 @item nopass
6009 @itemx ignore
6010 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6011 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6012 @end table
6013 @c @end group
6014
6015 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6016 program until you
6017 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6018 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6019 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6020 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6021 program sees that signal when you continue.
6022
6023 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6024 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6025 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6026 erroneous signals.
6027
6028 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6029 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6030 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6031 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6032 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6033 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6034 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6035 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6036 Program a Signal}.
6037
6038 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6039 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6040
6041 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6042 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6043 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6044 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6045 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6046 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6047 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6048 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6049 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6050 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6051 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6052 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6053 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6054
6055 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6056
6057 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6058 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6059 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6060 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6061
6062 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6063 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6064 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6065 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6066
6067 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6068 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6072 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6073 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6074 (@value{GDBP}) c
6075 Continuing.
6076
6077 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6078 main () sigusr1.c:28
6079 28 p = 0;
6080 (@value{GDBP}) si
6081 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6082 9 @{
6083 @end smallexample
6084
6085 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6086 program to receive the signal first:
6087
6088 @smallexample
6089 (@value{GDBP}) n
6090 28 p = 0;
6091 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6092 (@value{GDBP}) si
6093 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6094 9 @{
6095 (@value{GDBP})
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 @cindex extra signal information
6099 @anchor{extra signal information}
6100
6101 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6102 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6103 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6104 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6105 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6106 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6107 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6108 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6109 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6110 system header.
6111
6112 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6113 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6118 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6119 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6120 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6121 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6122 type = struct @{
6123 int si_signo;
6124 int si_errno;
6125 int si_code;
6126 union @{
6127 int _pad[28];
6128 struct @{...@} _kill;
6129 struct @{...@} _timer;
6130 struct @{...@} _rt;
6131 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6132 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6133 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6134 @} _sifields;
6135 @}
6136 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6137 type = struct @{
6138 void *si_addr;
6139 @}
6140 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6141 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6142 @end group
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6146
6147 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6148 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6149 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6150 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6151 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6152 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6153 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6154 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6155 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6156 information is displayed.
6157
6158 The usual output of a segfault is:
6159 @smallexample
6160 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6161 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6162 68 value = *(p + len);
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 While a bound violation is presented as:
6166 @smallexample
6167 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6168 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6169 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6170 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6171 68 value = *(p + len);
6172 @end smallexample
6173
6174 @node Thread Stops
6175 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6176
6177 @cindex stopped threads
6178 @cindex threads, stopped
6179
6180 @cindex continuing threads
6181 @cindex threads, continuing
6182
6183 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6184 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6185 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6186 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6187 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6188 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6189 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6190 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6191 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6192
6193 @menu
6194 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6195 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6196 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6197 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6198 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6199 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6200 @end menu
6201
6202 @node All-Stop Mode
6203 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6204
6205 @cindex all-stop mode
6206
6207 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6208 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6209 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6210 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6211 underfoot.
6212
6213 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6214 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6215 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6216
6217 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6218 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6219 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6220 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6221 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6222 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6223 stops.
6224
6225 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6226 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6227 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6228 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6229
6230 @cindex automatic thread selection
6231 @cindex switching threads automatically
6232 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6233 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6234 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6235 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6236 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6237 thread.
6238
6239 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6240 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6244 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6245 @cindex lock scheduler
6246 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6247 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6248 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6249 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6250 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6251 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6252 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6253 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6254 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6255 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6256 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6257 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6258 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6259 @code{on} in replay mode.
6260
6261 @item show scheduler-locking
6262 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6263 @end table
6264
6265 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6266 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6267 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6268 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6269 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6270 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6271 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6272 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6273 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6274 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6275 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6276 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6277 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6278 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6279
6280 @table @code
6281 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6282 @item set schedule-multiple
6283 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6284 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6285 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6286 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6287 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6288 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6289
6290 @item show schedule-multiple
6291 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6292 multiple processes.
6293 @end table
6294
6295 @node Non-Stop Mode
6296 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6297
6298 @cindex non-stop mode
6299
6300 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6301 @c with more details.
6302
6303 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6304 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6305 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6306 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6307 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6308 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6309
6310 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6311 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6312 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6313 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6314 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6315 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6316 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6317 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6318 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6319 independently and simultaneously.
6320
6321 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6322 or attach to your program:
6323
6324 @smallexample
6325 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6326 set pagination off
6327
6328 # Finally, turn it on!
6329 set non-stop on
6330 @end smallexample
6331
6332 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6333
6334 @table @code
6335 @kindex set non-stop
6336 @item set non-stop on
6337 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6338 @item set non-stop off
6339 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6340 @kindex show non-stop
6341 @item show non-stop
6342 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6343 @end table
6344
6345 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6346 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6347 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6348 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6349 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6350 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6351 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6352 default.
6353
6354 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6355 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6356 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6357
6358 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6359 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6360 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6361 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6362 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6363
6364 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6365 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6366 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6367 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6368 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6369
6370 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6371
6372 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6373 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6374 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6375 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6376 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6377 previously current thread.
6378
6379 @node Background Execution
6380 @subsection Background Execution
6381
6382 @cindex foreground execution
6383 @cindex background execution
6384 @cindex asynchronous execution
6385 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6386
6387 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6388 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6389 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6390 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6391 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6392 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6393
6394 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6395 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6396
6397 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6398 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6399 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6400 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6401 are:
6402
6403 @table @code
6404 @kindex run&
6405 @item run
6406 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6407
6408 @item attach
6409 @kindex attach&
6410 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6411
6412 @item step
6413 @kindex step&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6415
6416 @item stepi
6417 @kindex stepi&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6419
6420 @item next
6421 @kindex next&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6423
6424 @item nexti
6425 @kindex nexti&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6427
6428 @item continue
6429 @kindex continue&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6431
6432 @item finish
6433 @kindex finish&
6434 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6435
6436 @item until
6437 @kindex until&
6438 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6439
6440 @end table
6441
6442 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6443 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6444 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6445 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6446 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6447 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6448
6449 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6450 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6451
6452 @table @code
6453 @kindex interrupt
6454 @item interrupt
6455 @itemx interrupt -a
6456
6457 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6458 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6459 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6460 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6461 @end table
6462
6463 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6464 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6465
6466 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6467 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6468 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6469
6470 @table @code
6471 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6472 @cindex thread breakpoints
6473 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6474 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6475 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6476 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6477 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6478 specify some source line.
6479
6480 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6481 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6482 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6483 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6484 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6485
6486 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6487 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6488 program.
6489
6490 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6491 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6492 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6493
6494 @smallexample
6495 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 @end table
6499
6500 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6501 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6502 thread list. For example:
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 (@value{GDBP}) c
6506 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6507 @end smallexample
6508
6509 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6510 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6511 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6512 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6513 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6514 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6515 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6516 command.
6517
6518 @node Interrupted System Calls
6519 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6520
6521 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6522 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6523 @cindex premature return from system calls
6524 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6525 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6526 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6527 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6528 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6529 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6530 stop execution.
6531
6532 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6533 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6534 style anyways.
6535
6536 For example, do not write code like this:
6537
6538 @smallexample
6539 sleep (10);
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6543 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6544
6545 Instead, write this:
6546
6547 @smallexample
6548 int unslept = 10;
6549 while (unslept > 0)
6550 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6551 @end smallexample
6552
6553 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6554 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6555 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6556 @value{GDBN}.
6557
6558 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6559 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6560 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6561 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6562
6563 @node Observer Mode
6564 @subsection Observer Mode
6565
6566 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6567 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6568 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6569 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6570 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6571
6572 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6573 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6574 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6575 mode.
6576
6577 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6578 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6579 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6580 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6581 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6582
6583 @table @code
6584
6585 @kindex observer
6586 @item set observer on
6587 @itemx set observer off
6588 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6589 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6590 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6591 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6592
6593 @item show observer
6594 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6595
6596 @kindex may-write-registers
6597 @item set may-write-registers on
6598 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6599 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6600 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6601 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6602
6603 @item show may-write-registers
6604 Show the current permission to write registers.
6605
6606 @kindex may-write-memory
6607 @item set may-write-memory on
6608 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6609 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6610 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6611 defaults to @code{on}.
6612
6613 @item show may-write-memory
6614 Show the current permission to write memory.
6615
6616 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6617 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6618 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6619 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6620 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6621 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6622
6623 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6624 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6625
6626 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6627 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6628 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6629 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6630 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6631 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6632 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6633
6634 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6635 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6636
6637 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6639 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6640 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6641 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6642 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6643 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6644
6645 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6646 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6647
6648 @kindex may-interrupt
6649 @item set may-interrupt on
6650 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6651 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6652 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6653 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6654 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6655
6656 @item show may-interrupt
6657 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6658
6659 @end table
6660
6661 @node Reverse Execution
6662 @chapter Running programs backward
6663 @cindex reverse execution
6664 @cindex running programs backward
6665
6666 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6667 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6668 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6669 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6670
6671 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6672 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6673 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6674 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6675 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6676 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6677
6678 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6679 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6680 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6681 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6682 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6683 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6684 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6685 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6686 prior values@footnote{
6687 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6688 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6689 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6690
6691 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6692 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6693 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6694 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6695 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6696 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6697 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6698 }.
6699
6700 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6701 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @kindex reverse-continue
6705 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6706 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6707 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6708 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6709 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6710 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6711 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6712
6713 @kindex reverse-step
6714 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6715 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6716 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6717 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6718
6719 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6720 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6721 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6722 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6723 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6724 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6725
6726 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6727 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6728
6729 @kindex reverse-stepi
6730 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6731 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6732 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6733 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6734 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6735 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6736 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6737
6738 @kindex reverse-next
6739 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6740 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6741 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6742 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6743 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6744 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6745 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6746 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6747 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6748 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6749
6750 @kindex reverse-nexti
6751 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6752 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6753 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6754 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6755 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6756 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6757 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6758 frame) is reached.
6759
6760 @kindex reverse-finish
6761 @item reverse-finish
6762 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6763 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6764 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6765 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6766
6767 @kindex set exec-direction
6768 @item set exec-direction
6769 Set the direction of target execution.
6770 @item set exec-direction reverse
6771 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6772 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6773 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6774 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6775 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6776 @item set exec-direction forward
6777 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6778 This is the default.
6779 @end table
6780
6781
6782 @node Process Record and Replay
6783 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6784 @cindex process record and replay
6785 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6786
6787 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6788 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6789 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6790
6791 @cindex replay mode
6792 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6793 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6794 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6795 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6796 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6797 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6798 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6799 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6800 execution log.
6801
6802 @cindex record mode
6803 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6804 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6805 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6806 for future replay.
6807
6808 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6809 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6810 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6811 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6812 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6813 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6814
6815 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6816 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6817 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6818 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6819
6820 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6821 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @kindex target record
6825 @kindex target record-full
6826 @kindex target record-btrace
6827 @kindex record
6828 @kindex record full
6829 @kindex record btrace
6830 @kindex record btrace bts
6831 @kindex record btrace pt
6832 @kindex record bts
6833 @kindex record pt
6834 @kindex rec
6835 @kindex rec full
6836 @kindex rec btrace
6837 @kindex rec btrace bts
6838 @kindex rec btrace pt
6839 @kindex rec bts
6840 @kindex rec pt
6841 @item record @var{method}
6842 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6843 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6844 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6845 recording methods are available:
6846
6847 @table @code
6848 @item full
6849 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6850 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6851 execution.
6852
6853 @item btrace @var{format}
6854 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6855 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6856 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6857 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6858 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6859 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6860 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6861
6862 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6863 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6864 formats are available:
6865
6866 @table @code
6867 @item bts
6868 @cindex branch trace store
6869 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6870 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6871 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6872
6873 @item pt
6874 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6875 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6876 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6877 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6878
6879 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6880 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6881 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6882
6883 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6884 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6885 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6886 buffer-size with care.
6887 @end table
6888
6889 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6890 @end table
6891
6892 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6893 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6894 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6895 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6896
6897 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6898 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6899 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6900 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6901 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6902
6903 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6904 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6905 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6906 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6907 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6908 does not support these two modes.
6909
6910 @kindex record stop
6911 @kindex rec s
6912 @item record stop
6913 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6914 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6915 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6916
6917 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6918 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6919 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6920 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6921 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6922
6923 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6924 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6925 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6926 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6927 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6928
6929 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6930 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6931
6932 @kindex record goto
6933 @item record goto
6934 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6935 ways to specify the location to go to:
6936
6937 @table @code
6938 @item record goto begin
6939 @itemx record goto start
6940 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6941
6942 @item record goto end
6943 Go to the end of the execution log.
6944
6945 @item record goto @var{n}
6946 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6947 @end table
6948
6949 @kindex record save
6950 @item record save @var{filename}
6951 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6953 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6954
6955 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6956
6957 @kindex record restore
6958 @item record restore @var{filename}
6959 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6960 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6961
6962 @kindex set record full
6963 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6964 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6965 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6966 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6967
6968 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6969 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6970 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6971 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6972 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6973 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6974 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6975 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6976
6977 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6978 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6979 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6980
6981 @kindex show record full
6982 @item show record full insn-number-max
6983 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6984 recording method.
6985
6986 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6987 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6988 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6989 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6990 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6991 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6992 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6993 oldest one to be deleted.
6994
6995 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6996 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6997
6998 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6999 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7000
7001 @item set record full memory-query
7002 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7003 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7004 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7005 case.
7006
7007 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7008 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7009 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7010 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7011 results.
7012
7013 @item show record full memory-query
7014 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7015
7016 @kindex set record btrace
7017 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7018 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7019 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7020 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7021 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7022 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7023 You can use the following command for that:
7024
7025 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7026 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7027 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7028 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7029 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7030 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7031 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7032 position.
7033
7034 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7035 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7036 errata when decoding the trace.
7037
7038 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7039 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7040 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7041 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7042 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7043 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7044 which the trace was recorded.
7045
7046 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7047 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7048 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7049 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7050 disable the workarounds.
7051
7052 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7053 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7054 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7055 (default).
7056
7057 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7058 identifiers are currently supported:
7059
7060 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7061
7062 @item @code{intel}
7063 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7064
7065 @end multitable
7066
7067 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7068 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7069
7070 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7071 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7072 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7073
7074 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7075 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7076 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7077 supports.
7078
7079 @smallexample
7080 (gdb) info record
7081 Active record target: record-btrace
7082 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7083 Buffer size: 16kB.
7084 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7085 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7086 (gdb) info record
7087 Active record target: record-btrace
7088 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7089 Buffer size: 16kB.
7090 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7091 @end smallexample
7092
7093 @kindex show record btrace
7094 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7095 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7096
7097 @item show record btrace cpu
7098 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7099 workarounds.
7100
7101 @kindex set record btrace bts
7102 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7103 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7104 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7105 format. Default is 64KB.
7106
7107 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7109 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7110 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7111 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7112 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7113 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7114
7115 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7116 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7117
7118 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7119 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7120
7121 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7122 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7123 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7124
7125 @kindex set record btrace pt
7126 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7127 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7128 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7129 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7130
7131 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7132 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7133 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7134 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7135 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7136 actual buffer size for each thread.
7137
7138 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7139 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7140
7141 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7142 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7143
7144 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7145 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7146 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7147
7148 @kindex info record
7149 @item info record
7150 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7151 method:
7152
7153 @table @code
7154 @item full
7155 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7156 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7157
7158 @itemize @bullet
7159 @item
7160 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7161 @item
7162 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7163 @item
7164 Highest recorded instruction number.
7165 @item
7166 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7167 @item
7168 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7169 @item
7170 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7171 @end itemize
7172
7173 @item btrace
7174 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7175
7176 @itemize @bullet
7177 @item
7178 Recording format.
7179 @item
7180 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7181 @item
7182 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7183 instructions.
7184 @item
7185 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7186 @end itemize
7187
7188 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7189 @itemize @bullet
7190 @item
7191 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7192 @end itemize
7193
7194 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7195 @itemize @bullet
7196 @item
7197 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7198 @end itemize
7199 @end table
7200
7201 @kindex record delete
7202 @kindex rec del
7203 @item record delete
7204 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7205 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7206 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7207 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7208
7209 @kindex record instruction-history
7210 @kindex rec instruction-history
7211 @item record instruction-history
7212 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7213 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7214 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7215 are printed in execution order.
7216
7217 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7218 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7219 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7220
7221 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7222 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7223 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7224 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7225 @code{/p} modifier.
7226
7227 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7228 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7229 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7230
7231 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7232 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7233
7234 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7235 disassemble:
7236
7237 @table @code
7238 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7239 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7240 @var{insn}.
7241
7242 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7243 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7244 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7245 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7246 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7247 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7248
7249 @item record instruction-history
7250 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7251
7252 @item record instruction-history -
7253 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7254
7255 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7256 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7257 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7258 number @var{end} is included.
7259 @end table
7260
7261 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7262
7263 @kindex set record
7264 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7265 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7266 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7267 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7268 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7269
7270 @kindex show record
7271 @item show record instruction-history-size
7272 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7273 instruction-history} command.
7274
7275 @kindex record function-call-history
7276 @kindex rec function-call-history
7277 @item record function-call-history
7278 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7279 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7280 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7281 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7282 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7283 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7284 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7285 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7286 given together.
7287
7288 @smallexample
7289 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7290 1 void foo (void)
7291 2 @{
7292 3 @}
7293 4
7294 5 void bar (void)
7295 6 @{
7296 7 ...
7297 8 foo ();
7298 9 ...
7299 10 @}
7300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7301 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7302 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7303 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7304 @end smallexample
7305
7306 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7307 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7308 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7309 to print:
7310
7311 @table @code
7312 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7313 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7314
7315 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7316 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7317 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7318 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7319 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7320
7321 @item record function-call-history
7322 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7323
7324 @item record function-call-history -
7325 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7326
7327 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7328 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7329 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7330 @end table
7331
7332 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7333
7334 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7335 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7336 Define how many lines to print in the
7337 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7338 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7339
7340 @item show record function-call-history-size
7341 Show how many lines to print in the
7342 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7343 @end table
7344
7345
7346 @node Stack
7347 @chapter Examining the Stack
7348
7349 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7350 stopped and how it got there.
7351
7352 @cindex call stack
7353 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7354 is generated.
7355 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7356 the arguments of the call,
7357 and the local variables of the function being called.
7358 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7359 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7360 stack}.
7361
7362 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7363 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7364
7365 @cindex selected frame
7366 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7367 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7368 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7369 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7370 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7371 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7372
7373 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7374 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7375 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7376
7377 @menu
7378 * Frames:: Stack frames
7379 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7380 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7381 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7382 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7383 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7384
7385 @end menu
7386
7387 @node Frames
7388 @section Stack Frames
7389
7390 @cindex frame, definition
7391 @cindex stack frame
7392 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7393 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7394 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7395 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7396 which the function is executing.
7397
7398 @cindex initial frame
7399 @cindex outermost frame
7400 @cindex innermost frame
7401 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7402 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7403 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7404 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7405 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7406 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7407 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7408 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7409
7410 @cindex frame pointer
7411 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7412 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7413 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7414 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7415 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7416 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7417
7418 @cindex frame level
7419 @cindex frame number
7420 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7421 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7422 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7423 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7424 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7425 describe this number.
7426
7427 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7428 @c underflow problems.
7429 @cindex frameless execution
7430 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7431 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7432 @smallexample
7433 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7434 @end smallexample
7435 generates functions without a frame.)
7436 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7437 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7438 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7439 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7440 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7441 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7442 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7443
7444 @node Backtrace
7445 @section Backtraces
7446
7447 @cindex traceback
7448 @cindex call stack traces
7449 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7450 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7451 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7452 stack.
7453
7454 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7455 @kindex backtrace
7456 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7457 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7458 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7459 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7460 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7461 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7462
7463 @table @code
7464 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7465 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7466 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7467 be one of the following:
7468
7469 @table @code
7470 @item @var{n}
7471 @itemx @var{n}
7472 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7473 number.
7474
7475 @item -@var{n}
7476 @itemx -@var{n}
7477 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7478 number.
7479
7480 @item full
7481 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7482 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7483
7484 @item no-filters
7485 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7486 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7487 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7488 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7489 support.
7490
7491 @item hide
7492 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7493 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7494 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7495 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7496 @end table
7497 @end table
7498
7499 @kindex where
7500 @kindex info stack
7501 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7502 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7503
7504 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7505 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7506 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7507 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7508 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7509 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7510 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7511 multi-threaded program.
7512
7513 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7514 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7515 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7516 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7517 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7518 line number.
7519
7520 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7521 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7522
7523 @smallexample
7524 @group
7525 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7526 at builtin.c:993
7527 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7528 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7529 at macro.c:71
7530 (More stack frames follow...)
7531 @end group
7532 @end smallexample
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7536 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7537 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7538
7539 @noindent
7540 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7541 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7542 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7543 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7544 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7545
7546 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7547 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7548 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7549 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7550 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7551 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7552 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7553 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7554 such a backtrace might look like:
7555
7556 @smallexample
7557 @group
7558 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7559 at builtin.c:993
7560 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7561 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7562 at macro.c:71
7563 (More stack frames follow...)
7564 @end group
7565 @end smallexample
7566
7567 @noindent
7568 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7569 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7570
7571 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7572 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7573 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7574
7575 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7576 @cindex program entry point
7577 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7578 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7579 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7580 @code{main}@footnote{
7581 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7582 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7583 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7584 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7585 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7586 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7587
7588 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7589 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item set backtrace past-main
7593 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7594 @kindex set backtrace
7595 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-main off
7598 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7599 default.
7600
7601 @item show backtrace past-main
7602 @kindex show backtrace
7603 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7604
7605 @item set backtrace past-entry
7606 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7607 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7608 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7609 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7610
7611 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7612 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7613 application. This is the default.
7614
7615 @item show backtrace past-entry
7616 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7617
7618 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7619 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7620 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7621 @cindex backtrace limit
7622 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7623 or zero means unlimited levels.
7624
7625 @item show backtrace limit
7626 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7627 @end table
7628
7629 You can control how file names are displayed.
7630
7631 @table @code
7632 @item set filename-display
7633 @itemx set filename-display relative
7634 @cindex filename-display
7635 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7636
7637 @item set filename-display basename
7638 Display only basename of a filename.
7639
7640 @item set filename-display absolute
7641 Display an absolute filename.
7642
7643 @item show filename-display
7644 Show the current way to display filenames.
7645 @end table
7646
7647 @node Selection
7648 @section Selecting a Frame
7649
7650 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7651 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7652 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7653 of the stack frame just selected.
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7657 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7658 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7659 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7660 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7661 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7662
7663 @table @code
7664 @kindex frame level
7665 @item @var{num}
7666 @item level @var{num}
7667 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7668 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7669 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7670 for @code{main}.
7671
7672 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7673 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7674 commands are equivalent:
7675
7676 @smallexample
7677 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7678 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7679 @end smallexample
7680
7681 @kindex frame address
7682 @item address @var{stack-address}
7683 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7684 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7685 @command{info frame}, for example:
7686
7687 @smallexample
7688 (gdb) info frame
7689 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7690 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7691 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7692 source language c++.
7693 Arglist at unknown address.
7694 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7698 indicated by the line:
7699
7700 @smallexample
7701 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7702 @end smallexample
7703
7704 @kindex frame function
7705 @item function @var{function-name}
7706 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7707 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7708 most stack frame is selected.
7709
7710 @kindex frame view
7711 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7712 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7713 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7714 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7715
7716 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7717 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7718 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7719 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7720
7721 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7722 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7723 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7724 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7725
7726 @end table
7727
7728 @kindex up
7729 @item up @var{n}
7730 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7731 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7732 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7733
7734 @kindex down
7735 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7736 @item down @var{n}
7737 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7738 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7739 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7740 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7741 @end table
7742
7743 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7744 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7745 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7746 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7747
7748 @need 1000
7749 For example:
7750
7751 @smallexample
7752 @group
7753 (@value{GDBP}) up
7754 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7755 at env.c:10
7756 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7757 @end group
7758 @end smallexample
7759
7760 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7761 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7762 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7763 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7764 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7765 for details.
7766
7767 @table @code
7768 @kindex select-frame
7769 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7770 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7771 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7772 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7773 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7774 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7775 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7776
7777 @kindex down-silently
7778 @kindex up-silently
7779 @item up-silently @var{n}
7780 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7781 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7782 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7783 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7784 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7785 distracting.
7786 @end table
7787
7788 @node Frame Info
7789 @section Information About a Frame
7790
7791 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7792 stack frame.
7793
7794 @table @code
7795 @item frame
7796 @itemx f
7797 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7798 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7799 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7800 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7801 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7802
7803 @kindex info frame
7804 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7805 @item info frame
7806 @itemx info f
7807 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7808 including:
7809
7810 @itemize @bullet
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame
7813 @item
7814 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7815 @item
7816 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7817 @item
7818 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7819 @item
7820 the address of the frame's arguments
7821 @item
7822 the address of the frame's local variables
7823 @item
7824 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7825 @item
7826 which registers were saved in the frame
7827 @end itemize
7828
7829 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7830 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7831 the usual conventions.
7832
7833 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7834 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7835 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7836 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7837 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7838 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7839
7840 @kindex info args
7841 @item info args [-q]
7842 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7843
7844 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7845 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
7846 have been printed.
7847
7848 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7849 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
7850 with the provided regexp(s).
7851
7852 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
7853 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7854
7855 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
7856 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7857 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7858 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7859 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7860 of special characters or quotes.
7861
7862 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
7863 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7864 @var{type_regexp}.
7865
7866 @item info locals [-q]
7867 @kindex info locals
7868 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7869 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7870 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7871
7872 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7873 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
7874 have been printed.
7875
7876 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7877 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
7878 with the provided regexp(s).
7879
7880 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
7881 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7882
7883 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
7884 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7885 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7886 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7887 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7888 of special characters or quotes.
7889
7890 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
7891 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7892 @var{type_regexp}.
7893
7894 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
7895 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
7896 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
7897 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
7898 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
7899 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
7900 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
7901 @smallexample
7902 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
7903 @end smallexample
7904 @noindent
7905 or the equivalent shorter form
7906 @smallexample
7907 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
7908 @end smallexample
7909
7910 @end table
7911
7912 @node Frame Apply
7913 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7914 @kindex frame apply
7915 @cindex apply command to several frames
7916 @table @code
7917 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7918 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7919 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7920
7921 @table @code
7922 @item @code{all}
7923 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7924
7925 @item @var{count}
7926 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7927 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7928
7929 @item @var{-count}
7930 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7931 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7932
7933 @item @code{level}
7934 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7935 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7936 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7937 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7938 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7939 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7940
7941 @end table
7942
7943 @end table
7944
7945 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7946 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7947 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7948 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7949
7950 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7951 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7952 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7953 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7954 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7955
7956 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7957 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7958 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7959 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7960
7961 @table @code
7962 @item -c
7963 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7964 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7965 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7966 @item -s
7967 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7968 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7969 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7970 are not printed.
7971 @item -q
7972 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7973 information.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7977 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7978 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7979 @code{#1 main} frame.
7980
7981 @smallexample
7982 @group
7983 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7984 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7985 No symbol "j" in current context.
7986 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7987 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7988 No symbol "j" in current context.
7989 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7990 $1 = 5
7991 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7992 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7993 $2 = 5
7994 (gdb)
7995 @end group
7996 @end smallexample
7997
7998 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7999 information before the command output:
8000
8001 @smallexample
8002 @group
8003 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8004 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8005 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8006 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8007 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8008 (gdb)
8009 @end group
8010 @end smallexample
8011
8012 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8013 @smallexample
8014 @group
8015 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8016 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8017 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8018 (gdb)
8019 @end group
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 @table @code
8023
8024 @kindex faas
8025 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8026 @item faas @var{command}
8027 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8028 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8029
8030 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8031 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8032 is, using:
8033 @smallexample
8034 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8035 @end smallexample
8036
8037 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8038 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8039 @end table
8040
8041
8042 @node Frame Filter Management
8043 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8044 @cindex managing frame filters
8045
8046 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8047 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8048
8049 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8050 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @kindex info frame-filter
8054 @item info frame-filter
8055 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8056 their name, priority and enabled status.
8057
8058 @kindex disable frame-filter
8059 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8060 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8061 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8062 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8063 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8064 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8065 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8066 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8067 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8068 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8069 may be enabled again later.
8070
8071 @kindex enable frame-filter
8072 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8073 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8074 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8075 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8076 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8077 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8078 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8079 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8080 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8081
8082 Example:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 (gdb) info frame-filter
8086
8087 global frame-filters:
8088 Priority Enabled Name
8089 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8090 100 Yes Reverse
8091
8092 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8093 Priority Enabled Name
8094 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8095
8096 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8097 Priority Enabled Name
8098 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8099
8100 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8101 (gdb) info frame-filter
8102
8103 global frame-filters:
8104 Priority Enabled Name
8105 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8106 100 Yes Reverse
8107
8108 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8109 Priority Enabled Name
8110 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8111
8112 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8113 Priority Enabled Name
8114 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8115
8116 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8117 (gdb) info frame-filter
8118
8119 global frame-filters:
8120 Priority Enabled Name
8121 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8122 100 Yes Reverse
8123
8124 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8125 Priority Enabled Name
8126 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8127
8128 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8129 Priority Enabled Name
8130 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8131 @end smallexample
8132
8133 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8134 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8135 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8136 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8137 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8138 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8139 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8140
8141 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8142 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8143 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8144 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8145 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8146 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8147 dictionary resides.
8148
8149 Example:
8150
8151 @smallexample
8152 (gdb) info frame-filter
8153
8154 global frame-filters:
8155 Priority Enabled Name
8156 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8157 100 Yes Reverse
8158
8159 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8160 Priority Enabled Name
8161 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8162
8163 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8164 Priority Enabled Name
8165 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8166
8167 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8168 (gdb) info frame-filter
8169
8170 global frame-filters:
8171 Priority Enabled Name
8172 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8173 50 Yes Reverse
8174
8175 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8176 Priority Enabled Name
8177 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8178
8179 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8180 Priority Enabled Name
8181 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8182 @end smallexample
8183 @end table
8184
8185 @node Source
8186 @chapter Examining Source Files
8187
8188 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8189 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8190 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8191 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8192 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8193 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8194 source files by explicit command.
8195
8196 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8197 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8198 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8199
8200 @menu
8201 * List:: Printing source lines
8202 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8203 * Edit:: Editing source files
8204 * Search:: Searching source files
8205 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8206 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8207 @end menu
8208
8209 @node List
8210 @section Printing Source Lines
8211
8212 @kindex list
8213 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8214 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8215 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8216 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8217 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8218
8219 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8220
8221 @table @code
8222 @item list @var{linenum}
8223 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8224 current source file.
8225
8226 @item list @var{function}
8227 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8228 @var{function}.
8229
8230 @item list
8231 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8232 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8233 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8234 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8235 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8236
8237 @item list -
8238 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8239 @end table
8240
8241 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8242 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8243 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex set listsize
8247 @item set listsize @var{count}
8248 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8249 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8250 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8251 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8252
8253 @kindex show listsize
8254 @item show listsize
8255 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8256 @end table
8257
8258 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8259 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8260 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8261 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8262 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8263
8264 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8265 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8266 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8267 to specify some source line.
8268
8269 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8270
8271 @table @code
8272 @item list @var{location}
8273 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8274
8275 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8276 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8277 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8278 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8279 the same source file as the first location.
8280
8281 @item list ,@var{last}
8282 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8283
8284 @item list @var{first},
8285 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8286
8287 @item list +
8288 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8289
8290 @item list -
8291 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8292
8293 @item list
8294 As described in the preceding table.
8295 @end table
8296
8297 @node Specify Location
8298 @section Specifying a Location
8299 @cindex specifying location
8300 @cindex location
8301 @cindex source location
8302
8303 @menu
8304 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8305 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8306 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8307 @end menu
8308
8309 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8310 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8311 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8312 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8313 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8314
8315 @node Linespec Locations
8316 @subsection Linespec Locations
8317 @cindex linespec locations
8318
8319 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8320 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8321 specifying a linespec:
8322
8323 @table @code
8324 @item @var{linenum}
8325 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8326
8327 @item -@var{offset}
8328 @itemx +@var{offset}
8329 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8330 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8331 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8332 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8333 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8334 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8335 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8336 linespec.
8337
8338 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8339 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8340 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8341 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8342 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8343 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8344 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8345
8346 @item @var{function}
8347 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8348 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8349
8350 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8351 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8352 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8353 means in all packages.
8354
8355 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8356 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8357 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8358
8359 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8360 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8361 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8362 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8363
8364 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8365
8366 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8367 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8368
8369 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8370 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8371 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8372 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8373 functions in different source files.
8374
8375 @item @var{label}
8376 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8377 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8378 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8379 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8380
8381 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8382 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8383 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8384 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8385 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8386 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8387
8388 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8389 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8390 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8391 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8392 each one of those probes.
8393 @end table
8394
8395 @node Explicit Locations
8396 @subsection Explicit Locations
8397 @cindex explicit locations
8398
8399 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8400 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8401
8402 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8403 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8404 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8405 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8406 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8407
8408 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8409 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8410 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8411 the symbol table to know.
8412
8413 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8414 following table:
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @item -source @var{filename}
8418 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8419 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8420 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8421 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8422 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8423
8424 @item -function @var{function}
8425 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8426 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8427 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8428 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8429
8430 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8431 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8432 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8433 means in all packages.
8434
8435 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8436 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8437 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8438 breakpoint on both symbols.
8439
8440 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8441
8442 @item -qualified
8443
8444 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8445 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8446
8447 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8448 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8449 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8450
8451 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8452 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8453 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8454
8455 @item -label @var{label}
8456 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8457 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8458 selected stack frame.
8459
8460 @item -line @var{number}
8461 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8462 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8463 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8464 relative to the current line.
8465 @end table
8466
8467 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8468 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8469
8470 @node Address Locations
8471 @subsection Address Locations
8472 @cindex address locations
8473
8474 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8475 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8476
8477 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8478 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8479 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8480 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8481 source files.
8482
8483 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8484 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8485 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8486 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8487 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8488 of @var{address}:
8489
8490 @table @code
8491 @item @var{expression}
8492 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8493
8494 @item @var{funcaddr}
8495 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8496 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8497 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8498 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8499 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8500 (although the Pascal form also works).
8501
8502 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8503 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8504
8505 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8506 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8507 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8508 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8509 functions with identical names in different source files.
8510 @end table
8511
8512 @node Edit
8513 @section Editing Source Files
8514 @cindex editing source files
8515
8516 @kindex edit
8517 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8518 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8519 The editing program of your choice
8520 is invoked with the current line set to
8521 the active line in the program.
8522 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8523 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8524
8525 @table @code
8526 @item edit @var{location}
8527 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8528 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8529 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8530 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8531 command most commonly used:
8532
8533 @table @code
8534 @item edit @var{number}
8535 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8536
8537 @item edit @var{function}
8538 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8539 @end table
8540
8541 @end table
8542
8543 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8544 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8545 @footnote{
8546 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8547 following command-line syntax:
8548 @smallexample
8549 ex +@var{number} file
8550 @end smallexample
8551 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8552 the file where to start editing.}.
8553 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8554 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8555 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8556 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8557 @smallexample
8558 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8559 export EDITOR
8560 gdb @dots{}
8561 @end smallexample
8562 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8563 @smallexample
8564 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8565 gdb @dots{}
8566 @end smallexample
8567
8568 @node Search
8569 @section Searching Source Files
8570 @cindex searching source files
8571
8572 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8573 regular expression.
8574
8575 @table @code
8576 @kindex search
8577 @kindex forward-search
8578 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8579 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8580 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8581 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8582 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8583 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8584 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8585 @code{fo}.
8586
8587 @kindex reverse-search
8588 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8589 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8590 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8591 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8592 this command as @code{rev}.
8593 @end table
8594
8595 @node Source Path
8596 @section Specifying Source Directories
8597
8598 @cindex source path
8599 @cindex directories for source files
8600 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8601 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8602 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8603 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8604 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8605 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8606 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8607
8608 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8609 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8610 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8611 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8612 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8613 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8614 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8615 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8616 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8617 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8618 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8619
8620 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8621 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8622 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8623 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8624 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8625 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8626
8627 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8628 source files.
8629
8630 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8631 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8632 each line is in the file.
8633
8634 @kindex directory
8635 @kindex dir
8636 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8637 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8638 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8639
8640 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8641 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8642
8643 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8644 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8645 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8646 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8647 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8648 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8649 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8650 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8651 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8652 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8653 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8654 name to look up the sources.
8655
8656 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8657 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8658 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8659 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8660 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8661 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8662 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8663 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8664
8665 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8666 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8667 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8668 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8669 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8670 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8671 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8672
8673 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8674 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8675 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8676 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8677 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8678 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8679 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8680 command.
8681
8682 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8683 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8684 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8685 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8686 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8687 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8688 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8689
8690 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8691 @cindex default source path substitution
8692 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8693 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8694 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8695 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8696 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8697 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8698 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8699 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8700 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8701 together.
8702
8703 @table @code
8704 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8705 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8706 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8707 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8708 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8709 part of absolute file names) or
8710 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8711 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8712
8713 @kindex cdir
8714 @kindex cwd
8715 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8716 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8717 @cindex compilation directory
8718 @cindex current directory
8719 @cindex working directory
8720 @cindex directory, current
8721 @cindex directory, compilation
8722 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8723 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8724 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8725 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8726 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8727 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8728
8729 @item directory
8730 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8731
8732 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8733 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8734
8735 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8736 @kindex set directories
8737 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8738 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8739
8740 @item show directories
8741 @kindex show directories
8742 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8743
8744 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8745 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8746 @kindex set substitute-path
8747 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8748 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8749 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8750
8751 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8752 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8753
8754 @smallexample
8755 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8756 @end smallexample
8757
8758 @noindent
8759 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8760 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8761 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8762
8763 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8764 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8765 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8766 the substitution.
8767
8768 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8769
8770 @smallexample
8771 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8772 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8773 @end smallexample
8774
8775 @noindent
8776 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8777 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8778 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8779 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8780
8781
8782 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8783 @kindex unset substitute-path
8784 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8785 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8786 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8787
8788 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8789
8790 @item show substitute-path [path]
8791 @kindex show substitute-path
8792 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8793 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8794
8795 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8796 rules.
8797
8798 @end table
8799
8800 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8801 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8802 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8803
8804 @enumerate
8805 @item
8806 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8807
8808 @item
8809 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8810 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8811 directories in one command.
8812 @end enumerate
8813
8814 @node Machine Code
8815 @section Source and Machine Code
8816 @cindex source line and its code address
8817
8818 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8819 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8820 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8821 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8822 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8823 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8824 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8825 well as hex.
8826
8827 @table @code
8828 @kindex info line
8829 @item info line
8830 @itemx info line @var{location}
8831 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8832 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8833 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8834 information about the current source line is printed.
8835 @end table
8836
8837 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8838 the object code for the first line of function
8839 @code{m4_changequote}:
8840
8841 @smallexample
8842 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8843 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8844 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8845 @end smallexample
8846
8847 @noindent
8848 @cindex code address and its source line
8849 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8850 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8851 @smallexample
8852 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8853 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8854 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8855 @end smallexample
8856
8857 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8858 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8859 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8860 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8861 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8862 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8863 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8864 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8865 Variables}).
8866
8867 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8868 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8869 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8870 line.
8871
8872 @table @code
8873 @kindex disassemble
8874 @cindex assembly instructions
8875 @cindex instructions, assembly
8876 @cindex machine instructions
8877 @cindex listing machine instructions
8878 @item disassemble
8879 @itemx disassemble /m
8880 @itemx disassemble /s
8881 @itemx disassemble /r
8882 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8883 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8884 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8885 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8886 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8887 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8888 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8889 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8890 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8891 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8892
8893 @table @code
8894 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8895 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8896 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8897 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8898 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8899 @end table
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8903 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8904
8905 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8906 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8907
8908 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8909 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8910 @end table
8911
8912 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8913 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8914
8915 @smallexample
8916 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8917 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8918 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8919 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8920 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8921 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8922 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8923 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8924 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8925 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8926 End of assembler dump.
8927 @end smallexample
8928
8929 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8930 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8931 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8932
8933 @smallexample
8934 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8935 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8936 5 @{
8937 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8938 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8939 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8940 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8941 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8942
8943 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8944 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8945 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8946
8947 7 return 0;
8948 8 @}
8949 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8950 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8951 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8952
8953 End of assembler dump.
8954 @end smallexample
8955
8956 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8957 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8958 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8959 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8960 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8961 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8962 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8963 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8964 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8965
8966 @file{foo.h}:
8967
8968 @smallexample
8969 int
8970 foo (int a)
8971 @{
8972 if (a < 0)
8973 return a * 2;
8974 if (a == 0)
8975 return 1;
8976 return a + 10;
8977 @}
8978 @end smallexample
8979
8980 @file{foo.c}:
8981
8982 @smallexample
8983 #include "foo.h"
8984 volatile int x, y;
8985 int
8986 main ()
8987 @{
8988 x = foo (y);
8989 return 0;
8990 @}
8991 @end smallexample
8992
8993 @smallexample
8994 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8995 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8996 5 @{
8997
8998 6 x = foo (y);
8999 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9000 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9001
9002 7 return 0;
9003 8 @}
9004 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9005 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9006 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9007 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9008
9009 End of assembler dump.
9010 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9011 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9012 foo.c:
9013 5 @{
9014 6 x = foo (y);
9015 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9016
9017 foo.h:
9018 4 if (a < 0)
9019 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9020 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9021
9022 6 if (a == 0)
9023 7 return 1;
9024 8 return a + 10;
9025 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9026 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9027 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9028 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9029
9030 foo.c:
9031 6 x = foo (y);
9032 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9033
9034 7 return 0;
9035 8 @}
9036 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9037 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9038
9039 foo.h:
9040 5 return a * 2;
9041 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9042 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9043 End of assembler dump.
9044 @end smallexample
9045
9046 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9047
9048 @smallexample
9049 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9050 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9051 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9052 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9053 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9054 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9055 End of assembler dump.
9056 @end smallexample
9057
9058 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9059 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9060 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9061 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9062
9063 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9064 mnemonics or other syntax.
9065
9066 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9067 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9068 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9069 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9070 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @kindex set disassembler-options
9074 @cindex disassembler options
9075 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9076 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9077 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9078 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9079 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9080 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9081 The default value is the empty string.
9082
9083 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9084 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9085 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9086 and S/390.
9087
9088 @kindex show disassembler-options
9089 @item show disassembler-options
9090 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9091 @end table
9092
9093 @table @code
9094 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9095 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9096 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9097 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9098 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9099 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9100
9101 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9102 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9103 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9104 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9105
9106 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9107 @item show disassembly-flavor
9108 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9109 @end table
9110
9111 @table @code
9112 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9113 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9114 @item set disassemble-next-line
9115 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9116 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9117 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9118 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9119 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9120 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9121 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9122 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9123 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9124 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9125 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9126 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9127 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9128 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9129 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9130 instruction.
9131 @end table
9132
9133
9134 @node Data
9135 @chapter Examining Data
9136
9137 @cindex printing data
9138 @cindex examining data
9139 @kindex print
9140 @kindex inspect
9141 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9142 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9143 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9144 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9145 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9146 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9147
9148 @table @code
9149 @item print @var{expr}
9150 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9151 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9152 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9153 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9154 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9155 Formats}.
9156
9157 @item print
9158 @itemx print /@var{f}
9159 @cindex reprint the last value
9160 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9161 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9162 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9163 @end table
9164
9165 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9166 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9167 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9168
9169 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9170 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9171 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9172 Table}.
9173
9174 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9175 @kindex explore
9176 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9177 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9178 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9179 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9180 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9181 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9182 embedded in the higher level data types.
9183
9184 @table @code
9185 @item explore @var{arg}
9186 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9187 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9191 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9192 C program as
9193
9194 @smallexample
9195 struct SimpleStruct
9196 @{
9197 int i;
9198 double d;
9199 @};
9200
9201 struct ComplexStruct
9202 @{
9203 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9204 int arr[10];
9205 @};
9206 @end smallexample
9207
9208 @noindent
9209 followed by variable declarations as
9210
9211 @smallexample
9212 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9213 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9214 @end smallexample
9215
9216 @noindent
9217 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9218 @code{explore} command as follows.
9219
9220 @smallexample
9221 (gdb) explore cs
9222 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9223 the following fields:
9224
9225 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9226 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9227
9228 Enter the field number of choice:
9229 @end smallexample
9230
9231 @noindent
9232 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9233 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9234 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9235 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9236 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9237 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9238 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9239 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9243 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9244 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9245 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9246
9247 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9248 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9249
9250 Press enter to return to parent value:
9251 @end smallexample
9252
9253 @noindent
9254 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9255 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9256 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9257 to explore.
9258
9259 @smallexample
9260 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9261 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9262
9263 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9264
9265 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9266
9267 Press enter to return to parent value:
9268 @end smallexample
9269
9270 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9271 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9272 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9273 level data structure).
9274
9275 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9276 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9277 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9278 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9279 same example as above, your can explore the type
9280 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9281 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9282
9283 @smallexample
9284 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9285 @end smallexample
9286
9287 @noindent
9288 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9289 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9290 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9291 example.
9292
9293 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9294 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9295 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9296 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9297 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9298
9299 @table @code
9300 @item explore value @var{expr}
9301 @cindex explore value
9302 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9303 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9304 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9305 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9306 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9307
9308 @item explore type @var{arg}
9309 @cindex explore type
9310 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9311 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9312 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9313 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9314 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9315 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9316 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9317 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9318 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9319 @end table
9320
9321 @menu
9322 * Expressions:: Expressions
9323 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9324 * Variables:: Program variables
9325 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9326 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9327 * Memory:: Examining memory
9328 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9329 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9330 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9331 * Value History:: Value history
9332 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9333 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9334 * Registers:: Registers
9335 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9336 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9337 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9338 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9339 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9340 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9341 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9342 character set than GDB does
9343 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9344 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9345 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9346 @end menu
9347
9348 @node Expressions
9349 @section Expressions
9350
9351 @cindex expressions
9352 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9353 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9354 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9355 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9356 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9357 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9358 @ref{Compilation}.
9359
9360 @cindex arrays in expressions
9361 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9362 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9363 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9364 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9365 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9366 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9367
9368 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9369 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9370 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9371 languages.
9372
9373 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9374 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9375
9376 @cindex casts, in expressions
9377 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9378 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9379 at that address in memory.
9380 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9381
9382 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9383 to programming languages:
9384
9385 @table @code
9386 @item @@
9387 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9388 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9389
9390 @item ::
9391 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9392 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9393
9394 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9395 @cindex type casting memory
9396 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9397 @cindex casts, to view memory
9398 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9399 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9400 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9401 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9402 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9403 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9404 @end table
9405
9406 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9407 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9408 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9409
9410 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9411 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9412 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9413 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9414 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9415 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9416 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9417
9418 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9419 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9420 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9421 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9422 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9423 as well.
9424
9425 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9426 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9427 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9428 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9429 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9430 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9431 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9432 choices.
9433
9434 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9435 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9436 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9437
9438 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9439 @smallexample
9440 @group
9441 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9442 [0] cancel
9443 [1] all
9444 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9445 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9446 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9447 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9448 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9449 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9450 > 2 4 6
9451 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9452 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9453 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9454 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9455 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9456 breakpoints.
9457 (@value{GDBP})
9458 @end group
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 @table @code
9462 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9463 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9464 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9465
9466 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9467 is ambiguous.
9468
9469 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9470 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9471 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9472 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9473 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9474 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9475 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9476 in the use of the menu.
9477
9478 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9479 when an ambiguity is detected.
9480
9481 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9482 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9483
9484 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9485 @item show multiple-symbols
9486 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9487 @end table
9488
9489 @node Variables
9490 @section Program Variables
9491
9492 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9493 in your program.
9494
9495 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9496 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9497
9498 @itemize @bullet
9499 @item
9500 global (or file-static)
9501 @end itemize
9502
9503 @noindent or
9504
9505 @itemize @bullet
9506 @item
9507 visible according to the scope rules of the
9508 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9509 @end itemize
9510
9511 @noindent This means that in the function
9512
9513 @smallexample
9514 foo (a)
9515 int a;
9516 @{
9517 bar (a);
9518 @{
9519 int b = test ();
9520 bar (b);
9521 @}
9522 @}
9523 @end smallexample
9524
9525 @noindent
9526 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9527 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9528 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9529 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9530
9531 @cindex variable name conflict
9532 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9533 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9534 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9535 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9536 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9537 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9538 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9539
9540 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9541 @ifnotinfo
9542 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9543 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9544 @end ifnotinfo
9545 @smallexample
9546 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9547 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9548 @end smallexample
9549
9550 @noindent
9551 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9552 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9553 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9554 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9555
9556 @smallexample
9557 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9558 @end smallexample
9559
9560 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9561 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9562 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9563 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9564 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9565
9566 @smallexample
9567 void
9568 foo (int a)
9569 @{
9570 if (a < 10)
9571 bar (a);
9572 else
9573 process (a); /* Stop here */
9574 @}
9575
9576 int
9577 bar (int a)
9578 @{
9579 foo (a + 5);
9580 @}
9581 @end smallexample
9582
9583 @noindent
9584 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9585 here is what you might see
9586 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9587
9588 @smallexample
9589 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9590 $1 = 10
9591 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9592 $2 = 5
9593 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9594 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9595 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9596 $3 = 5
9597 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9598 $4 = 0
9599 @end smallexample
9600
9601 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9602 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9603 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9604 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9605 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9606
9607 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9608 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9609 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9610 @code{some_global}.
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9614 $1 = 23
9615 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9616 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9617 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9618 $2 = 27
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @cindex wrong values
9622 @cindex variable values, wrong
9623 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9624 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9625 @quotation
9626 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9627 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9628 scope, and just before exit.
9629 @end quotation
9630 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9631 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9632 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9633 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9634 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9635 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9636 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9637 variable definitions may be gone.
9638
9639 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9640 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9641 when compiling.
9642
9643 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9644 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9645 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9646 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9647 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9648 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9649 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9650
9651 @smallexample
9652 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9653 @end smallexample
9654
9655 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9656 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9657 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9658 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9659 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9660
9661 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9662 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9663 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9664 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9665
9666 @cindex no debug info variables
9667 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9668 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9669 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9670 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9671 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9672 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9673 example, in a C program:
9674
9675 @smallexample
9676 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9677 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9678 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9679 $1 = 3.14
9680 @end smallexample
9681
9682 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9683 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9684 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9685 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9686 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9687
9688 @smallexample
9689 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9690 29 i++;
9691 (gdb) next
9692 30 e (i);
9693 (gdb) print i
9694 $1 = 31
9695 (gdb) print i@@entry
9696 $2 = 30
9697 @end smallexample
9698
9699 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9700 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9701 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9702 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9703 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9704 For program code
9705
9706 @smallexample
9707 char var0[] = "A";
9708 signed char var1[] = "A";
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 You get during debugging
9712 @smallexample
9713 (gdb) print var0
9714 $1 = "A"
9715 (gdb) print var1
9716 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9717 @end smallexample
9718
9719 @node Arrays
9720 @section Artificial Arrays
9721
9722 @cindex artificial array
9723 @cindex arrays
9724 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9725 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9726 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9727 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9728 program.
9729
9730 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9731 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9732 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9733 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9734 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9735 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9736 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9737 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9738 example. If a program says
9739
9740 @smallexample
9741 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9742 @end smallexample
9743
9744 @noindent
9745 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9746
9747 @smallexample
9748 p *array@@len
9749 @end smallexample
9750
9751 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9752 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9753 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9754 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9755 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9756
9757 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9758 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9759 The value need not be in memory:
9760 @smallexample
9761 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9762 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9763 @end smallexample
9764
9765 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9766 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9767 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9768 @smallexample
9769 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9770 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9771 @end smallexample
9772
9773 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9774 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9775 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9776 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9777 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9778 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9779 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9780 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9781 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9782 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9783
9784 @smallexample
9785 set $i = 0
9786 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9787 @key{RET}
9788 @key{RET}
9789 @dots{}
9790 @end smallexample
9791
9792 @node Output Formats
9793 @section Output Formats
9794
9795 @cindex formatted output
9796 @cindex output formats
9797 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9798 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9799 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9800 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9801 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9802
9803 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9804 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9805 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9806 letters supported are:
9807
9808 @table @code
9809 @item x
9810 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9811 hexadecimal.
9812
9813 @item d
9814 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9815
9816 @item u
9817 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9818
9819 @item o
9820 Print as integer in octal.
9821
9822 @item t
9823 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9824 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9825 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9826 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9827
9828 @item a
9829 @cindex unknown address, locating
9830 @cindex locate address
9831 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9832 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9833 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9834
9835 @smallexample
9836 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9837 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9838 @end smallexample
9839
9840 @noindent
9841 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9842 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9843
9844 @item c
9845 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9846 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9847 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9848 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9849
9850 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9851 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9852 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9853 data.
9854
9855 @item f
9856 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9857 using typical floating point syntax.
9858
9859 @item s
9860 @cindex printing strings
9861 @cindex printing byte arrays
9862 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9863 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9864 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9865 natural types.
9866
9867 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9868 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9869 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9870 array.
9871
9872 @item z
9873 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9874 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9875 to the size of the integer type.
9876
9877 @item r
9878 @cindex raw printing
9879 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9880 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9881 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9882 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9883 pretty-printer which might exist.
9884 @end table
9885
9886 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9887
9888 @smallexample
9889 p/x $pc
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 @noindent
9893 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9894 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9895
9896 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9897 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9898 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9899
9900 @node Memory
9901 @section Examining Memory
9902
9903 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9904 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9905
9906 @cindex examining memory
9907 @table @code
9908 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9909 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9910 @itemx x @var{addr}
9911 @itemx x
9912 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9913 @end table
9914
9915 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9916 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9917 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9918 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9919 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9920
9921 @table @r
9922 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9923 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9924 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9925 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9926 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9927 @c 4.1.2.
9928
9929 @item @var{f}, the display format
9930 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9931 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9932 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9933 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9934 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9935
9936 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9937 The unit size is any of
9938
9939 @table @code
9940 @item b
9941 Bytes.
9942 @item h
9943 Halfwords (two bytes).
9944 @item w
9945 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9946 @item g
9947 Giant words (eight bytes).
9948 @end table
9949
9950 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9951 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9952 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9953 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9954 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9955 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9956 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9957 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9958 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9959 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9960 be altered.
9961
9962 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9963 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9964 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9965 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9966 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9967 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9968 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9969 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9970 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9971 a value from memory).
9972 @end table
9973
9974 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9975 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9976 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9977 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9978 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9979
9980 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9981 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9982 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9983
9984 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9985 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9986 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9987 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9988 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9989
9990 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9991 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9992 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9993 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9994 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9995 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9996 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9997 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9998 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9999
10000 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10001 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10002 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10003 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10004 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10005 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10006
10007 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10008 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10009 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10010 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10011 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10012 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10013 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10014
10015 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10016 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10017
10018 @smallexample
10019 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10020 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10021 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10022 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10023 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10024 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10028 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10029 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10030 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10031 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10032 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10033 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10034 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10035 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10036
10037 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10038 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10039 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10040
10041 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10042 @cindex addressable memory unit
10043 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10044 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10045 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10046 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10047 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10048 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10049 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10050 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10051 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10052
10053 @cindex remote memory comparison
10054 @cindex target memory comparison
10055 @cindex verify remote memory image
10056 @cindex verify target memory image
10057 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10058 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10059 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10060 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10061 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10062 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10063
10064 @table @code
10065 @kindex compare-sections
10066 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10067 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10068 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10069 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10070 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10071 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10072
10073 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10074 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10075 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10076 @end table
10077
10078 @node Auto Display
10079 @section Automatic Display
10080 @cindex automatic display
10081 @cindex display of expressions
10082
10083 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10084 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10085 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10086 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10087 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10088 The automatic display looks like this:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 2: foo = 38
10092 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 @noindent
10096 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10097 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10098 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10099 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10100 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10101 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10102
10103 @table @code
10104 @kindex display
10105 @item display @var{expr}
10106 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10107 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10108
10109 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10110
10111 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10112 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10113 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10114 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10115 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10116
10117 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10118 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10119 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10120 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10121 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10122 @end table
10123
10124 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10125 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10126 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10127
10128 @table @code
10129 @kindex delete display
10130 @kindex undisplay
10131 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10132 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10133 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10134 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10135 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10136 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10137 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10138
10139 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10140 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10141
10142 @kindex disable display
10143 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10144 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10145 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10146 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10147 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10148 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10149 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10150 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10151
10152 @kindex enable display
10153 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10154 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10155 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10156 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10157 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10158 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10159 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10160
10161 @item display
10162 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10163 done when your program stops.
10164
10165 @kindex info display
10166 @item info display
10167 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10168 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10169 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10170 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10171 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10172 @end table
10173
10174 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10175 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10176 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10177 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10178 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10179 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10180 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10181 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10182 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10183 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10184 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10185
10186 @node Print Settings
10187 @section Print Settings
10188
10189 @cindex format options
10190 @cindex print settings
10191 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10192 and symbols are printed.
10193
10194 @noindent
10195 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10196
10197 @table @code
10198 @kindex set print
10199 @item set print address
10200 @itemx set print address on
10201 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10202 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10203 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10204 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10205 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10206 @code{set print address on}:
10207
10208 @smallexample
10209 @group
10210 (@value{GDBP}) f
10211 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10212 at input.c:530
10213 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10214 @end group
10215 @end smallexample
10216
10217 @item set print address off
10218 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10219 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10220
10221 @smallexample
10222 @group
10223 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10224 (@value{GDBP}) f
10225 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10226 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10227 @end group
10228 @end smallexample
10229
10230 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10231 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10232 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10233 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10234
10235 @kindex show print
10236 @item show print address
10237 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10238 @end table
10239
10240 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10241 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10242 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10243 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10244 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10245 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10246 it prints a symbolic address:
10247
10248 @table @code
10249 @item set print symbol-filename on
10250 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10251 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10252 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10253 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10254
10255 @item set print symbol-filename off
10256 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10257 default.
10258
10259 @item show print symbol-filename
10260 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10261 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10262 @end table
10263
10264 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10265 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10266 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10267
10268 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10269 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10270
10271 @table @code
10272 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10273 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10274 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10275 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10276 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10277 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10278 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10279 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10280
10281 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10282 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10283 symbolic address.
10284 @end table
10285
10286 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10287 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10288 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10289 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10290 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10291 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10292 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10293 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10297 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10298 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10299 @end smallexample
10300
10301 @quotation
10302 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10303 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10304 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10305 @end quotation
10306
10307 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10308 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10309
10310 @table @code
10311 @item set print symbol on
10312 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10313 one exists.
10314
10315 @item set print symbol off
10316 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10317 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10318 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10319
10320 @item show print symbol
10321 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10322 address.
10323 @end table
10324
10325 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10326
10327 @table @code
10328 @item set print array
10329 @itemx set print array on
10330 @cindex pretty print arrays
10331 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10332 but uses more space. The default is off.
10333
10334 @item set print array off
10335 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10336
10337 @item show print array
10338 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10339 arrays.
10340
10341 @cindex print array indexes
10342 @item set print array-indexes
10343 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10344 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10345 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10346 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10347
10348 @item set print array-indexes off
10349 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10350
10351 @item show print array-indexes
10352 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10353 arrays.
10354
10355 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10356 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10357 @cindex number of array elements to print
10358 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10359 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10360 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10361 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10362 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10363 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10364 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10365 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10366
10367 @item show print elements
10368 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10369 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10370
10371 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10372 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10373 @cindex printing frame argument values
10374 @cindex print all frame argument values
10375 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10376 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10377 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10378 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10379 values are:
10380
10381 @table @code
10382 @item all
10383 The values of all arguments are printed.
10384
10385 @item scalars
10386 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10387 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10388 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10389 only scalar arguments are shown:
10390
10391 @smallexample
10392 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10393 at frame-args.c:23
10394 @end smallexample
10395
10396 @item none
10397 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10398 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10399
10400 @smallexample
10401 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10402 at frame-args.c:23
10403 @end smallexample
10404 @end table
10405
10406 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10407 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10408 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10409 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10410 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10411 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10412 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10413 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10414 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10415 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10416
10417 @item show print frame-arguments
10418 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10419
10420 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10421 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10422
10423 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10424 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10425 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10426 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10427 This is the default.
10428
10429 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10430 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10431
10432 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10433 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10434 @kindex set print entry-values
10435 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10436 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10437 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10438 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10439 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10440
10441 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10442 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10443 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10444 @code{no} setting.
10445
10446 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10447 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10448 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10449 this information.
10450
10451 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10452
10453 @table @code
10454 @item no
10455 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10456 point.
10457 @smallexample
10458 #0 equal (val=5)
10459 #0 different (val=6)
10460 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10461 #0 born (val=10)
10462 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10463 @end smallexample
10464
10465 @item only
10466 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10467 values are never printed.
10468 @smallexample
10469 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10470 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10471 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10472 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10473 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10474 @end smallexample
10475
10476 @item preferred
10477 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10478 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10479 value for such parameter.
10480 @smallexample
10481 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10482 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10483 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10484 #0 born (val=10)
10485 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 @item if-needed
10489 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10490 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10491 parameter.
10492 @smallexample
10493 #0 equal (val=5)
10494 #0 different (val=6)
10495 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10496 #0 born (val=10)
10497 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10498 @end smallexample
10499
10500 @item both
10501 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10502 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10503 optimizations.
10504 @smallexample
10505 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10506 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10507 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10508 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10509 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10510 @end smallexample
10511
10512 @item compact
10513 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10514 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10515 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10516 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10517 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10518 @smallexample
10519 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10520 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10521 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10522 #0 born (val=10)
10523 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10524 @end smallexample
10525
10526 @item default
10527 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10528 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10529 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10530 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10531 @smallexample
10532 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10533 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10534 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10535 #0 born (val=10)
10536 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10537 @end smallexample
10538 @end table
10539
10540 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10541 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10542
10543 @item show print entry-values
10544 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10545 entry.
10546
10547 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10548 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10549 @cindex repeated array elements
10550 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10551 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10552 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10553 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10554 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10555 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10556 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10557 is 10.
10558
10559 @item show print repeats
10560 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10561 elements.
10562
10563 @item set print null-stop
10564 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10565 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10566 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10567 contain only short strings.
10568 The default is off.
10569
10570 @item show print null-stop
10571 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10572 @sc{null} character.
10573
10574 @item set print pretty on
10575 @cindex print structures in indented form
10576 @cindex indentation in structure display
10577 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10578 per line, like this:
10579
10580 @smallexample
10581 @group
10582 $1 = @{
10583 next = 0x0,
10584 flags = @{
10585 sweet = 1,
10586 sour = 1
10587 @},
10588 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10589 @}
10590 @end group
10591 @end smallexample
10592
10593 @item set print pretty off
10594 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10595
10596 @smallexample
10597 @group
10598 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10599 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10600 @end group
10601 @end smallexample
10602
10603 @noindent
10604 This is the default format.
10605
10606 @item show print pretty
10607 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10608
10609 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10610 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10611 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10612 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10613 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10614 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10615 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10616 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10617
10618 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10619 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10620 international character sets, and is the default.
10621
10622 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10623 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10624
10625 @item set print union on
10626 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10627 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10628 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10629
10630 @item set print union off
10631 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10632 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10633 instead.
10634
10635 @item show print union
10636 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10637 structures and other unions.
10638
10639 For example, given the declarations
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10643 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10644 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10645 Bug_forms;
10646
10647 struct thing @{
10648 Species it;
10649 union @{
10650 Tree_forms tree;
10651 Bug_forms bug;
10652 @} form;
10653 @};
10654
10655 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10656 @end smallexample
10657
10658 @noindent
10659 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10660
10661 @smallexample
10662 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10663 @end smallexample
10664
10665 @noindent
10666 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10667
10668 @smallexample
10669 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10670 @end smallexample
10671
10672 @noindent
10673 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10674 and in Pascal.
10675 @end table
10676
10677 @need 1000
10678 @noindent
10679 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10680
10681 @table @code
10682 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10683 @item set print demangle
10684 @itemx set print demangle on
10685 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10686 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10687 linkage. The default is on.
10688
10689 @item show print demangle
10690 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10691
10692 @item set print asm-demangle
10693 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10694 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10695 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10696 The default is off.
10697
10698 @item show print asm-demangle
10699 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10700 or demangled form.
10701
10702 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10703 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10704 @kindex set demangle-style
10705 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10706 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
10707 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
10708 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
10709 decoding style by inspecting your program.
10710
10711 @item show demangle-style
10712 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10713
10714 @item set print object
10715 @itemx set print object on
10716 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10717 @cindex display derived types
10718 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10719 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10720 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10721 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10722 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10723 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10724 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10725
10726 @item set print object off
10727 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10728 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10729
10730 @item show print object
10731 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10732
10733 @item set print static-members
10734 @itemx set print static-members on
10735 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10736 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10737
10738 @item set print static-members off
10739 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10740
10741 @item show print static-members
10742 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10743
10744 @item set print pascal_static-members
10745 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10746 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10747 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10748 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10749
10750 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10751 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10752
10753 @item show print pascal_static-members
10754 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10755
10756 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10757 @item set print vtbl
10758 @itemx set print vtbl on
10759 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10760 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10761 @cindex VTBL display
10762 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10763 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10764 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10765
10766 @item set print vtbl off
10767 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10768
10769 @item show print vtbl
10770 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10771 @end table
10772
10773 @node Pretty Printing
10774 @section Pretty Printing
10775
10776 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10777 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10778 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10779
10780 @menu
10781 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10782 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10783 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10784 @end menu
10785
10786 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10787 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10788
10789 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10790 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10791 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10792
10793 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10794 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10795 pretty-printers with their names.
10796 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10797 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10798 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10799 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10800
10801 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10802 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10803 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10804 do anything special.
10805
10806 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10807
10808 @itemize @bullet
10809 @item
10810 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10811 all inferiors.
10812
10813 @item
10814 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10815 when debugging that program.
10816 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10817
10818 @item
10819 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10820 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10821 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10822 @end itemize
10823
10824 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10825 pretty-printers are selected,
10826
10827 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10828 for new types.
10829
10830 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10831 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10832
10833 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10834
10835 @smallexample
10836 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10837 $1 = @{
10838 static npos = 4294967295,
10839 _M_dataplus = @{
10840 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10841 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10842 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10843 @},
10844 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10845 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10846 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10847 @}
10848 @}
10849 @end smallexample
10850
10851 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10852
10853 @smallexample
10854 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10855 $2 = "abcd"
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10859 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10860 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10861
10862 @table @code
10863 @kindex info pretty-printer
10864 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10865 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10866 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10867
10868 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10869 whose pretty-printers to list.
10870 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10871 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10872 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10873 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10874 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10875
10876 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10877 to list.
10878
10879 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10880 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10881 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10882 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10883
10884 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10885 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10886 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10887 @end table
10888
10889 Example:
10890
10891 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10892 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10893 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10894 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10895
10896 @smallexample
10897 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10898 library1.so:
10899 foo
10900 library2.so:
10901 bar
10902 bar1
10903 bar2
10904 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10905 library2.so:
10906 bar
10907 bar1
10908 bar2
10909 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10910 1 printer disabled
10911 2 of 3 printers enabled
10912 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10913 library1.so:
10914 foo [disabled]
10915 library2.so:
10916 bar
10917 bar1
10918 bar2
10919 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10920 1 printer disabled
10921 1 of 3 printers enabled
10922 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10923 library1.so:
10924 foo [disabled]
10925 library2.so:
10926 bar
10927 bar1 [disabled]
10928 bar2
10929 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10930 1 printer disabled
10931 0 of 3 printers enabled
10932 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10933 library1.so:
10934 foo [disabled]
10935 library2.so:
10936 bar [disabled]
10937 bar1 [disabled]
10938 bar2
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10942 as can each individual subprinter.
10943
10944 @node Value History
10945 @section Value History
10946
10947 @cindex value history
10948 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10949 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10950 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10951 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10952 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10953 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10954 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10955 symbol table.
10956
10957 @cindex @code{$}
10958 @cindex @code{$$}
10959 @cindex history number
10960 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10961 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10962 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10963 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10964 history number.
10965
10966 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10967 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10968 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10969 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10970 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10971 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10972 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10973
10974 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10975 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10976
10977 @smallexample
10978 p *$
10979 @end smallexample
10980
10981 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10982 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10983
10984 @smallexample
10985 p *$.next
10986 @end smallexample
10987
10988 @noindent
10989 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10990 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10991
10992 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10993 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10994
10995 @smallexample
10996 print x
10997 set x=5
10998 @end smallexample
10999
11000 @noindent
11001 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11002 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11003
11004 @table @code
11005 @kindex show values
11006 @item show values
11007 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11008 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11009 values} does not change the history.
11010
11011 @item show values @var{n}
11012 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11013
11014 @item show values +
11015 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11016 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11017 @end table
11018
11019 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11020 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11021
11022 @node Convenience Vars
11023 @section Convenience Variables
11024
11025 @cindex convenience variables
11026 @cindex user-defined variables
11027 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11028 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11029 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11030 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11031 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11032
11033 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11034 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11035 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11036 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11037 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11038
11039 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11040 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11041 For example:
11042
11043 @smallexample
11044 set $foo = *object_ptr
11045 @end smallexample
11046
11047 @noindent
11048 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11049 @code{object_ptr}.
11050
11051 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11052 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11053 value with another assignment at any time.
11054
11055 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11056 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11057 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11058 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11059
11060 @table @code
11061 @kindex show convenience
11062 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11063 @item show convenience
11064 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11065 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11066 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11067
11068 @kindex init-if-undefined
11069 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11070 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11071 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11072 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11073 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11074 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11075 override default values used in a command script.
11076
11077 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11078 any side-effects do not occur.
11079 @end table
11080
11081 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11082 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11083 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11084
11085 @smallexample
11086 set $i = 0
11087 print bar[$i++]->contents
11088 @end smallexample
11089
11090 @noindent
11091 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11092
11093 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11094 values likely to be useful.
11095
11096 @table @code
11097 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11098 @item $_
11099 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11100 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11101 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11102 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11103 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11104 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11105 to the type of @code{$__}.
11106
11107 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11108 @item $__
11109 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11110 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11111 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11112
11113 @item $_exitcode
11114 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11115 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11116 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11117 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11118
11119 @item $_exitsignal
11120 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11121 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11122 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11123 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11124
11125 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11126 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11127 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11128 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11129 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11130
11131 @smallexample
11132 #include <signal.h>
11133
11134 int
11135 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11136 @{
11137 raise (SIGALRM);
11138 return 0;
11139 @}
11140 @end smallexample
11141
11142 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11143 or signalled would be:
11144
11145 @smallexample
11146 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11147 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11148 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11149 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11150 >echo The program has exited\n
11151 >else
11152 >echo The program has signalled\n
11153 >end
11154 >end
11155 (@value{GDBP}) run
11156 Starting program:
11157
11158 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11159 The program no longer exists.
11160 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11161 The program has signalled
11162 @end smallexample
11163
11164 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11165 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11166 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11167 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11168
11169 @smallexample
11170 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11171 The program has exited
11172 @end smallexample
11173
11174 @item $_exception
11175 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11176 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11177
11178 @item $_probe_argc
11179 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11180 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11181
11182 @item $_sdata
11183 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11184 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11185 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11186 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11187 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11188
11189 @item $_siginfo
11190 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11191 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11192 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11193 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11194 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11195
11196 @item $_tlb
11197 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11198 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11199 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11200 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11201 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11202 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11203
11204 @item $_inferior
11205 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11206 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11207
11208 @item $_thread
11209 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11210
11211 @item $_gthread
11212 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11213
11214 @end table
11215
11216 @node Convenience Funs
11217 @section Convenience Functions
11218
11219 @cindex convenience functions
11220 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11221 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11222 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11223 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11224 @value{GDBN}.
11225
11226 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11227 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11228
11229 @table @code
11230
11231 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11232 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11233 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11234 returns zero.
11235
11236 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11237 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11238 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11239 it is @code{void}:
11240
11241 @smallexample
11242 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11243 $1 = void
11244 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11245 $2 = 1
11246 (@value{GDBP}) run
11247 Starting program: ./a.out
11248 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11249 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11250 $3 = 0
11251 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11252 $4 = 0
11253 @end smallexample
11254
11255 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11256 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11257 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11258 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11259 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11260 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11261 anymore.
11262
11263 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11264 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11265
11266 @smallexample
11267 void
11268 foo (void)
11269 @{
11270 @}
11271 @end smallexample
11272
11273 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11274
11275 @smallexample
11276 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11277 $1 = void
11278 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11279 $2 = 1
11280 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11281 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11282 $3 = void
11283 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11284 $4 = 1
11285 @end smallexample
11286
11287 @end table
11288
11289 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11290 @code{Python} support.
11291
11292 @table @code
11293
11294 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11295 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11296 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11297 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11298 Otherwise it returns zero.
11299
11300 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11301 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11302 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11303 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11304 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11305 regular expression support.
11306
11307 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11308 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11309 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11310 Otherwise it returns zero.
11311
11312 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11313 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11314 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11315
11316 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11317 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11318 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11319 Otherwise it returns zero.
11320
11321 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11322 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11323 The default is 1.
11324
11325 Example:
11326
11327 @smallexample
11328 (gdb) backtrace
11329 #0 bottom_func ()
11330 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11331 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11332 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11333 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11334 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11335 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11336 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11337 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11338 $1 = 1
11339 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11340 $1 = 1
11341 @end smallexample
11342
11343 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11344 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11345 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11346 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11347
11348 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11349 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11350 The default is 1.
11351
11352 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11353 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11354 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11355 Otherwise it returns zero.
11356
11357 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11358 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11359 The default is 1.
11360
11361 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11362 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11363 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11364 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11365
11366 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11367 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11368 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11369 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11370
11371 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11372 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11373 The default is 1.
11374
11375 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11376 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11377 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11378 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11379
11380 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11381 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11382 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11383
11384 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11385 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11386 an enumerated type:
11387
11388 @smallexample
11389 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11390 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11391 @end smallexample
11392
11393 @end table
11394
11395 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11396 convenience functions.
11397
11398 @table @code
11399 @item help function
11400 @kindex help function
11401 @cindex show all convenience functions
11402 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11403 @end table
11404
11405 @node Registers
11406 @section Registers
11407
11408 @cindex registers
11409 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11410 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11411 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11412 your machine.
11413
11414 @table @code
11415 @kindex info registers
11416 @item info registers
11417 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11418 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11419
11420 @kindex info all-registers
11421 @cindex floating point registers
11422 @item info all-registers
11423 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11424 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11425
11426 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11427 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11428 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11429 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11430
11431 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11432 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11433 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11434 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11435 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11436 @end table
11437
11438 @anchor{standard registers}
11439 @cindex stack pointer register
11440 @cindex program counter register
11441 @cindex process status register
11442 @cindex frame pointer register
11443 @cindex standard registers
11444 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11445 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11446 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11447 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11448 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11449 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11450 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11451 you could print the program counter in hex with
11452
11453 @smallexample
11454 p/x $pc
11455 @end smallexample
11456
11457 @noindent
11458 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11459
11460 @smallexample
11461 x/i $pc
11462 @end smallexample
11463
11464 @noindent
11465 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11466 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11467 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11468 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11469 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11470 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11471 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11472
11473 @smallexample
11474 set $sp += 4
11475 @end smallexample
11476
11477 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11478 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11479 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11480 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11481 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11482 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11483 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11484
11485 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11486 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11487 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11488 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11489 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11490 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11491 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11492
11493 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11494 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11495 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11496 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11497 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11498 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11499 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11500 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11501 prints the data in both formats.
11502
11503 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11504 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11505 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11506 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11507 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11508 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11509 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11510
11511 @smallexample
11512 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11513 $1 = @{
11514 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11515 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11516 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11517 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11518 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11519 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11520 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11521 @}
11522 @end smallexample
11523
11524 @noindent
11525 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11526 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11527 value to a @code{struct} member:
11528
11529 @smallexample
11530 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11531 @end smallexample
11532
11533 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11534 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11535 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11536 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11537 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11538 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11539
11540 @cindex caller-saved registers
11541 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11542 @cindex volatile registers
11543 @cindex <not saved> values
11544 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11545 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11546 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11547 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11548 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11549 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11550 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11551 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11552 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11553 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11554 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11555 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11556 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11557 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11558 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11559 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11560 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11561 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11562 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11563 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11564 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11565 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11566 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11567
11568 @node Floating Point Hardware
11569 @section Floating Point Hardware
11570 @cindex floating point
11571
11572 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11573 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11574
11575 @table @code
11576 @kindex info float
11577 @item info float
11578 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11579 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11580 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11581 the ARM and x86 machines.
11582 @end table
11583
11584 @node Vector Unit
11585 @section Vector Unit
11586 @cindex vector unit
11587
11588 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11589 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11590
11591 @table @code
11592 @kindex info vector
11593 @item info vector
11594 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11595 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11596 @end table
11597
11598 @node OS Information
11599 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11600 @cindex OS information
11601
11602 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11603 you debug your program.
11604
11605 @cindex auxiliary vector
11606 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11607 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11608 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11609 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11610 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11611 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11612 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11613 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11614 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11615 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11616 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11617 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11618
11619 @table @code
11620 @kindex info auxv
11621 @item info auxv
11622 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11623 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11624 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11625 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11626 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11627 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11628 an unrecognized tag.
11629 @end table
11630
11631 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11632 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11633 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11634 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11635 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11636 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11637 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11638
11639 @table @code
11640 @kindex info os
11641 @item info os @var{infotype}
11642
11643 Display OS information of the requested type.
11644
11645 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11646
11647 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11648 @table @code
11649 @kindex info os cpus
11650 @item cpus
11651 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11652 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11653 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11654 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11655 kernel initialization.
11656
11657 @kindex info os files
11658 @item files
11659 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11660 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11661 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11662 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11663
11664 @kindex info os modules
11665 @item modules
11666 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11667 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11668 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11669 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11670 in memory.
11671
11672 @kindex info os msg
11673 @item msg
11674 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11675 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11676 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11677 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11678 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11679 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11680 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11681 the message queue was last changed.
11682
11683 @kindex info os processes
11684 @item processes
11685 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11686 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11687 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11688 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11689 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11690 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11691
11692 @kindex info os procgroups
11693 @item procgroups
11694 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11695 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11696 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11697 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11698 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11699 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11700 and the process group leader is listed first.
11701
11702 @kindex info os semaphores
11703 @item semaphores
11704 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11705 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11706 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11707 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11708 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11709
11710 @kindex info os shm
11711 @item shm
11712 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11713 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11714 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11715 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11716 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11717 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11718 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11719
11720 @kindex info os sockets
11721 @item sockets
11722 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11723 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11724 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11725 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11726 connection.
11727
11728 @kindex info os threads
11729 @item threads
11730 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11731 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11732 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11733 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11734 process is not listed.
11735 @end table
11736
11737 @item info os
11738 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11739 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11740 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11741 types, this command will report an error.
11742 @end table
11743
11744 @node Memory Region Attributes
11745 @section Memory Region Attributes
11746 @cindex memory region attributes
11747
11748 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11749 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11750 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11751 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11752 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11753 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11754 user can override the fetched regions.
11755
11756 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11757 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11758 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11759 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11760 all memory.
11761
11762 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11763 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11764
11765 @table @code
11766 @kindex mem
11767 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11768 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11769 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11770 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11771 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11772 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11773
11774 @item mem auto
11775 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11776 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11777
11778 @kindex delete mem
11779 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11780 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11781 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11782
11783 @kindex disable mem
11784 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11785 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11786 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11787 It may be enabled again later.
11788
11789 @kindex enable mem
11790 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11791 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11792
11793 @kindex info mem
11794 @item info mem
11795 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11796 for each region:
11797
11798 @table @emph
11799 @item Memory Region Number
11800 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11801 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11802 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11803
11804 @item Lo Address
11805 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11806
11807 @item Hi Address
11808 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11809
11810 @item Attributes
11811 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11812 @end table
11813 @end table
11814
11815
11816 @subsection Attributes
11817
11818 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11819 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11820 write accesses to a memory region.
11821
11822 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11823 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11824 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11825
11826 @table @code
11827 @item ro
11828 Memory is read only.
11829 @item wo
11830 Memory is write only.
11831 @item rw
11832 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11833 @end table
11834
11835 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11836 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11837 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11838 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11839 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11840
11841 @table @code
11842 @item 8
11843 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11844 @item 16
11845 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11846 @item 32
11847 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11848 @item 64
11849 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11850 @end table
11851
11852 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11853 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11854 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11855 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11856 @c
11857 @c @table @code
11858 @c @item hwbreak
11859 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11860 @c @item swbreak (default)
11861 @c @end table
11862
11863 @subsubsection Data Cache
11864 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11865 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11866 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11867 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11868 registers.
11869
11870 @table @code
11871 @item cache
11872 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11873 @item nocache
11874 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11875 @end table
11876
11877 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11878 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11879 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11880 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11881 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11882
11883 @table @code
11884 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11885 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11886 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11887 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11888 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11889 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11890 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11891 The default value is @code{on}.
11892 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11893 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11894 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11895 @end table
11896
11897
11898 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11899 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11900 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11901 @c
11902 @c @table @code
11903 @c @item verify
11904 @c @item noverify (default)
11905 @c @end table
11906
11907 @node Dump/Restore Files
11908 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11909 @cindex dump/restore files
11910 @cindex append data to a file
11911 @cindex dump data to a file
11912 @cindex restore data from a file
11913
11914 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11915 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11916 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11917 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11918 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11919 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11920 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11921
11922 @table @code
11923
11924 @kindex dump
11925 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11926 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11927 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11928 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11929
11930 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11931 @table @code
11932 @item binary
11933 Raw binary form.
11934 @item ihex
11935 Intel hex format.
11936 @item srec
11937 Motorola S-record format.
11938 @item tekhex
11939 Tektronix Hex format.
11940 @item verilog
11941 Verilog Hex format.
11942 @end table
11943
11944 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11945 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11946 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11947 form.
11948
11949 @kindex append
11950 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11951 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11952 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11953 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11954 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11955
11956 @kindex restore
11957 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11958 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11959 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11960 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11961 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11962
11963 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11964 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11965 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11966 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11967 from that location.
11968
11969 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11970 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11971 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11972 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11973
11974 @end table
11975
11976 @node Core File Generation
11977 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11978 @cindex dump core from inferior
11979
11980 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11981 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11982 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11983 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11984 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11985 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11986 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11987
11988 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11989 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11990 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11991
11992 @table @code
11993 @kindex gcore
11994 @kindex generate-core-file
11995 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11996 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11997 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11998 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11999 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12000 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12001
12002 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12003 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12004
12005 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12006 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12007 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12008 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12009 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12010
12011 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12012 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12013 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12014 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12015 Enable or disable the use of the file
12016 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12017 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12018 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12019 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12020
12021 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12022 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12023 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12024 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12025 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12026 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12027 about the bits that can be set in the
12028 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12029 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12030
12031 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12032 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12033 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12034 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12035 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12036 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12037 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12038 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12039
12040 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12041 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12042 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12043 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12044 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12045 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12046 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12047
12048 The default value is @code{off}.
12049 @end table
12050
12051 @node Character Sets
12052 @section Character Sets
12053 @cindex character sets
12054 @cindex charset
12055 @cindex translating between character sets
12056 @cindex host character set
12057 @cindex target character set
12058
12059 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12060 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12061 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12062 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12063 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12064 @dfn{target character set}.
12065
12066 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12067 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12068 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12069 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12070 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12071 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12072 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12073 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12074 character and string literals in expressions.
12075
12076 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12077 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12078 target-charset} command, described below.
12079
12080 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12081 support:
12082
12083 @table @code
12084 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12085 @kindex set target-charset
12086 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12087 list of supported target character sets, type
12088 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12089
12090 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12091 @kindex set host-charset
12092 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12093
12094 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12095 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12096 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12097 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12098 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12099
12100 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12101 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12102 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12103
12104 @item set charset @var{charset}
12105 @kindex set charset
12106 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12107 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12108 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12109 for both host and target.
12110
12111 @item show charset
12112 @kindex show charset
12113 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12114
12115 @item show host-charset
12116 @kindex show host-charset
12117 Show the name of the current host character set.
12118
12119 @item show target-charset
12120 @kindex show target-charset
12121 Show the name of the current target character set.
12122
12123 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12124 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12125 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12126 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12127 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12128 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12129
12130 @item show target-wide-charset
12131 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12132 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12133 @end table
12134
12135 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12136 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12137 @file{charset-test.c}:
12138
12139 @smallexample
12140 #include <stdio.h>
12141
12142 char ascii_hello[]
12143 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12144 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12145 char ibm1047_hello[]
12146 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12147 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12148
12149 main ()
12150 @{
12151 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12152 @}
12153 @end smallexample
12154
12155 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12156 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12157 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12158
12159 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12160
12161 @smallexample
12162 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12163 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12164 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12165 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12166 @dots{}
12167 (@value{GDBP})
12168 @end smallexample
12169
12170 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12171 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12172 strings:
12173
12174 @smallexample
12175 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12176 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12177 (@value{GDBP})
12178 @end smallexample
12179
12180 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12181 initial character set:
12182 @smallexample
12183 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12184 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12185 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12186 (@value{GDBP})
12187 @end smallexample
12188
12189 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12190 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12191 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12192 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12193 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12194
12195 @smallexample
12196 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12197 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12198 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12199 $2 = 72 'H'
12200 (@value{GDBP})
12201 @end smallexample
12202
12203 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12204 literals you use in expressions:
12205
12206 @smallexample
12207 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12208 $3 = 43 '+'
12209 (@value{GDBP})
12210 @end smallexample
12211
12212 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12213 character.
12214
12215 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12216 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12217 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12218
12219 @smallexample
12220 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12221 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12222 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12223 $5 = 200 '\310'
12224 (@value{GDBP})
12225 @end smallexample
12226
12227 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12228 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12229
12230 @smallexample
12231 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12232 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12233 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12234 @end smallexample
12235
12236 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12237 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12238 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12239 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12240 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12241
12242 @smallexample
12243 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12244 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12245 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12246 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12247 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12248 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12249 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12250 $7 = 72 '\110'
12251 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12252 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12253 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12254 $9 = 200 'H'
12255 (@value{GDBP})
12256 @end smallexample
12257
12258 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12259 string literals you use in expressions:
12260
12261 @smallexample
12262 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12263 $10 = 78 '+'
12264 (@value{GDBP})
12265 @end smallexample
12266
12267 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12268 character.
12269
12270 @node Caching Target Data
12271 @section Caching Data of Targets
12272 @cindex caching data of targets
12273
12274 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12275 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12276 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12277 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12278 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12279 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12280 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12281 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12282 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12283 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12284 is executing.
12285 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12286 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12287 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12288 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12289 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12290 in the code segment.
12291 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12292 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12293
12294 @table @code
12295 @kindex set remotecache
12296 @item set remotecache on
12297 @itemx set remotecache off
12298 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12299 with old scripts.
12300
12301 @kindex show remotecache
12302 @item show remotecache
12303 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12304
12305 @kindex set stack-cache
12306 @item set stack-cache on
12307 @itemx set stack-cache off
12308 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12309 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12310
12311 @kindex show stack-cache
12312 @item show stack-cache
12313 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12314
12315 @kindex set code-cache
12316 @item set code-cache on
12317 @itemx set code-cache off
12318 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12319 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12320 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12321
12322 @kindex show code-cache
12323 @item show code-cache
12324 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12325 accesses.
12326
12327 @kindex info dcache
12328 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12329 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12330 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12331 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12332 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12333 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12334
12335 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12336 printed in hex.
12337
12338 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12339 @cindex dcache size
12340 @kindex set dcache size
12341 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12342
12343 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12344 @cindex dcache line-size
12345 @kindex set dcache line-size
12346 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12347 Must be a power of 2.
12348
12349 @item show dcache size
12350 @kindex show dcache size
12351 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12352
12353 @item show dcache line-size
12354 @kindex show dcache line-size
12355 Show default size of dcache lines.
12356
12357 @end table
12358
12359 @node Searching Memory
12360 @section Search Memory
12361 @cindex searching memory
12362
12363 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12364 @code{find} command.
12365
12366 @table @code
12367 @kindex find
12368 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12369 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12370 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12371 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12372 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12373 @end table
12374
12375 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12376 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12377
12378 @table @r
12379 @item @var{s}, search query size
12380 The size of each search query value.
12381
12382 @table @code
12383 @item b
12384 bytes
12385 @item h
12386 halfwords (two bytes)
12387 @item w
12388 words (four bytes)
12389 @item g
12390 giant words (eight bytes)
12391 @end table
12392
12393 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12394 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12395 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12396 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12397 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12398
12399 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12400 value's type in the current language.
12401 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12402 pattern as a mixture of types.
12403 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12404 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12405 which is typically four bytes.
12406
12407 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12408 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12409 @end table
12410
12411 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12412 (@code{"}).
12413 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12414 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12415
12416 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12417 number of matches found.
12418
12419 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12420 @samp{$_}.
12421 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12422
12423 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12424
12425 @smallexample
12426 void
12427 hello ()
12428 @{
12429 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12430 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12431 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12432 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12433 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12434 @}
12435 @end smallexample
12436
12437 @noindent
12438 you get during debugging:
12439
12440 @smallexample
12441 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12442 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12443 1 pattern found
12444 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12445 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12446 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12447 2 patterns found.
12448 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12449 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12450 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12451 2 patterns found.
12452 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12453 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12454 1 pattern found
12455 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12456 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12457 1 pattern found
12458 (gdb) print $numfound
12459 $1 = 1
12460 (gdb) print $_
12461 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12462 @end smallexample
12463
12464 @node Value Sizes
12465 @section Value Sizes
12466
12467 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12468 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12469 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12470 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12471 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12472
12473 @table @code
12474 @kindex set max-value-size
12475 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12476 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12477 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12478 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12479 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12480
12481 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12482 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12483
12484 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12485 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12486 currently 16 bytes.
12487
12488 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12489 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12490 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12491 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12492 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12493 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12494 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12495 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12496
12497 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12498
12499 @kindex show max-value-size
12500 @item show max-value-size
12501 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12502 allocate for the contents of a value.
12503 @end table
12504
12505 @node Optimized Code
12506 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12507 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12508 @cindex debugging optimized code
12509
12510 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12511 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12512 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12513 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12514 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12515 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12516 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12517
12518 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12519 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12520 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12521 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12522
12523 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12524 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12525 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12526 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12527 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12528 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12529
12530 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12531 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12532 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12533 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12534 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12535
12536 @menu
12537 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12538 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12539 @end menu
12540
12541 @node Inline Functions
12542 @section Inline Functions
12543 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12544
12545 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12546 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12547 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12548 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12549 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12550 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12551 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12552 @code{info frame} command.
12553
12554 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12555 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12556 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12557 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12558 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12559 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12560 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12561 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12562 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12563 local variables in the caller.
12564
12565 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12566 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12567 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12568 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12569 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12570 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12571 instructions are executed.
12572
12573 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12574 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12575 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12576 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12577
12578 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12579 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12580
12581 @itemize @bullet
12582 @item
12583 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12584 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12585 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12586 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12587 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12588 or inside the inlined function instead.
12589
12590 @item
12591 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12592 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12593 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12594 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12595
12596 @end itemize
12597
12598 @node Tail Call Frames
12599 @section Tail Call Frames
12600 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12601
12602 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12603 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12604 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12605 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12606 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12607
12608 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12609 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12610 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12611 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12612 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12613 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12614 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12615
12616 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12617 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12618 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12619 this information.
12620
12621 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12622 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12623
12624 @smallexample
12625 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12626 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12627 (gdb) info frame
12628 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12629 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12630 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12631 source language c++.
12632 Arglist at unknown address.
12633 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12634 @end smallexample
12635
12636 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12637 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12638 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12639 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12640 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12641 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12642
12643 @table @code
12644 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12645 @item set debug entry-values
12646 @kindex set debug entry-values
12647 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12648 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12649 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12650 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12651 result.
12652
12653 @item show debug entry-values
12654 @kindex show debug entry-values
12655 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12656 values at function entry and tail calls.
12657 @end table
12658
12659 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12660 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12661 reference by variable @code{x}):
12662
12663 @smallexample
12664 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12665 void (*x) (void) = c;
12666 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12667 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12668 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12669
12670 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12671 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12672 a () at t.c:3
12673 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12674 (gdb) bt
12675 #0 a () at t.c:3
12676 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12677 @end smallexample
12678
12679 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12680
12681 @smallexample
12682 int i;
12683 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12684 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12685 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12686 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12687 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12688 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12689 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12690 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12691
12692 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12693 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12694 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12695 (gdb) bt
12696 #0 f () at t.c:2
12697 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12698 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12699 @end smallexample
12700
12701 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12702 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12703
12704 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12705 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12706 @set ARROW @click{}
12707 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12708 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12709 @end ifset
12710 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12711 @set ARROW ->
12712 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12713 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12714 @end ifclear
12715
12716 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12717 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12718 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12719
12720 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12721 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12722 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12723 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12724 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12725 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12726
12727 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12728 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12729 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12730 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12731 omitted.
12732
12733 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12734 entry may fail:
12735
12736 @smallexample
12737 int v;
12738 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12739 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12740 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12741 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12742 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12743 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12744
12745 (gdb) bt
12746 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12747 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12748 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12749 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12750 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12751 @end smallexample
12752
12753 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12754 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12755 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12756 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12757 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12758
12759 @node Macros
12760 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12761
12762 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12763 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12764 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12765 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12766 where it was defined.
12767
12768 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12769 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12770 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12771 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12772
12773 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12774 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12775 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12776 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12777 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12778 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12779 see @ref{List}.
12780
12781 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12782 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12783 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12784
12785 @table @code
12786
12787 @kindex macro expand
12788 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12789 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12790 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12791 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12792 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12793 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12794 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12795 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12796 it can be any string of tokens.
12797
12798 @kindex macro exp1
12799 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12800 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12801 @cindex expand macro once
12802 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12803 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12804 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12805 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12806 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12807 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12808 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12809 can be any string of tokens.
12810
12811 @kindex info macro
12812 @cindex macro definition, showing
12813 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12814 @cindex macros, from debug info
12815 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12816 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12817 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12818 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12819 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12820 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12821
12822 @kindex info macros
12823 @item info macros @var{location}
12824 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12825 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12826 command-line where those definitions were established.
12827
12828 @kindex macro define
12829 @cindex user-defined macros
12830 @cindex defining macros interactively
12831 @cindex macros, user-defined
12832 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12833 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12834 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12835 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12836 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12837 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12838 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12839 @var{arglist}.
12840
12841 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12842 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12843 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12844 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12845 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12846
12847 @kindex macro undef
12848 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12849 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12850 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12851 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12852 in the program being debugged.
12853
12854 @kindex macro list
12855 @item macro list
12856 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12857 @end table
12858
12859 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12860 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12861 show our source files:
12862
12863 @smallexample
12864 $ cat sample.c
12865 #include <stdio.h>
12866 #include "sample.h"
12867
12868 #define M 42
12869 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12870
12871 main ()
12872 @{
12873 #define N 28
12874 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12875 #undef N
12876 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12877 #define N 1729
12878 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12879 @}
12880 $ cat sample.h
12881 #define Q <
12882 $
12883 @end smallexample
12884
12885 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12886 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12887 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12888 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12889 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12890 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12891 information.
12892
12893 @smallexample
12894 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12895 $
12896 @end smallexample
12897
12898 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12899
12900 @smallexample
12901 $ gdb -nw sample
12902 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12903 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12904 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12905 (@value{GDBP})
12906 @end smallexample
12907
12908 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12909 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12910 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12911
12912 @smallexample
12913 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12914 3
12915 4 #define M 42
12916 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12917 6
12918 7 main ()
12919 8 @{
12920 9 #define N 28
12921 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12922 11 #undef N
12923 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12924 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12925 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12926 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12927 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12928 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12929 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12930 #define Q <
12931 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12932 expands to: (42 + 1)
12933 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12934 expands to: once (M + 1)
12935 (@value{GDBP})
12936 @end smallexample
12937
12938 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12939 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12940 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12941 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12942
12943 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12944 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12945
12946 @smallexample
12947 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12948 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12949 (@value{GDBP}) run
12950 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12951
12952 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12953 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12954 (@value{GDBP})
12955 @end smallexample
12956
12957 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12958
12959 @smallexample
12960 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12961 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12962 #define N 28
12963 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12964 expands to: 28 < 42
12965 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12966 $1 = 1
12967 (@value{GDBP})
12968 @end smallexample
12969
12970 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12971 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12972 thereof) in force at each point:
12973
12974 @smallexample
12975 (@value{GDBP}) next
12976 Hello, world!
12977 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12978 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12979 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12980 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12981 (@value{GDBP}) next
12982 We're so creative.
12983 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12984 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12985 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12986 #define N 1729
12987 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12988 expands to: 1729 < 42
12989 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12990 $2 = 0
12991 (@value{GDBP})
12992 @end smallexample
12993
12994 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12995 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12996 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12997 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12998
12999 @smallexample
13000 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13001 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13002 -D__STDC__=1
13003 (@value{GDBP})
13004 @end smallexample
13005
13006
13007 @node Tracepoints
13008 @chapter Tracepoints
13009 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13010 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13011
13012 @cindex tracepoints
13013 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13014 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13015 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13016 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13017 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13018 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13019 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13020
13021 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13022 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13023 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13024 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13025 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13026 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13027 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13028 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13029 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13030 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13031 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13032
13033 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13034 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13035 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13036 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13037 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13038 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13039 Packets}.
13040
13041 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13042 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13043 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13044
13045 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13046
13047 @menu
13048 * Set Tracepoints::
13049 * Analyze Collected Data::
13050 * Tracepoint Variables::
13051 * Trace Files::
13052 @end menu
13053
13054 @node Set Tracepoints
13055 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13056
13057 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13058 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13059 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13060 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13061 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13062 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13063 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13064
13065 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13066 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13067 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13068 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13069 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13070 tracepoint was hit.
13071
13072 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13073 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13074 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13075 either.
13076
13077 @cindex fast tracepoints
13078 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13079 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13080 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13081
13082 @cindex static tracepoints
13083 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13084 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13085 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13086 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13087 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13088 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13089 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13090 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13091 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13092 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13093 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13094 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13095 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13096 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13097 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13098 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13099 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13100 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13101 static tracepoint marker.
13102
13103 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13104 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13105
13106 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13107 conditions and actions.
13108
13109 @menu
13110 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13111 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13112 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13113 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13114 * Trace State Variables::
13115 * Tracepoint Actions::
13116 * Listing Tracepoints::
13117 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13118 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13119 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13120 @end menu
13121
13122 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13123 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13124
13125 @table @code
13126 @cindex set tracepoint
13127 @kindex trace
13128 @item trace @var{location}
13129 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13130 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13131 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13132 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13133 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13134 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13135 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13136 in tracing}).
13137 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13138 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13139 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13140 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13141 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13142 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13143 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13144 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13145 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13146 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13147 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13148 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13149
13150 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13151
13152 @smallexample
13153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13154
13155 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13156
13157 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13158
13159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13160
13161 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13162 @end smallexample
13163
13164 @noindent
13165 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13166
13167 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13168 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13169 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13170 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13171 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13172 information on tracepoint conditions.
13173
13174 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13175 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13176 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13177 @kindex ftrace
13178 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13179 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13180 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13181 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13182 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13183 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13184 message.
13185
13186 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13187 @code{trace}.
13188
13189 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13190 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13191 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13192 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13193 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13194 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13195 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13196 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13197
13198 @example
13199 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13200 @end example
13201
13202 @noindent
13203 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13204 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13205
13206 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13207 @cindex set static tracepoint
13208 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13209 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13210 @kindex strace
13211 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13212 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13213 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13214 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13215 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13216
13217 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13218 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13219 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13220 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13221 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13222 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13223 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13224 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13225 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13226 tracing engine:
13227
13228 @smallexample
13229 main ()
13230 @{
13231 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13232 @}
13233 @end smallexample
13234
13235 @noindent
13236 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13237 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13238
13239 @smallexample
13240 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13241 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13242 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13243 Data: "str %s"
13244 [etc...]
13245 @end smallexample
13246
13247 @noindent
13248 so you may probe the marker above with:
13249
13250 @smallexample
13251 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13252 @end smallexample
13253
13254 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13255 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13256 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13257 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13258 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13259 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13260 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13261 the @samp{Data:} field.
13262
13263 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13264 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13265 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13266
13267 @vindex $tpnum
13268 @cindex last tracepoint number
13269 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13270 @cindex tracepoint number
13271 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13272 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13273
13274 @kindex delete tracepoint
13275 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13276 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13277 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13278 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13279 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13280
13281 Examples:
13282
13283 @smallexample
13284 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13285
13286 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13287 @end smallexample
13288
13289 @noindent
13290 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13291 @end table
13292
13293 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13294 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13295
13296 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13297
13298 @table @code
13299 @kindex disable tracepoint
13300 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13301 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13302 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13303 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13304 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13305 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13306 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13307 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13308 next trace experiment.
13309
13310 @kindex enable tracepoint
13311 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13312 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13313 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13314 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13315 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13316 next time a trace experiment is run.
13317 @end table
13318
13319 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13320 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13321
13322 @table @code
13323 @kindex passcount
13324 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13325 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13326 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13327 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13328 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13329 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13330 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13331 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13332 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13333 user.
13334
13335 Examples:
13336
13337 @smallexample
13338 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13339 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13340
13341 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13342 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13343 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13344 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13345 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13346 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13347 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13348 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13349 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13350 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13351 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13352 @end smallexample
13353 @end table
13354
13355 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13356 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13357 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13358 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13359
13360 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13361 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13362 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13363 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13364 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13365 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13366 is true.
13367
13368 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13369 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13370 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13371 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13372 just as with breakpoints.
13373
13374 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13375 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13376 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13377 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13378 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13379 accesses, and so forth.
13380
13381 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13382 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13383 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13384 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13385 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13386 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13387 search through.
13388
13389 @smallexample
13390 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13391 @end smallexample
13392
13393 @node Trace State Variables
13394 @subsection Trace State Variables
13395 @cindex trace state variables
13396
13397 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13398 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13399 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13400 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13401 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13402 integers.
13403
13404 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13405 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13406 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13407 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13408
13409 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13410 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13411 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13412 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13413 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13414 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13415 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13416 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13417 variable with the same name.
13418
13419 @table @code
13420
13421 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13422 @kindex tvariable
13423 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13424 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13425 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13426 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13427 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13428 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13429 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13430 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13431 value. The default initial value is 0.
13432
13433 @item info tvariables
13434 @kindex info tvariables
13435 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13436 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13437 currently running.
13438
13439 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13440 @kindex delete tvariable
13441 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13442 are specified.
13443
13444 @end table
13445
13446 @node Tracepoint Actions
13447 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13448
13449 @table @code
13450 @kindex actions
13451 @cindex tracepoint actions
13452 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13453 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13454 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13455 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13456 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13457 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13458 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13459 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13460 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13461 @code{while-stepping}.
13462
13463 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13464 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13465 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13466
13467 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13468 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13469 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13470
13471 @smallexample
13472 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13473
13474 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13475
13476 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13477 @end smallexample
13478
13479 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13480 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13481 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13482 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13483 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13484 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13485 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13486 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13487
13488 @smallexample
13489 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13490 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13491 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13492 > collect bar,baz
13493 > collect $regs
13494 > while-stepping 12
13495 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13496 > end
13497 end
13498 @end smallexample
13499
13500 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13501 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13502 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13503 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13504 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13505 special arguments are supported:
13506
13507 @table @code
13508 @item $regs
13509 Collect all registers.
13510
13511 @item $args
13512 Collect all function arguments.
13513
13514 @item $locals
13515 Collect all local variables.
13516
13517 @item $_ret
13518 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13519 of a backtrace.
13520
13521 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13522 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13523 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13524 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13525 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13526 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13527
13528 @item $_probe_argc
13529 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13530 tracepoint is located.
13531 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13532
13533 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13534 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13535 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13536 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13537
13538 @item $_sdata
13539 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13540 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13541 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13542 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13543 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13544 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13545 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13546 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13547 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13548
13549 @smallexample
13550 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13551 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13552 @end smallexample
13553
13554 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13555 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13556 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13557 @value{GDBN}.
13558 @end table
13559
13560 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13561 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13562 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13563
13564 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13565 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13566 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13567 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13568 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13569 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13570 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13571 @samp{mystr}.
13572
13573 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13574 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13575
13576 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13577 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13578 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13579 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13580 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13581 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13582 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13583 action were used.
13584
13585 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13586 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13587 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13588 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13589 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13590 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13591
13592 @smallexample
13593 > while-stepping 12
13594 > collect $regs, myglobal
13595 > end
13596 >
13597 @end smallexample
13598
13599 @noindent
13600 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13601 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13602 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13603 @code{stepping}.
13604
13605 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13606 @kindex set default-collect
13607 @cindex default collection action
13608 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13609 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13610 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13611 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13612 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13613 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13614
13615 @item show default-collect
13616 @kindex show default-collect
13617 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13618 tracepoint hit.
13619
13620 @end table
13621
13622 @node Listing Tracepoints
13623 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13624
13625 @table @code
13626 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13627 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13628 @cindex information about tracepoints
13629 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13630 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13631 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13632 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13633 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13634 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13635
13636 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13637 tracing:
13638
13639 @itemize @bullet
13640 @item
13641 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13642
13643 @item
13644 the state about installed on target of each location
13645 @end itemize
13646
13647 @smallexample
13648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13649 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13650 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13651 while-stepping 20
13652 collect globfoo, $regs
13653 end
13654 collect globfoo2
13655 end
13656 pass count 1200
13657 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13658 collect $eip
13659 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13660 installed on target
13661 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13662 installed on target
13663 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13664 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13665 not installed on target
13666 (@value{GDBP})
13667 @end smallexample
13668
13669 @noindent
13670 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13671 @end table
13672
13673 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13674 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13675
13676 @table @code
13677 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13678 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13679 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13680 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13681 program.
13682
13683 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13684
13685 @table @emph
13686 @item Count
13687 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13688 stable identifier.
13689 @item ID
13690 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13691 @item Enabled or Disabled
13692 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13693 that are not enabled.
13694 @item Address
13695 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13696 @item What
13697 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13698 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13699 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13700 will be left blank.
13701 @end table
13702
13703 @noindent
13704 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13705
13706 @table @emph
13707 @item Data
13708 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13709 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13710 marker call.
13711 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13712 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13713 @end table
13714
13715 @smallexample
13716 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13717 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13718 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13719 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13720 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13721 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13722 Data: str %s
13723 (@value{GDBP})
13724 @end smallexample
13725 @end table
13726
13727 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13728 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13729
13730 @table @code
13731 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13732 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13733 @cindex collected data discarded
13734 @item tstart
13735 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13736 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13737 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13738 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13739 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13740 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13741 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13742 information, and so forth.
13743
13744 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13745 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13746 @item tstop
13747 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13748 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13749 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13750 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13751 needs to be stopped quickly.
13752
13753 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13754 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13755 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13756
13757 @kindex tstatus
13758 @cindex status of trace data collection
13759 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13760 @item tstatus
13761 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13762 collection.
13763 @end table
13764
13765 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13766
13767 @smallexample
13768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13769 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13770 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13771 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13772 > while-stepping 11
13773 > collect $regs
13774 > end
13775 > end
13776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13777 [time passes @dots{}]
13778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13779 @end smallexample
13780
13781 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13782 @cindex disconnected tracing
13783 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13784 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13785 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13786 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13787 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13788 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13789 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13790 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13791
13792 @table @code
13793 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13794 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13795 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13796 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13797 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13798 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13799 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13800 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13801
13802 @item show disconnected-tracing
13803 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13804 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13805
13806 @end table
13807
13808 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13809 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13810 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13811 it will continue after reconnection.
13812
13813 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13814 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13815 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13816 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13817 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13818 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13819 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13820 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13821 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13822 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13823
13824 @cindex circular trace buffer
13825 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13826 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13827 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13828 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13829 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13830 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13831 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13832 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13833 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13834 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13835 the next run.
13836
13837 @table @code
13838 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13839 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13840 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13841 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13842 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13843 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13844 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13845
13846 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13847 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13848 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13849 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13850 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13851 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13852
13853 @end table
13854
13855 @table @code
13856 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13857 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13858 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13859 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13860 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13861 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13862 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13863 likes. This is also the default.
13864
13865 @item show trace-buffer-size
13866 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13867 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13868 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13869 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13870 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13871 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13872 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13873 @end table
13874
13875 @table @code
13876 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13877 @kindex set trace-user
13878
13879 @item show trace-user
13880 @kindex show trace-user
13881
13882 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13883 @kindex set trace-notes
13884 Set the trace run's notes.
13885
13886 @item show trace-notes
13887 @kindex show trace-notes
13888 Show the trace run's notes.
13889
13890 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13891 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13892 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13893 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13894 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13895
13896 @item show trace-stop-notes
13897 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13898 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13899
13900 @end table
13901
13902 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13903 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13904
13905 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13906 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13907 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13908 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13909 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13910 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13911 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13912 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13913 mentioned here.
13914
13915 @itemize @bullet
13916
13917 @item
13918 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13919 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13920 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13921 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13922 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13923 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13924 cannot be collected either.
13925
13926 @item
13927 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13928 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13929 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13930 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13931 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13932 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13933 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13934 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13935 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13936 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13937
13938 @item
13939 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13940 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13941 in a misleading way.
13942
13943 @item
13944 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13945 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13946 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13947 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13948 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13949 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13950 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13951 by @code{ptr}.
13952
13953 @item
13954 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13955 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13956 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13957 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13958 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13959 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13960 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13961 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13962 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13963 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13964 invalid address.
13965
13966 @item
13967 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13968 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13969 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13970 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13971 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13972 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13973 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13974 it to zero.
13975
13976 @end itemize
13977
13978 @node Analyze Collected Data
13979 @section Using the Collected Data
13980
13981 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13982 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13983 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13984 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13985 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13986 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13987 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13988 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13989 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13990 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13991 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13992 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13993 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13994 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13995 the buffer will fail.
13996
13997 @menu
13998 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13999 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14000 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14001 @end menu
14002
14003 @node tfind
14004 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14005
14006 @kindex tfind
14007 @cindex select trace snapshot
14008 @cindex find trace snapshot
14009 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14010 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14011 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14012 snapshot is selected.
14013
14014 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14015
14016 @table @code
14017 @item tfind start
14018 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14019 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14020
14021 @item tfind none
14022 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14023
14024 @item tfind end
14025 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14026
14027 @item tfind
14028 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14029 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14030
14031 @item tfind -
14032 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14033 retracing earlier steps.
14034
14035 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14036 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14037 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14038 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14039 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14040
14041 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14042 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14043 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14044 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14045 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14046
14047 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14048 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14049 addresses (exclusive).
14050
14051 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14052 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14053 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14054
14055 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14056 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14057 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14058 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14059 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14060 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14061 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14062 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14063 @end table
14064
14065 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14066 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14067 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14068 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14069 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14070 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14071 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14072 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14073 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14074 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14075 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14076 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14077 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14078 tracepoint as the current one.
14079
14080 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14081 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14082 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14083 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14084 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14085
14086 @smallexample
14087 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14088 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14089 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14090 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14091 > tfind
14092 > end
14093
14094 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14095 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14096 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14097 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14098 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14099 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14100 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14101 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14102 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14103 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14104 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14105 @end smallexample
14106
14107 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14108 the buffer:
14109
14110 @smallexample
14111 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14113 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14114 > tfind line
14115 > end
14116
14117 Frame 0, X = 1
14118 Frame 7, X = 2
14119 Frame 13, X = 255
14120 @end smallexample
14121
14122 @node tdump
14123 @subsection @code{tdump}
14124 @kindex tdump
14125 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14126 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14127
14128 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14129 the current trace snapshot.
14130
14131 @smallexample
14132 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14134 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14135 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14136 > end
14137
14138 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14139
14140 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14141 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14142 at gdb_test.c:444
14143 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14144
14145 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14146 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14147 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14148 d1 0x18 24
14149 d2 0x80 128
14150 d3 0x33 51
14151 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14152 d5 0x22 34
14153 d6 0xe0 224
14154 d7 0x380035 3670069
14155 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14156 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14157 a2 0x100 256
14158 a3 0x322000 3284992
14159 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14160 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14161 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14162 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14163 ps 0x0 0
14164 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14165 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14166 fpstatus 0x0 0
14167 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14168 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14169 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14170 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14171 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14172 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14173 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14174 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14175 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14176
14177 (@value{GDBP})
14178 @end smallexample
14179
14180 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14181 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14182 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14183 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14184
14185 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14186 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14187 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14188 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14189 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14190 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14191 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14192 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14193 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14194 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14195
14196 @node save tracepoints
14197 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14198 @kindex save tracepoints
14199 @kindex save-tracepoints
14200 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14201
14202 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14203 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14204 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14205 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14206 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14207 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14208
14209 @node Tracepoint Variables
14210 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14211 @cindex tracepoint variables
14212 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14213
14214 @table @code
14215 @vindex $trace_frame
14216 @item (int) $trace_frame
14217 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14218 snapshot is selected.
14219
14220 @vindex $tracepoint
14221 @item (int) $tracepoint
14222 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14223
14224 @vindex $trace_line
14225 @item (int) $trace_line
14226 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14227
14228 @vindex $trace_file
14229 @item (char []) $trace_file
14230 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14231
14232 @vindex $trace_func
14233 @item (char []) $trace_func
14234 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14235 @end table
14236
14237 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14238 use @code{output} instead.
14239
14240 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14241 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14242 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14243 which are managed by the target.
14244
14245 @smallexample
14246 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14247
14248 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14249 > output $trace_file
14250 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14251 > tfind
14252 > end
14253 @end smallexample
14254
14255 @node Trace Files
14256 @section Using Trace Files
14257 @cindex trace files
14258
14259 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14260 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14261 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14262 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14263 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14264
14265 @table @code
14266
14267 @kindex tsave
14268 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14269 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14270 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14271 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14272 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14273 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14274 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14275 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14276 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14277 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14278 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14279 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14280 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14281 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14282 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14283
14284 @kindex target tfile
14285 @kindex tfile
14286 @kindex target ctf
14287 @kindex ctf
14288 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14289 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14290 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14291 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14292 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14293 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14294 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14295 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14296 the host.
14297
14298 @smallexample
14299 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14300 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14301 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14302 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14303 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14304 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14305 i = 0
14306 a = 0
14307 b = 1 '\001'
14308 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14309 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14310 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14311 $1 = 1
14312 @end smallexample
14313
14314 @end table
14315
14316 @node Overlays
14317 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14318 @cindex overlays
14319
14320 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14321 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14322 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14323 use overlays.
14324
14325 @menu
14326 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14327 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14328 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14329 mapped by asking the inferior.
14330 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14331 @end menu
14332
14333 @node How Overlays Work
14334 @section How Overlays Work
14335 @cindex mapped overlays
14336 @cindex unmapped overlays
14337 @cindex load address, overlay's
14338 @cindex mapped address
14339 @cindex overlay area
14340
14341 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14342 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14343 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14344 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14345 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14346
14347 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14348 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14349 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14350 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14351 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14352 largest overlay as well.
14353
14354 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14355 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14356 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14357 there.
14358
14359 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14360 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14361 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14362
14363 @smallexample
14364 @group
14365 Data Instruction Larger
14366 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14367 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14368 | | | | | |
14369 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14370 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14371 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14372 | and heap | | | | | |
14373 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14374 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14375 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14376 | | | | | |
14377 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14378 address | | | | | |
14379 | overlay | <-' | | |
14380 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14381 | | <---. | | load address
14382 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14383 | | | |
14384 +-----------+ | |
14385 +-----------+
14386 | |
14387 +-----------+
14388
14389 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14390 @end group
14391 @end smallexample
14392
14393 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14394 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14395 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14396 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14397 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14398 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14399 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14400 program and the overlay area.
14401
14402 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14403 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14404 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14405 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14406 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14407 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14408 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14409
14410 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14411 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14412 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14413
14414 @itemize @bullet
14415
14416 @item
14417 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14418 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14419 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14420 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14421
14422 @item
14423 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14424 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14425 your program's performance.
14426
14427 @item
14428 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14429 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14430 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14431 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14432 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14433 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14434 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14435
14436 @item
14437 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14438 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14439 instruction and data spaces.
14440
14441 @end itemize
14442
14443 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14444 improved in many ways:
14445
14446 @itemize @bullet
14447
14448 @item
14449 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14450 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14451 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14452 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14453 area in the usual way.
14454
14455 @item
14456 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14457 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14458
14459 @item
14460 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14461 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14462 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14463 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14464 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14465 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14466 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14467
14468 @end itemize
14469
14470
14471 @node Overlay Commands
14472 @section Overlay Commands
14473
14474 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14475 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14476 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14477 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14478 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14479 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14480
14481 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14482 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14483
14484 @table @code
14485 @item overlay off
14486 @kindex overlay
14487 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14488 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14489 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14490 overlay support is disabled.
14491
14492 @item overlay manual
14493 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14494 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14495 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14496 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14497 commands described below.
14498
14499 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14500 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14501 @cindex map an overlay
14502 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14503 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14504 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14505 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14506 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14507 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14508
14509 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14510 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14511 @cindex unmap an overlay
14512 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14513 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14514 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14515 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14516
14517 @item overlay auto
14518 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14519 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14520 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14521 Overlay Debugging}.
14522
14523 @item overlay load-target
14524 @itemx overlay load
14525 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14526 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14527 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14528 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14529 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14530 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14531
14532 @item overlay list-overlays
14533 @itemx overlay list
14534 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14535 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14536 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14537
14538 @end table
14539
14540 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14541 of the function the address falls in:
14542
14543 @smallexample
14544 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14545 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14546 @end smallexample
14547 @noindent
14548 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14549 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14550 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14551 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14552
14553 @smallexample
14554 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14555 No sections are mapped.
14556 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14557 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14558 @end smallexample
14559 @noindent
14560 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14561 name normally:
14562
14563 @smallexample
14564 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14565 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14566 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14567 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14568 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14572 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14573 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14574 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14575 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14576
14577 @itemize @bullet
14578 @item
14579 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14580 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14581 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14582 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14583 @item
14584 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14585 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14586 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14587 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14588 breakpoints properly.
14589 @end itemize
14590
14591
14592 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14593 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14594 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14595
14596 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14597 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14598 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14599 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14600 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14601 current state of the overlays.
14602
14603 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14604 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14605
14606 @table @asis
14607
14608 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14609 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14610
14611 @smallexample
14612 struct
14613 @{
14614 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14615 unsigned long vma;
14616
14617 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14618 unsigned long size;
14619
14620 /* The overlay's load address. */
14621 unsigned long lma;
14622
14623 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14624 zero otherwise. */
14625 unsigned long mapped;
14626 @}
14627 @end smallexample
14628
14629 @item @code{_novlys}:
14630 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14631 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14632
14633 @end table
14634
14635 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14636 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14637 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14638 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14639 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14640 currently mapped.
14641
14642 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14643 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14644 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14645 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14646 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14647 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14648 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14649 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14650 are not being executed.
14651
14652 @node Overlay Sample Program
14653 @section Overlay Sample Program
14654 @cindex overlay example program
14655
14656 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14657 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14658 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14659 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14660 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14661 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14662 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14663
14664 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14665 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14666 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14667 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14668
14669 @table @file
14670 @item overlays.c
14671 The main program file.
14672 @item ovlymgr.c
14673 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14674 @item foo.c
14675 @itemx bar.c
14676 @itemx baz.c
14677 @itemx grbx.c
14678 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14679 @item d10v.ld
14680 @itemx m32r.ld
14681 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14682 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14683 @end table
14684
14685 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14686 cross-compiler like this:
14687
14688 @smallexample
14689 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14690 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14691 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14692 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14693 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14694 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14695 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14696 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14697 @end smallexample
14698
14699 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14700 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14701 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14702
14703
14704 @node Languages
14705 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14706 @cindex languages
14707
14708 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14709 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14710 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14711 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14712 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14713 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14714
14715 @cindex working language
14716 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14717 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14718 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14719 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14720 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14721 language}.
14722
14723 @menu
14724 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14725 * Show:: Displaying the language
14726 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14727 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14728 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14729 @end menu
14730
14731 @node Setting
14732 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14733
14734 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14735 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14736 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14737 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14738 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14739 are printed, etc.
14740
14741 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14742 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14743 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14744 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14745 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14746 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14747 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14748 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14749 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14750 Displaying the Language}.
14751
14752 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14753 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14754 another language. In that case, make the
14755 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14756 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14757 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14758
14759 @menu
14760 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14761 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14762 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14763 @end menu
14764
14765 @node Filenames
14766 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14767
14768 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14769 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14770
14771 @table @file
14772 @item .ada
14773 @itemx .ads
14774 @itemx .adb
14775 @itemx .a
14776 Ada source file.
14777
14778 @item .c
14779 C source file
14780
14781 @item .C
14782 @itemx .cc
14783 @itemx .cp
14784 @itemx .cpp
14785 @itemx .cxx
14786 @itemx .c++
14787 C@t{++} source file
14788
14789 @item .d
14790 D source file
14791
14792 @item .m
14793 Objective-C source file
14794
14795 @item .f
14796 @itemx .F
14797 Fortran source file
14798
14799 @item .mod
14800 Modula-2 source file
14801
14802 @item .s
14803 @itemx .S
14804 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14805 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14806 @end table
14807
14808 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14809 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14810
14811 @node Manually
14812 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14813
14814 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14815 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14816 your program.
14817
14818 @kindex set language
14819 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14820 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14821 a language, such as
14822 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14823 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14824
14825 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14826 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14827 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14828 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14829 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14830 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14831 command such as:
14832
14833 @smallexample
14834 print a = b + c
14835 @end smallexample
14836
14837 @noindent
14838 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14839 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14840 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14841 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14842
14843 @node Automatically
14844 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14845
14846 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14847 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14848 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14849 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14850 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14851 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14852 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14853 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14854 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14855
14856 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14857 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14858 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14859 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14860 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14861
14862 @node Show
14863 @section Displaying the Language
14864
14865 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14866 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14867
14868 @table @code
14869 @item show language
14870 @anchor{show language}
14871 @kindex show language
14872 Display the current working language. This is the
14873 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14874 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14875
14876 @item info frame
14877 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14878 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14879 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14880 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14881 information listed here.
14882
14883 @item info source
14884 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14885 Display the source language of this source file.
14886 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14887 information listed here.
14888 @end table
14889
14890 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14891 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14892 with a language explicitly:
14893
14894 @table @code
14895 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14896 @kindex set extension-language
14897 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14898 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14899
14900 @item info extensions
14901 @kindex info extensions
14902 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14903 @end table
14904
14905 @node Checks
14906 @section Type and Range Checking
14907
14908 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14909 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14910 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14911 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14912 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14913 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14914 errors when your program is running.
14915
14916 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14917 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14918 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14919 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14920
14921 @menu
14922 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14923 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14924 @end menu
14925
14926 @cindex type checking
14927 @cindex checks, type
14928 @node Type Checking
14929 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14930
14931 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14932 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14933 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14934 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14935
14936 @smallexample
14937 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14938
14939 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14940 $1 = 2
14941 @exdent but
14942 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14943 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14944 @end smallexample
14945
14946 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14947 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14948
14949 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14950 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14951 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14952 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14953 expressions like the second example above.
14954
14955 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14956 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14957 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14958 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14959 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14960 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14961
14962 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14963
14964 @kindex set check type
14965 @kindex show check type
14966 @table @code
14967 @item set check type on
14968 @itemx set check type off
14969 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14970 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14971 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14972
14973 @item show check type
14974 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14975 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14976 @end table
14977
14978 @cindex range checking
14979 @cindex checks, range
14980 @node Range Checking
14981 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14982
14983 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14984 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14985 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14986 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14987 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14988
14989 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14990 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14991 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14992 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14993
14994 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14995 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14996 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14997 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14998 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14999 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15000
15001 @smallexample
15002 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15003 @end smallexample
15004
15005 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15006 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15007 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15008
15009 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15010
15011 @kindex set check range
15012 @kindex show check range
15013 @table @code
15014 @item set check range auto
15015 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15016 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15017 each language.
15018
15019 @item set check range on
15020 @itemx set check range off
15021 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15022 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15023 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15024 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15025
15026 @item set check range warn
15027 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15028 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15029 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15030 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15031 systems).
15032
15033 @item show range
15034 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15035 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15036 @end table
15037
15038 @node Supported Languages
15039 @section Supported Languages
15040
15041 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15042 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15043 @c This is false ...
15044 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15045 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15046 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15047 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15048 language.
15049
15050 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15051 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15052 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15053 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15054 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15055 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15056 language reference or tutorial.
15057
15058 @menu
15059 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15060 * D:: D
15061 * Go:: Go
15062 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15063 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15064 * Fortran:: Fortran
15065 * Pascal:: Pascal
15066 * Rust:: Rust
15067 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15068 * Ada:: Ada
15069 @end menu
15070
15071 @node C
15072 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15073
15074 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15075 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15076
15077 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15078 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15079 together.
15080
15081 @cindex C@t{++}
15082 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15083 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15084 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15085 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15086 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15087 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15088 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15089
15090 @menu
15091 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15092 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15093 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15094 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15095 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15096 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15097 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15098 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15099 @end menu
15100
15101 @node C Operators
15102 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15103
15104 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15105
15106 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15107 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15108 often defined on groups of types.
15109
15110 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15111
15112 @itemize @bullet
15113
15114 @item
15115 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15116 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15117
15118 @item
15119 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15120 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15121
15122 @item
15123 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15124
15125 @item
15126 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15127
15128 @end itemize
15129
15130 @noindent
15131 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15132 in order of increasing precedence:
15133
15134 @table @code
15135 @item ,
15136 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15137 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15138 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15139
15140 @item =
15141 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15142 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15143
15144 @item @var{op}=
15145 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15146 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15147 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15148 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15149 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15150
15151 @item ?:
15152 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15153 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15154 should be of an integral type.
15155
15156 @item ||
15157 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15158
15159 @item &&
15160 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15161
15162 @item |
15163 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15164
15165 @item ^
15166 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15167
15168 @item &
15169 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15170
15171 @item ==@r{, }!=
15172 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15173 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15174
15175 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15176 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15177 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15178 and non-zero for true.
15179
15180 @item <<@r{, }>>
15181 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15182
15183 @item @@
15184 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15185
15186 @item +@r{, }-
15187 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15188 pointer types.
15189
15190 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15191 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15192 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15193 integral types.
15194
15195 @item ++@r{, }--
15196 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15197 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15198 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15199 operation takes place.
15200
15201 @item *
15202 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15203 @code{++}.
15204
15205 @item &
15206 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15207
15208 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15209 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15210 to examine the address
15211 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15212 stored.
15213
15214 @item -
15215 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15216 precedence as @code{++}.
15217
15218 @item !
15219 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15220 @code{++}.
15221
15222 @item ~
15223 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15224 @code{++}.
15225
15226
15227 @item .@r{, }->
15228 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15229 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15230 pointer based on the stored type information.
15231 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15232
15233 @item .*@r{, }->*
15234 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15235
15236 @item []
15237 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15238 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15239
15240 @item ()
15241 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15242
15243 @item ::
15244 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15245 and @code{class} types.
15246
15247 @item ::
15248 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15249 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15250 above.
15251 @end table
15252
15253 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15254 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15255 predefined meaning.
15256
15257 @node C Constants
15258 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15259
15260 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15261
15262 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15263 following ways:
15264
15265 @itemize @bullet
15266 @item
15267 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15268 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15269 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15270 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15271 @code{long} value.
15272
15273 @item
15274 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15275 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15276 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15277 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15278 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15279 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15280 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15281 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15282 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15283 constant.
15284
15285 @item
15286 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15287 integral equivalents.
15288
15289 @item
15290 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15291 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15292 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15293 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15294 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15295 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15296 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15297 @samp{\n} for newline.
15298
15299 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15300 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15301 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15302 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15303
15304 @item
15305 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15306 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15307 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15308 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15309 characters.
15310
15311 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15312 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15313 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15314
15315 @item
15316 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15317 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15318
15319 @item
15320 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15321 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15322 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15323 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15324 @end itemize
15325
15326 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15327 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15328
15329 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15330 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15331
15332 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15333 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15334 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15335 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15336 @quotation
15337 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15338 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15339 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15340 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15341 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15342 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15343 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15344 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15345 @end quotation
15346
15347 @enumerate
15348
15349 @cindex member functions
15350 @item
15351 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15352
15353 @smallexample
15354 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15355 @end smallexample
15356
15357 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15358 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15359 @item
15360 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15361 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15362 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15363 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15364 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15365
15366 @cindex call overloaded functions
15367 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15368 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15369 @item
15370 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15371 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15372 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15373 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15374 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15375 default arguments.
15376
15377 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15378 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15379 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15380 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15381 number of function arguments.
15382
15383 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15384 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15385 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15386
15387 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15388 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15389 @smallexample
15390 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15391 @end smallexample
15392
15393 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15394 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15395
15396 @cindex reference declarations
15397 @item
15398 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15399 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15400 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15401
15402 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15403 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15404 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15405 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15406 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15407
15408 @item
15409 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15410 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15411 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15412 necessary, for example in an expression like
15413 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15414 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15415 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15416
15417 @item
15418 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15419 specification.
15420 @end enumerate
15421
15422 @node C Defaults
15423 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15424
15425 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15426
15427 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15428 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15429 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15430 selects the working language.
15431
15432 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15433 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15434 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15435 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15436 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15437 for further details.
15438
15439 @node C Checks
15440 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15441
15442 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15443
15444 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15445 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15446 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15447 constants to pointers.
15448
15449 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15450 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15451 that is not itself an array.
15452
15453 @node Debugging C
15454 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15455
15456 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15457 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15458 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15459 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15460
15461 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15462 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15463 ,Expressions}.
15464
15465 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15466 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15467
15468 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15469
15470 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15471 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15472
15473 @table @code
15474 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15475 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15476 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15477 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15478 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15479 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15480
15481 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15482 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15483 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15484 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15485 classes.
15486 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15487
15488 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15489 @item catch throw
15490 @itemx catch rethrow
15491 @itemx catch catch
15492 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15493 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15494
15495 @cindex inheritance
15496 @item ptype @var{typename}
15497 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15498 @var{typename}.
15499 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15500
15501 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15502 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15503 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15504 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15505 multiple inheritance is in use.
15506
15507 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15508 @item demangle @var{name}
15509 Demangle @var{name}.
15510 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15511
15512 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15513 @item set print demangle
15514 @itemx show print demangle
15515 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15516 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15517 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15518 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15519 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15520
15521 @item set print object
15522 @itemx show print object
15523 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15524 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15525
15526 @item set print vtbl
15527 @itemx show print vtbl
15528 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15529 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15530 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15531 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15532
15533 @kindex set overload-resolution
15534 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15535 @item set overload-resolution on
15536 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15537 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15538 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15539 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15540 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15541 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15542
15543 @item set overload-resolution off
15544 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15545 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15546 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15547 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15548 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15549 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15550 argument types.
15551
15552 @kindex show overload-resolution
15553 @item show overload-resolution
15554 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15555
15556 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15557 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15558 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15559 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15560 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15561 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15562 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15563
15564 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15565
15566 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15567 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15568 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15569 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15570 for more detail.
15571
15572 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15573 function that returns a std::string:
15574
15575 @smallexample
15576 std::string function(int);
15577 @end smallexample
15578
15579 @noindent
15580 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15581 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15582
15583 @smallexample
15584 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15585 @end smallexample
15586
15587 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15588 tag. For example:
15589
15590 @smallexample
15591 (gdb) b function(int)
15592 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15593 (gdb) info breakpoints
15594 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15595 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15596 at main.cc:10
15597 @end smallexample
15598
15599 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15600 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15601 name, like:
15602
15603 @smallexample
15604 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15605 @end smallexample
15606 @end table
15607
15608 @node Decimal Floating Point
15609 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15610 @cindex decimal floating point format
15611
15612 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15613 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15614 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15615 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15616
15617 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15618 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15619 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15620 configured target.
15621
15622 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15623 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15624 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15625
15626 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15627 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15628 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15629
15630 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15631 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15632 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15633
15634 @node D
15635 @subsection D
15636
15637 @cindex D
15638 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15639 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15640 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15641
15642 @node Go
15643 @subsection Go
15644
15645 @cindex Go (programming language)
15646 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15647 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15648
15649 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15650
15651 @table @code
15652 @cindex current Go package
15653 @item The current Go package
15654 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15655 specifying global variables and functions.
15656
15657 For example, given the program:
15658
15659 @example
15660 package main
15661 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15662 func main () @{
15663 // ...
15664 @}
15665 @end example
15666
15667 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15668
15669 @example
15670 (gdb) p myglob
15671 (gdb) p main.myglob
15672 @end example
15673
15674 @cindex builtin Go types
15675 @item Builtin Go types
15676 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15677 as a string.
15678
15679 @cindex builtin Go functions
15680 @item Builtin Go functions
15681 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15682 function and handles it internally.
15683
15684 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15685 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15686 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15687 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15688 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15689 @end table
15690
15691 @node Objective-C
15692 @subsection Objective-C
15693
15694 @cindex Objective-C
15695 This section provides information about some commands and command
15696 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15697 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15698 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15699
15700 @menu
15701 * Method Names in Commands::
15702 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15703 @end menu
15704
15705 @node Method Names in Commands
15706 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15707
15708 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15709 names as line specifications:
15710
15711 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15712 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15713 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15714 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15715 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15716 @itemize
15717 @item @code{clear}
15718 @item @code{break}
15719 @item @code{info line}
15720 @item @code{jump}
15721 @item @code{list}
15722 @end itemize
15723
15724 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15725
15726 @smallexample
15727 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15728 @end smallexample
15729
15730 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15731 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15732 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15733 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15734 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15735 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15736 debugged, enter:
15737
15738 @smallexample
15739 break -[Fruit create]
15740 @end smallexample
15741
15742 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15743 enter:
15744
15745 @smallexample
15746 list +[NSText initialize]
15747 @end smallexample
15748
15749 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15750 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15751 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15752 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15753
15754 @smallexample
15755 break create
15756 @end smallexample
15757
15758 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15759 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15760 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15761 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15762 none apply.
15763
15764 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15765 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15766
15767 @smallexample
15768 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15769 @end smallexample
15770
15771 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15772 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15773 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15774 @kindex print-object
15775 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15776
15777 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15778
15779 @smallexample
15780 print -[@var{object} hash]
15781 @end smallexample
15782
15783 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15784 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15785 @noindent
15786 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15787 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15788 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15789 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15790 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15791 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15792
15793 @node OpenCL C
15794 @subsection OpenCL C
15795
15796 @cindex OpenCL C
15797 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15798
15799 @menu
15800 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15801 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15802 * OpenCL C Operators::
15803 @end menu
15804
15805 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15806 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15807
15808 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15809 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15810 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15811 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15812 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15813
15814 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15815 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15816
15817 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15818 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15819 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15820 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15821
15822 @node OpenCL C Operators
15823 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15824
15825 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15826 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15827 vector data types.
15828
15829 @node Fortran
15830 @subsection Fortran
15831 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15832
15833 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15834 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15835
15836 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15837 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15838 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15839 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15840 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15841 underscore.
15842
15843 @menu
15844 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15845 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15846 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15847 @end menu
15848
15849 @node Fortran Operators
15850 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15851
15852 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15853
15854 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15855 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15856 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15857
15858 @table @code
15859 @item **
15860 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15861 of the second one.
15862
15863 @item :
15864 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15865 represent a section of array.
15866
15867 @item %
15868 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15869 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15870 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15871 union type.
15872 @end table
15873
15874 @node Fortran Defaults
15875 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15876
15877 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15878
15879 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15880 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15881 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15882 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15883
15884 @node Special Fortran Commands
15885 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15886
15887 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15888
15889 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15890 such as displaying common blocks.
15891
15892 @table @code
15893 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15894 @kindex info common
15895 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15896 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15897 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15898 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15899 printed.
15900 @end table
15901
15902 @node Pascal
15903 @subsection Pascal
15904
15905 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15906 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15907 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15908 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15909 syntax.
15910
15911 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15912 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15913 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15914
15915 @node Rust
15916 @subsection Rust
15917
15918 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15919 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15920 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15921 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15922
15923 @itemize @bullet
15924 @item
15925 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15926 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15927 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15928
15929 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15930 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15931 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15932 @samp{B}.
15933
15934 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15935 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15936
15937 @item
15938 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15939 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15940 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15941 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15942 @samp{K::x::y}.
15943
15944 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15945 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15946 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15947 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15948 scope.
15949
15950 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15951 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15952
15953 @item
15954 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15955 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15956
15957 @item
15958 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15959
15960 @item
15961 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15962 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15963 never be destroyed.
15964
15965 @item
15966 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15967 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15968 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15969
15970 @item
15971 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15972 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15973 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15974 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15975 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15976 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15977 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15978 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15979
15980 @item
15981 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15982 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15983 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15984 @itemize @bullet
15985
15986 @item
15987 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15988
15989 @item
15990 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15991
15992 @item
15993 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15994 type names.
15995
15996 @item
15997 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15998
15999 @item
16000 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16001 available in the crate.
16002 @end itemize
16003 @end itemize
16004
16005 @node Modula-2
16006 @subsection Modula-2
16007
16008 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16009
16010 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16011 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16012 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16013 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16014 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16015 table.
16016
16017 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16018 @menu
16019 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16020 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16021 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16022 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16023 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16024 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16025 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16026 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16027 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16028 @end menu
16029
16030 @node M2 Operators
16031 @subsubsection Operators
16032 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16033
16034 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16035 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16036 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16037 following definitions hold:
16038
16039 @itemize @bullet
16040
16041 @item
16042 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16043 their subranges.
16044
16045 @item
16046 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16047
16048 @item
16049 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16050
16051 @item
16052 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16053 @var{type}}.
16054
16055 @item
16056 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16057
16058 @item
16059 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16060
16061 @item
16062 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16063 @end itemize
16064
16065 @noindent
16066 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16067 increasing precedence:
16068
16069 @table @code
16070 @item ,
16071 Function argument or array index separator.
16072
16073 @item :=
16074 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16075 @var{value}.
16076
16077 @item <@r{, }>
16078 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16079 types.
16080
16081 @item <=@r{, }>=
16082 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16083 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16084 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16085
16086 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16087 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16088 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16089 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16090 comment character.
16091
16092 @item IN
16093 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16094 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16095
16096 @item OR
16097 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16098
16099 @item AND@r{, }&
16100 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16101
16102 @item @@
16103 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16104
16105 @item +@r{, }-
16106 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16107 and difference on set types.
16108
16109 @item *
16110 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16111 on set types.
16112
16113 @item /
16114 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16115 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16116
16117 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16118 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16119 precedence as @code{*}.
16120
16121 @item -
16122 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16123
16124 @item ^
16125 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16126
16127 @item NOT
16128 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16129 @code{^}.
16130
16131 @item .
16132 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16133 precedence as @code{^}.
16134
16135 @item []
16136 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16137
16138 @item ()
16139 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16140 as @code{^}.
16141
16142 @item ::@r{, }.
16143 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16144 @end table
16145
16146 @quotation
16147 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16148 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16149 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16150 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16151 @end quotation
16152
16153
16154 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16155 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16156 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16157
16158 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16159 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16160
16161 @table @var
16162
16163 @item a
16164 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16165
16166 @item c
16167 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16168
16169 @item i
16170 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16171
16172 @item m
16173 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16174 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16175 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16176
16177 @item n
16178 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16179
16180 @item r
16181 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16182
16183 @item t
16184 represents a type.
16185
16186 @item v
16187 represents a variable.
16188
16189 @item x
16190 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16191 explanation of the function for details.
16192 @end table
16193
16194 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16195
16196 @table @code
16197 @item ABS(@var{n})
16198 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16199
16200 @item CAP(@var{c})
16201 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16202 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16203
16204 @item CHR(@var{i})
16205 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16206
16207 @item DEC(@var{v})
16208 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16209
16210 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16211 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16212 new value.
16213
16214 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16215 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16216 set.
16217
16218 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16219 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16220
16221 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16222 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16223
16224 @item INC(@var{v})
16225 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16226
16227 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16228 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16229 new value.
16230
16231 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16232 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16233 there. Returns the new set.
16234
16235 @item MAX(@var{t})
16236 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16237
16238 @item MIN(@var{t})
16239 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16240
16241 @item ODD(@var{i})
16242 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16243
16244 @item ORD(@var{x})
16245 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16246 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16247 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16248 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16249
16250 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16251 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16252 variable or a type.
16253
16254 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16255 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16256
16257 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16258 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16259 variable or a type.
16260
16261 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16262 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16263 @end table
16264
16265 @quotation
16266 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16267 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16268 an error.
16269 @end quotation
16270
16271 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16272 @node M2 Constants
16273 @subsubsection Constants
16274
16275 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16276 ways:
16277
16278 @itemize @bullet
16279
16280 @item
16281 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16282 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16283 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16284 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16285
16286 @item
16287 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16288 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16289 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16290 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16291 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16292 digits.
16293
16294 @item
16295 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16296 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16297 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16298 followed by a @samp{C}.
16299
16300 @item
16301 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16302 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16303 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16304 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16305 sequences.
16306
16307 @item
16308 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16309
16310 @item
16311 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16312 @code{FALSE}.
16313
16314 @item
16315 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16316
16317 @item
16318 Set constants are not yet supported.
16319 @end itemize
16320
16321 @node M2 Types
16322 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16323 @cindex Modula-2 types
16324
16325 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16326 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16327 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16328 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16329 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16330 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16331
16332 The first example contains the following section of code:
16333
16334 @smallexample
16335 VAR
16336 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16337 r: [20..40] ;
16338 @end smallexample
16339
16340 @noindent
16341 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16342 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16343
16344 @smallexample
16345 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16346 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16347 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16348 SET OF CHAR
16349 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16350 21
16351 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16352 [20..40]
16353 @end smallexample
16354
16355 @noindent
16356 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16357
16358 @smallexample
16359 VAR
16360 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16361 @end smallexample
16362
16363 @noindent
16364 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16368 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16369 @end smallexample
16370
16371 @noindent
16372 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16373 expressions using the debugger.
16374
16375 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16376 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16377
16378 @smallexample
16379 VAR
16380 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16381 @end smallexample
16382
16383 @smallexample
16384 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16385 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16386 @end smallexample
16387
16388 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16389 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16390 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16391 above.
16392
16393 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16394
16395 @smallexample
16396 TYPE
16397 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16398 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16399 VAR
16400 s: t ;
16401 BEGIN
16402 s := blue ;
16403 @end smallexample
16404
16405 @noindent
16406 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16407 and value of a variable.
16408
16409 @smallexample
16410 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16411 $1 = blue
16412 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16413 type = [blue..yellow]
16414 @end smallexample
16415
16416 @noindent
16417 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16418 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16419 their @code{C} counterparts.
16420
16421 @smallexample
16422 VAR
16423 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16424 BEGIN
16425 s[1] := 1 ;
16426 @end smallexample
16427
16428 @smallexample
16429 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16430 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16431 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16432 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16433 @end smallexample
16434
16435 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16436 pointer types as shown in this example:
16437
16438 @smallexample
16439 VAR
16440 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16441 BEGIN
16442 NEW(s) ;
16443 s^[1] := 1 ;
16444 @end smallexample
16445
16446 @noindent
16447 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16448
16449 @smallexample
16450 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16451 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16452 @end smallexample
16453
16454 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16455 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16456 types:
16457
16458 @smallexample
16459 TYPE
16460 foo = RECORD
16461 f1: CARDINAL ;
16462 f2: CHAR ;
16463 f3: myarray ;
16464 END ;
16465
16466 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16467 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16468 VAR
16469 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16470 @end smallexample
16471
16472 @noindent
16473 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16474 below.
16475
16476 @smallexample
16477 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16478 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16479 f1 : CARDINAL;
16480 f2 : CHAR;
16481 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16482 END
16483 @end smallexample
16484
16485 @node M2 Defaults
16486 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16487 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16488
16489 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16490 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16491 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16492 selected the working language.
16493
16494 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16495 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16496 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16497 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16498
16499 @node Deviations
16500 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16501 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16502
16503 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16504 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16505
16506 @itemize @bullet
16507 @item
16508 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16509 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16510 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16511 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16512 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16513 returned a pointer.)
16514
16515 @item
16516 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16517 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16518 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16519 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16520
16521 @item
16522 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16523 argument.
16524
16525 @item
16526 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16527 @end itemize
16528
16529 @node M2 Checks
16530 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16531 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16532
16533 @quotation
16534 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16535 range checking.
16536 @end quotation
16537 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16538
16539 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16540
16541 @itemize @bullet
16542 @item
16543 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16544 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16545
16546 @item
16547 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16548 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16549 @end itemize
16550
16551 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16552 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16553
16554 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16555 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16556
16557 @node M2 Scope
16558 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16559 @cindex scope
16560 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16561 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16562 @ifinfo
16563 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16564 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16565 @end ifinfo
16566 @ifnotinfo
16567 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16568 @end ifnotinfo
16569
16570 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16571 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16572 similar syntax:
16573
16574 @smallexample
16575
16576 @var{module} . @var{id}
16577 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16578 @end smallexample
16579
16580 @noindent
16581 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16582 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16583 identifier within your program, except another module.
16584
16585 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16586 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16587 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16588 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16589
16590 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16591 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16592 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16593 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16594 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16595 @var{module}.
16596
16597 @node GDB/M2
16598 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16599
16600 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16601 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16602 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16603 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16604 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16605 analogue in Modula-2.
16606
16607 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16608 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16609 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16610 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16611 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16612 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16613
16614 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16615 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16616 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16617
16618 @node Ada
16619 @subsection Ada
16620 @cindex Ada
16621
16622 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16623 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16624 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16625 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16626 to be difficult.
16627
16628
16629 @cindex expressions in Ada
16630 @menu
16631 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16632 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16633 in @value{GDBN}.
16634 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16635 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16636 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16637 subprograms.
16638 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16639 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16640 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16641 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16642 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16643 Profile
16644 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16645 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16646 @end menu
16647
16648 @node Ada Mode Intro
16649 @subsubsection Introduction
16650 @cindex Ada mode, general
16651
16652 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16653 syntax, with some extensions.
16654 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16655
16656 @itemize @bullet
16657 @item
16658 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16659 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16660 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16661 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16662
16663 @item
16664 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16665 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16666
16667 @item
16668 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16669 @end itemize
16670
16671 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16672 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16673 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16674 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16675 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16676
16677 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16678 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16679 was translated from an Ada source file.
16680
16681 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16682 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16683 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16684 middle (to allow based literals).
16685
16686 @node Omissions from Ada
16687 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16688 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16689
16690 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16691
16692 @itemize @bullet
16693 @item
16694 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16695
16696 @itemize @minus
16697 @item
16698 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16699 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16700
16701 @item
16702 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16703
16704 @item
16705 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16706
16707 @item
16708 @t{'Tag}.
16709
16710 @item
16711 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16712 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16713
16714 @item
16715 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16716 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16717
16718 @item
16719 @t{'Address}.
16720 @end itemize
16721
16722 @item
16723 The names in
16724 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16725 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16726 not currently available.
16727
16728 @item
16729 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16730 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16731 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16732 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16733 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16734 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16735 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16736 indeterminate values.
16737
16738 @item
16739 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16740 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16741 are not implemented.
16742
16743 @item
16744 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16745 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16746 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16747 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16748 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16749
16750 @smallexample
16751 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16752 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16753 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16754 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16755 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16756 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16757 @end smallexample
16758
16759 Changing a
16760 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16761 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16762 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16763 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16764 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16765 declared to have a type such as:
16766
16767 @smallexample
16768 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16769 Id : Integer;
16770 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16771 end record;
16772 @end smallexample
16773
16774 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16775 assignments:
16776
16777 @smallexample
16778 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16779 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16780 @end smallexample
16781
16782 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16783 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16784 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16785 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16786 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16787 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16788 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16789 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16790
16791 @item
16792 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16793
16794 @item
16795 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16796 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16797 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16798 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16799 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16800 the proper resolution.
16801
16802 @item
16803 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16804
16805 @item
16806 Entry calls are not implemented.
16807
16808 @item
16809 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16810 formats are not supported.
16811
16812 @item
16813 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16814
16815 @item
16816 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16817 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16818 context.
16819 Should your program
16820 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16821 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16822 @end itemize
16823
16824 @node Additions to Ada
16825 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16826 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16827
16828 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16829 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16830
16831 @itemize @bullet
16832 @item
16833 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16834 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16835 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16836 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16837 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16838 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16839 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16840 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16841
16842 @item
16843 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16844 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16845 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16846
16847 @item
16848 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16849 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16850
16851 @item
16852 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16853 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16854 @end itemize
16855
16856 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16857 additions specific to Ada:
16858
16859 @itemize @bullet
16860 @item
16861 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16862 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16863
16864 @smallexample
16865 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16866 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16867 @end smallexample
16868
16869 @item
16870 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16871 the value of its right-hand operand.
16872 This allows, for example,
16873 complex conditional breaks:
16874
16875 @smallexample
16876 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16877 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16878 @end smallexample
16879
16880 @item
16881 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16882 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16883 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16884 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16885 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16886 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16887 in strings. For example,
16888 @smallexample
16889 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16890 @end smallexample
16891 @noindent
16892 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16893 after each period.
16894
16895 @item
16896 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16897 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16898 to write
16899
16900 @smallexample
16901 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16902 @end smallexample
16903
16904 @item
16905 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16906 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16907 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16908 of 3 might print as
16909
16910 @smallexample
16911 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16912 @end smallexample
16913
16914 @noindent
16915 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16916 clause.
16917
16918 @item
16919 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16920 multi-character subsequence of
16921 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16922 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16923 in place of @t{a'length}.
16924
16925 @item
16926 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16927 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16928 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16929 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16930 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16931 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16932 For example,
16933 @smallexample
16934 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16935 @end smallexample
16936
16937 @item
16938 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16939 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16940 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16941 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16942 object.
16943
16944 @end itemize
16945
16946 @node Overloading support for Ada
16947 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16948 @cindex overloading, Ada
16949
16950 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16951 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16952 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16953 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16954 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16955 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16956
16957 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16958 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16959 use, for instance:
16960
16961 @smallexample
16962 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16963 Multiple matches for f
16964 [0] cancel
16965 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16966 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16967 >
16968 @end smallexample
16969
16970 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16971 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16972 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16973
16974 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16975 case:
16976
16977 @table @code
16978
16979 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16980 @item set ada print-signatures
16981 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16982 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16983 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16984
16985 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16986 @item show ada print-signatures
16987 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16988 overloads selection menu.
16989 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16990
16991 @end table
16992
16993 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16994 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16995
16996 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16997 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16998 before reaching the main procedure.
16999 As defined in the Ada Reference
17000 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17001 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17002 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17003 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17004
17005 @node Ada Exceptions
17006 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17007
17008 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17009
17010 @table @code
17011 @kindex info exceptions
17012 @item info exceptions
17013 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17014 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17015 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17016 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17017 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17018 @end table
17019
17020 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17021 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17022 argument.
17023
17024 @smallexample
17025 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17026 All defined Ada exceptions:
17027 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17028 program_error: 0x613d20
17029 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17030 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17031 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17032 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17033 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17034 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17035 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17036 @end smallexample
17037
17038 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17039 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17040
17041 @node Ada Tasks
17042 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17043 @cindex Ada, tasking
17044
17045 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17046 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17047
17048 @table @code
17049 @kindex info tasks
17050 @item info tasks
17051 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17052
17053
17054 @smallexample
17055 @iftex
17056 @leftskip=0.5cm
17057 @end iftex
17058 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17059 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17060 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17061 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17062 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17063 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17064
17065 @end smallexample
17066
17067 @noindent
17068 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17069 task currently being inspected.
17070
17071 @table @asis
17072 @item ID
17073 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17074
17075 @item TID
17076 The Ada task ID.
17077
17078 @item P-ID
17079 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17080
17081 @item Pri
17082 The base priority of the task.
17083
17084 @item State
17085 Current state of the task.
17086
17087 @table @code
17088 @item Unactivated
17089 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17090 executing.
17091
17092 @item Runnable
17093 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17094 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17095
17096 @item Terminated
17097 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17098 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17099 terminated themselves.
17100
17101 @item Child Activation Wait
17102 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17103
17104 @item Accept Statement
17105 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17106
17107 @item Waiting on entry call
17108 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17109
17110 @item Async Select Wait
17111 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17112 select statement.
17113
17114 @item Delay Sleep
17115 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17116 alternative open.
17117
17118 @item Child Termination Wait
17119 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17120 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17121 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17122
17123 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17124 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17125 finish terminating.
17126
17127 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17128 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17129 @end table
17130
17131 @item Name
17132 Name of the task in the program.
17133
17134 @end table
17135
17136 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17137 @item info task @var{taskno}
17138 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17139 the following example:
17140 @smallexample
17141 @iftex
17142 @leftskip=0.5cm
17143 @end iftex
17144 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17145 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17146 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17147 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17148 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17149 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17150 Name: task_1
17151 Thread: 0
17152 LWP: 0x1fac
17153 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17154 Base Priority: 15
17155 State: Runnable
17156 @end smallexample
17157
17158 @item task
17159 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17160 @cindex current Ada task ID
17161 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17162
17163 @smallexample
17164 @iftex
17165 @leftskip=0.5cm
17166 @end iftex
17167 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17168 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17169 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17170 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17171 (@value{GDBP}) task
17172 [Current task is 2]
17173 @end smallexample
17174
17175 @item task @var{taskno}
17176 @cindex Ada task switching
17177 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17178 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17179 from the current task to the given task.
17180
17181 @smallexample
17182 @iftex
17183 @leftskip=0.5cm
17184 @end iftex
17185 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17186 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17187 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17188 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17189 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17190 [Switching to task 1]
17191 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17192 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17193 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17194 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17195 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17196 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17197 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17198 @end smallexample
17199
17200 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17201 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17202 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17203 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17204 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17205 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17206 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17207 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17208 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17209
17210 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17211 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17212 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17213 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17214 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17215
17216 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17217 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17218 program.
17219
17220 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17221 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17222 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17223
17224 For example,
17225
17226 @smallexample
17227 @iftex
17228 @leftskip=0.5cm
17229 @end iftex
17230 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17231 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17232 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17233 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17234 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17235 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17236 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17237 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17238 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17239 Continuing.
17240 task # 1 running
17241 task # 2 running
17242
17243 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17244 15 flush;
17245 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17246 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17247 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17248 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17249 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17250 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17251 @end smallexample
17252 @end table
17253
17254 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17255 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17256 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17257
17258 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17259 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17260 the platform being used.
17261 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17262 switching is not supported.
17263
17264 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17265 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17266 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17267 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17268 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17269 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17270
17271 @node Ravenscar Profile
17272 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17273 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17274
17275 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17276 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17277 requirements.
17278
17279 @table @code
17280 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17281 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17282 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17283 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17284 Profile. This is the default.
17285
17286 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17287 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17288 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17289 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17290 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17291 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17292 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17293
17294 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17295 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17296 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17297 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17298
17299 @end table
17300
17301 @node Ada Settings
17302 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17303 @cindex Ada settings
17304
17305 @table @code
17306 @kindex set varsize-limit
17307 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17308 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17309 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17310 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17311 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17312 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17313 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17314
17315 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17316 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17317 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17318 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17319 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17320 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17321 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17322 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17323 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17324 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17325 size is less than @var{size}.
17326
17327 @kindex show varsize-limit
17328 @item show varsize-limit
17329 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17330 @end table
17331
17332 @node Ada Glitches
17333 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17334 @cindex Ada, problems
17335
17336 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17337 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17338 @value{GDBN},
17339 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17340 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17341
17342 @itemize @bullet
17343 @item
17344 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17345 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17346
17347 @item
17348 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17349 argument lists are treated as positional).
17350
17351 @item
17352 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17353
17354 @item
17355 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17356 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17357 the host machine.
17358
17359 @item
17360 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17361 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17362 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17363 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17364 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17365 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17366 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17367 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17368 you can usually resolve the confusion
17369 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17370 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17371 @end itemize
17372
17373 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17374 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17375 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17376 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17377 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17378 enabled.
17379
17380 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17381 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17382 @table @code
17383
17384 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17385 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17386 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17387 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17388 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17389 This is the default.
17390
17391 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17392 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17393 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17394 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17395 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17396 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17397 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17398
17399 @end table
17400
17401 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17402 @cindex GNAT encoding
17403 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17404 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17405 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17406 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17407 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17408 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17409
17410 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17411 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17412 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17413 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17414 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17415 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17416 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17417 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17418
17419 @table @code
17420
17421 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17422 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17423 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17424 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17425
17426 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17427 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17428 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17429
17430 @end table
17431
17432 @node Unsupported Languages
17433 @section Unsupported Languages
17434
17435 @cindex unsupported languages
17436 @cindex minimal language
17437 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17438 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17439 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17440 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17441 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17442 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17443
17444 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17445 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17446 language.
17447
17448 @node Symbols
17449 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17450
17451 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17452 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17453 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17454 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17455 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17456 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17457 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17458
17459 @cindex symbol names
17460 @cindex names of symbols
17461 @cindex quoting names
17462 @anchor{quoting names}
17463 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17464 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17465 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17466 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17467 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17468 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17469 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17470 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17471
17472 @smallexample
17473 p 'foo.c'::x
17474 @end smallexample
17475
17476 @noindent
17477 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17478
17479 @table @code
17480 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17481 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17482 @kindex set case-sensitive
17483 @item set case-sensitive on
17484 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17485 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17486 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17487 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17488 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17489 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17490 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17491 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17492 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17493 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17494 case-insensitive matches.
17495
17496 @kindex show case-sensitive
17497 @item show case-sensitive
17498 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17499 lookups.
17500
17501 @kindex set print type methods
17502 @item set print type methods
17503 @itemx set print type methods on
17504 @itemx set print type methods off
17505 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17506 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17507 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17508 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17509 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17510 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17511
17512 @kindex show print type methods
17513 @item show print type methods
17514 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17515 classes.
17516
17517 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17518 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17519 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17520 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17521 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17522 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17523 types defined in classes.
17524
17525 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17526 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17527 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17528 printing classes.
17529
17530 @kindex set print type typedefs
17531 @item set print type typedefs
17532 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17533 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17534
17535 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17536 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17537 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17538 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17539 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17540 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17541 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17542 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17543 types.
17544
17545 @kindex show print type typedefs
17546 @item show print type typedefs
17547 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17548 printing classes.
17549
17550 @kindex info address
17551 @cindex address of a symbol
17552 @item info address @var{symbol}
17553 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17554 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17555 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17556 is always stored.
17557
17558 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17559 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17560 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17561
17562 @kindex info symbol
17563 @cindex symbol from address
17564 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17565 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17566 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17567 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17568 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17569
17570 @smallexample
17571 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17572 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17573 @end smallexample
17574
17575 @noindent
17576 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17577 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17578
17579 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17580 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17581
17582 @smallexample
17583 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17584 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17585 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17586 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17587 @end smallexample
17588
17589 @kindex demangle
17590 @cindex demangle
17591 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17592 Demangle @var{name}.
17593 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17594 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17595
17596 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17597 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17598
17599 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17600 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17601
17602 @kindex whatis
17603 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17604 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17605 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17606 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17607
17608 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17609 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17610 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17611
17612 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17613 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17614 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17615 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17616 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17617 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17618 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17619 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17620 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17621
17622 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17623 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17624 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17625 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17626 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17627 unroll it.
17628
17629 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17630 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17631 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17632
17633 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17634 Available flags are:
17635
17636 @table @code
17637 @item r
17638 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17639 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17640 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17641
17642 @item m
17643 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17644
17645 @item M
17646 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17647 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17648
17649 @item t
17650 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17651 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17652 names are substituted when printing other types.
17653
17654 @item T
17655 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17656 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17657
17658 @item o
17659 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17660 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17661
17662 For example, given the following declarations:
17663
17664 @smallexample
17665 struct tuv
17666 @{
17667 int a1;
17668 char *a2;
17669 int a3;
17670 @};
17671
17672 struct xyz
17673 @{
17674 int f1;
17675 char f2;
17676 void *f3;
17677 struct tuv f4;
17678 @};
17679
17680 union qwe
17681 @{
17682 struct tuv fff1;
17683 struct xyz fff2;
17684 @};
17685
17686 struct tyu
17687 @{
17688 int a1 : 1;
17689 int a2 : 3;
17690 int a3 : 23;
17691 char a4 : 2;
17692 int64_t a5;
17693 int a6 : 5;
17694 int64_t a7 : 3;
17695 @};
17696 @end smallexample
17697
17698 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17699
17700 @smallexample
17701 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17702 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17703 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17704 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17705 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17706 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17707
17708 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17709 @}
17710 @end smallexample
17711
17712 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17713 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17714 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17715 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17716 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17717 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17718 its fields.
17719
17720 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17721
17722 @smallexample
17723 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17724 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17725 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17726 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17727 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17728 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17729 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17730
17731 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17732 @} fff1;
17733 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17734 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17735 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17736 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17737 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17738 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17739 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17740 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17741 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17742 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17743
17744 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17745 @} f4;
17746
17747 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17748 @} fff2;
17749
17750 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17751 @}
17752 @end smallexample
17753
17754 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17755 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17756 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17757 of these structures' fields.
17758
17759 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17760 bitfields:
17761
17762 @smallexample
17763 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17764 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17765 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17766 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17767 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17768 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17769 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17770 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17771 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17772 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17773 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17774
17775 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17776 @}
17777 @end smallexample
17778
17779 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17780 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17781 @end table
17782
17783 @kindex ptype
17784 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17785 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17786 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17787 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17788
17789 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17790 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17791 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17792 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17793 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17794 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17795 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17796 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17797
17798 For example, for this variable declaration:
17799
17800 @smallexample
17801 typedef double real_t;
17802 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17803 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17804 complex_t var;
17805 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17806 @end smallexample
17807
17808 @noindent
17809 the two commands give this output:
17810
17811 @smallexample
17812 @group
17813 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17814 type = complex_t
17815 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17816 type = struct complex @{
17817 real_t real;
17818 double imag;
17819 @}
17820 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17821 type = struct complex
17822 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17823 type = struct complex
17824 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17825 type = struct complex @{
17826 real_t real;
17827 double imag;
17828 @}
17829 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17830 type = real_t *
17831 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17832 type = double *
17833 @end group
17834 @end smallexample
17835
17836 @noindent
17837 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17838 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17839
17840 @cindex incomplete type
17841 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17842 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17843 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17844 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17845 given these declarations:
17846
17847 @smallexample
17848 struct foo;
17849 struct foo *fooptr;
17850 @end smallexample
17851
17852 @noindent
17853 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17854
17855 @smallexample
17856 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17857 $1 = <incomplete type>
17858 @end smallexample
17859
17860 @noindent
17861 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17862 completely specified.
17863
17864 @cindex unknown type
17865 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17866 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17867 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17868 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17869 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17870 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17871 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17872 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17873
17874 @smallexample
17875 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17876 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17877 @end smallexample
17878
17879 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17880 of such variables.
17881
17882 @kindex info types
17883 @item info types @var{regexp}
17884 @itemx info types
17885 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17886 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17887 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17888 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17889 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17890 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17891 name is @code{value}.
17892
17893 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
17894 to print the type description according to the
17895 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
17896 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
17897 language of the type, other values mean to use
17898 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
17899
17900 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17901 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17902 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17903
17904 @kindex info type-printers
17905 @item info type-printers
17906 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17907 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17908 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17909 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17910 type printers.
17911
17912 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17913
17914 @kindex enable type-printer
17915 @kindex disable type-printer
17916 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17917 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17918 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17919
17920 @kindex info scope
17921 @cindex local variables
17922 @item info scope @var{location}
17923 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17924 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17925 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17926 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17927 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17928
17929 @smallexample
17930 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17931 Scope for command_line_handler:
17932 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17933 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17934 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17935 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17936 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17937 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17938 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17939 @end smallexample
17940
17941 @noindent
17942 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17943 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17944 collect}.
17945
17946 @kindex info source
17947 @item info source
17948 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17949 the function containing the current point of execution:
17950 @itemize @bullet
17951 @item
17952 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17953 @item
17954 the directory it was compiled in,
17955 @item
17956 its length, in lines,
17957 @item
17958 which programming language it is written in,
17959 @item
17960 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17961 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17962 @item
17963 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17964 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17965 @item
17966 whether the debugging information includes information about
17967 preprocessor macros.
17968 @end itemize
17969
17970
17971 @kindex info sources
17972 @item info sources
17973 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17974 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17975 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17976
17977 @kindex info functions
17978 @item info functions [-q]
17979 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17980 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17981 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17982 number.
17983
17984 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
17985 to print the function name and type according to the
17986 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
17987 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
17988 language of the function, other values mean to use
17989 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
17990
17991 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
17992 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
17993 have been printed.
17994
17995 @item info functions [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
17996 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
17997 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
17998
17999 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18000 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18001 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18002 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18003 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18004 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18005 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18006
18007 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18008 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18009 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18010 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18011 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18012 of special characters or quotes.
18013 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18014 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18015 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18016 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18017 int.
18018
18019 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18020 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18021 @var{type_regexp}.
18022
18023
18024 @kindex info variables
18025 @item info variables [-q]
18026 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18027 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18028 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18029 their respective source line numbers.
18030
18031 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18032 to print the variable name and type according to the
18033 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18034 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18035 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18036 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18037
18038 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18039 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18040 have been printed.
18041
18042 @item info variables [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18043 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18044 with the provided regexp(s).
18045
18046 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18047 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18048
18049 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18050 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18051 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18052 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18053 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18054 of special characters or quotes.
18055
18056 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18057 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18058 @var{type_regexp}.
18059
18060 @kindex info classes
18061 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18062 @item info classes
18063 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18064 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18065 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18066 expression.
18067
18068 @kindex info selectors
18069 @item info selectors
18070 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18071 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18072 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18073 expression.
18074
18075 @ignore
18076 This was never implemented.
18077 @kindex info methods
18078 @item info methods
18079 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18080 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18081 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18082 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18083 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18084 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18085 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18086 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18087 @end ignore
18088
18089 @cindex opaque data types
18090 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18091 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18092 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18093 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18094 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18095 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18096 another source file. The default is on.
18097
18098 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18099 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18100
18101 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18102 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18103 is printed as follows:
18104 @smallexample
18105 @{<no data fields>@}
18106 @end smallexample
18107
18108 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18109 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18110 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18111
18112 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18113 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18114 @item set print symbol-loading
18115 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18116 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18117 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18118 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18119 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18120 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18121 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18122 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18123 can be annoying.
18124 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18125 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18126 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18127 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18128
18129 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18130 @item show print symbol-loading
18131 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18132 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18133
18134 @kindex maint print symbols
18135 @cindex symbol dump
18136 @kindex maint print psymbols
18137 @cindex partial symbol dump
18138 @kindex maint print msymbols
18139 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18140 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18141 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18142 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18143 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18144 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18145 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18146 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18147 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18148 that objfile.
18149 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18150 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18151 @code{main}.
18152 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18153 source file.
18154
18155 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18156 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18157 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18158 tables.
18159 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18160 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18161 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18162 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18163 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18164 ``ELF symbols''.
18165
18166 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18167 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18168
18169 @kindex maint info symtabs
18170 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18171 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18172 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18173 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18174 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18175 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18176 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18177
18178 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18179 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18180 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18181 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18182 structure in more detail. For example:
18183
18184 @smallexample
18185 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18186 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18187 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18188 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18189 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18190 readin no
18191 fullname (null)
18192 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18193 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18194 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18195 dependencies (none)
18196 @}
18197 @}
18198 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18199 (@value{GDBP})
18200 @end smallexample
18201 @noindent
18202 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18203 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18204 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18205 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18206 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18207
18208 @smallexample
18209 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18210 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18211 line 1574.
18212 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18213 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18214 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18215 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18216 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18217 dirname (null)
18218 fullname (null)
18219 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18220 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18221 debugformat DWARF 2
18222 @}
18223 @}
18224 (@value{GDBP})
18225 @end smallexample
18226
18227 @kindex maint info line-table
18228 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18229 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18230 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18231
18232 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18233 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18234 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18235
18236 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18237 @cindex symbol cache size
18238 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18239 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18240 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18241 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18242 with different sizes.
18243
18244 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18245 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18246 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18247
18248 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18249 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18250 @item maint print symbol-cache
18251 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18252 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18253
18254 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18255 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18256 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18257 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18258 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18259
18260 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18261 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18262 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18263 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18264 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18265 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18266
18267 @end table
18268
18269 @node Altering
18270 @chapter Altering Execution
18271
18272 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18273 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18274 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18275 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18276 program.
18277
18278 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18279 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18280 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18281
18282 @menu
18283 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18284 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18285 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18286 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18287 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18288 * Patching:: Patching your program
18289 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18290 @end menu
18291
18292 @node Assignment
18293 @section Assignment to Variables
18294
18295 @cindex assignment
18296 @cindex setting variables
18297 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18298 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18299
18300 @smallexample
18301 print x=4
18302 @end smallexample
18303
18304 @noindent
18305 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18306 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18307 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18308 information on operators in supported languages.
18309
18310 @kindex set variable
18311 @cindex variables, setting
18312 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18313 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18314 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18315 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18316 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18317
18318 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18319 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18320 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18321 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18322 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18323 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18324 command @code{set width}:
18325
18326 @smallexample
18327 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18328 type = double
18329 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18330 $4 = 13
18331 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18332 Invalid syntax in expression.
18333 @end smallexample
18334
18335 @noindent
18336 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18337 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18338
18339 @smallexample
18340 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18341 @end smallexample
18342
18343 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18344 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18345 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18346 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18347 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18348 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18349
18350 @smallexample
18351 @group
18352 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18353 type = double
18354 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18355 $1 = 1
18356 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18357 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18358 $2 = 1
18359 (@value{GDBP}) r
18360 The program being debugged has been started already.
18361 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18362 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18363 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18364 Invalid bfd target.
18365 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18366 The current BFD target is "=4".
18367 @end group
18368 @end smallexample
18369
18370 @noindent
18371 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18372 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18373 @code{g}, use
18374
18375 @smallexample
18376 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18377 @end smallexample
18378
18379 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18380 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18381 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18382 same length or shorter.
18383 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18384 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18385
18386 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18387 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18388 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18389 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18390 and representation in memory), and
18391
18392 @smallexample
18393 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18394 @end smallexample
18395
18396 @noindent
18397 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18398
18399 @node Jumping
18400 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18401
18402 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18403 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18404 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18405
18406 @table @code
18407 @kindex jump
18408 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18409 @item jump @var{location}
18410 @itemx j @var{location}
18411 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18412 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18413 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18414 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18415 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18416
18417 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18418 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18419 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18420 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18421 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18422 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18423 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18424 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18425 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18426 @end table
18427
18428 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18429 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18430 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18431 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18432 example,
18433
18434 @smallexample
18435 set $pc = 0x485
18436 @end smallexample
18437
18438 @noindent
18439 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18440 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18441 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18442
18443 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18444 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18445 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18446 detail.
18447
18448 @c @group
18449 @node Signaling
18450 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18451 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18452
18453 @table @code
18454 @kindex signal
18455 @item signal @var{signal}
18456 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18457 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18458 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18459 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18460
18461 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18462 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18463 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18464 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18465 signal.
18466
18467 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18468 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18469 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18470 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18471 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18472 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18473 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18474 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18475
18476 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18477 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18478 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18479 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18480 passes the signal directly to your program.
18481
18482 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18483 after executing the command.
18484
18485 @kindex queue-signal
18486 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18487 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18488 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18489 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18490 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18491 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18492 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18493 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18494 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18495
18496 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18497 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18498 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18499 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18500 @code{continue} command.
18501
18502 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18503 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18504 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18505 (@pxref{Signals}).
18506 @end table
18507 @c @end group
18508
18509 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18510 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18511
18512 @node Returning
18513 @section Returning from a Function
18514
18515 @table @code
18516 @cindex returning from a function
18517 @kindex return
18518 @item return
18519 @itemx return @var{expression}
18520 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18521 command. If you give an
18522 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18523 value.
18524 @end table
18525
18526 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18527 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18528 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18529 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18530
18531 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18532 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18533 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18534 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18535 of functions.
18536
18537 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18538 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18539 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18540 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18541 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18542
18543 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18544 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18545 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18546 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18547 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18548 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18549 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18550 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18551 assignment into the right register(s).
18552
18553 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18554 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18555 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18556 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18557 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18558 into a @code{long long int}:
18559
18560 @smallexample
18561 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18562 29 return 31;
18563 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18564 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18565 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18566 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18567 (@value{GDBP})
18568 @end smallexample
18569
18570 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18571 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18572 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18573 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18574 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18575 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18576 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18577 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18578
18579 @smallexample
18580 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18581 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18582 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18583 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18584 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18585 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18586 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18587 (@value{GDBP})
18588 @end smallexample
18589
18590 @node Calling
18591 @section Calling Program Functions
18592
18593 @table @code
18594 @cindex calling functions
18595 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18596 @item print @var{expr}
18597 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18598 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18599 debugged.
18600
18601 @kindex call
18602 @item call @var{expr}
18603 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18604 returned values.
18605
18606 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18607 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18608 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18609 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18610 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18611 value history.
18612 @end table
18613
18614 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18615 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18616 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18617 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18618
18619 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18620 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18621 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18622 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18623 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18624 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18625 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18626 in that case is controlled by the
18627 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18628
18629 @table @code
18630 @item set unwindonsignal
18631 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18632 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18633 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18634 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18635 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18636 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18637 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18638 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18639 received.
18640
18641 @item show unwindonsignal
18642 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18643 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18644 @value{GDBN}.
18645
18646 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18647 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18648 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18649 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18650 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18651 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18652 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18653 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18654 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18655 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18656
18657 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18658 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18659 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18660 @value{GDBN}.
18661
18662 @end table
18663
18664 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18665
18666 @cindex no debug info functions
18667 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18668 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18669 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18670 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18671 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18672 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18673
18674 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18675 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18676 declared return type. For example:
18677
18678 @smallexample
18679 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18680 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18681 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18682 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18683 @end smallexample
18684
18685 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18686 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18687 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18688 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18689
18690 @smallexample
18691 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18692 @end smallexample
18693
18694 @noindent
18695 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18696
18697 @smallexample
18698 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18699 @end smallexample
18700
18701 @noindent
18702 these calls are equivalent:
18703
18704 @smallexample
18705 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18706 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18707 @end smallexample
18708
18709 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18710 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18711 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18712 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18713 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18714 float parameters, and no debug info:
18715
18716 @smallexample
18717 float
18718 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18719 float v1, v2;
18720 @{
18721 return v1 * v2;
18722 @}
18723 @end smallexample
18724
18725 @noindent
18726 you call it like this:
18727
18728 @smallexample
18729 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18730 @end smallexample
18731
18732 @node Patching
18733 @section Patching Programs
18734
18735 @cindex patching binaries
18736 @cindex writing into executables
18737 @cindex writing into corefiles
18738
18739 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18740 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18741 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18742 patching your program's binary.
18743
18744 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18745 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18746 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18747 repairs.
18748
18749 @table @code
18750 @kindex set write
18751 @item set write on
18752 @itemx set write off
18753 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18754 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18755 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18756
18757 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18758 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18759 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18760
18761 @item show write
18762 @kindex show write
18763 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18764 as well as reading.
18765 @end table
18766
18767 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18768 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18769 @cindex injecting code
18770 @cindex writing into executables
18771 @cindex compiling code
18772
18773 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18774 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18775 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18776 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18777
18778 @table @code
18779 @kindex compile code
18780 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18781 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18782 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18783 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18784 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18785 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18786 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18787 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18788 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18789 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18790 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18791 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18792
18793 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18794 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18795 E.g.:
18796
18797 @smallexample
18798 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18799 @end smallexample
18800
18801 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18802 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18803 from actual source code. E.g.:
18804
18805 @smallexample
18806 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18807 @end smallexample
18808
18809 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18810 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18811 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18812 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18813 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18814 editor.
18815
18816 @smallexample
18817 compile code
18818 >printf ("hello\n");
18819 >printf ("world\n");
18820 >end
18821 @end smallexample
18822
18823 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18824 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18825 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18826 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18827 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18828 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18829 inferior symbols otherwise.
18830
18831 @kindex compile file
18832 @item compile file @var{filename}
18833 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18834 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18835
18836 @smallexample
18837 compile file /home/user/example.c
18838 @end smallexample
18839 @end table
18840
18841 @table @code
18842 @item compile print @var{expr}
18843 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18844 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18845 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18846 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18847 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18848 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18849 Formats}.
18850
18851 @item compile print
18852 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18853 @cindex reprint the last value
18854 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18855 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18856 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18857 multiple-line editor.
18858 @end table
18859
18860 @noindent
18861 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18862
18863 @table @code
18864 @anchor{set debug compile}
18865 @item set debug compile
18866 @cindex compile command debugging info
18867 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18868 injecting the code. The default is off.
18869
18870 @item show debug compile
18871 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18872 compiling and injecting the code.
18873
18874 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18875 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18876 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18877 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18878 The default is off.
18879
18880 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18881 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18882 C@t{++} type conversion.
18883 @end table
18884
18885 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18886
18887 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18888 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18889 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18890 injecting process.
18891
18892 @noindent
18893 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18894
18895 @table @asis
18896 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18897 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18898 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18899 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18900
18901 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18902 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18903 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18904 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18905 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18906 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18907 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18908 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18909
18910 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18911 @end table
18912
18913 @noindent
18914 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18915
18916 @table @code
18917 @item set compile-args
18918 @cindex compile command options override
18919 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18920 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18921 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18922 compilation.
18923
18924 @item show compile-args
18925 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18926 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18927 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18928 @end table
18929
18930 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18931
18932 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18933 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18934 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18935
18936 @table @asis
18937 @item C code examples and caveats
18938 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18939 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18940 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18941 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18942 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18943
18944 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18945 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18946 much like any other normal debugging session.
18947
18948 @smallexample
18949 void function1 (void)
18950 @{
18951 int i = 42;
18952 printf ("function 1\n");
18953 @}
18954
18955 void function2 (void)
18956 @{
18957 int j = 12;
18958 function1 ();
18959 @}
18960
18961 int main(void)
18962 @{
18963 int k = 6;
18964 int *p;
18965 function2 ();
18966 return 0;
18967 @}
18968 @end smallexample
18969
18970 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18971 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18972 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18973
18974 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18975 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18976 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18977 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18978 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18979
18980 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18981 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18982 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18983 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18984 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18985 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18986 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18987 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18988 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18989 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18990
18991 @smallexample
18992 compile code k = 3;
18993 @end smallexample
18994
18995 @noindent
18996 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18997 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18998 @code{compile} command changes it.
18999
19000 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19001 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19002 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19003 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19004 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19005
19006 @smallexample
19007 compile code j = 3;
19008 @end smallexample
19009
19010 @noindent
19011 will result in a compilation error message.
19012
19013 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19014 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19015 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19016
19017 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19018 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19019 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19020 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19021
19022 @smallexample
19023 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19024 @end smallexample
19025
19026 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19027 command has completed:
19028
19029 @smallexample
19030 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19031 @end smallexample
19032
19033 @noindent
19034 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19035 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19036 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19037 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19038 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19039
19040 @smallexample
19041 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19042 @end smallexample
19043
19044 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19045 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19046 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19047 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19048 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19049 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19050 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19051 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19052
19053 @smallexample
19054 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19055 @end smallexample
19056
19057 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19058 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19059 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19060 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19061 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19062 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19063 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19064
19065 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19066 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19067 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19068 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19069 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19070 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19071
19072 @smallexample
19073 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19074 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19075 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19076 Compilation failed.
19077 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19078 42
19079 @end smallexample
19080
19081 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19082 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19083 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19084 will print to the console.
19085 @end table
19086
19087 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19088
19089 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19090 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19091 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19092 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19093 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19094 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19095 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19096 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19097
19098
19099 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19100 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19101 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19102 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19103 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19104 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19105 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19106
19107 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19108 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19109 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19110 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19111 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19112 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19113 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19114
19115 @table @code
19116 @item set compile-gcc
19117 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19118 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19119 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19120 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19121 default.
19122
19123 @item show compile-gcc
19124 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19125 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19126 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19127 @end table
19128
19129 @node GDB Files
19130 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19131
19132 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19133 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19134 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19135 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19136
19137 @menu
19138 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19139 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19140 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19141 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19142 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19143 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19144 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19145 @end menu
19146
19147 @node Files
19148 @section Commands to Specify Files
19149
19150 @cindex symbol table
19151 @cindex core dump file
19152
19153 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19154 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19155 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19156 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19157
19158 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19159 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19160 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19161 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19162 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19163 new files are useful.
19164
19165 @table @code
19166 @cindex executable file
19167 @kindex file
19168 @item file @var{filename}
19169 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19170 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19171 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19172 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19173 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19174 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19175 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19176 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19177
19178 @cindex unlinked object files
19179 @cindex patching object files
19180 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19181 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19182 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19183 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19184 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19185 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19186 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19187 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19188
19189 @item file
19190 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19191 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19192
19193 @kindex exec-file
19194 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19195 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19196 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19197 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19198 discard information on the executable file.
19199
19200 @kindex symbol-file
19201 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19202 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19203 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19204 table and program to run from the same file.
19205
19206 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19207 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19208 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19209 enabled.
19210
19211 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19212 program's symbol table.
19213
19214 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19215 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19216 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19217 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19218 @value{GDBN}.
19219
19220 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19221 executing it once.
19222
19223 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19224 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19225 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19226 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19227 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19228 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19229 optimized code.
19230
19231 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19232 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19233 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19234 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19235 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19236
19237 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19238 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19239 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19240 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19241 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19242 Warnings and Messages}.)
19243
19244 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19245 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19246 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19247 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19248 in stabs format.
19249
19250 @kindex readnow
19251 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19252 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19253 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19254 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19255 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19256 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19257 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19258 entire symbol table available.
19259
19260 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19261 @cindex never read symbols
19262 @cindex symbols, never read
19263 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19264 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19265 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19266 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19267 @xref{--readnever}.
19268
19269 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19270 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19271 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19272 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19273 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19274 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19275 @c files.
19276
19277 @kindex core-file
19278 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19279 @itemx core
19280 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19281 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19282 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19283 executable file itself for other parts.
19284
19285 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19286 to be used.
19287
19288 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19289 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19290 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19291 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19292 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19293
19294 @kindex add-symbol-file
19295 @cindex dynamic linking
19296 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19297 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19298 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19299 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19300 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19301 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19302 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19303 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19304 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19305 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19306 can be given as an expression.
19307
19308 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19309 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19310 specified explicitly.
19311
19312 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19313 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19314 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19315 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19316
19317 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19318
19319 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19320 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19321 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19322 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19323 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19324 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19325 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19326 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19327 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19328
19329 @itemize @bullet
19330 @item
19331 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19332 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19333 @item
19334 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19335 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19336 @item
19337 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19338 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19339 @end itemize
19340
19341 @noindent
19342 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19343 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19344 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19345 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19346 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19347 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19348 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19349 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19350 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19351 way.
19352
19353 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19354
19355 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19356 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19357 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19358 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19359 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19360 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19361
19362 @smallexample
19363 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19364 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19365 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19366 (y or n) y
19367 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19368 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19369 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19370 (gdb)
19371 @end smallexample
19372
19373
19374 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19375
19376 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19377 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19378 @cindex load symbols from memory
19379 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19380 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19381 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19382 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19383 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19384 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19385 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19386 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19387 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19388
19389 @kindex section
19390 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19391 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19392 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19393 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19394 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19395 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19396 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19397 their addresses.
19398
19399 @kindex info files
19400 @kindex info target
19401 @item info files
19402 @itemx info target
19403 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19404 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19405 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19406 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19407 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19408 current ones.
19409
19410 @kindex maint info sections
19411 @item maint info sections
19412 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19413 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19414 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19415 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19416 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19417 may be arbitrarily combined):
19418
19419 @table @code
19420 @item ALLOBJ
19421 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19422 @item @var{sections}
19423 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19424 @item @var{section-flags}
19425 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19426 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19427 @table @code
19428 @item ALLOC
19429 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19430 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19431 @item LOAD
19432 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19433 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19434 @item RELOC
19435 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19436 @item READONLY
19437 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19438 @item CODE
19439 Section contains executable code only.
19440 @item DATA
19441 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19442 @item ROM
19443 Section will reside in ROM.
19444 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19445 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19446 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19447 Section is not empty.
19448 @item NEVER_LOAD
19449 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19450 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19451 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19452 COFF shared library information.
19453 @item IS_COMMON
19454 Section contains common symbols.
19455 @end table
19456 @end table
19457 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19458 @cindex read-only sections
19459 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19460 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19461 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19462 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19463 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19464 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19465 enhancement to debugging performance.
19466
19467 The default is off.
19468
19469 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19470 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19471 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19472 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19473
19474 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19475 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19476 @end table
19477
19478 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19479 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19480 name and remembers it that way.
19481
19482 @cindex shared libraries
19483 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19484 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19485 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19486 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19487
19488 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19489 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19490
19491 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19492 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19493 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19494 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19495 debugging a core file).
19496
19497 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19498 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19499 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19500
19501 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19502 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19503 particularly large or there are many of them.
19504
19505 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19506 commands:
19507
19508 @table @code
19509 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19510 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19511 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19512 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19513 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19514 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19515 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19516 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19517
19518 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19519 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19520 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19521 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19522 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19523 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19524 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19525 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19526 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19527
19528 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19529 @item show auto-solib-add
19530 Display the current autoloading mode.
19531 @end table
19532
19533 @cindex load shared library
19534 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19535 command:
19536
19537 @table @code
19538 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19539 @kindex info share
19540 @item info share @var{regex}
19541 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19542 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19543 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19544 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19545
19546 @kindex info dll
19547 @item info dll @var{regex}
19548 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19549
19550 @kindex sharedlibrary
19551 @kindex share
19552 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19553 @itemx share @var{regex}
19554 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19555 Unix regular expression.
19556 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19557 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19558 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19559 loaded.
19560
19561 @item nosharedlibrary
19562 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19563 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19564 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19565 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19566 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19567 discarded.
19568 @end table
19569
19570 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19571 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19572 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19573 Catchpoints}).
19574
19575 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19576 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19577 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19578 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19579
19580 @table @code
19581 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19582 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19583 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19584 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19585 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19586 shared library.
19587
19588 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19589 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19590 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19591 library events happen.
19592 @end table
19593
19594 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19595 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19596 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19597 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19598 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19599 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19600 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19601 not.
19602
19603 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19604 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19605 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19606 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19607 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19608
19609 @table @code
19610 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19611 @cindex system root, alternate
19612 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19613 @kindex set sysroot
19614 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19615 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19616 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19617 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19618 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19619 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19620 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19621 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19622 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19623 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19624 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19625 @var{path}.
19626
19627 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19628 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19629 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19630 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19631 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19632 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19633 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19634 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19635 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19636 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19637 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19638 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19639 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19640 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19641
19642 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19643 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19644 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19645 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19646 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19647
19648 @smallexample
19649 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19650 @end smallexample
19651
19652 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19653 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19654 system:
19655
19656 @smallexample
19657 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19658 @end smallexample
19659
19660 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19661 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19662 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19663 colons:
19664
19665 @smallexample
19666 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19667 @end smallexample
19668
19669 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19670 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19671 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19672 @samp{z}):
19673
19674 @smallexample
19675 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19676 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19677 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19678 @end smallexample
19679
19680 @noindent
19681 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19682 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19683 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19684
19685 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19686 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19687
19688 @smallexample
19689 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19690 @end smallexample
19691
19692 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19693 if you don't want or need to.
19694
19695 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19696 sysroot}.
19697
19698 @cindex default system root
19699 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19700 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19701 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19702 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19703 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19704 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19705 location.
19706
19707 @kindex show sysroot
19708 @item show sysroot
19709 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19710
19711 @kindex set solib-search-path
19712 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19713 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19714 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19715 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19716 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19717 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19718 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19719 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19720 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19721 of shared library symbols.
19722
19723 @kindex show solib-search-path
19724 @item show solib-search-path
19725 Display the current shared library search path.
19726
19727 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19728 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19729 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19730 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19731 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19732
19733 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19734 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19735 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19736 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19737 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19738 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19739 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19740 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19741 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19742 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19743 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19744 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19745 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19746 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19747 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19748 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19749 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19750 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19751 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19752 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19753 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19754 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19755
19756 @table @code
19757 @item unix
19758 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19759 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19760 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19761 the forward slash.
19762
19763 @item dos-based
19764 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19765 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19766 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19767 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19768 considered directory separators.
19769
19770 @item auto
19771 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19772 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19773 This is the default.
19774 @end table
19775 @end table
19776
19777 @cindex file name canonicalization
19778 @cindex base name differences
19779 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19780 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19781 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19782 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19783 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19784 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19785 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19786 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19787 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19788 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19789 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19790 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19791 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19792 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19793 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19794
19795 @table @code
19796 @item set basenames-may-differ
19797 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19798 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19799
19800 @item show basenames-may-differ
19801 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19802 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19803 @end table
19804
19805 @node File Caching
19806 @section File Caching
19807 @cindex caching of opened files
19808 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19809
19810 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19811 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19812 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19813 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19814
19815 @table @code
19816 @kindex maint info bfds
19817 @item maint info bfds
19818 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19819 @value{GDBN}.
19820
19821 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19822 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19823 @kindex bfd caching
19824 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19825 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19826 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19827 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19828 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19829 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19830 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19831 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19832 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19833
19834 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19835 @kindex bfd caching
19836 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19837 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19838
19839 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19840 @kindex bfd caching
19841 @item show debug bfd-cache
19842 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19843 @end table
19844
19845 @node Separate Debug Files
19846 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19847 @cindex separate debugging information files
19848 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19849 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19850 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19851 @cindex global debugging information directories
19852 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19853 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19854
19855 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19856 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19857 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19858 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19859 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19860 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19861 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19862
19863 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19864 file:
19865
19866 @itemize @bullet
19867 @item
19868 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19869 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19870 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19871 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19872 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19873 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19874 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19875 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19876
19877 @item
19878 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19879 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19880 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19881 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19882 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19883 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19884 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19885 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19886 below.
19887 @end itemize
19888
19889 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19890 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19891
19892 @itemize @bullet
19893 @item
19894 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19895 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19896 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19897 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19898 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19899
19900 @item
19901 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19902 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19903 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19904 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19905 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19906 hex characters, not 10.)
19907 @end itemize
19908
19909 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19910 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19911 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19912 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19913 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19914 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19915
19916 @itemize @minus
19917 @item
19918 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19919 @item
19920 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19921 @item
19922 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19923 @item
19924 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19925 @end itemize
19926
19927 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19928 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19929 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19930 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19931 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19932
19933 @table @code
19934
19935 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19936 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19937 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19938 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19939 concatenating them by a path separator.
19940
19941 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19942 @item show debug-file-directory
19943 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19944 information files.
19945
19946 @end table
19947
19948 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19949 @cindex debug link sections
19950 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19951 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19952
19953 @itemize
19954 @item
19955 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19956 a zero byte,
19957 @item
19958 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19959 boundary within the section, and
19960 @item
19961 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19962 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19963 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19964 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19965 @end itemize
19966
19967 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19968 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19969 described above.
19970
19971 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19972 @cindex build ID sections
19973 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19974 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19975 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19976 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19977 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19978 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19979 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19980 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19981 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19982
19983 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19984 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19985 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19986 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19987 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19988 in an ordinary executable.
19989
19990 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19991 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19992 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19993 following commands:
19994
19995 @smallexample
19996 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19997 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19998 @end smallexample
19999
20000 @noindent
20001 These commands remove the debugging
20002 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20003 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20004 two files:
20005
20006 @itemize @bullet
20007 @item
20008 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20009 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20010
20011 @smallexample
20012 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20013 @end smallexample
20014
20015 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20016 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20017 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20018 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20019
20020 @item
20021 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20022 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20023 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20024 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20025 @end itemize
20026
20027 @noindent
20028
20029 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20030 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20031 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20032
20033 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20034 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20035 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20036 @c different ways!
20037 @ifhtml
20038 @display
20039 @html
20040 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20041 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20042 @end html
20043 @end display
20044 @end ifhtml
20045 @ifnothtml
20046 @display
20047 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20048 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20049 @end display
20050 @end ifnothtml
20051
20052 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20053 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20054 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20055 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20056 CRC.
20057
20058 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20059 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20060 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20061 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20062 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20063
20064 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20065 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20066 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20067 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20068 @code{0xffffffff}.
20069
20070 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20071 @smallexample
20072 unsigned long
20073 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20074 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20075 @{
20076 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20077 @{
20078 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20079 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20080 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20081 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20082 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20083 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20084 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20085 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20086 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20087 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20088 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20089 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20090 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20091 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20092 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20093 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20094 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20095 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20096 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20097 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20098 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20099 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20100 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20101 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20102 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20103 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20104 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20105 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20106 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20107 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20108 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20109 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20110 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20111 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20112 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20113 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20114 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20115 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20116 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20117 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20118 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20119 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20120 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20121 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20122 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20123 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20124 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20125 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20126 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20127 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20128 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20129 0x2d02ef8d
20130 @};
20131 unsigned char *end;
20132
20133 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20134 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20135 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20136 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20137 @}
20138 @end smallexample
20139
20140 @noindent
20141 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20142
20143 @node MiniDebugInfo
20144 @section Debugging information in a special section
20145 @cindex separate debug sections
20146 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20147
20148 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20149 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20150 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20151 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20152
20153 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20154 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20155 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20156 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20157 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20158 debugging information might be included in the section.
20159
20160 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20161 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20162 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20163
20164 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20165 standard utilities:
20166
20167 @smallexample
20168 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20169 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20170 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20171 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20172
20173 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20174 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20175 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20176 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20177 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20178 | sort > funcsyms
20179
20180 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20181 # table.
20182 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20183
20184 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20185 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20186
20187 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20188 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20189 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20190 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20191
20192 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20193 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20194
20195 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20196 # original binary.
20197 xz mini_debuginfo
20198 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20199 @end smallexample
20200
20201 @node Index Files
20202 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20203 @cindex index files
20204 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20205
20206 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20207 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20208 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20209 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20210 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20211 startup.
20212
20213 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20214 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20215 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20219 @end smallexample
20220
20221 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20222
20223 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20224 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20225
20226 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20227 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20228 using @command{objcopy}.
20229
20230 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20231
20232 @table @code
20233 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20234 @kindex save gdb-index
20235 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20236 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20237 default creates it produces a single file
20238 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20239 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20240 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20241 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20242 given @var{directory}.
20243 @end table
20244
20245 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20246 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20247
20248 @smallexample
20249 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20250 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20254
20255 @smallexample
20256 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20257 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20258 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20259 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20260 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20261 @end smallexample
20262
20263 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20264 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20265 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20266 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20267 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20268 The default is @code{off}.
20269 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20270 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20271
20272 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20273 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20274
20275 @smallexample
20276 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20277 @end smallexample
20278
20279 Instead you must do, for example,
20280
20281 @smallexample
20282 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20283 @end smallexample
20284
20285 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20286 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20287 currently work for programs using Ada.
20288
20289 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20290
20291 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20292 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20293 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20294 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20295
20296 @table @code
20297
20298 @item set index-cache on
20299 @itemx set index-cache off
20300 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20301
20302 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20303 @itemx show index-cache directory
20304 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20305
20306 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20307 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20308 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20309 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20310 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20311 differ according to local convention.
20312
20313 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20314 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20315
20316 @item show index-cache stats
20317 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20318
20319 @end table
20320
20321 @node Symbol Errors
20322 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20323
20324 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20325 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20326 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20327 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20328 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20329 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20330 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20331 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20332 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20333 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20334 Messages}).
20335
20336 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20337
20338 @table @code
20339 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20340
20341 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20342 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20343 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20344 in its outer scope blocks.
20345
20346 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20347 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20348 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20349 function.
20350
20351 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20352
20353 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20354 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20355 do so.
20356
20357 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20358 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20359 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20360 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20361 Messages}.)
20362
20363 @item bad block start address patched
20364
20365 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20366 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20367 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20368
20369 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20370 starting on the previous source line.
20371
20372 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20373
20374 @cindex foo
20375 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20376 larger than the size of the string table.
20377
20378 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20379 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20380 with this name.
20381
20382 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20383
20384 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20385 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20386 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20387
20388 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20389 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20390 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20391 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20392 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20393 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20394
20395 @item stub type has NULL name
20396
20397 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20398
20399 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20400 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20401 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20402 it.
20403
20404 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20405
20406 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20407
20408 @end table
20409
20410 @node Data Files
20411 @section GDB Data Files
20412
20413 @cindex prefix for data files
20414 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20415 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20416
20417 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20418 is currently using.
20419
20420 @table @code
20421 @kindex set data-directory
20422 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20423 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20424 to @var{directory}.
20425
20426 @kindex show data-directory
20427 @item show data-directory
20428 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20429 @end table
20430
20431 @cindex default data directory
20432 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20433 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20434 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20435 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20436 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20437 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20438 location.
20439
20440 The data directory may also be specified with the
20441 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20442 @xref{Mode Options}.
20443
20444 @node Targets
20445 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20446
20447 @cindex debugging target
20448 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20449
20450 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20451 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20452 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20453 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20454 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20455 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20456 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20457 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20458
20459 @cindex target architecture
20460 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20461 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20462 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20463 command.
20464
20465 @table @code
20466 @kindex set architecture
20467 @kindex show architecture
20468 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20469 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20470 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20471 supported architectures.
20472
20473 @item show architecture
20474 Show the current target architecture.
20475
20476 @item set processor
20477 @itemx processor
20478 @kindex set processor
20479 @kindex show processor
20480 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20481 and @code{show architecture}.
20482 @end table
20483
20484 @menu
20485 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20486 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20487 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20488 @end menu
20489
20490 @node Active Targets
20491 @section Active Targets
20492
20493 @cindex stacking targets
20494 @cindex active targets
20495 @cindex multiple targets
20496
20497 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20498 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20499 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20500 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20501 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20502 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20503 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20504 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20505 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20506
20507 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20508 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20509 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20510 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20511
20512 @node Target Commands
20513 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20514
20515 @table @code
20516 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20517 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20518 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20519 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20520 protocol of the target machine.
20521
20522 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20523 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20524 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20525
20526 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20527 after executing the command.
20528
20529 @kindex help target
20530 @item help target
20531 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20532 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20533 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20534
20535 @item help target @var{name}
20536 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20537 select it.
20538
20539 @kindex set gnutarget
20540 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20541 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20542 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20543 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20544 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20545 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20546
20547 @quotation
20548 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20549 you must know the actual BFD name.
20550 @end quotation
20551
20552 @noindent
20553 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20554
20555 @kindex show gnutarget
20556 @item show gnutarget
20557 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20558 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20559 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20560 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20561 @end table
20562
20563 @cindex common targets
20564 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20565 configuration):
20566
20567 @table @code
20568 @kindex target
20569 @item target exec @var{program}
20570 @cindex executable file target
20571 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20572 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20573
20574 @item target core @var{filename}
20575 @cindex core dump file target
20576 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20577 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20578
20579 @item target remote @var{medium}
20580 @cindex remote target
20581 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20582 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20583 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20584
20585 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20586 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20587
20588 @smallexample
20589 target remote /dev/ttya
20590 @end smallexample
20591
20592 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20593 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20594 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20595 clobbered by the download.
20596
20597 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20598 @cindex built-in simulator target
20599 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20600 In general,
20601 @smallexample
20602 target sim
20603 load
20604 run
20605 @end smallexample
20606 @noindent
20607 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20608 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20609 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20610 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20611 Processors}.
20612
20613 @item target native
20614 @cindex native target
20615 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20616 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20617 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20618 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20619
20620 @end table
20621
20622 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20623 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20624
20625 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20626 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20627 various aspects of this process.
20628
20629 @table @code
20630
20631 @item set hash
20632 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20633 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20634 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20635 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20636 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20637 monitor.
20638
20639 @item show hash
20640 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20641 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20642
20643 @item set debug monitor
20644 @kindex set debug monitor
20645 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20646 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20647 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20648
20649 @item show debug monitor
20650 @kindex show debug monitor
20651 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20652 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20653 @end table
20654
20655 @table @code
20656
20657 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20658 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20659 @anchor{load}
20660 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20661 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20662 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20663 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20664 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20665 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20666
20667 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20668 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20669 target is @dots{}}''
20670
20671 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20672 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20673 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20674 specifies a fixed address.
20675 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20676
20677 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20678 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20679 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20680
20681 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20682 load programs into flash memory.
20683
20684 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20685 @end table
20686
20687 @table @code
20688
20689 @kindex flash-erase
20690 @item flash-erase
20691 @anchor{flash-erase}
20692
20693 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20694
20695 @end table
20696
20697 @node Byte Order
20698 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20699
20700 @cindex choosing target byte order
20701 @cindex target byte order
20702
20703 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20704 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20705 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20706 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20707 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20708 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20709
20710 @table @code
20711 @kindex set endian
20712 @item set endian big
20713 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20714
20715 @item set endian little
20716 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20717
20718 @item set endian auto
20719 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20720 executable.
20721
20722 @item show endian
20723 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20724
20725 @end table
20726
20727 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20728 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20729 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20730 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20731 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20732 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20733 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20734 and @code{big} otherwise.
20735
20736 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20737 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20738 target system.
20739
20740
20741 @node Remote Debugging
20742 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20743 @cindex remote debugging
20744
20745 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20746 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20747 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20748 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20749 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20750
20751 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20752 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20753 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20754 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20755 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20756 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20757
20758 Other remote targets may be available in your
20759 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20760
20761 @menu
20762 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20763 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20764 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20765 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20766 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20767 @end menu
20768
20769 @node Connecting
20770 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20771 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20772 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20773 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20774 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20775 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20776 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20777
20778 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20779 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20780 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20781 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20782
20783 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20784
20785 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20786 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20787 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20788 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20789
20790 @table @asis
20791
20792 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20793 @item Result of detach or program exit
20794 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20795 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20796 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20797
20798 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20799 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20800 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20801 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20802
20803 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20804 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20805 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20806 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20807
20808 @item Specifying the program to debug
20809 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20810 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20811 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20812 target.
20813
20814 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20815 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20816 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20817
20818 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20819 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20820 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20821 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20822
20823 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20824 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20825 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20826 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20827 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20828 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20829 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20830 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20831 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20832
20833 @item The @code{run} command
20834 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20835 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20836 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20837 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20838 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20839
20840 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20841 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20842 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20843 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20844 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20845
20846 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20847 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20848 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20849 @code{target remote} mode.
20850
20851 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20852 @item Attaching
20853 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20854 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20855 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20856
20857 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20858 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20859 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20860 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20861 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20862
20863 @end table
20864
20865 @anchor{Host and target files}
20866 @subsection Host and Target Files
20867 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20868 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20869
20870 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20871 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20872 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20873 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20874 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20875
20876 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20877 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20878 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20879 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20880 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20881
20882 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20883 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20884 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20885 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20886 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20887 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20888 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20889 target libraries.
20890
20891 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20892 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20893 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20894 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20895 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20896 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20897 programs.
20898
20899 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20900 @cindex remote connection commands
20901 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20902 local Unix domain socket, or
20903 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20904 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20905 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20906 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20907 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20908 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20909
20910 @table @code
20911
20912 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20913 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20914 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20915 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20916 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20917
20918 @smallexample
20919 target remote /dev/ttyb
20920 @end smallexample
20921
20922 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20923 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20924 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20925 @code{target} command.
20926
20927 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20928 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20929 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20930 @cindex Unix domain socket
20931 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20932 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20933
20934 @smallexample
20935 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20939 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20940 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20941 of connection.
20942 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20943 Unix domain sockets.
20944
20945 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20946 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20947 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20948 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20949 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20950 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20951 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20952 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20953 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20954 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20955 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20956 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20957 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20958 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20959 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20960 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20961 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20962 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20963 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20964 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20965 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20966 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20967
20968 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20969 @code{manyfarms}:
20970
20971 @smallexample
20972 target remote manyfarms:2828
20973 @end smallexample
20974
20975 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20976 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20977 square bracket syntax:
20978
20979 @smallexample
20980 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20981 @end smallexample
20982
20983 @noindent
20984 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20985
20986 @smallexample
20987 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20988 @end smallexample
20989
20990 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20991 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20992 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20993 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20994 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20995 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20996
20997 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20998 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20999 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21000 port 1234 on your local machine:
21001
21002 @smallexample
21003 target remote :1234
21004 @end smallexample
21005 @noindent
21006
21007 Note that the colon is still required here.
21008
21009 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21010 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21011 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21012 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21013 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21014 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21015 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21016 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21017 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21018 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21019 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21020 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21021 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21022
21023 @smallexample
21024 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21025 @end smallexample
21026
21027 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21028 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21029 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21030 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21031
21032 @item target remote | @var{command}
21033 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21034 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21035 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21036 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21037 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21038 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21039 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21040 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21041 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21042
21043 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21044 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21045 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21046
21047 @end table
21048
21049 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21050 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21051 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21052 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21053 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21054 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21055 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21056
21057 @smallexample
21058 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21059 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21060 @end smallexample
21061
21062 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21063 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21064 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21065 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21066
21067 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21068 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21069
21070 @table @code
21071 @kindex detach (remote)
21072 @item detach
21073 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21074 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21075 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21076 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21077 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21078 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21079 still connected to the target.
21080
21081 @kindex disconnect
21082 @item disconnect
21083 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21084 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21085 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21086 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21087 another target.
21088
21089 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21090 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21091 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21092 @kindex monitor
21093 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21094 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21095 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21096 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21097 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21098 and implement.
21099 @end table
21100
21101 @node File Transfer
21102 @section Sending files to a remote system
21103 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21104 @cindex file transfer
21105 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21106
21107 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21108 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21109 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21110 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21111 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21112 the only way to upload or download files.
21113
21114 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21115
21116 @table @code
21117 @kindex remote put
21118 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21119 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21120 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21121
21122 @kindex remote get
21123 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21124 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21125 on the host system.
21126
21127 @kindex remote delete
21128 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21129 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21130
21131 @end table
21132
21133 @node Server
21134 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21135
21136 @kindex gdbserver
21137 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21138 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21139 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21140 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21141 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21142
21143 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21144 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21145 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21146 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21147 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21148 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21149 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21150 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21151 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21152 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21153 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21154 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21155 choice for debugging.
21156
21157 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21158 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21159 protocol.
21160
21161 @quotation
21162 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21163 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21164 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21165 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21166 @code{gdbserver}.
21167 @end quotation
21168
21169 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21170 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21171 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21172 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21173
21174 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21175 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21176 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21177 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21178 system does all the symbol handling.
21179
21180 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21181 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21182 syntax is:
21183
21184 @smallexample
21185 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21186 @end smallexample
21187
21188 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21189 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21190 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21191 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21192 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21193 @file{/dev/com1}:
21194
21195 @smallexample
21196 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21197 @end smallexample
21198
21199 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21200 with it.
21201
21202 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21203
21204 @smallexample
21205 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21206 @end smallexample
21207
21208 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21209 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21210 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21211 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21212 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21213 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21214 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21215 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21216 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21217 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21218 @code{target remote} command.
21219
21220 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21221 with ssh:
21222
21223 @smallexample
21224 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21225 @end smallexample
21226
21227 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21228 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21229 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21230 You could elide it if you want to.
21231
21232 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21233 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21234 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21235 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21236
21237 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21238 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21239 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21240 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21241
21242 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21243 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21244
21245 @smallexample
21246 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21247 @end smallexample
21248
21249 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21250 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21251
21252 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21253 @value{GDBN} attach command
21254 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21255
21256 @pindex pidof
21257 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21258 @code{pidof} utility:
21259
21260 @smallexample
21261 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21262 @end smallexample
21263
21264 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21265 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21266 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21267
21268 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21269
21270 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21271 port.
21272
21273 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21274 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21275 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21276 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21277 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21278 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21279 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21280 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21281
21282 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21283 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21284 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21285
21286 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21287 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21288 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21289 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21290 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21291 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21292 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21293 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21294 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21295 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21296 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21297 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21298
21299 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21300 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21301
21302 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21303 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21304 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21305 program. For more information,
21306 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21307
21308 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21309 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21310 status information about the debugging process.
21311 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21312 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21313 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21314 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21315
21316 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21317 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21318 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21319 Possible options are:
21320
21321 @table @code
21322 @item none
21323 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21324 @item all
21325 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21326 @item timestamps
21327 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21328 @end table
21329
21330 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21331 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21332
21333 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21334 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21335 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21336 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21337 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21338
21339 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21340 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21341 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21342 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21343
21344 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21345 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21346 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21347 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21348
21349 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21350 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21351 environment:
21352
21353 @smallexample
21354 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21355 @end smallexample
21356
21357 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21358 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21359
21360 @smallexample
21361 $ gdbserver --selftest
21362 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21363 @end smallexample
21364
21365 These tests are disabled in release.
21366 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21367
21368 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21369 @itemize
21370
21371 @item
21372 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21373
21374 @item
21375 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21376 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21377 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21378 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21379 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21380 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21381
21382 @item
21383 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21384 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21385 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21386 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21387 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21388 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21389 program is already on the target.
21390
21391 @end itemize
21392
21393 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21394 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21395 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21396
21397 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21398 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21399 Here are the available commands.
21400
21401 @table @code
21402 @item monitor help
21403 List the available monitor commands.
21404
21405 @item monitor set debug 0
21406 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21407 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21408
21409 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21410 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21411 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21412 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21413
21414 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21415 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21416 Possible options are:
21417
21418 @table @code
21419 @item none
21420 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21421 @item all
21422 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21423 @item timestamps
21424 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21425 @end table
21426
21427 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21428 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21429
21430 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21431 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21432 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21433 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21434 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21435 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21436
21437 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21438 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21439
21440 @item monitor exit
21441 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21442 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21443 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21444 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21445 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21446
21447 @end table
21448
21449 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21450 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21451
21452 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21453 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21454
21455 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21456 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21457 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21458 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21459 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21460 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21461 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21462 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21463 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21464 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21465 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21466 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21467
21468 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21469
21470 @table @code
21471 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21472
21473 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21474 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21475 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21476
21477 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21478
21479 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21480 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21481 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21482 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21483 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21484 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21485
21486 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21487
21488 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21489 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21490 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21491 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21492 command for that. For example:
21493
21494 @smallexample
21495 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21496 @end smallexample
21497
21498 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21499 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21500 @end table
21501
21502 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21503 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21504 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21505 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21506 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21507 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21508 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21509 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21510 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21511 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21512
21513 @smallexample
21514 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21515 @end smallexample
21516
21517 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21518
21519 @smallexample
21520 $ gdb myprogram
21521 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21522 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21523 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21524 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21525 @end smallexample
21526
21527 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21528 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21529 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21530 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21531 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21532 tracing.
21533
21534 @node Remote Configuration
21535 @section Remote Configuration
21536
21537 @kindex set remote
21538 @kindex show remote
21539 This section documents the configuration options available when
21540 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21541 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21542 system-call-allowed}.
21543
21544 @table @code
21545 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21546 @cindex address size for remote targets
21547 @cindex bits in remote address
21548 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21549 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21550 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21551 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21552
21553 @item show remoteaddresssize
21554 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21555
21556 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21557 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21558 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21559 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21560 remote targets.
21561
21562 @item show serial baud
21563 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21564
21565 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21566 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21567 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21568
21569 @item show serial parity
21570 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21571
21572 @item set remotebreak
21573 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21574 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21575 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21576 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21577 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21578 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21579 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21580 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21581
21582 @item show remotebreak
21583 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21584 interrupt the remote program.
21585
21586 @item set remoteflow on
21587 @itemx set remoteflow off
21588 @kindex set remoteflow
21589 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21590 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21591
21592 @item show remoteflow
21593 @kindex show remoteflow
21594 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21595
21596 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21597 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21598 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21599 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21600 @code{ascii}.
21601
21602 @item show remotelogbase
21603 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21604 protocol.
21605
21606 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21607 @cindex record serial communications on file
21608 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21609 default is not to record at all.
21610
21611 @item show remotelogfile
21612 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21613 serial communications.
21614
21615 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21616 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21617 @cindex remote timeout
21618 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21619 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21620
21621 @item show remotetimeout
21622 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21623 responses.
21624
21625 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21626 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21627 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21628 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21629 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21630 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21631 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21632 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21633 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21634 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21635
21636 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21637 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21638 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21639 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21640
21641 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21642 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21643 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21644 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21645 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21646 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21647 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21648 length.
21649
21650 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21651 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21652 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21653
21654 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21655 @itemx show remote exec-file
21656 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21657 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21658 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21659 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21660 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21661 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21662
21663 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21664 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21665 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21666 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21667 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21668 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21669 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21670 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21671 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21672 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21673
21674 @item show interrupt-sequence
21675 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21676 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21677 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21678 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21679
21680 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21681 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21682 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21683 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21684 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21685 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21686
21687 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21688 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21689 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21690
21691 @kindex set tcp
21692 @kindex show tcp
21693 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21694 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21695 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21696 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21697 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21698 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21699 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21700 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21701 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21702
21703 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21704 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21705
21706 @item show tcp auto-retry
21707 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21708
21709 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21710 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21711 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21712 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21713 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21714 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21715 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21716 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21717 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21718 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21719 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21720
21721 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21722 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21723 @end table
21724
21725 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21726 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21727 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21728 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21729 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21730 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21731 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21732 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21733 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21734
21735 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21736 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21737 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21738 @value{GDBN} developers.
21739
21740 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21741 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21742 are:
21743
21744 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21745 @item Command Name
21746 @tab Remote Packet
21747 @tab Related Features
21748
21749 @item @code{fetch-register}
21750 @tab @code{p}
21751 @tab @code{info registers}
21752
21753 @item @code{set-register}
21754 @tab @code{P}
21755 @tab @code{set}
21756
21757 @item @code{binary-download}
21758 @tab @code{X}
21759 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21760
21761 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21762 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21763 @tab @code{info auxv}
21764
21765 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21766 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21767 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21768
21769 @item @code{attach}
21770 @tab @code{vAttach}
21771 @tab @code{attach}
21772
21773 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21774 @tab @code{vCont}
21775 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21776
21777 @item @code{run}
21778 @tab @code{vRun}
21779 @tab @code{run}
21780
21781 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21782 @tab @code{Z0}
21783 @tab @code{break}
21784
21785 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21786 @tab @code{Z1}
21787 @tab @code{hbreak}
21788
21789 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21790 @tab @code{Z2}
21791 @tab @code{watch}
21792
21793 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21794 @tab @code{Z3}
21795 @tab @code{rwatch}
21796
21797 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21798 @tab @code{Z4}
21799 @tab @code{awatch}
21800
21801 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21802 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21803 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21804
21805 @item @code{target-features}
21806 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21807 @tab @code{set architecture}
21808
21809 @item @code{library-info}
21810 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21811 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21812
21813 @item @code{memory-map}
21814 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21815 @tab @code{info mem}
21816
21817 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21818 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21819 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21820
21821 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21822 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21823 @tab @code{info spu}
21824
21825 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21826 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21827 @tab @code{info spu}
21828
21829 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21830 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21831 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21832
21833 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21834 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21835 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21836
21837 @item @code{threads}
21838 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21839 @tab @code{info threads}
21840
21841 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21842 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21843 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21844
21845 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21846 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21847 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21848
21849 @item @code{search-memory}
21850 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21851 @tab @code{find}
21852
21853 @item @code{supported-packets}
21854 @tab @code{qSupported}
21855 @tab Remote communications parameters
21856
21857 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21858 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21859 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21860
21861 @item @code{pass-signals}
21862 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21863 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21864
21865 @item @code{program-signals}
21866 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21867 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21868
21869 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21870 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21871 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21872
21873 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21874 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21875 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21876
21877 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21878 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21879 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21880
21881 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21882 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21883 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21884
21885 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21886 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21887 @tab @code{remote delete}
21888
21889 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21890 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21891 @tab Host I/O
21892
21893 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21894 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21895 @tab Host I/O
21896
21897 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21898 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21899 @tab Host I/O
21900
21901 @item @code{noack-packet}
21902 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21903 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21904
21905 @item @code{osdata}
21906 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21907 @tab @code{info os}
21908
21909 @item @code{query-attached}
21910 @tab @code{qAttached}
21911 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21912
21913 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21914 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21915 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21916
21917 @item @code{trace-status}
21918 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21919 @tab @code{tstatus}
21920
21921 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21922 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21923 @tab Traceframe info
21924
21925 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21926 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21927 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21928
21929 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21930 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21931 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21932
21933 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21934 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21935 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21936
21937 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21938 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21939 @tab @code{set environment}
21940
21941 @item @code{environment-unset}
21942 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21943 @tab @code{unset environment}
21944
21945 @item @code{environment-reset}
21946 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21947 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21948
21949 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21950 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21951 @tab @code{set cwd}
21952
21953 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21954 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21955 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21956
21957 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21958 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21959 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21960
21961 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21962 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21963 @tab @code{break}
21964
21965 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21966 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21967 @tab @code{hbreak}
21968
21969 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21970 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21971 @tab @code{fork}
21972
21973 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21974 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21975 @tab @code{vfork}
21976
21977 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21978 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21979 @tab @code{exec}
21980
21981 @item @code{thread-events}
21982 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21983 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21984
21985 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21986 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21987 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21988
21989 @end multitable
21990
21991 @node Remote Stub
21992 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21993
21994 @cindex debugging stub, example
21995 @cindex remote stub, example
21996 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21997 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21998 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21999 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22000 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22001 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22002 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22003 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22004
22005 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22006 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22007 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22008 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22009 program, you need:
22010
22011 @enumerate
22012 @item
22013 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22014 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22015 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22016
22017 @item
22018 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22019 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22020
22021 @item
22022 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22023 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22024 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22025 documentation.
22026 @end enumerate
22027
22028 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22029 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22030 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22031
22032 @table @emph
22033 @item On the host,
22034 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22035 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22036 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22037
22038 @item On the target,
22039 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22040 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22041 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22042
22043 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22044 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22045 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22046 @end table
22047
22048 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22049 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22050 @sc{sparc} boards.
22051
22052 @cindex remote serial stub list
22053 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22054
22055 @table @code
22056
22057 @item i386-stub.c
22058 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22059 @cindex Intel
22060 @cindex i386
22061 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22062
22063 @item m68k-stub.c
22064 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22065 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22066 @cindex m680x0
22067 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22068
22069 @item sh-stub.c
22070 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22071 @cindex Renesas
22072 @cindex SH
22073 For Renesas SH architectures.
22074
22075 @item sparc-stub.c
22076 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22077 @cindex Sparc
22078 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22079
22080 @item sparcl-stub.c
22081 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22082 @cindex Fujitsu
22083 @cindex SparcLite
22084 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22085
22086 @end table
22087
22088 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22089 recently added stubs.
22090
22091 @menu
22092 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22093 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22094 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22095 @end menu
22096
22097 @node Stub Contents
22098 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22099
22100 @cindex remote serial stub
22101 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22102 subroutines:
22103
22104 @table @code
22105 @item set_debug_traps
22106 @findex set_debug_traps
22107 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22108 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22109 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22110 program's startup code.
22111
22112 @item handle_exception
22113 @findex handle_exception
22114 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22115 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22116 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22117 run when a trap is triggered.
22118
22119 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22120 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22121 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22122 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22123 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22124 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22125 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22126 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22127 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22128 machine.
22129
22130 @item breakpoint
22131 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22132 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22133 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22134 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22135 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22136 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22137 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22138 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22139 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22140 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22141 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22142
22143 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22144 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22145 start of your debugging session.
22146 @end table
22147
22148 @node Bootstrapping
22149 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22150
22151 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22152 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22153 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22154 debugging target machine.
22155
22156 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22157 serial port.
22158
22159 @table @code
22160 @item int getDebugChar()
22161 @findex getDebugChar
22162 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22163 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22164 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22165
22166 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22167 @findex putDebugChar
22168 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22169 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22170 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22171 @end table
22172
22173 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22174 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22175 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22176 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22177 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22178 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22179 remote system to stop.
22180
22181 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22182 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22183 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22184 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22185
22186 Other routines you need to supply are:
22187
22188 @table @code
22189 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22190 @findex exceptionHandler
22191 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22192 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22193 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22194 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22195 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22196 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22197 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22198 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22199 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22200 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22201 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22202 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22203 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22204
22205 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22206 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22207 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22208 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22209 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22210
22211 @item void flush_i_cache()
22212 @findex flush_i_cache
22213 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22214 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22215 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22216
22217 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22218 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22219 @end table
22220
22221 @noindent
22222 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22223
22224 @table @code
22225 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22226 @findex memset
22227 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22228 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22229 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22230 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22231 @end table
22232
22233 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22234 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22235 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22236 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22237
22238
22239 @node Debug Session
22240 @subsection Putting it All Together
22241
22242 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22243 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22244 steps.
22245
22246 @enumerate
22247 @item
22248 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22249 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22250 @display
22251 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22252 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22253 @end display
22254
22255 @item
22256 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22257 procedure is called:
22258
22259 @smallexample
22260 set_debug_traps();
22261 breakpoint();
22262 @end smallexample
22263
22264 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22265 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22266 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22267 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22268 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22269 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22270 progress.
22271
22272 @item
22273 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22274 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22275
22276 @smallexample
22277 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22278 @end smallexample
22279
22280 @noindent
22281 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22282 function in your program, that function is called when
22283 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22284 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22285 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22286
22287 @item
22288 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22289 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22290
22291 @item
22292 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22293 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22294
22295 @item
22296 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22297 @c document that. FIXME.
22298 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22299 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22300
22301 @item
22302 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22303 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22304
22305 @end enumerate
22306
22307 @node Configurations
22308 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22309
22310 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22311 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22312 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22313
22314 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22315 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22316 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22317 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22318 are quite different from each other.
22319
22320 @menu
22321 * Native::
22322 * Embedded OS::
22323 * Embedded Processors::
22324 * Architectures::
22325 @end menu
22326
22327 @node Native
22328 @section Native
22329
22330 This section describes details specific to particular native
22331 configurations.
22332
22333 @menu
22334 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22335 * Process Information:: Process information
22336 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22337 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22338 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22339 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22340 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
22341 @end menu
22342
22343 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22344 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22345
22346 @cindex libkvm
22347 @cindex kernel memory image
22348 @cindex kernel crash dump
22349
22350 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22351 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22352 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22353 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22354 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22355 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22356 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22357 @code{kvm} target:
22358
22359 @smallexample
22360 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22361 @end smallexample
22362
22363 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22364 argument:
22365
22366 @smallexample
22367 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22368 @end smallexample
22369
22370 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22371 available:
22372
22373 @table @code
22374 @kindex kvm
22375 @item kvm pcb
22376 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22377
22378 @item kvm proc
22379 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22380 modern FreeBSD systems.
22381 @end table
22382
22383 @node Process Information
22384 @subsection Process Information
22385 @cindex /proc
22386 @cindex examine process image
22387 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22388
22389 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22390 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22391 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22392 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22393 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22394 any process running on your system.
22395
22396 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22397 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22398 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22399 systems.
22400
22401 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22402 information.
22403
22404 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22405 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22406 information available from a live process. Process information is
22407 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22408 systems.
22409
22410 @table @code
22411 @kindex info proc
22412 @cindex process ID
22413 @item info proc
22414 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22415 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22416 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22417 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22418 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22419 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22420 executable file's absolute file name.
22421
22422 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22423 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22424 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22425 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22426 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22427 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22428
22429 @item info proc cmdline
22430 @cindex info proc cmdline
22431 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22432 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22433
22434 @item info proc cwd
22435 @cindex info proc cwd
22436 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22437 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22438
22439 @item info proc exe
22440 @cindex info proc exe
22441 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22442 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22443
22444 @item info proc files
22445 @cindex info proc files
22446 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22447 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22448 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22449 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22450 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22451 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22452 FreeBSD.
22453
22454 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22455 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22456
22457 @smallexample
22458 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22459 process 22136
22460 Open files:
22461
22462 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22463 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22464 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22465 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22466 root dir - r-------- /
22467 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22468 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22469 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22470 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22471 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22472 @end smallexample
22473
22474 @item info proc mappings
22475 @cindex memory address space mappings
22476 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22477 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22478 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22479 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22480 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22481
22482 @item info proc stat
22483 @itemx info proc status
22484 @cindex process detailed status information
22485 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22486 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22487 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22488 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22489 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22490
22491 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22492 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22493
22494 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22495 proc status}.
22496
22497 @item info proc all
22498 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22499 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22500
22501 @ignore
22502 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22503 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22504 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22505 @kindex info proc times
22506 @item info proc times
22507 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22508 its children.
22509
22510 @kindex info proc id
22511 @item info proc id
22512 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22513 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22514 @end ignore
22515
22516 @item set procfs-trace
22517 @kindex set procfs-trace
22518 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22519 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22520
22521 @item show procfs-trace
22522 @kindex show procfs-trace
22523 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22524
22525 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22526 @kindex set procfs-file
22527 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22528 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22529 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22530 standard output.
22531
22532 @item show procfs-file
22533 @kindex show procfs-file
22534 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22535
22536 @item proc-trace-entry
22537 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22538 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22539 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22540 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22541 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22542 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22543 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22544 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22545 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22546
22547 @item info pidlist
22548 @kindex info pidlist
22549 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22550 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22551 processes and all the threads within each process.
22552
22553 @item info meminfo
22554 @kindex info meminfo
22555 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22556 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22557 @end table
22558
22559 @node DJGPP Native
22560 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22561 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22562 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22563 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22564
22565 @cindex DPMI
22566 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22567 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22568 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22569 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22570
22571 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22572 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22573 subsection describes those commands.
22574
22575 @table @code
22576 @kindex info dos
22577 @item info dos
22578 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22579 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22580
22581 @kindex sysinfo
22582 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22583 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22584 @item info dos sysinfo
22585 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22586 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22587 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22588
22589 @cindex GDT
22590 @cindex LDT
22591 @cindex IDT
22592 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22593 @cindex descriptor tables display
22594 @item info dos gdt
22595 @itemx info dos ldt
22596 @itemx info dos idt
22597 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22598 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22599 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22600 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22601 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22602 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22603 rights.
22604
22605 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22606 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22607 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22608 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22609 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22610
22611 @cindex garbled pointers
22612 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22613 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22614 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22615 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22616 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22617 debugged program's data segment:
22618
22619 @smallexample
22620 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22621 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22622 @end smallexample
22623
22624 @noindent
22625 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22626 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22627
22628 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22629 @item info dos pde
22630 @itemx info dos pte
22631 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22632 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22633 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22634 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22635 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22636 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22637 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22638 that is currently in use.
22639
22640 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22641 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22642 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22643 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22644 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22645 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22646 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22647
22648 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22649 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22650 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22651 controller.
22652
22653 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22654
22655 @cindex physical address from linear address
22656 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22657 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22658 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22659 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22660 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22661 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22662 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22663
22664 @smallexample
22665 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22666 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22667 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22668 @end smallexample
22669
22670 @noindent
22671 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22672 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22673 attributes of that page.
22674
22675 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22676 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22677 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22678 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22679 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22680 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22681
22682 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22683 transfer buffer:
22684
22685 @smallexample
22686 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22687 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22688 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22689 @end smallexample
22690
22691 @noindent
22692 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22693 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22694 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22695 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22696 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22697
22698 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22699 @end table
22700
22701 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22702 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22703 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22704 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22705
22706 @table @code
22707 @kindex set com1base
22708 @kindex set com1irq
22709 @kindex set com2base
22710 @kindex set com2irq
22711 @kindex set com3base
22712 @kindex set com3irq
22713 @kindex set com4base
22714 @kindex set com4irq
22715 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22716 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22717 port.
22718
22719 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22720 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22721 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22722
22723 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22724 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22725 other 3 COM ports.
22726
22727 @kindex show com1base
22728 @kindex show com1irq
22729 @kindex show com2base
22730 @kindex show com2irq
22731 @kindex show com3base
22732 @kindex show com3irq
22733 @kindex show com4base
22734 @kindex show com4irq
22735 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22736 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22737 lines used by the COM ports.
22738
22739 @item info serial
22740 @kindex info serial
22741 @cindex DOS serial port status
22742 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22743 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22744 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22745 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22746 @end table
22747
22748
22749 @node Cygwin Native
22750 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22751 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22752 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22753 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22754
22755 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22756 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22757
22758 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22759 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22760 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22761 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22762 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22763 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22764 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22765 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22766
22767 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22768 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22769 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22770
22771 @table @code
22772 @kindex info w32
22773 @item info w32
22774 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22775 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22776
22777 @item info w32 selector
22778 This command displays information returned by
22779 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22780 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22781 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22782 Without argument, this command displays information
22783 about the six segment registers.
22784
22785 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22786 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22787 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22788 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22789
22790 @kindex signal-event
22791 @item signal-event @var{id}
22792 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22793 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22794
22795 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22796 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22797 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22798 (for x86_64 versions):
22799
22800 @itemize @minus
22801 @item
22802 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22803 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22804 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22805
22806 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22807 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22808 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22809 to attach.
22810
22811 @item
22812 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22813 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22814 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22815 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22816 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22817 @end itemize
22818
22819 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22820 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22821 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22822 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22823 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22824 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22825 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22826 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22827 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22828 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22829 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22830
22831 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22832 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22833 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22834 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22835
22836 @kindex set new-console
22837 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22838 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22839 be started in a new console on next start.
22840 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22841 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22842
22843 @kindex show new-console
22844 @item show new-console
22845 Displays whether a new console is used
22846 when the debuggee is started.
22847
22848 @kindex set new-group
22849 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22850 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22851 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22852 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22853 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22854
22855 @kindex show new-group
22856 @item show new-group
22857 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22858
22859 @kindex set debugevents
22860 @item set debugevents
22861 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22862 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22863 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22864 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22865 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22866
22867 @kindex set debugexec
22868 @item set debugexec
22869 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22870 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22871
22872 @kindex set debugexceptions
22873 @item set debugexceptions
22874 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22875 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22876
22877 @kindex set debugmemory
22878 @item set debugmemory
22879 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22880 and writes by the debugger.
22881
22882 @kindex set shell
22883 @item set shell
22884 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22885 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22886
22887 @kindex show shell
22888 @item show shell
22889 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22890
22891 @end table
22892
22893 @menu
22894 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22895 @end menu
22896
22897 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22898 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22899 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22900 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22901
22902 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22903 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22904 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22905 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22906 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22907 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22908 ``minimal symbols''.
22909
22910 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22911 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22912 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22913 program run once to completion.
22914
22915 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22916
22917 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22918 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22919 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22920 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22921 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22922 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22923 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22924 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22925 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22926
22927 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22928 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22929 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22930 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22931 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22932 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22933
22934 @smallexample
22935 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22936 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22937
22938 Non-debugging symbols:
22939 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22940 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22941 @end smallexample
22942
22943 @smallexample
22944 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22945 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22946
22947 Non-debugging symbols:
22948 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22949 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22950 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22951 [etc...]
22952 @end smallexample
22953
22954 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22955
22956 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22957 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22958 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22959 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22960 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22961 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22962 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22963
22964 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22965 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22966 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22967 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22968 problem:
22969
22970 @smallexample
22971 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22972 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22973 @end smallexample
22974
22975 @smallexample
22976 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22977 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22978 @end smallexample
22979
22980 And two possible solutions:
22981
22982 @smallexample
22983 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22984 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22985 @end smallexample
22986
22987 @smallexample
22988 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22989 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22990 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22991 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22992 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22993 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22994 @end smallexample
22995
22996 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22997 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22998 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22999 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23000 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23001
23002 @smallexample
23003 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23004 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23005 @end smallexample
23006
23007 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23008 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23009 safe.
23010
23011 @node Hurd Native
23012 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23013 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23014
23015 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23016 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23017
23018 @table @code
23019 @item set signals
23020 @itemx set sigs
23021 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23022 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23023 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23024 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23025 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23026 @code{signals}.
23027
23028 @item show signals
23029 @itemx show sigs
23030 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23031 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23032 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23033
23034 @item set signal-thread
23035 @itemx set sigthread
23036 @kindex set signal-thread
23037 @kindex set sigthread
23038 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23039 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23040 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23041 signal-thread}.
23042
23043 @item show signal-thread
23044 @itemx show sigthread
23045 @kindex show signal-thread
23046 @kindex show sigthread
23047 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23048 delivered a signal.
23049
23050 @item set stopped
23051 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23052 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23053 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23054 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23055
23056 @item show stopped
23057 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23058 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23059 stopped.
23060
23061 @item set exceptions
23062 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23063 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23064 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23065 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23066 trapping on.
23067
23068 @item show exceptions
23069 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23070 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23071
23072 @item set task pause
23073 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23074 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23075 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23076 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23077 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23078 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23079 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23080 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23081 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23082
23083 @item show task pause
23084 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23085 Show the current state of task suspension.
23086
23087 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23088 @cindex task suspend count
23089 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23090 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23091 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23092
23093 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23094 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23095
23096 @item set task exception-port
23097 @itemx set task excp
23098 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23099 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23100 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23101 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23102
23103 @item set noninvasive
23104 @cindex noninvasive task options
23105 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23106 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23107 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23108 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23109
23110 @item info send-rights
23111 @itemx info receive-rights
23112 @itemx info port-rights
23113 @itemx info port-sets
23114 @itemx info dead-names
23115 @itemx info ports
23116 @itemx info psets
23117 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23118 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23119 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23120 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23121 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23122 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23123 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23124 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23125 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23126
23127 @item set thread pause
23128 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23129 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23130 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23131 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23132 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23133 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23134 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23135 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23136 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23137 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23138 only the current thread.
23139
23140 @item show thread pause
23141 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23142 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23143
23144 @item set thread run
23145 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23146
23147 @item show thread run
23148 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23149
23150 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23151 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23152 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23153 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23154 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23155 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23156 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23157
23158 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23159 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23160 detaching.
23161
23162 @item set thread exception-port
23163 @itemx set thread excp
23164 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23165 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23166 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23167
23168 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23169 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23170 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23171 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23172
23173 @item set thread default
23174 @itemx show thread default
23175 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23176 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23177 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23178 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23179 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23180 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23181 the non-default commands.
23182 @end table
23183
23184 @node Darwin
23185 @subsection Darwin
23186 @cindex Darwin
23187
23188 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23189
23190 @table @code
23191 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23192 @kindex set debug darwin
23193 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23194 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23195
23196 @item show debug darwin
23197 @kindex show debug darwin
23198 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23199
23200 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23201 @kindex set debug mach-o
23202 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23203 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23204 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23205 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23206 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23207 usage.
23208
23209 @item show debug mach-o
23210 @kindex show debug mach-o
23211 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23212
23213 @item set mach-exceptions on
23214 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23215 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23216 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23217 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23218 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23219 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23220
23221 @item show mach-exceptions
23222 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23223 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23224 @end table
23225
23226 @node FreeBSD
23227 @subsection FreeBSD
23228 @cindex FreeBSD
23229
23230 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23231 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23232 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23233 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23234 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23235 are also caught.
23236
23237 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23238 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23239 both variants:
23240
23241 @smallexample
23242 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
23243 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
23244 (@value{GDBP})
23245 @end smallexample
23246
23247
23248 @node Embedded OS
23249 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23250
23251 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23252 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23253 architectures.
23254
23255 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23256 various real-time operating systems.
23257
23258 @node Embedded Processors
23259 @section Embedded Processors
23260
23261 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23262 configurations.
23263
23264 @cindex send command to simulator
23265 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23266 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23267
23268 @table @code
23269 @item sim @var{command}
23270 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23271 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23272 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23273 acceptable commands.
23274 @end table
23275
23276
23277 @menu
23278 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23279 * ARM:: ARM
23280 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23281 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23282 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23283 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23284 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23285 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23286 * CRIS:: CRIS
23287 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23288 @end menu
23289
23290 @node ARC
23291 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23292 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23293 @cindex ARC specific commands
23294 @cindex ARC600
23295 @cindex ARC700
23296 @cindex ARC EM
23297 @cindex ARC HS
23298
23299 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23300
23301 @table @code
23302 @item set debug arc
23303 @kindex set debug arc
23304 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23305 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23306
23307 @item show debug arc
23308 @kindex show debug arc
23309 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23310
23311 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23312 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23313 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23314
23315 @end table
23316
23317 @node ARM
23318 @subsection ARM
23319
23320 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23321
23322 @table @code
23323 @item set arm disassembler
23324 @kindex set arm
23325 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23326 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23327
23328 @item show arm disassembler
23329 @kindex show arm
23330 Show the current disassembly style.
23331
23332 @item set arm apcs32
23333 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23334 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23335
23336 @item show arm apcs32
23337 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23338
23339 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23340 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23341 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23342
23343 @table @code
23344 @item auto
23345 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23346 @item softfpa
23347 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23348 processors.
23349 @item fpa
23350 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23351 @item softvfp
23352 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23353 @item vfp
23354 VFP co-processor.
23355 @end table
23356
23357 @item show arm fpu
23358 Show the current type of the FPU.
23359
23360 @item set arm abi
23361 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23362
23363 @item show arm abi
23364 Show the currently used ABI.
23365
23366 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23367 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23368 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23369 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23370 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23371 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23372 register).
23373
23374 @item show arm fallback-mode
23375 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23376
23377 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23378 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23379 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23380 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23381 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23382
23383 @item show arm force-mode
23384 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23385
23386 @item set debug arm
23387 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23388 target support subsystem.
23389
23390 @item show debug arm
23391 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23392 @end table
23393
23394 @table @code
23395 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23396 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23397
23398 @table @code
23399 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23400 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23401 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23402 The default value is @code{all}.
23403
23404 @table @code
23405 @item none
23406 @item demon
23407 @item angel
23408 @item redboot
23409 @item all
23410 @end table
23411 @end table
23412 @end table
23413
23414 @node M68K
23415 @subsection M68k
23416
23417 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23418
23419 @node MicroBlaze
23420 @subsection MicroBlaze
23421 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23422 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23423
23424 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23425 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23426 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23427 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23428 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23429 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23430 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23431 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23432 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23433 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23434 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23435
23436 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23437
23438 @table @code
23439 @item target remote :1234
23440 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23441 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23442
23443 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23444 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23445 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23446
23447 @item load
23448 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23449
23450 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23451 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23452
23453 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23454 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23455 @end table
23456
23457 @node MIPS Embedded
23458 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23459
23460 @noindent
23461 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23462
23463 @table @code
23464 @item set mipsfpu double
23465 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23466 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23467 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23468 @itemx show mipsfpu
23469 @kindex set mipsfpu
23470 @kindex show mipsfpu
23471 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23472 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23473 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23474 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23475 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23476 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23477 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23478 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23479 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23480 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23481 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23482 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23483 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23484
23485 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23486 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23487 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23488
23489 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23490 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23491 @end table
23492
23493 @node OpenRISC 1000
23494 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23495 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23496
23497 @noindent
23498 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23499 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23500 FPGA's.
23501
23502 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23503 a target:
23504
23505 @table @code
23506
23507 @kindex target sim
23508 @item target sim
23509
23510 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23511 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23512 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23513 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23514
23515 Example: @code{target sim}
23516
23517 @item set debug or1k
23518 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23519 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23520
23521 @item show debug or1k
23522 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23523 @end table
23524
23525 @node PowerPC Embedded
23526 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23527
23528 @cindex DVC register
23529 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23530 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23531
23532 @smallexample
23533 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23534 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23535 @end smallexample
23536
23537 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23538 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23539 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23540 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23541 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23542 or newer.
23543
23544 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23545 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23546 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23547 watching variables of scalar types.
23548
23549 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23550 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23551
23552 @smallexample
23553 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23554 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23555 @end smallexample
23556
23557 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23558 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23559
23560 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23561 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23562 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23563 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23564 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23565 use the @code{break-range} command.
23566
23567 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23568
23569 @table @code
23570 @kindex break-range
23571 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23572 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23573 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23574 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23575 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23576 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23577 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23578 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23579 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23580
23581 @kindex set powerpc
23582 @item set powerpc soft-float
23583 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23584 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23585 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23586 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23587
23588 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23589 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23590 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23591 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23592 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23593 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23594 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23595 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23596
23597 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23598 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23599 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23600 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23601 address of its first byte.
23602
23603 @end table
23604
23605 @node AVR
23606 @subsection Atmel AVR
23607 @cindex AVR
23608
23609 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23610 following AVR-specific commands:
23611
23612 @table @code
23613 @item info io_registers
23614 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23615 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23616 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23617 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23618 @end table
23619
23620 @node CRIS
23621 @subsection CRIS
23622 @cindex CRIS
23623
23624 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23625 following CRIS-specific commands:
23626
23627 @table @code
23628 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23629 @cindex CRIS version
23630 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23631 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23632 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23633
23634 @item show cris-version
23635 Show the current CRIS version.
23636
23637 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23638 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23639 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23640 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23641 @code{R59}.
23642
23643 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23644 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23645
23646 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23647 @cindex CRIS mode
23648 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23649 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23650 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23651
23652 @item show cris-mode
23653 Show the current CRIS mode.
23654 @end table
23655
23656 @node Super-H
23657 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23658 @cindex Super-H
23659
23660 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23661 commands:
23662
23663 @table @code
23664 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23665 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23666 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23667 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23668 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23669 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23670 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23671 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23672 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23673 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23674 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23675 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23676
23677 @item show sh calling-convention
23678 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23679 Show the current calling convention setting.
23680
23681 @end table
23682
23683
23684 @node Architectures
23685 @section Architectures
23686
23687 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23688 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23689
23690 @menu
23691 * AArch64::
23692 * i386::
23693 * Alpha::
23694 * MIPS::
23695 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23696 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23697 * PowerPC::
23698 * Nios II::
23699 * Sparc64::
23700 * S12Z::
23701 @end menu
23702
23703 @node AArch64
23704 @subsection AArch64
23705 @cindex AArch64 support
23706
23707 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23708 following special commands:
23709
23710 @table @code
23711 @item set debug aarch64
23712 @kindex set debug aarch64
23713 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23714 messages are to be displayed.
23715
23716 @item show debug aarch64
23717 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23718
23719 @end table
23720
23721 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23722 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23723
23724 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23725 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23726 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23727 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23728 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23729 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23730
23731 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23732 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23733 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23734 target process.
23735
23736
23737 @node i386
23738 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23739
23740 @table @code
23741 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23742 @kindex set struct-convention
23743 @cindex struct return convention
23744 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23745 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23746 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23747 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23748 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23749 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23750 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23751 be returned in a register.
23752
23753 @item show struct-convention
23754 @kindex show struct-convention
23755 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23756 from functions.
23757 @end table
23758
23759
23760 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23761 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23762
23763 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23764 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23765 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23766 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23767 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23768 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23769 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23770
23771 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23772 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23773 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23774 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23775 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23776 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23777
23778 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23779 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23780 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23781
23782 @smallexample
23783 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23784 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23785 @end smallexample
23786
23787 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23788 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23789 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23790 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23791 the pointer.
23792
23793 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23794 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23795 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23796 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23797 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23798
23799 @table @code
23800 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23801 @kindex show mpx bound
23802 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23803
23804 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23805 @kindex set mpx bound
23806 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23807 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23808 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23809 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23810 @end table
23811
23812 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23813 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23814 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23815 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23816
23817 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23818 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23819 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23820 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23821 function.
23822
23823 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23824 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23825 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23826 continuing the execution. For example:
23827
23828 @smallexample
23829 $ break *upper
23830 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23831 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23832 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23833 $ print $bnd0
23834 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23835 @end smallexample
23836
23837 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23838 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23839 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23840
23841 @node Alpha
23842 @subsection Alpha
23843
23844 See the following section.
23845
23846 @node MIPS
23847 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23848
23849 @cindex stack on Alpha
23850 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23851 @cindex Alpha stack
23852 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23853 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23854 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23855 find the beginning of a function.
23856
23857 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23858 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23859 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23860 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23861 commands:
23862
23863 @table @code
23864 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23865 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23866 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23867 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23868 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23869 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23870 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23871 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23872
23873 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23874 Display the current limit.
23875 @end table
23876
23877 @noindent
23878 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23879 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23880
23881 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23882 programs:
23883
23884 @table @code
23885 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23886 @kindex set mips abi
23887 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23888 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23889 values of @var{arg} are:
23890
23891 @table @samp
23892 @item auto
23893 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23894 default).
23895 @item o32
23896 @item o64
23897 @item n32
23898 @item n64
23899 @item eabi32
23900 @item eabi64
23901 @end table
23902
23903 @item show mips abi
23904 @kindex show mips abi
23905 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23906
23907 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23908 @kindex set mips compression
23909 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23910 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23911 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23912 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23913 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23914 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23915 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23916 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23917 provided by the executable.
23918
23919 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23920 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23921 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23922 identified as such.
23923
23924 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23925 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23926 implicitly from an executable.
23927
23928 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23929 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23930 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23931 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23932 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23933
23934 @item show mips compression
23935 @kindex show mips compression
23936 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23937 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23938
23939 @item set mipsfpu
23940 @itemx show mipsfpu
23941 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23942
23943 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23944 @kindex set mips mask-address
23945 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23946 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23947 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23948 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23949 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23950
23951 @item show mips mask-address
23952 @kindex show mips mask-address
23953 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23954 not.
23955
23956 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23957 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23958 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23959 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23960 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23961 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23962
23963 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23964 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23965 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23966
23967 @item set debug mips
23968 @kindex set debug mips
23969 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23970 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23971
23972 @item show debug mips
23973 @kindex show debug mips
23974 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23975 @end table
23976
23977
23978 @node HPPA
23979 @subsection HPPA
23980 @cindex HPPA support
23981
23982 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23983 following special commands:
23984
23985 @table @code
23986 @item set debug hppa
23987 @kindex set debug hppa
23988 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23989 messages are to be displayed.
23990
23991 @item show debug hppa
23992 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23993
23994 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23995 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23996 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23997 given @var{address}.
23998
23999 @end table
24000
24001
24002 @node SPU
24003 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24004 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
24005 @cindex SPU
24006
24007 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
24008 it provides the following special commands:
24009
24010 @table @code
24011 @item info spu event
24012 @kindex info spu
24013 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
24014 and pending event status.
24015
24016 @item info spu signal
24017 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
24018 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
24019 notification channels.
24020
24021 @item info spu mailbox
24022 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
24023 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
24024 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
24025
24026 @item info spu dma
24027 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24028 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24029 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24030
24031 @item info spu proxydma
24032 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24033 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24034 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24035
24036 @end table
24037
24038 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24039 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24040 special commands:
24041
24042 @table @code
24043 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24044 @kindex set spu
24045 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24046 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24047 function. The default is @code{off}.
24048
24049 @item show spu stop-on-load
24050 @kindex show spu
24051 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24052
24053 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24054 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24055 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24056 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24057 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24058 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24059
24060 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24061 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24062
24063 @end table
24064
24065 @node PowerPC
24066 @subsection PowerPC
24067 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24068
24069 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24070 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24071 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24072 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24073 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24074
24075 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24076 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24077 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24078
24079 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24080 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24081
24082 @node Nios II
24083 @subsection Nios II
24084 @cindex Nios II architecture
24085
24086 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24087 it provides the following special commands:
24088
24089 @table @code
24090
24091 @item set debug nios2
24092 @kindex set debug nios2
24093 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24094 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24095
24096 @item show debug nios2
24097 @kindex show debug nios2
24098 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24099 @end table
24100
24101 @node Sparc64
24102 @subsection Sparc64
24103 @cindex Sparc64 support
24104 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24105 @subsubsection ADI Support
24106
24107 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24108 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24109 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24110 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24111 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24112 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24113 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24114 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24115 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24116 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24117 signal.
24118
24119 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24120 ADI-enabled.
24121
24122 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24123 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24124
24125
24126 @table @code
24127 @kindex adi examine
24128 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24129
24130 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24131 cacheline.
24132
24133 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24134 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24135 block size, to display.
24136
24137 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24138 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24139
24140 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24141
24142 @smallexample
24143 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24144 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24145 @end smallexample
24146
24147 @kindex adi assign
24148 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24149
24150 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24151 to an address.
24152
24153 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24154 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24155 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24156
24157 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24158 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24159
24160 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24161
24162 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24163 variable "shmaddr":
24164
24165 @smallexample
24166 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24167 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24168 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24169 @end smallexample
24170
24171 @end table
24172
24173 @node S12Z
24174 @subsection S12Z
24175 @cindex S12Z support
24176
24177 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24178 it provides the following special command:
24179
24180 @table @code
24181 @item maint info bdccsr
24182 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24183 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24184 BDCCSR register.
24185 @end table
24186
24187
24188 @node Controlling GDB
24189 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24190
24191 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24192 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24193 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24194 described here.
24195
24196 @menu
24197 * Prompt:: Prompt
24198 * Editing:: Command editing
24199 * Command History:: Command history
24200 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24201 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24202 * Numbers:: Numbers
24203 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24204 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24205 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24206 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24207 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24208 @end menu
24209
24210 @node Prompt
24211 @section Prompt
24212
24213 @cindex prompt
24214
24215 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24216 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24217 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24218 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24219 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24220 which one you are talking to.
24221
24222 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24223 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24224 or a prompt that does not.
24225
24226 @table @code
24227 @kindex set prompt
24228 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24229 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24230
24231 @kindex show prompt
24232 @item show prompt
24233 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24234 @end table
24235
24236 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24237 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24238 are:
24239
24240 @table @code
24241 @kindex set extended-prompt
24242 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24243 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24244 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24245 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24246 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24247 is displayed.
24248
24249 For example:
24250
24251 @smallexample
24252 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24253 @end smallexample
24254
24255 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24256 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24257
24258 @kindex show extended-prompt
24259 @item show extended-prompt
24260 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24261 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24262 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24263 @end table
24264
24265 @node Editing
24266 @section Command Editing
24267 @cindex readline
24268 @cindex command line editing
24269
24270 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24271 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24272 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24273 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24274 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24275 debugging sessions.
24276
24277 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24278 command @code{set}.
24279
24280 @table @code
24281 @kindex set editing
24282 @cindex editing
24283 @item set editing
24284 @itemx set editing on
24285 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24286
24287 @item set editing off
24288 Disable command line editing.
24289
24290 @kindex show editing
24291 @item show editing
24292 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24293 @end table
24294
24295 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24296 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24297 @end ifset
24298 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24299 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24300 @end ifclear
24301 for more details about the Readline
24302 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24303 encouraged to read that chapter.
24304
24305 @node Command History
24306 @section Command History
24307 @cindex command history
24308
24309 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24310 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24311 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24312 history facility.
24313
24314 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24315 package, to provide the history facility.
24316 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24317 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24318 @end ifset
24319 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24320 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24321 @end ifclear
24322 for the detailed description of the History library.
24323
24324 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24325 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24326 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24327 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24328 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24329 pressed on a line by itself.
24330
24331 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24332 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24333 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24334 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24335
24336 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24337 history.
24338
24339 @table @code
24340 @cindex history substitution
24341 @cindex history file
24342 @kindex set history filename
24343 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24344 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24345 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24346 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24347 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24348 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24349 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24350 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24351 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24352 is not set.
24353
24354 @cindex save command history
24355 @kindex set history save
24356 @item set history save
24357 @itemx set history save on
24358 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24359 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24360
24361 @item set history save off
24362 Stop recording command history in a file.
24363
24364 @cindex history size
24365 @kindex set history size
24366 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24367 @item set history size @var{size}
24368 @itemx set history size unlimited
24369 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24370 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24371 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24372 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24373 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24374 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24375
24376 @cindex remove duplicate history
24377 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24378 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24379 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24380 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24381 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24382 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24383 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24384 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24385 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24386
24387 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24388 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24389
24390 @end table
24391
24392 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24393 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24394 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24395 @end ifset
24396 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24397 @xref{Event Designators},
24398 @end ifclear
24399 for more details.
24400
24401 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24402 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24403 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24404 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24405 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24406 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24407 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24408 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24409
24410 The commands to control history expansion are:
24411
24412 @table @code
24413 @item set history expansion on
24414 @itemx set history expansion
24415 @kindex set history expansion
24416 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24417
24418 @item set history expansion off
24419 Disable history expansion.
24420
24421 @c @group
24422 @kindex show history
24423 @item show history
24424 @itemx show history filename
24425 @itemx show history save
24426 @itemx show history size
24427 @itemx show history expansion
24428 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24429 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24430 @c @end group
24431 @end table
24432
24433 @table @code
24434 @kindex show commands
24435 @cindex show last commands
24436 @cindex display command history
24437 @item show commands
24438 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24439
24440 @item show commands @var{n}
24441 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24442
24443 @item show commands +
24444 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24445 @end table
24446
24447 @node Screen Size
24448 @section Screen Size
24449 @cindex size of screen
24450 @cindex screen size
24451 @cindex pagination
24452 @cindex page size
24453 @cindex pauses in output
24454
24455 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24456 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24457 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24458 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24459 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24460 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24461 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24462 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24463 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24464 following line.
24465
24466 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24467 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24468 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24469 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24470 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24471 width} commands:
24472
24473 @table @code
24474 @kindex set height
24475 @kindex set width
24476 @kindex show width
24477 @kindex show height
24478 @item set height @var{lpp}
24479 @itemx set height unlimited
24480 @itemx show height
24481 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24482 @itemx set width unlimited
24483 @itemx show width
24484 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24485 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24486 commands display the current settings.
24487
24488 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24489 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24490 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24491 buffer.
24492
24493 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24494 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24495
24496 @item set pagination on
24497 @itemx set pagination off
24498 @kindex set pagination
24499 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24500 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24501 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24502 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24503
24504 @item show pagination
24505 @kindex show pagination
24506 Show the current pagination mode.
24507 @end table
24508
24509 @node Output Styling
24510 @section Output Styling
24511 @cindex styling
24512 @cindex colors
24513
24514 @kindex set style
24515 @kindex show style
24516 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
24517 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
24518 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
24519 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
24520
24521 @table @code
24522 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
24523 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
24524 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
24525
24526 @item show style enabled
24527 Show the current state of styling.
24528 @end table
24529
24530 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
24531 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
24532 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
24533 intensity.
24534
24535 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
24536 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
24537
24538 @table @code
24539 @item set style filename background @var{color}
24540 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24541 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24542 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24543 and@samp{white}.
24544
24545 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
24546 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24547 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24548 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24549 and@samp{white}.
24550
24551 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
24552 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
24553 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
24554 @end table
24555
24556 The style-able objects are:
24557 @table @code
24558 @item filename
24559 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
24560 foreground color is green.
24561
24562 @item function
24563 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
24564 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
24565 style's foreground color is yellow.
24566
24567 @item variable
24568 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
24569 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
24570 foreground color is cyan.
24571
24572 @item address
24573 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
24574 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
24575 foreground color is blue.
24576 @end table
24577
24578 @node Numbers
24579 @section Numbers
24580 @cindex number representation
24581 @cindex entering numbers
24582
24583 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24584 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24585 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24586 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24587 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24588 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24589 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24590 both input and output with the commands described below.
24591
24592 @table @code
24593 @kindex set input-radix
24594 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24595 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24596 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24597 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24598 example, any of
24599
24600 @smallexample
24601 set input-radix 012
24602 set input-radix 10.
24603 set input-radix 0xa
24604 @end smallexample
24605
24606 @noindent
24607 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24608 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24609 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24610 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24611 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24612 change the radix.
24613
24614 @kindex set output-radix
24615 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24616 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24617 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24618 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24619
24620 @kindex show input-radix
24621 @item show input-radix
24622 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24623
24624 @kindex show output-radix
24625 @item show output-radix
24626 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24627
24628 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24629 @itemx show radix
24630 @kindex set radix
24631 @kindex show radix
24632 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24633 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24634 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24635 default value of 10.
24636
24637 @end table
24638
24639 @node ABI
24640 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24641
24642 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24643 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24644 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24645 current ABI.
24646
24647 @cindex OS ABI
24648 @kindex set osabi
24649 @kindex show osabi
24650 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24651
24652 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24653 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24654 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24655 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24656 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24657 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24658 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24659 platform provides.
24660
24661 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24662 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24663 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24664 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24665
24666 @table @code
24667 @item show osabi
24668 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24669
24670 @item set osabi
24671 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24672
24673 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24674 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24675 @end table
24676
24677 @cindex float promotion
24678
24679 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24680 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24681 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24682 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24683 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24684 @code{double} and then passed.
24685
24686 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24687 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24688 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24689
24690 @table @code
24691 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24692 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24693 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24694 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24695 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24696
24697 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24698 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24699 functions.
24700
24701 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24702 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24703 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24704 @end table
24705
24706 @kindex set cp-abi
24707 @kindex show cp-abi
24708 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24709 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24710 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24711 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24712 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24713 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24714 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24715 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24716 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24717 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24718 ``auto''.
24719
24720 @table @code
24721 @item show cp-abi
24722 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24723
24724 @item set cp-abi
24725 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24726
24727 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24728 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24729 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24730 @end table
24731
24732 @node Auto-loading
24733 @section Automatically loading associated files
24734 @cindex auto-loading
24735
24736 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24737 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24738 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24739 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24740 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24741 sources).
24742
24743 @menu
24744 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24745 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24746
24747 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24748 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24749 @end menu
24750
24751 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24752 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24753 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24754
24755 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24756 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24757 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24758
24759 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24760 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24761
24762 @table @code
24763 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24764 @kindex set auto-load off
24765 @item set auto-load off
24766 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24767 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24768 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24769 @smallexample
24770 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24771 @end smallexample
24772
24773 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24774 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24775 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24776 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24777 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24778 @code{set auto-load no}.
24779
24780 @anchor{show auto-load}
24781 @kindex show auto-load
24782 @item show auto-load
24783 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24784 or disabled.
24785
24786 @smallexample
24787 (gdb) show auto-load
24788 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24789 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24790 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24791 is on.
24792 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24793 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24794 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24795 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24796 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24797 @end smallexample
24798
24799 @anchor{info auto-load}
24800 @kindex info auto-load
24801 @item info auto-load
24802 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24803 not.
24804
24805 @smallexample
24806 (gdb) info auto-load
24807 gdb-scripts:
24808 Loaded Script
24809 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24810 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24811 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24812 loaded.
24813 python-scripts:
24814 Loaded Script
24815 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24816 @end smallexample
24817 @end table
24818
24819 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24820
24821 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24822 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24823 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24824 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24825 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24826 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24827 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24828 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24829 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24830 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24831 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24832 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24833 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24834 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24835 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24836 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24837 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24838 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24839 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24840 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24841 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24842 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24843 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24844 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24845 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24846 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24847 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24848 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24849 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24850 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24851 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24852 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24853 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24854 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24855 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24856 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24857 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24858 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24859 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24860 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24861 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24862 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24863 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24864 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24865 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24866 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24867 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24868 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24869 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24870 @end multitable
24871
24872 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24873 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24874 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24875
24876 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24877 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24878 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24879
24880 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24881 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24882
24883 @table @code
24884 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24885 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24886 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24887 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24888 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24889
24890 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24891 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24892 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24893 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24894 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24895
24896 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24897 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24898 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24899 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24900 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24901 @end table
24902
24903 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24904 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24905 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24906
24907 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24908
24909 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24910 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24911
24912 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24913 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24914 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24915 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24916 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24917 library.
24918
24919 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24920 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24921
24922 @table @code
24923 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24924 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24925 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24926 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24927
24928 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24929 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24930 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24931 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24932 enabled or disabled.
24933
24934 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24935 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24936 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24937 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24938 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24939 @end table
24940
24941 @node Auto-loading safe path
24942 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24943 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24944
24945 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24946 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24947 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24948 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24949 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24950
24951 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24952 get loaded:
24953
24954 @smallexample
24955 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24956 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24957 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24958 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24959 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24960 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24961 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24962 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24963 @end smallexample
24964
24965 @noindent
24966 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24967 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24968
24969 @smallexample
24970 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24971 @end smallexample
24972
24973 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24974
24975 @table @code
24976 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24977 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24978 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24979 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24980 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24981 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24982 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24983 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24984 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24985 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24986
24987 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24988 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24989 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24990
24991 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24992 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24993 @item show auto-load safe-path
24994 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24995 scripts.
24996
24997 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24998 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24999 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25000 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25001 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25002 by the host platform path separator in use.
25003 @end table
25004
25005 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25006 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25007 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25008 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25009 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25010
25011 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25012 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25013 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25014 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25015 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25016 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25017 init file in the current directory
25018 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25019
25020 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25021 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25022
25023 @table @asis
25024 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25025 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25026 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25027 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25028
25029 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25030 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25031 @value{GDBN} session.
25032
25033 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25034 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25035 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25036 from trusted sources.
25037
25038 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25039 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25040 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25041 trusted sources.
25042 @end table
25043
25044 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25045 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25046
25047 @table @asis
25048 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25049 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25050
25051 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25052 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25053 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25054 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25055 @end table
25056
25057 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25058 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25059 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25060 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25061 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25062 recommended to be entered.
25063
25064 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25065 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25066 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25067
25068 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25069 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25070 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25071 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25072 be printed.
25073
25074 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25075 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25076 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25077
25078 @smallexample
25079 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25080 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25081 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25082 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25083 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25084 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25085 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25086 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25087 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25088 @end smallexample
25089
25090 @table @code
25091 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25092 @kindex set debug auto-load
25093 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25094 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25095
25096 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25097 @kindex show debug auto-load
25098 @item show debug auto-load
25099 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25100 on or off.
25101 @end table
25102
25103 @node Messages/Warnings
25104 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25105
25106 @cindex verbose operation
25107 @cindex optional warnings
25108 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25109 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25110 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25111 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25112
25113 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25114 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25115 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25116
25117 @table @code
25118 @kindex set verbose
25119 @item set verbose on
25120 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25121
25122 @item set verbose off
25123 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25124
25125 @kindex show verbose
25126 @item show verbose
25127 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25128 @end table
25129
25130 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25131 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25132 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25133 Symbol Files}).
25134
25135 @table @code
25136
25137 @kindex set complaints
25138 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25139 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25140 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25141 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25142 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25143
25144 @kindex show complaints
25145 @item show complaints
25146 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25147
25148 @end table
25149
25150 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25151 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25152 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25153 you try to run a program which is already running:
25154
25155 @smallexample
25156 (@value{GDBP}) run
25157 The program being debugged has been started already.
25158 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25159 @end smallexample
25160
25161 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25162 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25163
25164 @table @code
25165
25166 @kindex set confirm
25167 @cindex flinching
25168 @cindex confirmation
25169 @cindex stupid questions
25170 @item set confirm off
25171 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25172 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25173 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25174
25175 @item set confirm on
25176 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25177
25178 @kindex show confirm
25179 @item show confirm
25180 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25181
25182 @end table
25183
25184 @cindex command tracing
25185 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25186 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25187 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25188 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25189
25190 @table @code
25191 @kindex set trace-commands
25192 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25193 @item set trace-commands on
25194 Enable command tracing.
25195 @item set trace-commands off
25196 Disable command tracing.
25197 @item show trace-commands
25198 Display the current state of command tracing.
25199 @end table
25200
25201 @node Debugging Output
25202 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25203 @cindex optional debugging messages
25204
25205 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25206 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25207 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25208 section documents those commands.
25209
25210 @table @code
25211 @kindex set exec-done-display
25212 @item set exec-done-display
25213 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25214 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25215 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25216 @kindex show exec-done-display
25217 @item show exec-done-display
25218 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25219 notification.
25220 @kindex set debug
25221 @cindex ARM AArch64
25222 @item set debug aarch64
25223 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25224 The default is off.
25225 @kindex show debug
25226 @item show debug aarch64
25227 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25228 ARM AArch64.
25229 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25230 @cindex architecture debugging info
25231 @item set debug arch
25232 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25233 @item show debug arch
25234 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25235 @item set debug aix-solib
25236 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25237 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25238 support module. The default is off.
25239 @item show debug aix-thread
25240 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25241 @item set debug aix-thread
25242 @cindex AIX threads
25243 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25244 module.
25245 @item show debug aix-thread
25246 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25247 @item set debug check-physname
25248 @cindex physname
25249 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25250 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25251 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25252 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25253 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25254 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25255 @item show debug check-physname
25256 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25257 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25258 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25259 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25260 exported symbols. The default is off.
25261 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25262 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25263 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25264 @item set debug dwarf-die
25265 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25266 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25267 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25268 A value of zero turns off the display.
25269 @item show debug dwarf-die
25270 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25271 @item set debug dwarf-line
25272 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25273 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25274 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25275 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25276 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25277 @item show debug dwarf-line
25278 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25279 @item set debug dwarf-read
25280 @cindex DWARF Reading
25281 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25282 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25283 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25284 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25285 @item show debug dwarf-read
25286 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25287 @item set debug displaced
25288 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25289 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25290 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25291 @item show debug displaced
25292 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25293 related to displaced stepping.
25294 @item set debug event
25295 @cindex event debugging info
25296 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25297 default is off.
25298 @item show debug event
25299 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25300 info.
25301 @item set debug expression
25302 @cindex expression debugging info
25303 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25304 expression parsing. The default is off.
25305 @item show debug expression
25306 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25307 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25308 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25309 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25310 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25311 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25312 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25313 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25314 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25315 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25316 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25317 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25318 @item set debug frame
25319 @cindex frame debugging info
25320 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25321 default is off.
25322 @item show debug frame
25323 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25324 info.
25325 @item set debug gnu-nat
25326 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25327 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25328 @item show debug gnu-nat
25329 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25330 @item set debug infrun
25331 @cindex inferior debugging info
25332 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25333 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25334 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25335 @item show debug infrun
25336 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25337 @item set debug jit
25338 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25339 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25340 @item show debug jit
25341 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25342 @item set debug lin-lwp
25343 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25344 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25345 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25346 @item show debug lin-lwp
25347 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25348 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25349 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25350 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25351 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25352 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25353 @item set debug mach-o
25354 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25355 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25356 processing. The default is off.
25357 @item show debug mach-o
25358 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25359 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25360 @item set debug notification
25361 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25362 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25363 The default is off.
25364 @item show debug notification
25365 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25366 @item set debug observer
25367 @cindex observer debugging info
25368 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25369 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25370 @item show debug observer
25371 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25372 @item set debug overload
25373 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25374 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25375 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25376 is off.
25377 @item show debug overload
25378 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25379 debugging info.
25380 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25381 @cindex debug expression parser
25382 @item set debug parser
25383 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25384 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25385 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25386 details. The default is off.
25387 @item show debug parser
25388 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25389 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25390 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25391 @cindex debug remote protocol
25392 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25393 @cindex display remote packets
25394 @item set debug remote
25395 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25396 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25397 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25398 @item show debug remote
25399 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25400
25401 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25402 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25403 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25404 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25405
25406 @item set debug serial
25407 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25408 default is off.
25409 @item show debug serial
25410 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25411 info.
25412 @item set debug solib-frv
25413 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25414 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25415 @item show debug solib-frv
25416 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25417 messages.
25418 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25419 @cindex symbol lookup
25420 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25421 The default is 0 (off).
25422 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25423 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25424 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25425 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25426 @item set debug symfile
25427 @cindex symbol file functions
25428 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25429 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25430 @item show debug symfile
25431 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25432 @item set debug symtab-create
25433 @cindex symbol table creation
25434 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25435 The default is 0 (off).
25436 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25437 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25438 @item show debug symtab-create
25439 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25440 @item set debug target
25441 @cindex target debugging info
25442 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25443 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25444 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25445 value of large memory transfers.
25446 @item show debug target
25447 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25448 info.
25449 @item set debug timestamp
25450 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25451 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25452 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25453 message.
25454 @item show debug timestamp
25455 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25456 debugging info.
25457 @item set debug varobj
25458 @cindex variable object debugging info
25459 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25460 info. The default is off.
25461 @item show debug varobj
25462 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25463 debugging info.
25464 @item set debug xml
25465 @cindex XML parser debugging
25466 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25467 @item show debug xml
25468 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25469 @end table
25470
25471 @node Other Misc Settings
25472 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25473 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25474
25475 @table @code
25476 @kindex set interactive-mode
25477 @item set interactive-mode
25478 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25479 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25480 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25481 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25482 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25483 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25484 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25485 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25486
25487 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25488 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25489 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25490 inside a cygwin window.
25491
25492 @kindex show interactive-mode
25493 @item show interactive-mode
25494 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25495 @end table
25496
25497 @node Extending GDB
25498 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25499 @cindex extending GDB
25500
25501 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25502 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25503 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25504 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25505 being debugged.
25506
25507 @menu
25508 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25509 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25510 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25511 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25512 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25513 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25514 @end menu
25515
25516 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25517 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25518 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25519 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25520 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25521 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25522
25523 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25524 setting:
25525
25526 @table @code
25527 @kindex set script-extension
25528 @kindex show script-extension
25529 @item set script-extension off
25530 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25531
25532 @item set script-extension soft
25533 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25534 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25535 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25536 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25537
25538 @item set script-extension strict
25539 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25540 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25541 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25542
25543 @item show script-extension
25544 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25545
25546 @end table
25547
25548 @node Sequences
25549 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25550
25551 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25552 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25553 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25554 files.
25555
25556 @menu
25557 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25558 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25559 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25560 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25561 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25562 @end menu
25563
25564 @node Define
25565 @subsection User-defined Commands
25566
25567 @cindex user-defined command
25568 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25569 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25570 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25571 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25572 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25573 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25574
25575 @smallexample
25576 define adder
25577 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25578 end
25579 @end smallexample
25580
25581 @noindent
25582 To execute the command use:
25583
25584 @smallexample
25585 adder 1 2 3
25586 @end smallexample
25587
25588 @noindent
25589 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25590 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25591 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25592 functions calls.
25593
25594 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25595 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25596 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25597 been passed.
25598
25599 @smallexample
25600 define adder
25601 if $argc == 2
25602 print $arg0 + $arg1
25603 end
25604 if $argc == 3
25605 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25606 end
25607 end
25608 @end smallexample
25609
25610 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25611 to process a variable number of arguments:
25612
25613 @smallexample
25614 define adder
25615 set $i = 0
25616 set $sum = 0
25617 while $i < $argc
25618 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25619 set $i = $i + 1
25620 end
25621 print $sum
25622 end
25623 @end smallexample
25624
25625 @table @code
25626
25627 @kindex define
25628 @item define @var{commandname}
25629 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25630 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25631 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25632 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25633 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25634 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25635
25636 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25637 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25638 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25639
25640 @kindex document
25641 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25642 @item document @var{commandname}
25643 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25644 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25645 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25646 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25647 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25648 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25649
25650 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25651 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25652 does not change the documentation.
25653
25654 @kindex dont-repeat
25655 @cindex don't repeat command
25656 @item dont-repeat
25657 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25658 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25659 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25660
25661 @kindex help user-defined
25662 @item help user-defined
25663 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25664 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25665 included (if any).
25666
25667 @kindex show user
25668 @item show user
25669 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25670 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25671 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25672 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25673 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25674
25675 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25676 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25677 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25678 @item show max-user-call-depth
25679 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25680 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25681 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25682 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25683 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25684 @end table
25685
25686 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25687 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25688
25689 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25690 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25691 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25692
25693 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25694 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25695 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25696 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25697
25698 @node Hooks
25699 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25700 @cindex command hooks
25701 @cindex hooks, for commands
25702 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25703
25704 @kindex hook
25705 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25706 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25707 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25708 before that command.
25709
25710 @cindex hooks, post-command
25711 @kindex hookpost
25712 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25713 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25714 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25715 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25716 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25717
25718 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25719 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25720
25721 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25722 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25723
25724 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25725 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25726 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25727 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25728 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25729
25730 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25731 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25732 you could define:
25733
25734 @smallexample
25735 define hook-stop
25736 handle SIGALRM nopass
25737 end
25738
25739 define hook-run
25740 handle SIGALRM pass
25741 end
25742
25743 define hook-continue
25744 handle SIGALRM pass
25745 end
25746 @end smallexample
25747
25748 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25749 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25750 you could define:
25751
25752 @smallexample
25753 define hook-echo
25754 echo <<<---
25755 end
25756
25757 define hookpost-echo
25758 echo --->>>\n
25759 end
25760
25761 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25762 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25763 (@value{GDBP})
25764
25765 @end smallexample
25766
25767 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25768 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25769 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25770 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25771 @c or not?
25772 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25773 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25774 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25775
25776 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25777 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25778 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25779
25780 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25781 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25782
25783 @node Command Files
25784 @subsection Command Files
25785
25786 @cindex command files
25787 @cindex scripting commands
25788 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25789 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25790 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25791 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25792 terminal.
25793
25794 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25795 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25796 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25797 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25798 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25799
25800 @table @code
25801 @kindex source
25802 @cindex execute commands from a file
25803 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25804 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25805 @end table
25806
25807 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25808 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25809 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25810 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25811 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25812
25813 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25814 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25815 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25816 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25817 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25818 is not relevant to scripts.
25819
25820 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25821 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25822 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25823 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25824 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25825 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25826 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25827 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25828 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25829 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25830 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25831 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25832 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25833 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25834
25835 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25836 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25837 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25838
25839 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25840 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25841 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25842 when called from command files.
25843
25844 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25845 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25846 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25847 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25848 the next command.
25849
25850 @smallexample
25851 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25852 @end smallexample
25853
25854 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25855 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25856 would be directed to @file{log}.
25857
25858 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25859 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25860 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25861 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25862 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25863 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25864 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25865 conditionally, etc.
25866
25867 @table @code
25868 @kindex if
25869 @kindex else
25870 @item if
25871 @itemx else
25872 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25873 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25874 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25875 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25876 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25877 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25878 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25879
25880 @kindex while
25881 @item while
25882 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25883 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25884 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25885 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25886 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25887 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25888
25889 @kindex loop_break
25890 @item loop_break
25891 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25892 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25893 line.
25894
25895 @kindex loop_continue
25896 @item loop_continue
25897 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25898 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25899 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25900 the controlling expression.
25901
25902 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25903 @item end
25904 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25905 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25906 @end table
25907
25908
25909 @node Output
25910 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25911
25912 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25913 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25914 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25915 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25916 want.
25917
25918 @table @code
25919 @kindex echo
25920 @item echo @var{text}
25921 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25922 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25923 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25924 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25925 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25926 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25927 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25928 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25929 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25930 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25931 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25932
25933 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25934 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25935
25936 @smallexample
25937 echo This is some text\n\
25938 which is continued\n\
25939 onto several lines.\n
25940 @end smallexample
25941
25942 produces the same output as
25943
25944 @smallexample
25945 echo This is some text\n
25946 echo which is continued\n
25947 echo onto several lines.\n
25948 @end smallexample
25949
25950 @kindex output
25951 @item output @var{expression}
25952 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25953 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25954 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25955 on expressions.
25956
25957 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25958 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25959 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25960 Formats}, for more information.
25961
25962 @kindex printf
25963 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25964 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25965 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25966 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25967 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25968 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25969 executing the code below:
25970
25971 @smallexample
25972 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25973 @end smallexample
25974
25975 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25976 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25977 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25978 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25979 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25980 printed.
25981
25982 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25983
25984 @smallexample
25985 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25986 @end smallexample
25987
25988 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25989 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25990 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25991
25992 @itemize @bullet
25993 @item
25994 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25995
25996 @item
25997 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25998 width.
25999
26000 @item
26001 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26002 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26003
26004 @item
26005 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26006 supported.
26007
26008 @item
26009 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26010
26011 @item
26012 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26013 @end itemize
26014
26015 @noindent
26016 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26017 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26018 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26019 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26020
26021 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26022 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26023 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26024 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26025 supported.
26026
26027 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26028 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26029 together with a floating point specifier.
26030 letters:
26031
26032 @itemize @bullet
26033 @item
26034 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26035
26036 @item
26037 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26038
26039 @item
26040 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26041 @end itemize
26042
26043 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26044 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26045 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26046
26047 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26048 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26049
26050 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26051 @smallexample
26052 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26053 @end smallexample
26054
26055 @anchor{eval}
26056 @kindex eval
26057 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26058 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26059 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26060
26061 @end table
26062
26063 @node Auto-loading sequences
26064 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26065 @cindex native script auto-loading
26066
26067 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26068 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26069 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26070 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26071
26072 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26073 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26074
26075 @table @code
26076 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26077 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26078 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26079 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26080
26081 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26082 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26083 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26084 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26085 disabled.
26086
26087 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26088 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26089 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26090 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26091 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26092 auto-loaded.
26093 @end table
26094
26095 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26096 matching names are printed.
26097
26098 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26099 @include python.texi
26100
26101 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26102 @include guile.texi
26103
26104 @node Auto-loading extensions
26105 @section Auto-loading extensions
26106 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26107
26108 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26109 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26110 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26111 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26112 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26113
26114 @menu
26115 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26116 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26117 * Which flavor to choose?::
26118 @end menu
26119
26120 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26121 debugging commands and features.
26122
26123 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26124 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26125 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26126 for more information.
26127 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26128 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26129
26130 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26131 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26132
26133 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26134 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26135 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26136 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26137 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26138
26139 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26140 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26141 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26142 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26143
26144 @table @code
26145 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26146 GDB's own command language
26147 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26148 Python
26149 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26150 Guile
26151 @end table
26152
26153 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26154 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26155 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26156 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26157 script in the specified extension language.
26158
26159 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26160 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26161
26162 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26163 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26164
26165 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26166 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26167 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26168 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26169 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26170 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26171
26172 @table @code
26173 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26174 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26175 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26176 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26177 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26178 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26179
26180 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26181 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26182
26183 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26184 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26185 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26186 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26187
26188 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26189 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26190 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26191 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26192 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26193 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26194 platform.
26195
26196 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26197 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26198 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26199
26200 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26201 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26202 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26203 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26204
26205 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26206 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26207 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26208 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26209 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26210 @end table
26211
26212 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26213 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26214 @var{objfile} is opened.
26215 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26216 is evaluated more than once.
26217
26218 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26219 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26220 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26221
26222 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26223 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26224 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26225 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26226 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26227 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26228 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26229
26230 The following entries are supported:
26231
26232 @table @code
26233 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26234 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26235 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26236 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26237 @end table
26238
26239 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26240
26241 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26242 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26243 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26244 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26245 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26246
26247 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26248 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26249
26250 @example
26251 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26252 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26253 asm("\
26254 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26255 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26256 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26257 .popsection \n\
26258 ");
26259 @end example
26260
26261 @noindent
26262 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26263 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26264
26265 @example
26266 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26267 @end example
26268
26269 The script name may include directories if desired.
26270
26271 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26272 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26273
26274 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26275 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26276 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26277 will remove duplicates.
26278
26279 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26280
26281 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26282 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26283 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26284 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26285 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26286 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26287 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26288 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26289 on its name.
26290
26291 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26292 testsuite.
26293
26294 @example
26295 #include "symcat.h"
26296 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26297 asm(
26298 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26299 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26300 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26301 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26302 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26303 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26304 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26305 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26306 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26307 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26308 ".byte 0\n"
26309 ".popsection\n"
26310 );
26311 @end example
26312
26313 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26314 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26315 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26316 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26317
26318 @node Which flavor to choose?
26319 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26320
26321 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26322 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26323
26324 @noindent
26325 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26326
26327 @itemize @bullet
26328 @item
26329 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26330
26331 @item
26332 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26333
26334 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26335 in the source search path.
26336 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26337 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26338
26339 @item
26340 Doesn't require source code additions.
26341 @end itemize
26342
26343 @noindent
26344 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26345
26346 @itemize @bullet
26347 @item
26348 Works with static linking.
26349
26350 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26351 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26352 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26353 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26354 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26355
26356 @item
26357 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26358
26359 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26360 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26361
26362 @item
26363 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26364
26365 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26366 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26367 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26368 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26369 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26370 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26371 @end itemize
26372
26373 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26374 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26375
26376 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26377 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26378 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26379
26380 @subsection Python comes first
26381
26382 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26383 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26384 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26385 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26386 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26387 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26388 pretty-printed form of a value).
26389 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26390 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26391 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26392
26393 @node Aliases
26394 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26395 @cindex aliases for commands
26396
26397 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26398 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26399 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26400 that involves less typing.
26401
26402 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26403 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26404 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26405
26406 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26407 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26408 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26409
26410 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26411
26412 @table @code
26413
26414 @kindex alias
26415 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26416
26417 @end table
26418
26419 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26420 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26421 underscores.
26422
26423 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26424 that is being aliased.
26425
26426 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26427 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26428 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26429
26430 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26431 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26432
26433 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26434 of a command so that there is less to type.
26435 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26436 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26437 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26438 The following will accomplish this.
26439
26440 @smallexample
26441 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26442 @end smallexample
26443
26444 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26445 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26446 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26447 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26448
26449 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26450 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26451 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26452 of a command.
26453
26454 @smallexample
26455 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26456 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26457 (gdb) set p elms 20
26458 (gdb) show p elms
26459 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26460 @end smallexample
26461
26462 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26463 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26464 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26465
26466 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26467 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26468
26469 @smallexample
26470 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26471 @end smallexample
26472
26473 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26474 alias for a more complex command.
26475 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26476
26477 @smallexample
26478 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26479 (gdb) spe 20
26480 @end smallexample
26481
26482 @node Interpreters
26483 @chapter Command Interpreters
26484 @cindex command interpreters
26485
26486 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26487 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26488 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26489
26490 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26491 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26492 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26493 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26494
26495 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26496 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26497 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26498 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26499
26500 @table @code
26501 @item console
26502 @cindex console interpreter
26503 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26504 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26505 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26506
26507 @item mi
26508 @cindex mi interpreter
26509 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
26510 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26511 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26512 Interface}.
26513
26514 @item mi3
26515 @cindex mi3 interpreter
26516 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
26517
26518 @item mi2
26519 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26520 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
26521
26522 @item mi1
26523 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26524 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
26525
26526 @end table
26527
26528 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26529
26530 @kindex interpreter-exec
26531 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26532 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26533 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26534
26535 @smallexample
26536 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26537 @end smallexample
26538
26539 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26540 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26541
26542 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26543 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26544 permanently.
26545
26546 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26547
26548 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26549 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26550 device (usually a tty).
26551
26552 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26553 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26554 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26555 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26556 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26557 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26558 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26559 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26560 the separate MI interpreter.
26561
26562 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26563 @code{new-ui} command:
26564
26565 @kindex new-ui
26566 @cindex new user interface
26567 @smallexample
26568 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26569 @end smallexample
26570
26571 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26572 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26573 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26574 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26575 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26576 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26577
26578 @smallexample
26579 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26580 @end smallexample
26581
26582 @noindent
26583 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26584
26585 @node TUI
26586 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26587 @cindex TUI
26588 @cindex Text User Interface
26589
26590 @menu
26591 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26592 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26593 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26594 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26595 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26596 @end menu
26597
26598 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26599 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26600 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26601 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26602 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26603 is available.
26604
26605 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26606 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26607 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26608 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26609 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26610 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26611
26612 @node TUI Overview
26613 @section TUI Overview
26614
26615 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26616
26617 @table @emph
26618 @item command
26619 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26620 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26621 managed using readline.
26622
26623 @item source
26624 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26625 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26626
26627 @item assembly
26628 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26629
26630 @item register
26631 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26632 when their values change.
26633 @end table
26634
26635 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26636 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26637 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26638 indicates the breakpoint type:
26639
26640 @table @code
26641 @item B
26642 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26643
26644 @item b
26645 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26646
26647 @item H
26648 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26649
26650 @item h
26651 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26652 @end table
26653
26654 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26655
26656 @table @code
26657 @item +
26658 Breakpoint is enabled.
26659
26660 @item -
26661 Breakpoint is disabled.
26662 @end table
26663
26664 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26665 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26666 changes.
26667
26668 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26669 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26670 layouts:
26671
26672 @itemize @bullet
26673 @item
26674 source only,
26675
26676 @item
26677 assembly only,
26678
26679 @item
26680 source and assembly,
26681
26682 @item
26683 source and registers, or
26684
26685 @item
26686 assembly and registers.
26687 @end itemize
26688
26689 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26690
26691 @table @emph
26692 @item target
26693 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26694 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26695
26696 @item process
26697 Gives the current process or thread number.
26698 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26699
26700 @item function
26701 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26702 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26703 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26704 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26705
26706 @item line
26707 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26708 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26709
26710 @item pc
26711 Indicates the current program counter address.
26712 @end table
26713
26714 @node TUI Keys
26715 @section TUI Key Bindings
26716 @cindex TUI key bindings
26717
26718 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26719 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26720 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26721 @end ifset
26722 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26723 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26724 @end ifclear
26725 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26726 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26727
26728 @table @kbd
26729 @kindex C-x C-a
26730 @item C-x C-a
26731 @kindex C-x a
26732 @itemx C-x a
26733 @kindex C-x A
26734 @itemx C-x A
26735 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26736 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26737 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26738 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26739 The screen is then refreshed.
26740
26741 @kindex C-x 1
26742 @item C-x 1
26743 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26744 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26745 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26746
26747 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26748
26749 @kindex C-x 2
26750 @item C-x 2
26751 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26752 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26753 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26754 previous layout and the new one.
26755
26756 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26757
26758 @kindex C-x o
26759 @item C-x o
26760 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26761 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26762 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26763
26764 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26765
26766 @kindex C-x s
26767 @item C-x s
26768 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26769 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26770 @end table
26771
26772 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26773
26774 @table @asis
26775 @kindex PgUp
26776 @item @key{PgUp}
26777 Scroll the active window one page up.
26778
26779 @kindex PgDn
26780 @item @key{PgDn}
26781 Scroll the active window one page down.
26782
26783 @kindex Up
26784 @item @key{Up}
26785 Scroll the active window one line up.
26786
26787 @kindex Down
26788 @item @key{Down}
26789 Scroll the active window one line down.
26790
26791 @kindex Left
26792 @item @key{Left}
26793 Scroll the active window one column left.
26794
26795 @kindex Right
26796 @item @key{Right}
26797 Scroll the active window one column right.
26798
26799 @kindex C-L
26800 @item @kbd{C-L}
26801 Refresh the screen.
26802 @end table
26803
26804 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26805 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26806 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26807 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26808 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26809
26810 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26811 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26812 @cindex TUI single key mode
26813
26814 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26815 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26816 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26817
26818 @table @kbd
26819 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26820 @item c
26821 continue
26822
26823 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26824 @item d
26825 down
26826
26827 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26828 @item f
26829 finish
26830
26831 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26832 @item n
26833 next
26834
26835 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26836 @item o
26837 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26838
26839 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26840 @item q
26841 exit the SingleKey mode.
26842
26843 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26844 @item r
26845 run
26846
26847 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26848 @item s
26849 step
26850
26851 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26852 @item i
26853 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26854
26855 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26856 @item u
26857 up
26858
26859 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26860 @item v
26861 info locals
26862
26863 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26864 @item w
26865 where
26866 @end table
26867
26868 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26869 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26870 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26871 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26872 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26873 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26874
26875
26876 @node TUI Commands
26877 @section TUI-specific Commands
26878 @cindex TUI commands
26879
26880 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26881 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26882 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26883 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26884
26885 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26886 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26887 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26888 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26889 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26890
26891 @table @code
26892 @item tui enable
26893 @kindex tui enable
26894 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26895 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26896 otherwise a default layout is used.
26897
26898 @item tui disable
26899 @kindex tui disable
26900 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26901
26902 @item info win
26903 @kindex info win
26904 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26905
26906 @item layout @var{name}
26907 @kindex layout
26908 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26909 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26910 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26911
26912 @table @code
26913 @item next
26914 Display the next layout.
26915
26916 @item prev
26917 Display the previous layout.
26918
26919 @item src
26920 Display the source and command windows.
26921
26922 @item asm
26923 Display the assembly and command windows.
26924
26925 @item split
26926 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26927
26928 @item regs
26929 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26930 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26931 register, assembler, and command windows.
26932 @end table
26933
26934 @item focus @var{name}
26935 @kindex focus
26936 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26937 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26938
26939 @table @code
26940 @item next
26941 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26942
26943 @item prev
26944 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26945
26946 @item src
26947 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26948
26949 @item asm
26950 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26951
26952 @item regs
26953 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26954
26955 @item cmd
26956 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26957 @end table
26958
26959 @item refresh
26960 @kindex refresh
26961 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26962
26963 @item tui reg @var{group}
26964 @kindex tui reg
26965 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26966 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26967 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26968 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26969 following groups are available on most targets:
26970 @table @code
26971 @item next
26972 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26973 through all of the available register groups.
26974
26975 @item prev
26976 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26977 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26978 @var{next}.
26979
26980 @item general
26981 Display the general registers.
26982 @item float
26983 Display the floating point registers.
26984 @item system
26985 Display the system registers.
26986 @item vector
26987 Display the vector registers.
26988 @item all
26989 Display all registers.
26990 @end table
26991
26992 @item update
26993 @kindex update
26994 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26995
26996 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26997 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26998 @kindex winheight
26999 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27000 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27001 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27002 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27003 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27004 @end table
27005
27006 @node TUI Configuration
27007 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27008 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27009
27010 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27011
27012 @table @code
27013 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27014 @kindex set tui border-kind
27015 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27016 The possible values are the following:
27017 @table @code
27018 @item space
27019 Use a space character to draw the border.
27020
27021 @item ascii
27022 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27023
27024 @item acs
27025 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27026 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27027 @end table
27028
27029 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27030 @kindex set tui border-mode
27031 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27032 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27033 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27034 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27035 @table @code
27036 @item normal
27037 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27038
27039 @item standout
27040 Use standout mode.
27041
27042 @item reverse
27043 Use reverse video mode.
27044
27045 @item half
27046 Use half bright mode.
27047
27048 @item half-standout
27049 Use half bright and standout mode.
27050
27051 @item bold
27052 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27053
27054 @item bold-standout
27055 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27056 @end table
27057
27058 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27059 @kindex set tui tab-width
27060 @kindex tabset
27061 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27062 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27063 assembly windows.
27064 @end table
27065
27066 @node Emacs
27067 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27068
27069 @cindex Emacs
27070 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27071 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27072 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27073 @value{GDBN}.
27074
27075 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27076 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27077 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27078 created Emacs buffer.
27079 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27080
27081 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27082 things:
27083
27084 @itemize @bullet
27085 @item
27086 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27087 the GUD buffer.
27088
27089 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27090 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27091
27092 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27093 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27094 in this way.
27095
27096 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27097 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27098 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27099 stop.
27100
27101 @item
27102 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27103
27104 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27105 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27106 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27107 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27108 and the source.
27109
27110 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27111 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27112 @end itemize
27113
27114 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27115 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27116 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27117 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27118
27119 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27120 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27121 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27122 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27123 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27124 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27125 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27126 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27127 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27128
27129 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27130 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27131 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27132 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27133
27134 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27135 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27136 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27137 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27138 one you want.
27139
27140 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27141 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27142
27143 @table @kbd
27144 @item C-h m
27145 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27146
27147 @item C-c C-s
27148 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27149 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27150
27151 @item C-c C-n
27152 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27153 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27154 to show the current file and location.
27155
27156 @item C-c C-i
27157 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27158 display window accordingly.
27159
27160 @item C-c C-f
27161 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27162 @code{finish} command.
27163
27164 @item C-c C-r
27165 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27166 command.
27167
27168 @item C-c <
27169 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27170 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27171 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27172
27173 @item C-c >
27174 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27175 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27176 @end table
27177
27178 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27179 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27180
27181 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27182 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27183 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27184 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27185 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27186 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27187 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27188
27189 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27190 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27191 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27192 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27193 frame.
27194
27195 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27196 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27197 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27198 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27199 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27200 to correspond properly with the code.
27201
27202 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27203 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27204 Emacs Manual}).
27205
27206 @node GDB/MI
27207 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27208
27209 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27210
27211 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27212 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27213 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27214 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27215 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27216 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27217
27218 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27219 in the form of a reference manual.
27220
27221 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27222 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27223 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27224
27225 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27226
27227 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27228 This chapter uses the following notation:
27229
27230 @itemize @bullet
27231 @item
27232 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27233
27234 @item
27235 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27236 it may or may not be given.
27237
27238 @item
27239 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27240 may repeat zero or more times.
27241
27242 @item
27243 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27244 may repeat one or more times.
27245
27246 @item
27247 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27248 @end itemize
27249
27250 @ignore
27251 @heading Dependencies
27252 @end ignore
27253
27254 @menu
27255 * GDB/MI General Design::
27256 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27257 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27258 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27259 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27260 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27261 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27262 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27263 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27264 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27265 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27266 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27267 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27268 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27269 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27270 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27271 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27272 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27273 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27274 @ignore
27275 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27276 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27277 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27278 @end ignore
27279 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27280 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27281 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27282 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27283 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27284 @end menu
27285
27286 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27287 @node GDB/MI General Design
27288 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27289 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27290
27291 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27292 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27293 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27294 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27295 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27296 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27297 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27298 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27299 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27300 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27301
27302 The important examples of notifications are:
27303 @itemize @bullet
27304
27305 @item
27306 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27307 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27308 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27309 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27310 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27311 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27312 command itself was successfully executed.
27313
27314 @item
27315 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27316 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27317 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27318 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27319 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27320 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27321
27322 @item
27323 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27324 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27325 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27326 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27327 orthogonal frontend design.
27328
27329 @end itemize
27330
27331 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27332 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27333 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27334 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27335 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27336 the user interface.
27337
27338
27339 @menu
27340 * Context management::
27341 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27342 * Thread groups::
27343 @end menu
27344
27345 @node Context management
27346 @subsection Context management
27347
27348 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27349
27350 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27351 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27352 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27353 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27354 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27355 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27356 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27357 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27358 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27359
27360 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27361 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27362 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27363 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27364 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27365 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27366 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27367 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27368 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27369 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27370 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27371
27372 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27373 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27374 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27375 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27376 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27377 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27378 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27379 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27380 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27381 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27382
27383 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27384 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27385 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27386 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27387 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27388 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27389 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27390 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27391 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27392 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27393 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27394 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27395 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27396 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27397 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27398 @samp{--frame} options.
27399
27400 @subsubsection Language
27401
27402 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27403 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27404 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27405 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27406 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27407 For instance:
27408
27409 @smallexample
27410 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27411 ^done,value="4"
27412 (gdb)
27413 @end smallexample
27414
27415 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27416 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27417 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27418
27419 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27420 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27421
27422 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27423 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27424 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27425 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27426 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27427 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27428 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27429 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27430 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27431
27432 @table @code
27433 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27434 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27435 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27436
27437 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27438 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27439 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27440
27441 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27442 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27443 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27444 MI commands even while the target is running.
27445
27446 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27447 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27448 @end table
27449
27450 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27451 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27452 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27453 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27454 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27455 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27456
27457 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27458 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27459 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27460 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27461 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27462 are running.
27463
27464 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27465 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27466 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27467 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27468 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27469 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27470 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27471 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27472 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27473 @samp{--thread} option).
27474
27475 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27476 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27477 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27478 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27479
27480 @node Thread groups
27481 @subsection Thread groups
27482 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27483 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27484 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27485 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27486 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27487
27488 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27489 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27490 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27491 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27492 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27493 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27494 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27495 into processes.
27496
27497 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27498 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27499 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27500 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27501 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27502 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27503 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27504 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27505 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27506 the members of specific thread group.
27507
27508 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27509 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27510 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27511 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27512 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27513 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27514 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27515 after attaching to that thread group.
27516
27517 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27518 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27519 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27520 such thread groups.
27521
27522 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27523 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27524 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27525
27526 @menu
27527 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27528 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27529 @end menu
27530
27531 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27532 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27533
27534 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27535 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27536 @table @code
27537 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27538 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27539
27540 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27541 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27542 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27543
27544 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27545 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27546 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27547
27548 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27549 "any sequence of digits"
27550
27551 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27552 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27553
27554 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27555 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27556
27557 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27558 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27559
27560 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27561 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27562 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27563
27564 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27565 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27566
27567 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27568 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27569 @end table
27570
27571 @noindent
27572 Notes:
27573
27574 @itemize @bullet
27575 @item
27576 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27577 output is described below.
27578
27579 @item
27580 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27581 finishes.
27582
27583 @item
27584 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27585 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27586 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27587 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27588 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27589 @end itemize
27590
27591 Pragmatics:
27592
27593 @itemize @bullet
27594 @item
27595 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27596
27597 @item
27598 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27599 @end itemize
27600
27601 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27602 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27603
27604 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27605 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27606 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27607 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27608 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27609 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27610
27611 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27612 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27613 @var{token}.
27614
27615 @table @code
27616 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27617 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27618
27619 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27620 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27621
27622 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27623 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27624
27625 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27626 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27627
27628 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27629 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27630
27631 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27632 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27633
27634 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27635 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27636
27637 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27638 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27639
27640 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27641 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27642
27643 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27644 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27645 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27646
27647 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27648 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27649
27650 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27651 @code{ @var{string} }
27652
27653 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27654 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27655
27656 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27657 @code{@var{c-string}}
27658
27659 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27660 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27661
27662 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27663 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27664 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27665
27666 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27667 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27668
27669 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27670 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27671
27672 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27673 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27674
27675 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27676 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27677
27678 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27679 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27680
27681 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27682 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27683 @end table
27684
27685 @noindent
27686 Notes:
27687
27688 @itemize @bullet
27689 @item
27690 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27691
27692 @item
27693 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27694 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27695 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27696 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27697 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27698 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27699 prior command.
27700
27701 @item
27702 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27703 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27704 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27705 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27706
27707 @item
27708 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27709 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27710 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27711 @samp{*}.
27712
27713 @item
27714 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27715 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27716 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27717 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27718
27719 @item
27720 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27721 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27722 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27723 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27724
27725 @item
27726 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27727 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27728 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27729
27730 @item
27731 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27732 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27733 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27734 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27735
27736 @item
27737 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27738 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27739 @var{values}.
27740
27741
27742 @end itemize
27743
27744 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27745 details about the various output records.
27746
27747 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27748 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27749 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27750
27751 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27752 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27753
27754 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27755 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27756 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27757 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27758 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27759 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27760
27761 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27762 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27763 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27764
27765 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27766 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27767 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27768 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27769
27770 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27771 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27772
27773 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
27774 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
27775 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
27776 does.
27777
27778 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27779 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27780 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27781 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27782
27783 @itemize @bullet
27784 @item
27785 New MI commands may be added.
27786
27787 @item
27788 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27789
27790 @item
27791 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27792 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27793
27794 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27795 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27796
27797 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27798 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27799 @end itemize
27800
27801 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27802 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
27803 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
27804 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
27805
27806 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
27807 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
27808 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
27809 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
27810
27811 The following table gives a summary of the the released versions of the MI
27812 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
27813 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
27814
27815 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
27816 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
27817
27818 @item
27819 @center 1
27820 @tab
27821 @center 5.1
27822 @tab
27823 None
27824
27825 @item
27826 @center 2
27827 @tab
27828 @center 6.0
27829 @tab
27830
27831 @itemize
27832 @item
27833 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
27834 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
27835 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
27836
27837 @item
27838 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
27839 than a tuple.
27840
27841 @item
27842 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
27843 a tuple.
27844 @end itemize
27845
27846 @item
27847 @center 3
27848 @tab
27849 @center 9.1
27850 @tab
27851
27852 @itemize
27853 @item
27854 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
27855 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
27856 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
27857 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
27858 is a list.
27859 @end itemize
27860
27861 @end multitable
27862
27863 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
27864 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
27865 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
27866
27867 @table @code
27868
27869 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
27870 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
27871 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
27872 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
27873
27874 @end @table
27875
27876 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27877 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27878 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27879 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27880 @cindex mailing lists
27881
27882 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27883 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27884 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27885
27886 @menu
27887 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27888 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27889 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27890 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27891 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27892 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27893 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27894 @end menu
27895
27896 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27897 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27898
27899 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27900 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27901 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27902 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27903
27904 @table @code
27905 @findex ^done
27906 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27907 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27908 values.
27909
27910 @item "^running"
27911 @findex ^running
27912 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27913 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27914 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27915 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27916 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27917 which threads are resumed.
27918
27919 @item "^connected"
27920 @findex ^connected
27921 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27922
27923 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27924 @findex ^error
27925 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27926 the corresponding error message.
27927
27928 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27929 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27930 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27931
27932 @table @samp
27933 @item "undefined-command"
27934 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27935 @end table
27936
27937 @item "^exit"
27938 @findex ^exit
27939 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27940
27941 @end table
27942
27943 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27944 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27945
27946 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27947 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27948 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27949 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27950 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27951
27952 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27953 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27954 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27955 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27956 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27957
27958 @table @code
27959 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27960 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27961 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27962
27963 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27964 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27965 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27966 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27967
27968 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27969 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27970 internals.
27971 @end table
27972
27973 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27974 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27975
27976 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27977 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27978 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27979 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27980 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27981 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27982
27983 The following is the list of possible async records:
27984
27985 @table @code
27986
27987 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27988 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27989 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27990 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27991 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27992 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27993 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27994 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27995 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27996 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27997 it run freely.
27998
27999 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28000 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28001 following values:
28002
28003 @table @code
28004 @item breakpoint-hit
28005 A breakpoint was reached.
28006 @item watchpoint-trigger
28007 A watchpoint was triggered.
28008 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28009 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28010 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28011 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28012 @item function-finished
28013 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28014 @item location-reached
28015 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28016 @item watchpoint-scope
28017 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28018 @item end-stepping-range
28019 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28020 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28021 @item exited-signalled
28022 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28023 @item exited
28024 The inferior exited.
28025 @item exited-normally
28026 The inferior exited normally.
28027 @item signal-received
28028 A signal was received by the inferior.
28029 @item solib-event
28030 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28031 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28032 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
28033 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
28034 @item fork
28035 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
28036 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28037 @item vfork
28038 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
28039 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28040 @item syscall-entry
28041 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
28042 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28043 @item syscall-return
28044 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
28045 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28046 @item exec
28047 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
28048 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28049 @end table
28050
28051 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
28052 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28053 Depending on whether all-stop
28054 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28055 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28056 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28057 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28058 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28059 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28060 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28061 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28062 if such information is not available.
28063
28064 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28065 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28066 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28067 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28068 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28069 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28070 cannot be used in any way.
28071
28072 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28073 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28074 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28075 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28076 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28077 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28078
28079 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28080 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28081 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28082 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28083 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28084 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28085
28086 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28087 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28088 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28089 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28090 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28091
28092 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28093 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28094 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28095 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28096 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28097 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28098 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28099 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28100 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28101
28102 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28103 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28104
28105 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28106 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28107 that thread.
28108
28109 @item =library-loaded,...
28110 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28111 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28112 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28113 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28114 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28115 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28116 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28117 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28118 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28119 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28120 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28121 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28122 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28123 to this library.
28124
28125 @item =library-unloaded,...
28126 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28127 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28128 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28129 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28130 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28131 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28132 thread groups.
28133
28134 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28135 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28136 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28137 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28138 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28139
28140 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28141 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28142 initial value @var{initial}.
28143
28144 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28145 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28146 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28147 trace state variables are deleted.
28148
28149 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28150 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28151 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28152 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28153 value of trace state variable is known.
28154
28155 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28156 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28157 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28158 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28159 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28160 user.
28161
28162 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28163 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28164 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28165
28166 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28167 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28168
28169 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28170 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28171 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28172 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28173 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28174
28175 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28176 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28177 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28178 for existing method and format values.
28179
28180 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28181 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28182 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28183 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28184 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28185 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28186
28187 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28188 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28189 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28190 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28191 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28192 executable code.
28193 @end table
28194
28195 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28196 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28197
28198 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28199 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28200 following fields:
28201
28202 @table @code
28203 @item number
28204 The breakpoint number.
28205
28206 @item type
28207 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28208 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28209
28210 @item catch-type
28211 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28212 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28213
28214 @item disp
28215 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28216 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28217 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28218
28219 @item enabled
28220 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28221 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28222 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28223
28224 @item addr
28225 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28226 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28227 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28228 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28229 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28230
28231 @item func
28232 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28233 If not known, this field is not present.
28234
28235 @item filename
28236 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28237 If not known, this field is not present.
28238
28239 @item fullname
28240 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28241 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28242
28243 @item line
28244 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28245 If not known, this field is not present.
28246
28247 @item at
28248 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28249 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28250 by a symbol name.
28251
28252 @item pending
28253 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28254 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28255
28256 @item evaluated-by
28257 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28258 @samp{target}.
28259
28260 @item thread
28261 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28262 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28263
28264 @item task
28265 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28266 field will hold the task identifier.
28267
28268 @item cond
28269 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28270
28271 @item ignore
28272 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28273
28274 @item enable
28275 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28276
28277 @item traceframe-usage
28278 FIXME.
28279
28280 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28281 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28282
28283 @item mask
28284 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28285
28286 @item pass
28287 A tracepoint's pass count.
28288
28289 @item original-location
28290 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28291 This field is optional.
28292
28293 @item times
28294 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28295
28296 @item installed
28297 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28298 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28299 is not.
28300
28301 @item what
28302 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28303
28304 @item locations
28305 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
28306 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
28307 location.
28308
28309 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is decribed below.
28310
28311 @end table
28312
28313 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
28314 following fields:
28315
28316 @table @code
28317
28318 @item number
28319 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
28320 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
28321 location within that breakpoint.
28322
28323 @item enabled
28324 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
28325 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28326 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28327
28328 @item addr
28329 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
28330
28331 @item func
28332 If known, the function in which the location appears.
28333 If not known, this field is not present.
28334
28335 @item file
28336 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
28337 If not known, this field is not present.
28338
28339 @item fullname
28340 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
28341 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28342
28343 @item line
28344 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
28345 If not known, this field is not present.
28346
28347 @item thread-groups
28348 The thread groups this location is in.
28349
28350 @end table
28351
28352 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28353 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28354
28355 @smallexample
28356 -> -break-insert main
28357 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28358 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28359 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28360 times="0"@}
28361 <- (gdb)
28362 @end smallexample
28363
28364 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28365 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28366
28367 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28368 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28369 fields:
28370
28371 @table @code
28372 @item level
28373 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28374 zero. This field is always present.
28375
28376 @item func
28377 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28378 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28379
28380 @item addr
28381 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28382
28383 @item file
28384 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28385 address. This field may be absent.
28386
28387 @item line
28388 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28389 may be absent.
28390
28391 @item from
28392 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28393 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28394
28395 @end table
28396
28397 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28398 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28399
28400 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28401 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28402 stated otherwise.
28403
28404 @table @code
28405 @item id
28406 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28407
28408 @item target-id
28409 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28410
28411 @item details
28412 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28413 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28414 frontend. This field is optional.
28415
28416 @item name
28417 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28418 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28419 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28420 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28421 field is omitted.
28422
28423 @item state
28424 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28425 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28426
28427 @item frame
28428 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28429 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28430 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28431
28432 @item core
28433 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28434 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28435 @end table
28436
28437 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28438 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28439
28440 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28441 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28442 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28443 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28444 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28445 the @code{exception-message} field.
28446
28447 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28448 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28449 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28450 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28451
28452 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28453 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28454 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28455 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28456
28457 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28458 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28459
28460 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28461
28462 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28463 information of the breakpoint.
28464
28465 @smallexample
28466 -> -break-insert main
28467 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28468 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28469 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28470 times="0"@}
28471 <- (gdb)
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 @subheading Program Execution
28475
28476 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28477 reason that execution stopped.
28478
28479 @smallexample
28480 -> -exec-run
28481 <- ^running
28482 <- (gdb)
28483 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28484 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28485 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28486 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28487 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28488 <- (gdb)
28489 -> -exec-continue
28490 <- ^running
28491 <- (gdb)
28492 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28493 <- (gdb)
28494 @end smallexample
28495
28496 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28497
28498 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28499
28500 @smallexample
28501 -> (gdb)
28502 <- -gdb-exit
28503 <- ^exit
28504 @end smallexample
28505
28506 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28507 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28508 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28509 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28510 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28511 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28512
28513 @subheading A Bad Command
28514
28515 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28516
28517 @smallexample
28518 -> -rubbish
28519 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28520 <- (gdb)
28521 @end smallexample
28522
28523
28524 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28525 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28526 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28527
28528 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28529 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28530
28531 @subheading Motivation
28532
28533 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28534
28535 @subheading Introduction
28536
28537 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28538
28539 @subheading Commands
28540
28541 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28542
28543 @subsubheading Synopsis
28544
28545 @smallexample
28546 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28547 @end smallexample
28548
28549 @subsubheading Result
28550
28551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28552
28553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28554
28555 @subsubheading Example
28556
28557 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28558 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28559
28560
28561 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28562 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28563 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28564
28565 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28566 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28567 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28568 breakpoints.
28569
28570 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28571 @findex -break-after
28572
28573 @subsubheading Synopsis
28574
28575 @smallexample
28576 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28577 @end smallexample
28578
28579 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28580 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28581 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28582 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28583
28584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28585
28586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28587
28588 @subsubheading Example
28589
28590 @smallexample
28591 (gdb)
28592 -break-insert main
28593 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28594 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28595 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28596 times="0"@}
28597 (gdb)
28598 -break-after 1 3
28599 ~
28600 ^done
28601 (gdb)
28602 -break-list
28603 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28604 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28605 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28606 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28607 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28608 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28609 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28610 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28611 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28612 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28613 (gdb)
28614 @end smallexample
28615
28616 @ignore
28617 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28618 @findex -break-catch
28619 @end ignore
28620
28621 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28622 @findex -break-commands
28623
28624 @subsubheading Synopsis
28625
28626 @smallexample
28627 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28628 @end smallexample
28629
28630 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28631 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28632 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28633 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28634 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28635 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28636
28637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28638
28639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28640
28641 @subsubheading Example
28642
28643 @smallexample
28644 (gdb)
28645 -break-insert main
28646 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28647 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28648 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28649 times="0"@}
28650 (gdb)
28651 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28652 ^done
28653 (gdb)
28654 @end smallexample
28655
28656 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28657 @findex -break-condition
28658
28659 @subsubheading Synopsis
28660
28661 @smallexample
28662 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28663 @end smallexample
28664
28665 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28666 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28667 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28668 command below).
28669
28670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28671
28672 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28673
28674 @subsubheading Example
28675
28676 @smallexample
28677 (gdb)
28678 -break-condition 1 1
28679 ^done
28680 (gdb)
28681 -break-list
28682 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28683 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28684 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28685 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28686 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28687 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28688 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28689 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28690 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28691 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28692 (gdb)
28693 @end smallexample
28694
28695 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28696 @findex -break-delete
28697
28698 @subsubheading Synopsis
28699
28700 @smallexample
28701 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28702 @end smallexample
28703
28704 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28705 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28706
28707 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28708
28709 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28710
28711 @subsubheading Example
28712
28713 @smallexample
28714 (gdb)
28715 -break-delete 1
28716 ^done
28717 (gdb)
28718 -break-list
28719 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28720 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28721 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28722 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28723 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28724 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28725 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28726 body=[]@}
28727 (gdb)
28728 @end smallexample
28729
28730 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28731 @findex -break-disable
28732
28733 @subsubheading Synopsis
28734
28735 @smallexample
28736 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28737 @end smallexample
28738
28739 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28740 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28741
28742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28743
28744 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28745
28746 @subsubheading Example
28747
28748 @smallexample
28749 (gdb)
28750 -break-disable 2
28751 ^done
28752 (gdb)
28753 -break-list
28754 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28755 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28756 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28757 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28758 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28759 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28760 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28761 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28762 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28763 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28764 (gdb)
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28768 @findex -break-enable
28769
28770 @subsubheading Synopsis
28771
28772 @smallexample
28773 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28774 @end smallexample
28775
28776 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28777
28778 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28779
28780 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28781
28782 @subsubheading Example
28783
28784 @smallexample
28785 (gdb)
28786 -break-enable 2
28787 ^done
28788 (gdb)
28789 -break-list
28790 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28791 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28792 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28793 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28794 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28795 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28796 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28797 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28798 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28799 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28800 (gdb)
28801 @end smallexample
28802
28803 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28804 @findex -break-info
28805
28806 @subsubheading Synopsis
28807
28808 @smallexample
28809 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28810 @end smallexample
28811
28812 @c REDUNDANT???
28813 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28814
28815 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28816 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28817 table.
28818
28819 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28820
28821 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28822
28823 @subsubheading Example
28824 N.A.
28825
28826 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28827 @findex -break-insert
28828 @anchor{-break-insert}
28829
28830 @subsubheading Synopsis
28831
28832 @smallexample
28833 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28834 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28835 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28836 @end smallexample
28837
28838 @noindent
28839 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28840
28841 @table @var
28842 @item linespec location
28843 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28844
28845 @item explicit location
28846 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28847 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28848 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28849
28850 @table @samp
28851 @item --source @var{filename}
28852 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28853 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28854
28855 @item --function @var{function}
28856 The name of a function or method.
28857
28858 @item --label @var{label}
28859 The name of a label.
28860
28861 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28862 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28863 @end table
28864
28865 @item address location
28866 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28867 @end table
28868
28869 @noindent
28870 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28871
28872 @table @samp
28873 @item -t
28874 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28875 @item -h
28876 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28877 @item -f
28878 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28879 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28880 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28881 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28882 cannot be parsed.
28883 @item -d
28884 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28885 @item -a
28886 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28887 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28888 @item -c @var{condition}
28889 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28890 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28891 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28892 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28893 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28894 @var{thread-id}.
28895 @end table
28896
28897 @subsubheading Result
28898
28899 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28900 resulting breakpoint.
28901
28902 Note: this format is open to change.
28903 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28904
28905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28906
28907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28908 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28909
28910 @subsubheading Example
28911
28912 @smallexample
28913 (gdb)
28914 -break-insert main
28915 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28916 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28917 times="0"@}
28918 (gdb)
28919 -break-insert -t foo
28920 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28921 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28922 times="0"@}
28923 (gdb)
28924 -break-list
28925 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28926 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28927 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28928 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28929 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28930 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28931 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28932 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28933 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28934 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28935 times="0"@},
28936 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28937 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28938 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28939 times="0"@}]@}
28940 (gdb)
28941 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28942 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28943 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28944 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28945 @c times="0"@}
28946 @c (gdb)
28947 @end smallexample
28948
28949 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28950 @findex -dprintf-insert
28951
28952 @subsubheading Synopsis
28953
28954 @smallexample
28955 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28956 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28957 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28958 [ @var{argument} ]
28959 @end smallexample
28960
28961 @noindent
28962 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28963 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28964
28965 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28966
28967 @table @samp
28968 @item -t
28969 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28970 @item -f
28971 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28972 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28973 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28974 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28975 cannot be parsed.
28976 @item -d
28977 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28978 @item -c @var{condition}
28979 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28980 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28981 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28982 to @var{ignore-count}.
28983 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28984 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28985 @var{thread-id}.
28986 @end table
28987
28988 @subsubheading Result
28989
28990 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28991 resulting breakpoint.
28992
28993 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28994
28995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28996
28997 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28998
28999 @subsubheading Example
29000
29001 @smallexample
29002 (gdb)
29003 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29004 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29005 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29006 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29007 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29008 original-location="foo"@}
29009 (gdb)
29010 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29011 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29012 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29013 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29014 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29015 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29016 (gdb)
29017 @end smallexample
29018
29019 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29020 @findex -break-list
29021
29022 @subsubheading Synopsis
29023
29024 @smallexample
29025 -break-list
29026 @end smallexample
29027
29028 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29029
29030 @table @samp
29031 @item Number
29032 number of the breakpoint
29033 @item Type
29034 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29035 @item Disposition
29036 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29037 or @samp{nokeep}
29038 @item Enabled
29039 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29040 @item Address
29041 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29042 @item What
29043 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29044 name, line number
29045 @item Thread-groups
29046 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29047 @item Times
29048 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29049 @end table
29050
29051 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29052 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29053
29054 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29055
29056 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29057
29058 @subsubheading Example
29059
29060 @smallexample
29061 (gdb)
29062 -break-list
29063 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29064 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29065 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29066 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29067 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29068 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29069 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29070 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29071 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29072 times="0"@},
29073 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29074 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29075 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29076 (gdb)
29077 @end smallexample
29078
29079 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29080
29081 @smallexample
29082 (gdb)
29083 -break-list
29084 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29085 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29086 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29087 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29088 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29089 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29090 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29091 body=[]@}
29092 (gdb)
29093 @end smallexample
29094
29095 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29096 @findex -break-passcount
29097
29098 @subsubheading Synopsis
29099
29100 @smallexample
29101 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29102 @end smallexample
29103
29104 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29105 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29106 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29107 command @samp{passcount}.
29108
29109 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29110 @findex -break-watch
29111
29112 @subsubheading Synopsis
29113
29114 @smallexample
29115 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29116 @end smallexample
29117
29118 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29119 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29120 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29121 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29122 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29123 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29124 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29125 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29126
29127 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29128 breakpoints inserted.
29129
29130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29131
29132 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29133 @samp{rwatch}.
29134
29135 @subsubheading Example
29136
29137 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29138
29139 @smallexample
29140 (gdb)
29141 -break-watch x
29142 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29143 (gdb)
29144 -exec-continue
29145 ^running
29146 (gdb)
29147 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29148 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29149 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29150 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29151 (gdb)
29152 @end smallexample
29153
29154 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29155 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29156 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29157
29158 @smallexample
29159 (gdb)
29160 -break-watch C
29161 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29162 (gdb)
29163 -exec-continue
29164 ^running
29165 (gdb)
29166 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29167 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29168 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29169 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29170 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29171 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29172 (gdb)
29173 -exec-continue
29174 ^running
29175 (gdb)
29176 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29177 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29178 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29179 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29180 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29181 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29182 (gdb)
29183 @end smallexample
29184
29185 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29186 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29187 deleted.
29188
29189 @smallexample
29190 (gdb)
29191 -break-watch C
29192 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29193 (gdb)
29194 -break-list
29195 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29196 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29197 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29198 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29199 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29200 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29201 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29202 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29203 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29204 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29205 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29206 times="1"@},
29207 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29208 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29209 (gdb)
29210 -exec-continue
29211 ^running
29212 (gdb)
29213 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29214 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29215 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29216 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29217 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29218 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29219 (gdb)
29220 -break-list
29221 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29222 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29223 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29224 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29225 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29226 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29227 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29228 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29229 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29230 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29231 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29232 times="1"@},
29233 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29234 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29235 (gdb)
29236 -exec-continue
29237 ^running
29238 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29239 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29240 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29241 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29242 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29243 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29244 (gdb)
29245 -break-list
29246 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29247 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29248 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29249 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29250 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29251 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29252 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29253 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29254 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29255 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29256 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29257 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29258 (gdb)
29259 @end smallexample
29260
29261
29262 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29263 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29264 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29265
29266 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29267 catchpoints.
29268
29269 @menu
29270 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29271 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29272 @end menu
29273
29274 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29275 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29276
29277 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29278 @findex -catch-load
29279
29280 @subsubheading Synopsis
29281
29282 @smallexample
29283 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29284 @end smallexample
29285
29286 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29287 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29288 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29289 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29290 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29291
29292
29293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29294
29295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29296
29297 @subsubheading Example
29298
29299 @smallexample
29300 -catch-load -t foo.so
29301 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29302 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29303 (gdb)
29304 @end smallexample
29305
29306
29307 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29308 @findex -catch-unload
29309
29310 @subsubheading Synopsis
29311
29312 @smallexample
29313 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29314 @end smallexample
29315
29316 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29317 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29318 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29319 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29320 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29321
29322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29323
29324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29325
29326 @subsubheading Example
29327
29328 @smallexample
29329 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29330 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29331 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29332 (gdb)
29333 @end smallexample
29334
29335 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29336 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29337
29338 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29339 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29340
29341 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29342 @findex -catch-assert
29343
29344 @subsubheading Synopsis
29345
29346 @smallexample
29347 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29348 @end smallexample
29349
29350 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29351
29352 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29353
29354 @table @samp
29355 @item -c @var{condition}
29356 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29357 @item -d
29358 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29359 @item -t
29360 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29361 @end table
29362
29363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29364
29365 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29366
29367 @subsubheading Example
29368
29369 @smallexample
29370 -catch-assert
29371 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29372 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29373 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29374 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29375 (gdb)
29376 @end smallexample
29377
29378 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29379 @findex -catch-exception
29380
29381 @subsubheading Synopsis
29382
29383 @smallexample
29384 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29385 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29386 @end smallexample
29387
29388 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29389 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29390 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29391 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29392 catchpoints.
29393
29394 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29395
29396 @table @samp
29397 @item -c @var{condition}
29398 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29399 @item -d
29400 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29401 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29402 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29403 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29404 @item -t
29405 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29406 @item -u
29407 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29408 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29409 @end table
29410
29411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29412
29413 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29414 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29415
29416 @subsubheading Example
29417
29418 @smallexample
29419 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29420 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29421 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29422 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29423 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29424 (gdb)
29425 @end smallexample
29426
29427 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29428 @findex -catch-handlers
29429
29430 @subsubheading Synopsis
29431
29432 @smallexample
29433 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29434 [ -t ]
29435 @end smallexample
29436
29437 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29438 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29439 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29440 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29441 catchpoints.
29442
29443 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29444
29445 @table @samp
29446 @item -c @var{condition}
29447 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29448 @item -d
29449 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29450 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29451 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29452 @item -t
29453 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29454 @end table
29455
29456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29457
29458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29459
29460 @subsubheading Example
29461
29462 @smallexample
29463 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29464 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29465 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29466 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29467 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29468 (gdb)
29469 @end smallexample
29470
29471 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29472 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29473 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29474
29475 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29476 @findex -exec-arguments
29477
29478
29479 @subsubheading Synopsis
29480
29481 @smallexample
29482 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29483 @end smallexample
29484
29485 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29486 @samp{-exec-run}.
29487
29488 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29489
29490 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29491
29492 @subsubheading Example
29493
29494 @smallexample
29495 (gdb)
29496 -exec-arguments -v word
29497 ^done
29498 (gdb)
29499 @end smallexample
29500
29501
29502 @ignore
29503 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29504 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29505
29506 @subsubheading Synopsis
29507
29508 @smallexample
29509 -exec-show-arguments
29510 @end smallexample
29511
29512 Print the arguments of the program.
29513
29514 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29515
29516 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29517
29518 @subsubheading Example
29519 N.A.
29520 @end ignore
29521
29522
29523 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29524 @findex -environment-cd
29525
29526 @subsubheading Synopsis
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29533
29534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29535
29536 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29537
29538 @subsubheading Example
29539
29540 @smallexample
29541 (gdb)
29542 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29543 ^done
29544 (gdb)
29545 @end smallexample
29546
29547
29548 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29549 @findex -environment-directory
29550
29551 @subsubheading Synopsis
29552
29553 @smallexample
29554 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29555 @end smallexample
29556
29557 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29558 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29559 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29560 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29561 occurs as normal.
29562 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29563 multiple directories in a single command
29564 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29565 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29566 If blanks are needed as
29567 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29568 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29569 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29570 character must not be used
29571 in any directory name.
29572 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29573
29574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29575
29576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29577
29578 @subsubheading Example
29579
29580 @smallexample
29581 (gdb)
29582 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29583 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29584 (gdb)
29585 -environment-directory ""
29586 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29587 (gdb)
29588 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29589 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29590 (gdb)
29591 -environment-directory -r
29592 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29593 (gdb)
29594 @end smallexample
29595
29596
29597 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29598 @findex -environment-path
29599
29600 @subsubheading Synopsis
29601
29602 @smallexample
29603 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29604 @end smallexample
29605
29606 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29607 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29608 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29609 supplied in addition to the
29610 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29611 occurs as normal.
29612 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29613 multiple directories in a single command
29614 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29615 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29616 If blanks are needed as
29617 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29618 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29619 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29620 character must not be used
29621 in any directory name.
29622 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29623
29624
29625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29626
29627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29628
29629 @subsubheading Example
29630
29631 @smallexample
29632 (gdb)
29633 -environment-path
29634 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29635 (gdb)
29636 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29637 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29638 (gdb)
29639 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29640 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29641 (gdb)
29642 @end smallexample
29643
29644
29645 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29646 @findex -environment-pwd
29647
29648 @subsubheading Synopsis
29649
29650 @smallexample
29651 -environment-pwd
29652 @end smallexample
29653
29654 Show the current working directory.
29655
29656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29657
29658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29659
29660 @subsubheading Example
29661
29662 @smallexample
29663 (gdb)
29664 -environment-pwd
29665 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29666 (gdb)
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29670 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29671 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29672
29673
29674 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29675 @findex -thread-info
29676
29677 @subsubheading Synopsis
29678
29679 @smallexample
29680 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29681 @end smallexample
29682
29683 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29684 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29685 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29686 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29687 current thread.
29688
29689 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29690
29691 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29692 about all threads.
29693
29694 @subsubheading Result
29695
29696 The result contains the following attributes:
29697
29698 @table @samp
29699 @item threads
29700 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29701 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29702
29703 @item current-thread-id
29704 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29705 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29706 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29707 the command.
29708
29709 @end table
29710
29711 @subsubheading Example
29712
29713 @smallexample
29714 -thread-info
29715 ^done,threads=[
29716 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29717 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29718 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29719 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29720 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29721 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29722 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29723 state="running"@}],
29724 current-thread-id="1"
29725 (gdb)
29726 @end smallexample
29727
29728 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29729 @findex -thread-list-ids
29730
29731 @subsubheading Synopsis
29732
29733 @smallexample
29734 -thread-list-ids
29735 @end smallexample
29736
29737 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29738 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29739 threads.
29740
29741 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29742 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29743
29744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29745
29746 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29747
29748 @subsubheading Example
29749
29750 @smallexample
29751 (gdb)
29752 -thread-list-ids
29753 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29754 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29755 (gdb)
29756 @end smallexample
29757
29758
29759 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29760 @findex -thread-select
29761
29762 @subsubheading Synopsis
29763
29764 @smallexample
29765 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29766 @end smallexample
29767
29768 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29769 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29770 topmost frame for that thread.
29771
29772 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29773 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29774
29775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29776
29777 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29778
29779 @subsubheading Example
29780
29781 @smallexample
29782 (gdb)
29783 -exec-next
29784 ^running
29785 (gdb)
29786 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29787 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29788 (gdb)
29789 -thread-list-ids
29790 ^done,
29791 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29792 number-of-threads="3"
29793 (gdb)
29794 -thread-select 3
29795 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29796 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29797 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29798 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29799 (gdb)
29800 @end smallexample
29801
29802 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29803 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29804 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29805
29806 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29807 @findex -ada-task-info
29808
29809 @subsubheading Synopsis
29810
29811 @smallexample
29812 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29813 @end smallexample
29814
29815 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29816 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29817
29818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29819
29820 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29821 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29822
29823 @subsubheading Result
29824
29825 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29826 defined for each Ada task:
29827
29828 @table @samp
29829 @item current
29830 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29831
29832 @item id
29833 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29834
29835 @item task-id
29836 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29837
29838 @item thread-id
29839 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29840 task.
29841
29842 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29843 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29844 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29845
29846 @item parent-id
29847 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29848 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29849
29850 @item priority
29851 The base priority of the task.
29852
29853 @item state
29854 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29855 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29856
29857 @item name
29858 The name of the task.
29859
29860 @end table
29861
29862 @subsubheading Example
29863
29864 @smallexample
29865 -ada-task-info
29866 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29867 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29868 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29869 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29870 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29871 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29872 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29873 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29874 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29875 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29876 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29877 (gdb)
29878 @end smallexample
29879
29880 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29881 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29882 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29883
29884 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29885 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29886 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29887 other cases.
29888
29889 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29890 @findex -exec-continue
29891
29892 @subsubheading Synopsis
29893
29894 @smallexample
29895 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29896 @end smallexample
29897
29898 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29899 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29900 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29901 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29902 @itemize @bullet
29903 @item
29904 breakpoints or watchpoints
29905 @item
29906 signals or exceptions
29907 @item
29908 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29909 @item
29910 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29911 @end itemize
29912 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29913 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29914 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29915 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29916 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29917 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29918
29919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29920
29921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29922
29923 @subsubheading Example
29924
29925 @smallexample
29926 -exec-continue
29927 ^running
29928 (gdb)
29929 @@Hello world
29930 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29931 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29932 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29933 (gdb)
29934 @end smallexample
29935
29936
29937 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29938 @findex -exec-finish
29939
29940 @subsubheading Synopsis
29941
29942 @smallexample
29943 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29944 @end smallexample
29945
29946 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29947 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29948 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29949 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29950 function was called.
29951
29952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29953
29954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29955
29956 @subsubheading Example
29957
29958 Function returning @code{void}.
29959
29960 @smallexample
29961 -exec-finish
29962 ^running
29963 (gdb)
29964 @@hello from foo
29965 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29966 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29967 (gdb)
29968 @end smallexample
29969
29970 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29971 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29972 value itself.
29973
29974 @smallexample
29975 -exec-finish
29976 ^running
29977 (gdb)
29978 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29979 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29980 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29981 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29982 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29983 (gdb)
29984 @end smallexample
29985
29986
29987 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29988 @findex -exec-interrupt
29989
29990 @subsubheading Synopsis
29991
29992 @smallexample
29993 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29994 @end smallexample
29995
29996 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29997 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29998 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29999 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30000 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30001
30002 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30003 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30004 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30005 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30006
30007 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30008 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30009 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30010 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30011
30012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30013
30014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30015
30016 @subsubheading Example
30017
30018 @smallexample
30019 (gdb)
30020 111-exec-continue
30021 111^running
30022
30023 (gdb)
30024 222-exec-interrupt
30025 222^done
30026 (gdb)
30027 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30028 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30029 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30030 (gdb)
30031
30032 (gdb)
30033 -exec-interrupt
30034 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30035 (gdb)
30036 @end smallexample
30037
30038 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30039 @findex -exec-jump
30040
30041 @subsubheading Synopsis
30042
30043 @smallexample
30044 -exec-jump @var{location}
30045 @end smallexample
30046
30047 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30048 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30049 different forms of @var{location}.
30050
30051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30052
30053 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30054
30055 @subsubheading Example
30056
30057 @smallexample
30058 -exec-jump foo.c:10
30059 *running,thread-id="all"
30060 ^running
30061 @end smallexample
30062
30063
30064 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
30065 @findex -exec-next
30066
30067 @subsubheading Synopsis
30068
30069 @smallexample
30070 -exec-next [--reverse]
30071 @end smallexample
30072
30073 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30074 of the next source line is reached.
30075
30076 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30077 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
30078 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
30079 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
30080 source line where the function was called.
30081
30082
30083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30084
30085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
30086
30087 @subsubheading Example
30088
30089 @smallexample
30090 -exec-next
30091 ^running
30092 (gdb)
30093 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
30094 (gdb)
30095 @end smallexample
30096
30097
30098 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30099 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30100
30101 @subsubheading Synopsis
30102
30103 @smallexample
30104 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
30105 @end smallexample
30106
30107 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
30108 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
30109 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
30110 printed as well.
30111
30112 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30113 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
30114 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
30115 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
30116 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
30117
30118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30119
30120 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
30121
30122 @subsubheading Example
30123
30124 @smallexample
30125 (gdb)
30126 -exec-next-instruction
30127 ^running
30128
30129 (gdb)
30130 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30131 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
30132 (gdb)
30133 @end smallexample
30134
30135
30136 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
30137 @findex -exec-return
30138
30139 @subsubheading Synopsis
30140
30141 @smallexample
30142 -exec-return
30143 @end smallexample
30144
30145 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
30146 Displays the new current frame.
30147
30148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30149
30150 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
30151
30152 @subsubheading Example
30153
30154 @smallexample
30155 (gdb)
30156 200-break-insert callee4
30157 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
30158 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
30159 (gdb)
30160 000-exec-run
30161 000^running
30162 (gdb)
30163 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30164 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30165 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30166 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30167 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30168 (gdb)
30169 205-break-delete
30170 205^done
30171 (gdb)
30172 111-exec-return
30173 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
30174 args=[@{name="strarg",
30175 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30176 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30177 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30178 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30179 (gdb)
30180 @end smallexample
30181
30182
30183 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
30184 @findex -exec-run
30185
30186 @subsubheading Synopsis
30187
30188 @smallexample
30189 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
30190 @end smallexample
30191
30192 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
30193 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
30194 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
30195 the program has exited exceptionally.
30196
30197 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
30198 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
30199 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
30200 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
30201 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
30202
30203 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
30204 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
30205 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
30206 (@pxref{Starting}).
30207
30208 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30209
30210 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
30211
30212 @subsubheading Examples
30213
30214 @smallexample
30215 (gdb)
30216 -break-insert main
30217 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30218 (gdb)
30219 -exec-run
30220 ^running
30221 (gdb)
30222 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30223 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30224 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30225 (gdb)
30226 @end smallexample
30227
30228 @noindent
30229 Program exited normally:
30230
30231 @smallexample
30232 (gdb)
30233 -exec-run
30234 ^running
30235 (gdb)
30236 x = 55
30237 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30238 (gdb)
30239 @end smallexample
30240
30241 @noindent
30242 Program exited exceptionally:
30243
30244 @smallexample
30245 (gdb)
30246 -exec-run
30247 ^running
30248 (gdb)
30249 x = 55
30250 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
30251 (gdb)
30252 @end smallexample
30253
30254 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
30255 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
30256
30257 @smallexample
30258 (gdb)
30259 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
30260 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
30261 @end smallexample
30262
30263
30264 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30265
30266
30267 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30268 @findex -exec-step
30269
30270 @subsubheading Synopsis
30271
30272 @smallexample
30273 -exec-step [--reverse]
30274 @end smallexample
30275
30276 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30277 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30278 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30279 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30280 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30281 previously executed source line.
30282
30283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30284
30285 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30286
30287 @subsubheading Example
30288
30289 Stepping into a function:
30290
30291 @smallexample
30292 -exec-step
30293 ^running
30294 (gdb)
30295 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30296 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30297 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30298 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30299 (gdb)
30300 @end smallexample
30301
30302 Regular stepping:
30303
30304 @smallexample
30305 -exec-step
30306 ^running
30307 (gdb)
30308 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30309 (gdb)
30310 @end smallexample
30311
30312
30313 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30314 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30315
30316 @subsubheading Synopsis
30317
30318 @smallexample
30319 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30320 @end smallexample
30321
30322 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30323 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30324 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30325 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30326 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30327 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30328 as well.
30329
30330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30331
30332 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30333
30334 @subsubheading Example
30335
30336 @smallexample
30337 (gdb)
30338 -exec-step-instruction
30339 ^running
30340
30341 (gdb)
30342 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30343 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30344 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30345 (gdb)
30346 -exec-step-instruction
30347 ^running
30348
30349 (gdb)
30350 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30351 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30352 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30353 (gdb)
30354 @end smallexample
30355
30356
30357 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30358 @findex -exec-until
30359
30360 @subsubheading Synopsis
30361
30362 @smallexample
30363 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30364 @end smallexample
30365
30366 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30367 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30368 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30369 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30370
30371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30372
30373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30374
30375 @subsubheading Example
30376
30377 @smallexample
30378 (gdb)
30379 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30380 ^running
30381 (gdb)
30382 x = 55
30383 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30384 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30385 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30386 (gdb)
30387 @end smallexample
30388
30389 @ignore
30390 @subheading -file-clear
30391 Is this going away????
30392 @end ignore
30393
30394 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30395 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30396 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30397
30398 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30399 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30400
30401 @smallexample
30402 -enable-frame-filters
30403 @end smallexample
30404
30405 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30406 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30407 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30408 request that this functionality be enabled.
30409
30410 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30411
30412 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30413 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30414
30415 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30416 @findex -stack-info-frame
30417
30418 @subsubheading Synopsis
30419
30420 @smallexample
30421 -stack-info-frame
30422 @end smallexample
30423
30424 Get info on the selected frame.
30425
30426 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30427
30428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30429 (without arguments).
30430
30431 @subsubheading Example
30432
30433 @smallexample
30434 (gdb)
30435 -stack-info-frame
30436 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30437 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30438 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30439 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30440 (gdb)
30441 @end smallexample
30442
30443 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30444 @findex -stack-info-depth
30445
30446 @subsubheading Synopsis
30447
30448 @smallexample
30449 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30450 @end smallexample
30451
30452 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30453 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30454
30455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30456
30457 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30458
30459 @subsubheading Example
30460
30461 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30462
30463 @smallexample
30464 (gdb)
30465 -stack-info-depth
30466 ^done,depth="12"
30467 (gdb)
30468 -stack-info-depth 4
30469 ^done,depth="4"
30470 (gdb)
30471 -stack-info-depth 12
30472 ^done,depth="12"
30473 (gdb)
30474 -stack-info-depth 11
30475 ^done,depth="11"
30476 (gdb)
30477 -stack-info-depth 13
30478 ^done,depth="12"
30479 (gdb)
30480 @end smallexample
30481
30482 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30483 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30484 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30485
30486 @subsubheading Synopsis
30487
30488 @smallexample
30489 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30490 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30491 @end smallexample
30492
30493 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30494 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30495 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30496 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30497 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30498 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30499 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30500 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30501
30502 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30503 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30504 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30505 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30506 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30507 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30508
30509 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30510 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30511 are still displayed, however.
30512
30513 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30514 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30515
30516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30517
30518 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30519 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30520 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30521
30522 @subsubheading Example
30523
30524 @smallexample
30525 (gdb)
30526 -stack-list-frames
30527 ^done,
30528 stack=[
30529 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30530 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30531 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30532 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30533 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30534 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30535 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30536 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30537 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30538 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30539 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30540 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30541 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30542 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30543 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30544 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30545 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30546 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30547 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30548 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30549 (gdb)
30550 -stack-list-arguments 0
30551 ^done,
30552 stack-args=[
30553 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30554 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30555 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30556 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30557 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30558 (gdb)
30559 -stack-list-arguments 1
30560 ^done,
30561 stack-args=[
30562 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30563 frame=@{level="1",
30564 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30565 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30566 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30567 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30568 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30569 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30570 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30571 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30572 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30573 (gdb)
30574 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30575 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30576 (gdb)
30577 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30578 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30579 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30580 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30581 (gdb)
30582 @end smallexample
30583
30584 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30585
30586
30587 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30588 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30589 @findex -stack-list-frames
30590
30591 @subsubheading Synopsis
30592
30593 @smallexample
30594 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30595 @end smallexample
30596
30597 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30598 following info:
30599
30600 @table @samp
30601 @item @var{level}
30602 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30603 @item @var{addr}
30604 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30605 @item @var{func}
30606 Function name.
30607 @item @var{file}
30608 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30609 @item @var{fullname}
30610 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30611 @item @var{line}
30612 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30613 @item @var{from}
30614 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30615 if the frame's function is not known.
30616 @item @var{arch}
30617 Frame's architecture.
30618 @end table
30619
30620 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30621 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30622 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30623 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30624 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30625 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30626 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30627 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30628 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30629
30630 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30631
30632 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30633
30634 @subsubheading Example
30635
30636 Full stack backtrace:
30637
30638 @smallexample
30639 (gdb)
30640 -stack-list-frames
30641 ^done,stack=
30642 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30643 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30644 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30645 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30646 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30647 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30648 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30649 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30650 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30651 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30652 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30653 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30654 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30655 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30656 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30657 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30658 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30659 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30660 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30661 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30662 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30663 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30664 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30665 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30666 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30667 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30668 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30669 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30670 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30671 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30672 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30673 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30674 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30675 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30676 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30677 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30678 (gdb)
30679 @end smallexample
30680
30681 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30682
30683 @smallexample
30684 (gdb)
30685 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30686 ^done,stack=
30687 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30688 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30689 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30690 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30691 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30692 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30693 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30694 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30695 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30696 (gdb)
30697 @end smallexample
30698
30699 Show a single frame:
30700
30701 @smallexample
30702 (gdb)
30703 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30704 ^done,stack=
30705 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30706 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30707 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30708 (gdb)
30709 @end smallexample
30710
30711
30712 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30713 @findex -stack-list-locals
30714 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30715
30716 @subsubheading Synopsis
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30720 @end smallexample
30721
30722 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30723 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30724 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30725 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30726 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30727 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30728 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30729 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30730 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30731 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30732
30733 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30734 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30735 variables are still displayed, however.
30736
30737 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30738 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30739
30740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30741
30742 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30743
30744 @subsubheading Example
30745
30746 @smallexample
30747 (gdb)
30748 -stack-list-locals 0
30749 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30750 (gdb)
30751 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30752 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30753 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30754 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30755 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30756 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30757 (gdb)
30758 @end smallexample
30759
30760 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30761 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30762 @findex -stack-list-variables
30763
30764 @subsubheading Synopsis
30765
30766 @smallexample
30767 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30768 @end smallexample
30769
30770 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30771 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30772 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30773 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30774 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30775 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30776 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30777
30778 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30779 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30780 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30781
30782 @subsubheading Example
30783
30784 @smallexample
30785 (gdb)
30786 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30787 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30788 (gdb)
30789 @end smallexample
30790
30791
30792 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30793 @findex -stack-select-frame
30794
30795 @subsubheading Synopsis
30796
30797 @smallexample
30798 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30799 @end smallexample
30800
30801 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30802 the stack.
30803
30804 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30805 option to every command.
30806
30807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30808
30809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30810 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30811
30812 @subsubheading Example
30813
30814 @smallexample
30815 (gdb)
30816 -stack-select-frame 2
30817 ^done
30818 (gdb)
30819 @end smallexample
30820
30821 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30822 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30823 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30824
30825 @ignore
30826
30827 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30828
30829 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30830 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30831 used by @code{Insight}.
30832
30833 The two main reasons for that are:
30834
30835 @enumerate 1
30836 @item
30837 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30838
30839 @item
30840 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30841 now).
30842 @end enumerate
30843
30844 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30845 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30846 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30847 hints about their use.
30848
30849 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30850 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30851 least, the following operations:
30852
30853 @itemize @bullet
30854 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30855 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30856 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30857 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30858 @end itemize
30859
30860 @end ignore
30861
30862 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30863
30864 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30865
30866 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30867 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30868 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30869 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30870 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30871 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30872 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30873 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30874 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30875 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30876 object, or to change display format.
30877
30878 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30879 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30880 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30881 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30882 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30883 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30884 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30885 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30886 child will be created.
30887
30888 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30889 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30890 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30891 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30892 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30893
30894 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30895 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30896 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30897 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30898 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30899 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30900 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30901 variables that frontend has created.
30902
30903 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30904 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30905 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30906 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30907 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30908 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30909 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30910 implicitly updated.
30911
30912 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30913 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30914 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30915 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30916 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30917 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30918 frame. Consider this example:
30919
30920 @smallexample
30921 void do_work(...)
30922 @{
30923 struct work_state state;
30924
30925 if (...)
30926 do_work(...);
30927 @}
30928 @end smallexample
30929
30930 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30931 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30932 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30933 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30934 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30935
30936 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30937 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30938 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30939 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30940 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30941 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30942
30943 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30944 access this functionality:
30945
30946 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30947 @item @strong{Operation}
30948 @tab @strong{Description}
30949
30950 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30951 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30952 @item @code{-var-create}
30953 @tab create a variable object
30954 @item @code{-var-delete}
30955 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30956 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30957 @tab set the display format of this variable
30958 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30959 @tab show the display format of this variable
30960 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30961 @tab tells how many children this object has
30962 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30963 @tab return a list of the object's children
30964 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30965 @tab show the type of this variable object
30966 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30967 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30968 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30969 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30970 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30971 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30972 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30973 @tab get the value of this variable
30974 @item @code{-var-assign}
30975 @tab set the value of this variable
30976 @item @code{-var-update}
30977 @tab update the variable and its children
30978 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30979 @tab set frozeness attribute
30980 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30981 @tab set range of children to display on update
30982 @end multitable
30983
30984 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30985 how it can be used.
30986
30987 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30988
30989 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30990 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30991
30992 @smallexample
30993 -enable-pretty-printing
30994 @end smallexample
30995
30996 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30997 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30998 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30999 request that this functionality be enabled.
31000
31001 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31002
31003 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31004 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31005
31006 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31007 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31008
31009 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31010 @findex -var-create
31011
31012 @subsubheading Synopsis
31013
31014 @smallexample
31015 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31016 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31017 @end smallexample
31018
31019 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31020 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31021 register.
31022
31023 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31024 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31025 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31026 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31027 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31028
31029 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31030 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31031 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31032 object must be created.
31033
31034 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31035 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31036
31037 @itemize @bullet
31038 @item
31039 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31040
31041 @item
31042 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31043
31044 @item
31045 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31046 @end itemize
31047
31048 @cindex dynamic varobj
31049 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31050 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31051 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31052 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31053 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31054 compatibility for existing clients.
31055
31056 @subsubheading Result
31057
31058 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
31059 are:
31060
31061 @table @samp
31062 @item name
31063 The name of the varobj.
31064
31065 @item numchild
31066 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
31067 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
31068 @samp{has_more} attribute.
31069
31070 @item value
31071 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
31072 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
31073 will not be interesting.
31074
31075 @item type
31076 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
31077 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
31078 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31079 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31080 @emph{declared} one.
31081
31082 @item thread-id
31083 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
31084 thread's global identifier.
31085
31086 @item has_more
31087 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
31088 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
31089
31090 @item dynamic
31091 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31092 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31093 then this attribute will not be present.
31094
31095 @item displayhint
31096 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31097 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31098 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31099 @end table
31100
31101 Typical output will look like this:
31102
31103 @smallexample
31104 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
31105 has_more="@var{has_more}"
31106 @end smallexample
31107
31108
31109 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
31110 @findex -var-delete
31111
31112 @subsubheading Synopsis
31113
31114 @smallexample
31115 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
31116 @end smallexample
31117
31118 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
31119 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
31120
31121 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
31122
31123
31124 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
31125 @findex -var-set-format
31126
31127 @subsubheading Synopsis
31128
31129 @smallexample
31130 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
31131 @end smallexample
31132
31133 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
31134 @var{format-spec}.
31135
31136 @anchor{-var-set-format}
31137 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
31138
31139 @smallexample
31140 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
31141 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
31142 @end smallexample
31143
31144 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
31145 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
31146 for pointers, etc.).
31147
31148 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
31149 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
31150 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
31151 zero-hexadecimal format.
31152
31153 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
31154 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
31155
31156 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
31157 @findex -var-show-format
31158
31159 @subsubheading Synopsis
31160
31161 @smallexample
31162 -var-show-format @var{name}
31163 @end smallexample
31164
31165 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
31166
31167 @smallexample
31168 @var{format} @expansion{}
31169 @var{format-spec}
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172
31173 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
31174 @findex -var-info-num-children
31175
31176 @subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178 @smallexample
31179 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
31183
31184 @smallexample
31185 numchild=@var{n}
31186 @end smallexample
31187
31188 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
31189 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
31190 be available.
31191
31192
31193 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
31194 @findex -var-list-children
31195
31196 @subsubheading Synopsis
31197
31198 @smallexample
31199 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
31200 @end smallexample
31201 @anchor{-var-list-children}
31202
31203 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
31204 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
31205 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
31206 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
31207 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
31208 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
31209 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
31210 and unions.
31211
31212 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
31213 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31214 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31215 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31216 reported.
31217
31218 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31219 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31220 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31221 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31222 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31223 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31224 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31225 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31226 the visible items.
31227
31228 For each child the following results are returned:
31229
31230 @table @var
31231
31232 @item name
31233 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31234
31235 @item exp
31236 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31237 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31238
31239 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31240 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31241
31242 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31243 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31244 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31245 type and value are not present.
31246
31247 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31248 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31249 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31250
31251 @item numchild
31252 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31253 0.
31254
31255 @item type
31256 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31257 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31258 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31259 @emph{declared} one.
31260
31261 @item value
31262 If values were requested, this is the value.
31263
31264 @item thread-id
31265 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31266 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31267
31268 @item frozen
31269 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31270
31271 @item displayhint
31272 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31273 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31274 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31275
31276 @item dynamic
31277 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31278 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31279 then this attribute will not be present.
31280
31281 @end table
31282
31283 The result may have its own attributes:
31284
31285 @table @samp
31286 @item displayhint
31287 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31288 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31289 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31290
31291 @item has_more
31292 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31293 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31294 @end table
31295
31296 @subsubheading Example
31297
31298 @smallexample
31299 (gdb)
31300 -var-list-children n
31301 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31302 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31303 (gdb)
31304 -var-list-children --all-values n
31305 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31306 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31307 @end smallexample
31308
31309
31310 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31311 @findex -var-info-type
31312
31313 @subsubheading Synopsis
31314
31315 @smallexample
31316 -var-info-type @var{name}
31317 @end smallexample
31318
31319 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31320 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31321 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31322
31323 @smallexample
31324 type=@var{typename}
31325 @end smallexample
31326
31327
31328 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31329 @findex -var-info-expression
31330
31331 @subsubheading Synopsis
31332
31333 @smallexample
31334 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31335 @end smallexample
31336
31337 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31338 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31339 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31340
31341 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31342 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31343
31344 @smallexample
31345 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31346 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31347 @end smallexample
31348
31349 @noindent
31350 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31351 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31352
31353 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31354 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31355 is of limited use.
31356
31357 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31358 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31359
31360 @subsubheading Synopsis
31361
31362 @smallexample
31363 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31364 @end smallexample
31365
31366 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31367 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31368 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31369 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31370 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31371 watchpoint from a variable object.
31372
31373 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31374 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31375
31376 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31377 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31378 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31379 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31380 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31381 @smallexample
31382 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31383 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31384 @end smallexample
31385
31386 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31387 @findex -var-show-attributes
31388
31389 @subsubheading Synopsis
31390
31391 @smallexample
31392 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31393 @end smallexample
31394
31395 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31396
31397 @smallexample
31398 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31399 @end smallexample
31400
31401 @noindent
31402 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31403
31404 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31405 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31406
31407 @subsubheading Synopsis
31408
31409 @smallexample
31410 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31411 @end smallexample
31412
31413 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31414 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31415 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31416 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31417 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31418 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31419 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31420
31421 @smallexample
31422 value=@var{value}
31423 @end smallexample
31424
31425 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31426 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31427
31428 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31429 @findex -var-assign
31430
31431 @subsubheading Synopsis
31432
31433 @smallexample
31434 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31435 @end smallexample
31436
31437 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31438 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31439 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31440 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31441
31442 @subsubheading Example
31443
31444 @smallexample
31445 (gdb)
31446 -var-assign var1 3
31447 ^done,value="3"
31448 (gdb)
31449 -var-update *
31450 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31451 (gdb)
31452 @end smallexample
31453
31454 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31455 @findex -var-update
31456
31457 @subsubheading Synopsis
31458
31459 @smallexample
31460 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31461 @end smallexample
31462
31463 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31464 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31465 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31466 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31467 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31468 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31469 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31470 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31471 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31472 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31473 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31474 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31475 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31476
31477 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31478 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31479 diagnostic.
31480
31481 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31482 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31483
31484 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31485 @samp{changelist}.
31486
31487 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31488
31489 @table @samp
31490 @item name
31491 The name of the varobj.
31492
31493 @item value
31494 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31495 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31496
31497 @item in_scope
31498 @anchor{-var-update}
31499 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31500
31501 @table @code
31502 @item "true"
31503 The variable object's current value is valid.
31504
31505 @item "false"
31506 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31507 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31508 scope.
31509
31510 @item "invalid"
31511 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31512 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31513 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31514 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31515 objects.
31516 @end table
31517
31518 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31519 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31520
31521 @item type_changed
31522 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31523 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31524 be @samp{false}.
31525
31526 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31527 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31528 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31529 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31530 unset.
31531
31532 @item new_type
31533 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31534 hold the new type.
31535
31536 @item new_num_children
31537 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31538 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31539
31540 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31541 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31542 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31543 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31544 children which may be available.
31545
31546 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31547 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31548 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31549 only happen at the end of the update range).
31550
31551 @item displayhint
31552 The display hint, if any.
31553
31554 @item has_more
31555 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31556 available outside the varobj's update range.
31557
31558 @item dynamic
31559 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31560 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31561 then this attribute will not be present.
31562
31563 @item new_children
31564 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31565 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31566 be listed in this attribute.
31567 @end table
31568
31569 @subsubheading Example
31570
31571 @smallexample
31572 (gdb)
31573 -var-assign var1 3
31574 ^done,value="3"
31575 (gdb)
31576 -var-update --all-values var1
31577 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31578 type_changed="false"@}]
31579 (gdb)
31580 @end smallexample
31581
31582 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31583 @findex -var-set-frozen
31584 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31585
31586 @subsubheading Synopsis
31587
31588 @smallexample
31589 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31590 @end smallexample
31591
31592 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31593 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31594 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31595 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31596 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31597 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31598 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31599 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31600 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31601 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31602 @code{-var-update} does.
31603
31604 @subsubheading Example
31605
31606 @smallexample
31607 (gdb)
31608 -var-set-frozen V 1
31609 ^done
31610 (gdb)
31611 @end smallexample
31612
31613 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31614 @findex -var-set-update-range
31615 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31616
31617 @subsubheading Synopsis
31618
31619 @smallexample
31620 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31621 @end smallexample
31622
31623 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31624 @code{-var-update}.
31625
31626 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31627 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31628 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31629 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31630
31631 @subsubheading Example
31632
31633 @smallexample
31634 (gdb)
31635 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31636 ^done
31637 @end smallexample
31638
31639 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31640 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31641 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31642
31643 @subsubheading Synopsis
31644
31645 @smallexample
31646 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31647 @end smallexample
31648
31649 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31650
31651 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31652 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31653
31654 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31655 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31656 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31657 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31658 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31659 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31660 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31661
31662 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31663 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31664 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31665 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31666
31667 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31668 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31669 can be used to check this.
31670
31671 @subsubheading Example
31672
31673 Resetting the visualizer:
31674
31675 @smallexample
31676 (gdb)
31677 -var-set-visualizer V None
31678 ^done
31679 @end smallexample
31680
31681 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31682
31683 @smallexample
31684 (gdb)
31685 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31686 ^done
31687 @end smallexample
31688
31689 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31690 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31691
31692 @smallexample
31693 (gdb)
31694 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31695 ^done
31696 @end smallexample
31697
31698 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31699 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31700 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31701
31702 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31703 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31704 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31705 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31706
31707 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31708 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31709
31710 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31711 @c @subheading -data-assign
31712 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31713 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31714 @c set variable
31715 @c @subsubheading Example
31716 @c N.A.
31717
31718 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31719 @findex -data-disassemble
31720
31721 @subsubheading Synopsis
31722
31723 @smallexample
31724 -data-disassemble
31725 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31726 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31727 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31728 -- @var{mode}
31729 @end smallexample
31730
31731 @noindent
31732 Where:
31733
31734 @table @samp
31735 @item @var{start-addr}
31736 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31737 @item @var{end-addr}
31738 is the end address
31739 @item @var{addr}
31740 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31741 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31742 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31743 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31744 @item @var{filename}
31745 is the name of the file to disassemble
31746 @item @var{linenum}
31747 is the line number to disassemble around
31748 @item @var{lines}
31749 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31750 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31751 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31752 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31753 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31754 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31755 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31756 are displayed.
31757 @item @var{mode}
31758 is one of:
31759 @itemize @bullet
31760 @item 0 disassembly only
31761 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31762 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31763 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31764 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31765 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31766 @end itemize
31767
31768 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31769 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31770 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31771 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31772 @end table
31773
31774 @subsubheading Result
31775
31776 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31777 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31778 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31779
31780 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31781 following fields:
31782
31783 @table @code
31784 @item address
31785 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31786
31787 @item func-name
31788 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31789
31790 @item offset
31791 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31792
31793 @item inst
31794 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31795
31796 @item opcodes
31797 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31798 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31799
31800 @end table
31801
31802 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31803 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31804
31805 @table @code
31806 @item line
31807 The line number within @samp{file}.
31808
31809 @item file
31810 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31811 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31812 used.
31813
31814 @item fullname
31815 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31816 using the source file search path
31817 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31818 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31819
31820 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31821 present in the debug information.
31822
31823 @item line_asm_insn
31824 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31825 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31826 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31827 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31828 @samp{opcodes}.
31829
31830 @end table
31831
31832 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31833 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31834 adjust its format.
31835
31836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31837
31838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31839
31840 @subsubheading Example
31841
31842 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31843
31844 @smallexample
31845 (gdb)
31846 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31847 ^done,
31848 asm_insns=[
31849 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31850 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31851 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31852 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31853 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31854 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31855 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31856 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31857 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31858 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31859 (gdb)
31860 @end smallexample
31861
31862 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31863 @code{main}.
31864
31865 @smallexample
31866 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31867 ^done,asm_insns=[
31868 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31869 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31870 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31871 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31872 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31873 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31874 [@dots{}]
31875 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31876 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31877 (gdb)
31878 @end smallexample
31879
31880 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31881
31882 @smallexample
31883 (gdb)
31884 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31885 ^done,asm_insns=[
31886 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31887 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31888 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31889 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31890 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31891 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31892 (gdb)
31893 @end smallexample
31894
31895 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31896
31897 @smallexample
31898 (gdb)
31899 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31900 ^done,asm_insns=[
31901 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31902 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31903 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31904 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31905 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31906 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31907 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31908 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31909 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31910 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31911 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31912 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31913 (gdb)
31914 @end smallexample
31915
31916
31917 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31918 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31919
31920 @subsubheading Synopsis
31921
31922 @smallexample
31923 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31924 @end smallexample
31925
31926 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31927 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31928 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31929
31930 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31931
31932 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31933 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31934 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31935
31936 @subsubheading Example
31937
31938 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31939 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31940 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31941 output.
31942
31943 @smallexample
31944 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31945 211^done,value="1"
31946 (gdb)
31947 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31948 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31949 (gdb)
31950 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31951 411^done,value="4"
31952 (gdb)
31953 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31954 511^done,value="4"
31955 (gdb)
31956 @end smallexample
31957
31958
31959 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31960 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31961
31962 @subsubheading Synopsis
31963
31964 @smallexample
31965 -data-list-changed-registers
31966 @end smallexample
31967
31968 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31969
31970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31971
31972 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31973 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31974
31975 @subsubheading Example
31976
31977 On a PPC MBX board:
31978
31979 @smallexample
31980 (gdb)
31981 -exec-continue
31982 ^running
31983
31984 (gdb)
31985 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31986 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31987 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31988 (gdb)
31989 -data-list-changed-registers
31990 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31991 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31992 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31993 (gdb)
31994 @end smallexample
31995
31996
31997 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31998 @findex -data-list-register-names
31999
32000 @subsubheading Synopsis
32001
32002 @smallexample
32003 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32004 @end smallexample
32005
32006 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32007 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32008 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32009 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32010 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32011 include empty register names.
32012
32013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32014
32015 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32016 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32017 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32018
32019 @subsubheading Example
32020
32021 For the PPC MBX board:
32022 @smallexample
32023 (gdb)
32024 -data-list-register-names
32025 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32026 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32027 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32028 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32029 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32030 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32031 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32032 (gdb)
32033 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32034 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32035 (gdb)
32036 @end smallexample
32037
32038 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32039 @findex -data-list-register-values
32040
32041 @subsubheading Synopsis
32042
32043 @smallexample
32044 -data-list-register-values
32045 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32046 @end smallexample
32047
32048 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
32049 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
32050 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
32051 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
32052 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
32053 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
32054
32055 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32056
32057 @table @code
32058 @item x
32059 Hexadecimal
32060 @item o
32061 Octal
32062 @item t
32063 Binary
32064 @item d
32065 Decimal
32066 @item r
32067 Raw
32068 @item N
32069 Natural
32070 @end table
32071
32072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32073
32074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
32075 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
32076
32077 @subsubheading Example
32078
32079 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
32080 don't appear in the actual output):
32081
32082 @smallexample
32083 (gdb)
32084 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
32085 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32086 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
32087 (gdb)
32088 -data-list-register-values x
32089 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
32090 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32091 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
32092 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
32093 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
32094 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
32095 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
32096 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32097 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32098 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32099 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32100 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32101 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32102 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
32103 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
32104 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
32105 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
32106 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
32107 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
32108 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
32109 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
32110 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
32111 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
32112 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
32113 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
32114 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
32115 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
32116 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
32117 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
32118 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
32119 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
32120 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
32121 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32122 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
32123 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
32124 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
32125 (gdb)
32126 @end smallexample
32127
32128
32129 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
32130 @findex -data-read-memory
32131
32132 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
32133
32134 @subsubheading Synopsis
32135
32136 @smallexample
32137 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32138 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
32139 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
32140 @end smallexample
32141
32142 @noindent
32143 where:
32144
32145 @table @samp
32146 @item @var{address}
32147 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
32148 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32149 quoted using the C convention.
32150
32151 @item @var{word-format}
32152 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
32153 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
32154 ,Output Formats}).
32155
32156 @item @var{word-size}
32157 The size of each memory word in bytes.
32158
32159 @item @var{nr-rows}
32160 The number of rows in the output table.
32161
32162 @item @var{nr-cols}
32163 The number of columns in the output table.
32164
32165 @item @var{aschar}
32166 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
32167 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
32168 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
32169 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
32170
32171 @item @var{byte-offset}
32172 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
32173 @end table
32174
32175 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
32176 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
32177 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
32178 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
32179 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
32180 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
32181 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
32182 @samp{addr}.
32183
32184 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
32185 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
32186 @samp{prev-page}.
32187
32188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32189
32190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
32191 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
32192
32193 @subsubheading Example
32194
32195 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
32196 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
32197 word. Display each word in hex.
32198
32199 @smallexample
32200 (gdb)
32201 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
32202 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
32203 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
32204 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
32205 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
32206 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
32207 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
32208 (gdb)
32209 @end smallexample
32210
32211 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
32212 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
32213
32214 @smallexample
32215 (gdb)
32216 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32217 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32218 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32219 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32220 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32221 (gdb)
32222 @end smallexample
32223
32224 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32225 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32226 used as the non-printable character.
32227
32228 @smallexample
32229 (gdb)
32230 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32231 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32232 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32233 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32234 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32235 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32236 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32237 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32238 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32239 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32240 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32241 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32242 (gdb)
32243 @end smallexample
32244
32245 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32246 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32247
32248 @subsubheading Synopsis
32249
32250 @smallexample
32251 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
32252 @var{address} @var{count}
32253 @end smallexample
32254
32255 @noindent
32256 where:
32257
32258 @table @samp
32259 @item @var{address}
32260 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32261 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32262 quoted using the C convention.
32263
32264 @item @var{count}
32265 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32266 literal.
32267
32268 @item @var{offset}
32269 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32270 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32271 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32272 arithmetics itself.
32273
32274 @end table
32275
32276 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32277 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32278 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32279 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32280 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32281 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32282
32283 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32284 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32285 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32286 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32287 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32288 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32289 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32290 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32291
32292 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32293 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32294 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32295 and has the following fields:
32296
32297 @table @code
32298 @item begin
32299 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32300
32301 @item end
32302 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32303
32304 @item offset
32305 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32306 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32307
32308 @item contents
32309 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32310
32311 @end table
32312
32313
32314
32315 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32316
32317 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32318
32319 @subsubheading Example
32320
32321 @smallexample
32322 (gdb)
32323 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32324 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32325 end="0xbffff15e",
32326 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32327 (gdb)
32328 @end smallexample
32329
32330
32331 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32332 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32333
32334 @subsubheading Synopsis
32335
32336 @smallexample
32337 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32338 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32339 @end smallexample
32340
32341 @noindent
32342 where:
32343
32344 @table @samp
32345 @item @var{address}
32346 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32347 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32348 be quoted using the C convention.
32349
32350 @item @var{contents}
32351 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32352 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32353
32354 @item @var{count}
32355 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32356 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32357 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32358 @var{count} memory units.
32359
32360 @end table
32361
32362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32363
32364 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32365
32366 @subsubheading Example
32367
32368 @smallexample
32369 (gdb)
32370 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32371 ^done
32372 (gdb)
32373 @end smallexample
32374
32375 @smallexample
32376 (gdb)
32377 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32378 ^done
32379 (gdb)
32380 @end smallexample
32381
32382 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32383 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32384 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32385
32386 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32387 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32388
32389 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32390 @findex -trace-find
32391
32392 @subsubheading Synopsis
32393
32394 @smallexample
32395 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32396 @end smallexample
32397
32398 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32399 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32400 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32401
32402 @table @samp
32403
32404 @item none
32405 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32406
32407 @item frame-number
32408 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32409 that index.
32410
32411 @item tracepoint-number
32412 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32413 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32414
32415 @item pc
32416 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32417 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32418 address.
32419
32420 @item pc-inside-range
32421 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32422 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32423 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32424
32425 @item pc-outside-range
32426 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32427 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32428 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32429
32430 @item line
32431 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32432 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32433 the specified location.
32434
32435 @end table
32436
32437 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32438 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32439
32440 @table @samp
32441 @item found
32442 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32443 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32444
32445 @item traceframe
32446 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32447 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32448
32449 @item tracepoint
32450 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32451 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32452
32453 @item frame
32454 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32455 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32456 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32457
32458 @end table
32459
32460 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32461
32462 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32463
32464 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32465 @findex -trace-define-variable
32466
32467 @subsubheading Synopsis
32468
32469 @smallexample
32470 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32471 @end smallexample
32472
32473 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32474 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32475 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32476 with the @samp{$} character.
32477
32478 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32479
32480 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32481
32482 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32483 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32484
32485 @subsubheading Synopsis
32486
32487 @smallexample
32488 -trace-frame-collected
32489 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32490 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32491 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32492 [--memory-contents]
32493 @end smallexample
32494
32495 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32496 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32497 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32498 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32499 See the output description table below for more details.
32500
32501 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32502 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32503 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32504 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32505 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32506
32507 For instance, if the actions were
32508 @smallexample
32509 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32510 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32511 @end smallexample
32512
32513 @noindent
32514 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32515 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32516 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32517 objects would be computed expressions.
32518
32519 An example output would be:
32520
32521 @smallexample
32522 (gdb)
32523 -trace-frame-collected
32524 ^done,
32525 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32526 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32527 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32528 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32529 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32530 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32531 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32532 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32533 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32534 ...
32535 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32536 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32537 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32538 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32539 (gdb)
32540 @end smallexample
32541
32542 Where:
32543
32544 @table @code
32545 @item explicit-variables
32546 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32547 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32548 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32549 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32550 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32551 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32552 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32553 arrays, structures and unions.
32554
32555 @item computed-expressions
32556 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32557 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32558 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32559 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32560
32561 @item registers
32562 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32563 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32564 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32565 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32566 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32567
32568 @item tvars
32569 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32570 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32571 current value are returned.
32572
32573 @item memory
32574 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32575 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32576 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32577
32578 @table @code
32579 @item address
32580 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32581
32582 @item length
32583 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32584
32585 @item contents
32586 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32587 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32588
32589 @end table
32590
32591 @end table
32592
32593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32594
32595 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32596
32597 @subsubheading Example
32598
32599 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32600 @findex -trace-list-variables
32601
32602 @subsubheading Synopsis
32603
32604 @smallexample
32605 -trace-list-variables
32606 @end smallexample
32607
32608 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32609 table has the following fields:
32610
32611 @table @samp
32612 @item name
32613 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32614
32615 @item initial
32616 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32617 field is always present.
32618
32619 @item current
32620 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32621 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32622 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32623 presently running.
32624
32625 @end table
32626
32627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32628
32629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32630
32631 @subsubheading Example
32632
32633 @smallexample
32634 (gdb)
32635 -trace-list-variables
32636 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32637 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32638 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32639 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32640 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32641 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32642 (gdb)
32643 @end smallexample
32644
32645 @subheading -trace-save
32646 @findex -trace-save
32647
32648 @subsubheading Synopsis
32649
32650 @smallexample
32651 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32652 @end smallexample
32653
32654 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32655 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32656 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32657 to perform the save.
32658
32659 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32660 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32661 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32662
32663 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32664
32665 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32666
32667
32668 @subheading -trace-start
32669 @findex -trace-start
32670
32671 @subsubheading Synopsis
32672
32673 @smallexample
32674 -trace-start
32675 @end smallexample
32676
32677 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32678 have any fields.
32679
32680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32681
32682 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32683
32684 @subheading -trace-status
32685 @findex -trace-status
32686
32687 @subsubheading Synopsis
32688
32689 @smallexample
32690 -trace-status
32691 @end smallexample
32692
32693 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32694 the following fields:
32695
32696 @table @samp
32697
32698 @item supported
32699 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32700 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32701 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32702 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32703 started. This field is always present.
32704
32705 @item running
32706 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32707 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32708 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32709
32710 @item stop-reason
32711 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32712 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32713 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32714 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32715 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32716 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32717 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32718 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32719 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32720
32721 @item stopping-tracepoint
32722 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32723 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32724 @samp{passcount}.
32725
32726 @item frames
32727 @itemx frames-created
32728 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32729 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32730 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32731 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32732
32733 @item buffer-size
32734 @itemx buffer-free
32735 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32736 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32737
32738 @item circular
32739 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32740 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32741 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32742 and may fill up.
32743
32744 @item disconnected
32745 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32746 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32747 that the trace run will stop.
32748
32749 @item trace-file
32750 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32751 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32752
32753 @end table
32754
32755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32756
32757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32758
32759 @subheading -trace-stop
32760 @findex -trace-stop
32761
32762 @subsubheading Synopsis
32763
32764 @smallexample
32765 -trace-stop
32766 @end smallexample
32767
32768 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32769 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32770 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32771
32772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32773
32774 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32775
32776
32777 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32778 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32779 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32780
32781
32782 @ignore
32783 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32784 @findex -symbol-info-address
32785
32786 @subsubheading Synopsis
32787
32788 @smallexample
32789 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32790 @end smallexample
32791
32792 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32793
32794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32795
32796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32797
32798 @subsubheading Example
32799 N.A.
32800
32801
32802 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32803 @findex -symbol-info-file
32804
32805 @subsubheading Synopsis
32806
32807 @smallexample
32808 -symbol-info-file
32809 @end smallexample
32810
32811 Show the file for the symbol.
32812
32813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32814
32815 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32816 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32817
32818 @subsubheading Example
32819 N.A.
32820
32821
32822 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32823 @findex -symbol-info-function
32824
32825 @subsubheading Synopsis
32826
32827 @smallexample
32828 -symbol-info-function
32829 @end smallexample
32830
32831 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32832
32833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32834
32835 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32836
32837 @subsubheading Example
32838 N.A.
32839
32840
32841 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32842 @findex -symbol-info-line
32843
32844 @subsubheading Synopsis
32845
32846 @smallexample
32847 -symbol-info-line
32848 @end smallexample
32849
32850 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32851
32852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32853
32854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32855 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32856
32857 @subsubheading Example
32858 N.A.
32859
32860
32861 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32862 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32863
32864 @subsubheading Synopsis
32865
32866 @smallexample
32867 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32868 @end smallexample
32869
32870 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32871
32872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32873
32874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32875
32876 @subsubheading Example
32877 N.A.
32878
32879
32880 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32881 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32882
32883 @subsubheading Synopsis
32884
32885 @smallexample
32886 -symbol-list-functions
32887 @end smallexample
32888
32889 List the functions in the executable.
32890
32891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32892
32893 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32894 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32895
32896 @subsubheading Example
32897 N.A.
32898 @end ignore
32899
32900
32901 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32902 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32903
32904 @subsubheading Synopsis
32905
32906 @smallexample
32907 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32908 @end smallexample
32909
32910 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32911 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32912 ascending PC order.
32913
32914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32915
32916 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32917
32918 @subsubheading Example
32919 @smallexample
32920 (gdb)
32921 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32922 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32923 (gdb)
32924 @end smallexample
32925
32926
32927 @ignore
32928 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32929 @findex -symbol-list-types
32930
32931 @subsubheading Synopsis
32932
32933 @smallexample
32934 -symbol-list-types
32935 @end smallexample
32936
32937 List all the type names.
32938
32939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32940
32941 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32942 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32943
32944 @subsubheading Example
32945 N.A.
32946
32947
32948 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32949 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32950
32951 @subsubheading Synopsis
32952
32953 @smallexample
32954 -symbol-list-variables
32955 @end smallexample
32956
32957 List all the global and static variable names.
32958
32959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32960
32961 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32962
32963 @subsubheading Example
32964 N.A.
32965
32966
32967 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32968 @findex -symbol-locate
32969
32970 @subsubheading Synopsis
32971
32972 @smallexample
32973 -symbol-locate
32974 @end smallexample
32975
32976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32977
32978 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32979
32980 @subsubheading Example
32981 N.A.
32982
32983
32984 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32985 @findex -symbol-type
32986
32987 @subsubheading Synopsis
32988
32989 @smallexample
32990 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32991 @end smallexample
32992
32993 Show type of @var{variable}.
32994
32995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32996
32997 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32998 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32999
33000 @subsubheading Example
33001 N.A.
33002 @end ignore
33003
33004
33005 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33006 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33007 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33008
33009 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33010 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33011
33012 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33013 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33014
33015 @subsubheading Synopsis
33016
33017 @smallexample
33018 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33019 @end smallexample
33020
33021 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33022 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33023 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33024 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33025 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33026 notification.
33027
33028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33029
33030 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33031
33032 @subsubheading Example
33033
33034 @smallexample
33035 (gdb)
33036 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33037 ^done
33038 (gdb)
33039 @end smallexample
33040
33041
33042 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33043 @findex -file-exec-file
33044
33045 @subsubheading Synopsis
33046
33047 @smallexample
33048 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33049 @end smallexample
33050
33051 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33052 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33053 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33054 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33055 notification.
33056
33057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33058
33059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
33060
33061 @subsubheading Example
33062
33063 @smallexample
33064 (gdb)
33065 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33066 ^done
33067 (gdb)
33068 @end smallexample
33069
33070
33071 @ignore
33072 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
33073 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
33074
33075 @subsubheading Synopsis
33076
33077 @smallexample
33078 -file-list-exec-sections
33079 @end smallexample
33080
33081 List the sections of the current executable file.
33082
33083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33084
33085 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
33086 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
33087 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
33088
33089 @subsubheading Example
33090 N.A.
33091 @end ignore
33092
33093
33094 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
33095 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
33096
33097 @subsubheading Synopsis
33098
33099 @smallexample
33100 -file-list-exec-source-file
33101 @end smallexample
33102
33103 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
33104 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
33105 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
33106 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
33107
33108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33109
33110 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
33111
33112 @subsubheading Example
33113
33114 @smallexample
33115 (gdb)
33116 123-file-list-exec-source-file
33117 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
33118 (gdb)
33119 @end smallexample
33120
33121
33122 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
33123 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
33124
33125 @subsubheading Synopsis
33126
33127 @smallexample
33128 -file-list-exec-source-files
33129 @end smallexample
33130
33131 List the source files for the current executable.
33132
33133 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
33134 name) of a source file.
33135
33136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33137
33138 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
33139 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
33140
33141 @subsubheading Example
33142 @smallexample
33143 (gdb)
33144 -file-list-exec-source-files
33145 ^done,files=[
33146 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
33147 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
33148 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
33149 (gdb)
33150 @end smallexample
33151
33152 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
33153 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
33154
33155 @subsubheading Synopsis
33156
33157 @smallexample
33158 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
33159 @end smallexample
33160
33161 List the shared libraries in the program.
33162 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
33163 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33164
33165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33166
33167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
33168 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
33169 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
33170 library. Each range has the following fields:
33171
33172 @table @samp
33173 @item from
33174 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
33175 @item to
33176 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
33177 @end table
33178
33179 @subsubheading Example
33180 @smallexample
33181 (gdb)
33182 -file-list-exec-source-files
33183 ^done,shared-libraries=[
33184 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
33185 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
33186 (gdb)
33187 @end smallexample
33188
33189
33190 @ignore
33191 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
33192 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
33193
33194 @subsubheading Synopsis
33195
33196 @smallexample
33197 -file-list-symbol-files
33198 @end smallexample
33199
33200 List symbol files.
33201
33202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33203
33204 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
33205
33206 @subsubheading Example
33207 N.A.
33208 @end ignore
33209
33210
33211 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
33212 @findex -file-symbol-file
33213
33214 @subsubheading Synopsis
33215
33216 @smallexample
33217 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33218 @end smallexample
33219
33220 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33221 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33222 produced, except for a completion notification.
33223
33224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33225
33226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33227
33228 @subsubheading Example
33229
33230 @smallexample
33231 (gdb)
33232 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33233 ^done
33234 (gdb)
33235 @end smallexample
33236
33237 @ignore
33238 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33239 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33240 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33241
33242 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33243
33244 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33245
33246 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33247
33248 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33249
33250 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33251
33252 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33253
33254 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33255
33256 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33257
33258 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33259 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33260 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33261
33262 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33263
33264 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33265
33266 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33267
33268 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33269 @end ignore
33270
33271
33272 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33273 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33274 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33275
33276
33277 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33278 @findex -target-attach
33279
33280 @subsubheading Synopsis
33281
33282 @smallexample
33283 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33284 @end smallexample
33285
33286 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33287 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33288 group, the id previously returned by
33289 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33290
33291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33292
33293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33294
33295 @subsubheading Example
33296 @smallexample
33297 (gdb)
33298 -target-attach 34
33299 =thread-created,id="1"
33300 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33301 ^done
33302 (gdb)
33303 @end smallexample
33304
33305 @ignore
33306 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33307 @findex -target-compare-sections
33308
33309 @subsubheading Synopsis
33310
33311 @smallexample
33312 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33313 @end smallexample
33314
33315 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33316 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33317
33318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33319
33320 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33321
33322 @subsubheading Example
33323 N.A.
33324 @end ignore
33325
33326
33327 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33328 @findex -target-detach
33329
33330 @subsubheading Synopsis
33331
33332 @smallexample
33333 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33334 @end smallexample
33335
33336 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33337 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33338 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33339
33340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33341
33342 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33343
33344 @subsubheading Example
33345
33346 @smallexample
33347 (gdb)
33348 -target-detach
33349 ^done
33350 (gdb)
33351 @end smallexample
33352
33353
33354 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33355 @findex -target-disconnect
33356
33357 @subsubheading Synopsis
33358
33359 @smallexample
33360 -target-disconnect
33361 @end smallexample
33362
33363 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33364 generally not resumed.
33365
33366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33367
33368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33369
33370 @subsubheading Example
33371
33372 @smallexample
33373 (gdb)
33374 -target-disconnect
33375 ^done
33376 (gdb)
33377 @end smallexample
33378
33379
33380 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33381 @findex -target-download
33382
33383 @subsubheading Synopsis
33384
33385 @smallexample
33386 -target-download
33387 @end smallexample
33388
33389 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33390 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33391
33392 @table @samp
33393 @item section
33394 The name of the section.
33395 @item section-sent
33396 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33397 @item section-size
33398 The size of the section.
33399 @item total-sent
33400 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33401 @item total-size
33402 The size of the overall executable to download.
33403 @end table
33404
33405 @noindent
33406 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33407 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33408
33409 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33410 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33411
33412 @table @samp
33413 @item section
33414 The name of the section.
33415 @item section-size
33416 The size of the section.
33417 @item total-size
33418 The size of the overall executable to download.
33419 @end table
33420
33421 @noindent
33422 At the end, a summary is printed.
33423
33424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33425
33426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33427
33428 @subsubheading Example
33429
33430 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33431 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33432
33433 @smallexample
33434 (gdb)
33435 -target-download
33436 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33437 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33438 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33439 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33440 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33441 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33442 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33443 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33444 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33445 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33446 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33447 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33448 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33449 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33450 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33451 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33452 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33453 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33454 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33455 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33456 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33457 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33458 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33459 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33460 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33461 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33462 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33463 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33464 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33465 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33466 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33467 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33468 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33469 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33470 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33471 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33472 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33473 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33474 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33475 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33476 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33477 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33478 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33479 write-rate="429"
33480 (gdb)
33481 @end smallexample
33482
33483
33484 @ignore
33485 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33486 @findex -target-exec-status
33487
33488 @subsubheading Synopsis
33489
33490 @smallexample
33491 -target-exec-status
33492 @end smallexample
33493
33494 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33495 not, for instance).
33496
33497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33498
33499 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33500
33501 @subsubheading Example
33502 N.A.
33503
33504
33505 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33506 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33507
33508 @subsubheading Synopsis
33509
33510 @smallexample
33511 -target-list-available-targets
33512 @end smallexample
33513
33514 List the possible targets to connect to.
33515
33516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33517
33518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33519
33520 @subsubheading Example
33521 N.A.
33522
33523
33524 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33525 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33526
33527 @subsubheading Synopsis
33528
33529 @smallexample
33530 -target-list-current-targets
33531 @end smallexample
33532
33533 Describe the current target.
33534
33535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33536
33537 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33538 other things).
33539
33540 @subsubheading Example
33541 N.A.
33542
33543
33544 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33545 @findex -target-list-parameters
33546
33547 @subsubheading Synopsis
33548
33549 @smallexample
33550 -target-list-parameters
33551 @end smallexample
33552
33553 @c ????
33554 @end ignore
33555
33556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33557
33558 No equivalent.
33559
33560 @subsubheading Example
33561 N.A.
33562
33563 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33564 @findex -target-flash-erase
33565
33566 @subsubheading Synopsis
33567
33568 @smallexample
33569 -target-flash-erase
33570 @end smallexample
33571
33572 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33573
33574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33575
33576 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33577 addresses and memory region sizes.
33578
33579 @smallexample
33580 (gdb)
33581 -target-flash-erase
33582 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33583 (gdb)
33584 @end smallexample
33585
33586 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33587 @findex -target-select
33588
33589 @subsubheading Synopsis
33590
33591 @smallexample
33592 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33593 @end smallexample
33594
33595 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33596
33597 @table @samp
33598 @item @var{type}
33599 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33600 @item @var{parameters}
33601 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33602 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33603 @end table
33604
33605 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33606 which the target program is, in the following form:
33607
33608 @smallexample
33609 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33610 args=[@var{arg list}]
33611 @end smallexample
33612
33613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33614
33615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33616
33617 @subsubheading Example
33618
33619 @smallexample
33620 (gdb)
33621 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33622 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33623 (gdb)
33624 @end smallexample
33625
33626 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33627 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33628 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33629
33630
33631 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33632 @findex -target-file-put
33633
33634 @subsubheading Synopsis
33635
33636 @smallexample
33637 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33638 @end smallexample
33639
33640 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33641 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33642
33643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33644
33645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33646
33647 @subsubheading Example
33648
33649 @smallexample
33650 (gdb)
33651 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33652 ^done
33653 (gdb)
33654 @end smallexample
33655
33656
33657 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33658 @findex -target-file-get
33659
33660 @subsubheading Synopsis
33661
33662 @smallexample
33663 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33664 @end smallexample
33665
33666 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33667 on the host system.
33668
33669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33670
33671 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33672
33673 @subsubheading Example
33674
33675 @smallexample
33676 (gdb)
33677 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33678 ^done
33679 (gdb)
33680 @end smallexample
33681
33682
33683 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33684 @findex -target-file-delete
33685
33686 @subsubheading Synopsis
33687
33688 @smallexample
33689 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33690 @end smallexample
33691
33692 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33693
33694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33695
33696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33697
33698 @subsubheading Example
33699
33700 @smallexample
33701 (gdb)
33702 -target-file-delete remotefile
33703 ^done
33704 (gdb)
33705 @end smallexample
33706
33707
33708 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33709 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33710 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33711
33712 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33713 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33714
33715 @subsubheading Synopsis
33716
33717 @smallexample
33718 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33719 @end smallexample
33720
33721 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33722 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33723 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33724
33725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33726
33727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33728
33729 @subsubheading Result
33730
33731 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33732 defined for each exception:
33733
33734 @table @samp
33735 @item name
33736 The name of the exception.
33737
33738 @item address
33739 The address of the exception.
33740
33741 @end table
33742
33743 @subsubheading Example
33744
33745 @smallexample
33746 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33747 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33748 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33749 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33750 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33751 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33752 @end smallexample
33753
33754 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33755
33756 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33757 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33758 Catchpoint Commands}.
33759
33760
33761 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33762 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33763 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33764
33765 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33766 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33767 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33768 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33769
33770 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33771 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33772 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33773
33774 @subsubheading Synopsis
33775
33776 @smallexample
33777 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33778 @end smallexample
33779
33780 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33781
33782 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33783 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33784 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33785 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33786 dash.
33787
33788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33789
33790 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33791
33792 @subsubheading Result
33793
33794 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33795
33796 @table @samp
33797 @item exists
33798 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33799 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33800
33801 @end table
33802
33803 @subsubheading Example
33804
33805 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33806
33807 @smallexample
33808 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33809 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33810 @end smallexample
33811
33812 @noindent
33813 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33814 to the debugger:
33815
33816 @smallexample
33817 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33818 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33819 @end smallexample
33820
33821 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33822 @findex -list-features
33823 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33824
33825 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33826 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33827 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33828 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33829 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33830 startup.
33831
33832 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33833 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33834 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33835 is given below.
33836
33837 Example output:
33838
33839 @smallexample
33840 (gdb) -list-features
33841 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33842 @end smallexample
33843
33844 The current list of features is:
33845
33846 @ftable @samp
33847 @item frozen-varobjs
33848 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33849 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33850 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33851 @item pending-breakpoints
33852 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33853 command.
33854 @item python
33855 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33856 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33857 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33858 @item thread-info
33859 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33860 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33861 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33862 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33863 @item breakpoint-notifications
33864 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33865 CLI will be announced via async records.
33866 @item ada-task-info
33867 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33868 @item language-option
33869 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33870 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33871 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33872 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33873 @item undefined-command-error-code
33874 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33875 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33876 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33877 @item exec-run-start-option
33878 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33879 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33880 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33881 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33882 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33883 @end ftable
33884
33885 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33886 @findex -list-target-features
33887
33888 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33889 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33890 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33891 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33892 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33893 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33894 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33895 Example output:
33896
33897 @smallexample
33898 (gdb) -list-target-features
33899 ^done,result=["async"]
33900 @end smallexample
33901
33902 The current list of features is:
33903
33904 @table @samp
33905 @item async
33906 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33907 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33908 while the target is running.
33909
33910 @item reverse
33911 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33912 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33913
33914 @end table
33915
33916 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33917 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33918 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33919
33920 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33921
33922 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33923 @findex -gdb-exit
33924
33925 @subsubheading Synopsis
33926
33927 @smallexample
33928 -gdb-exit
33929 @end smallexample
33930
33931 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33932
33933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33934
33935 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33936
33937 @subsubheading Example
33938
33939 @smallexample
33940 (gdb)
33941 -gdb-exit
33942 ^exit
33943 @end smallexample
33944
33945
33946 @ignore
33947 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33948 @findex -exec-abort
33949
33950 @subsubheading Synopsis
33951
33952 @smallexample
33953 -exec-abort
33954 @end smallexample
33955
33956 Kill the inferior running program.
33957
33958 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33959
33960 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33961
33962 @subsubheading Example
33963 N.A.
33964 @end ignore
33965
33966
33967 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33968 @findex -gdb-set
33969
33970 @subsubheading Synopsis
33971
33972 @smallexample
33973 -gdb-set
33974 @end smallexample
33975
33976 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33977 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33978
33979 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33980
33981 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33982
33983 @subsubheading Example
33984
33985 @smallexample
33986 (gdb)
33987 -gdb-set $foo=3
33988 ^done
33989 (gdb)
33990 @end smallexample
33991
33992
33993 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33994 @findex -gdb-show
33995
33996 @subsubheading Synopsis
33997
33998 @smallexample
33999 -gdb-show
34000 @end smallexample
34001
34002 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34003
34004 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34005
34006 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34007
34008 @subsubheading Example
34009
34010 @smallexample
34011 (gdb)
34012 -gdb-show annotate
34013 ^done,value="0"
34014 (gdb)
34015 @end smallexample
34016
34017 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34018
34019
34020 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34021 @findex -gdb-version
34022
34023 @subsubheading Synopsis
34024
34025 @smallexample
34026 -gdb-version
34027 @end smallexample
34028
34029 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34030
34031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34032
34033 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34034 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34035
34036 @subsubheading Example
34037
34038 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34039 @c box in TeX.
34040 @smallexample
34041 (gdb)
34042 -gdb-version
34043 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
34044 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34045 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34046 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34047 ~ certain conditions.
34048 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34049 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34050 ~ details.
34051 ~This GDB was configured as
34052 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34053 ^done
34054 (gdb)
34055 @end smallexample
34056
34057 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34058 @findex -list-thread-groups
34059
34060 @subheading Synopsis
34061
34062 @smallexample
34063 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
34064 @end smallexample
34065
34066 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
34067 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
34068 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
34069 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
34070 top-level thread groups.
34071
34072 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
34073 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
34074 available on the target.
34075
34076 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
34077 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
34078 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
34079 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
34080 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
34081 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
34082 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
34083 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
34084
34085 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
34086 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
34087 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
34088 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
34089 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
34090 @samp{threads} field.
34091
34092 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
34093 the following caveats:
34094
34095 @itemize @bullet
34096 @item
34097 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34098 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34099 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34100
34101 @item
34102 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
34103 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
34104 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
34105 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
34106 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
34107 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
34108
34109 @end itemize
34110
34111 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
34112 have the following fields:
34113
34114 @table @code
34115 @item id
34116 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
34117 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
34118 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
34119
34120 @item type
34121 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
34122 valid type.
34123
34124 @item pid
34125 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
34126 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
34127
34128 @item exit-code
34129 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
34130 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
34131 only if the process is not running.
34132
34133 @item num_children
34134 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
34135 absent for an available thread group.
34136
34137 @item threads
34138 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
34139 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
34140 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
34141
34142 @item cores
34143 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
34144 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
34145 such information is not available.
34146
34147 @item executable
34148 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
34149 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
34150 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
34151
34152 @end table
34153
34154 @subheading Example
34155
34156 @smallexample
34157 @value{GDBP}
34158 -list-thread-groups
34159 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
34160 -list-thread-groups 17
34161 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
34162 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
34163 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
34164 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
34165 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
34166 -list-thread-groups --available
34167 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
34168 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
34169 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34170 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34171 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
34172 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
34173 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34174 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34175 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
34176 @end smallexample
34177
34178 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
34179 @findex -info-os
34180
34181 @subsubheading Synopsis
34182
34183 @smallexample
34184 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
34185 @end smallexample
34186
34187 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
34188 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
34189 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
34190 of data of that type.
34191
34192 The types of information available depend on the target operating
34193 system.
34194
34195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34196
34197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
34198
34199 @subsubheading Example
34200
34201 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
34202 like this:
34203
34204 @smallexample
34205 @value{GDBP}
34206 -info-os
34207 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
34208 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
34209 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
34210 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
34211 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
34212 col2="CPUs"@},
34213 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34214 col2="File descriptors"@},
34215 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34216 col2="Kernel modules"@},
34217 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34218 col2="Message queues"@},
34219 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34220 col2="Processes"@},
34221 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34222 col2="Process groups"@},
34223 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34224 col2="Semaphores"@},
34225 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34226 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34227 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34228 col2="Sockets"@},
34229 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34230 col2="Threads"@}]
34231 @value{GDBP}
34232 -info-os processes
34233 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34234 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34235 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34236 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34237 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34238 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34239 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34240 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34241 ...
34242 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34243 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34244 (gdb)
34245 @end smallexample
34246
34247 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34248 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34249 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34250 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34251 @code{info os} omits it.)
34252
34253 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34254 @findex -add-inferior
34255
34256 @subheading Synopsis
34257
34258 @smallexample
34259 -add-inferior
34260 @end smallexample
34261
34262 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34263 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34264 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34265 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34266 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34267 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34268
34269 @subheading Example
34270
34271 @smallexample
34272 @value{GDBP}
34273 -add-inferior
34274 ^done,inferior="i3"
34275 @end smallexample
34276
34277 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34278 @findex -interpreter-exec
34279
34280 @subheading Synopsis
34281
34282 @smallexample
34283 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34284 @end smallexample
34285 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34286
34287 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34288
34289 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34290
34291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34292
34293 @subheading Example
34294
34295 @smallexample
34296 (gdb)
34297 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34298 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34299 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34300 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34301 ^done
34302 (gdb)
34303 @end smallexample
34304
34305 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34306 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34307
34308 @subheading Synopsis
34309
34310 @smallexample
34311 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34312 @end smallexample
34313
34314 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34315
34316 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34317
34318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34319
34320 @subheading Example
34321
34322 @smallexample
34323 (gdb)
34324 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34325 ^done
34326 (gdb)
34327 @end smallexample
34328
34329 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34330 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34331
34332 @subheading Synopsis
34333
34334 @smallexample
34335 -inferior-tty-show
34336 @end smallexample
34337
34338 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34339
34340 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34341
34342 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34343
34344 @subheading Example
34345
34346 @smallexample
34347 (gdb)
34348 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34349 ^done
34350 (gdb)
34351 -inferior-tty-show
34352 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34353 (gdb)
34354 @end smallexample
34355
34356 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34357 @findex -enable-timings
34358
34359 @subheading Synopsis
34360
34361 @smallexample
34362 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34363 @end smallexample
34364
34365 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34366 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34367 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34368 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34369
34370 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34371
34372 No equivalent.
34373
34374 @subheading Example
34375
34376 @smallexample
34377 (gdb)
34378 -enable-timings
34379 ^done
34380 (gdb)
34381 -break-insert main
34382 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34383 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34384 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34385 times="0"@},
34386 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34387 (gdb)
34388 -enable-timings no
34389 ^done
34390 (gdb)
34391 -exec-run
34392 ^running
34393 (gdb)
34394 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34395 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34396 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34397 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34398 (gdb)
34399 @end smallexample
34400
34401 @node Annotations
34402 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34403
34404 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34405 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34406 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34407 relatively high level.
34408
34409 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34410 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34411
34412 @ignore
34413 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34414 @end ignore
34415
34416 @menu
34417 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34418 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34419 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34420 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34421 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34422 * Annotations for Running::
34423 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34424 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34425 @end menu
34426
34427 @node Annotations Overview
34428 @section What is an Annotation?
34429 @cindex annotations
34430
34431 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34432 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34433 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34434 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34435 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34436 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34437 cannot contain newline characters.
34438
34439 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34440 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34441 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34442 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34443 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34444 means those three characters as output.
34445
34446 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34447 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34448 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34449 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34450 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34451 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34452 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34453 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34454 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34455
34456 @table @code
34457 @kindex set annotate
34458 @item set annotate @var{level}
34459 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34460 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34461
34462 @item show annotate
34463 @kindex show annotate
34464 Show the current annotation level.
34465 @end table
34466
34467 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34468
34469 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34470
34471 @smallexample
34472 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34473 GNU gdb 6.0
34474 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34475 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34476 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34477 under certain conditions.
34478 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34479 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34480 for details.
34481 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34482
34483 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34484 (@value{GDBP})
34485 ^Z^Zprompt
34486 @kbd{quit}
34487
34488 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34489 $
34490 @end smallexample
34491
34492 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34493 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34494 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34495 output from @value{GDBN}.
34496
34497 @node Server Prefix
34498 @section The Server Prefix
34499 @cindex server prefix
34500
34501 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34502 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34503 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34504 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34505 a transparent manner.
34506
34507 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34508 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34509 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34510 @code{print} command.
34511
34512 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34513 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34514
34515 @node Prompting
34516 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34517
34518 @cindex annotations for prompts
34519 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34520 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34521 over, etc.
34522
34523 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34524 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34525 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34526 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34527 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34528 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34529 features the following annotations:
34530
34531 @smallexample
34532 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34533 ^Z^Zprompt
34534 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34535 @end smallexample
34536
34537 The input types are
34538
34539 @table @code
34540 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34541 @findex prompt annotation
34542 @findex post-prompt annotation
34543 @item prompt
34544 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34545
34546 @findex pre-commands annotation
34547 @findex commands annotation
34548 @findex post-commands annotation
34549 @item commands
34550 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34551 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34552
34553 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34554 @findex overload-choice annotation
34555 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34556 @item overload-choice
34557 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34558
34559 @findex pre-query annotation
34560 @findex query annotation
34561 @findex post-query annotation
34562 @item query
34563 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34564
34565 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34566 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34567 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34568 @item prompt-for-continue
34569 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34570 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34571 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34572 presence of annotations.
34573 @end table
34574
34575 @node Errors
34576 @section Errors
34577 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34578
34579 @findex quit annotation
34580 @smallexample
34581 ^Z^Zquit
34582 @end smallexample
34583
34584 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34585
34586 @findex error annotation
34587 @smallexample
34588 ^Z^Zerror
34589 @end smallexample
34590
34591 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34592
34593 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34594 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34595 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34596 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34597 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34598 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34599 to the top level.
34600
34601 @findex error-begin annotation
34602 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34603
34604 @smallexample
34605 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34606 @end smallexample
34607
34608 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34609 message.
34610
34611 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34612 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34613 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34614
34615 @node Invalidation
34616 @section Invalidation Notices
34617
34618 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34619 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34620 changed.
34621
34622 @table @code
34623 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34624 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34625
34626 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34627 have changed.
34628
34629 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34630 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34631
34632 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34633 deleted a breakpoint.
34634 @end table
34635
34636 @node Annotations for Running
34637 @section Running the Program
34638 @cindex annotations for running programs
34639
34640 @findex starting annotation
34641 @findex stopping annotation
34642 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34643 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34644
34645 @smallexample
34646 ^Z^Zstarting
34647 @end smallexample
34648
34649 is output. When the program stops,
34650
34651 @smallexample
34652 ^Z^Zstopped
34653 @end smallexample
34654
34655 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34656 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34657
34658 @table @code
34659 @findex exited annotation
34660 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34661 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34662 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34663
34664 @findex signalled annotation
34665 @findex signal-name annotation
34666 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34667 @findex signal-string annotation
34668 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34669 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34670 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34671 annotation continues:
34672
34673 @smallexample
34674 @var{intro-text}
34675 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34676 @var{name}
34677 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34678 @var{middle-text}
34679 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34680 @var{string}
34681 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34682 @var{end-text}
34683 @end smallexample
34684
34685 @noindent
34686 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34687 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34688 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34689 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34690 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34691
34692 @findex signal annotation
34693 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34694 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34695 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34696 terminated with it.
34697
34698 @findex breakpoint annotation
34699 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34700 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34701
34702 @findex watchpoint annotation
34703 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34704 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34705 @end table
34706
34707 @node Source Annotations
34708 @section Displaying Source
34709 @cindex annotations for source display
34710
34711 @findex source annotation
34712 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34713
34714 @smallexample
34715 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34716 @end smallexample
34717
34718 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34719 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34720 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34721 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34722 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34723 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34724 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34725 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34726 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34727 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34728 depend on the language).
34729
34730 @node JIT Interface
34731 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34732 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34733 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34734
34735 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34736 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34737 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34738 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34739
34740 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34741 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34742 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34743 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34744 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34745 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34746
34747 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34748 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34749 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34750 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34751 LLVM JIT.
34752
34753 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34754 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34755 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34756 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34757 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34758 out about additional code.
34759
34760 @menu
34761 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34762 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34763 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34764 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34765 @end menu
34766
34767 @node Declarations
34768 @section JIT Declarations
34769
34770 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34771 implement the interface:
34772
34773 @smallexample
34774 typedef enum
34775 @{
34776 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34777 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34778 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34779 @} jit_actions_t;
34780
34781 struct jit_code_entry
34782 @{
34783 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34784 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34785 const char *symfile_addr;
34786 uint64_t symfile_size;
34787 @};
34788
34789 struct jit_descriptor
34790 @{
34791 uint32_t version;
34792 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34793 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34794 uint32_t action_flag;
34795 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34796 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34797 @};
34798
34799 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34800 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34801
34802 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34803 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34804 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34805 @end smallexample
34806
34807 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34808 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34809 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34810
34811 @node Registering Code
34812 @section Registering Code
34813
34814 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34815
34816 @itemize @bullet
34817 @item
34818 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34819 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34820
34821 @item
34822 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34823 file.
34824
34825 @item
34826 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34827
34828 @item
34829 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34830
34831 @item
34832 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34833 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34834 @end itemize
34835
34836 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34837 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34838 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34839 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34840
34841 @node Unregistering Code
34842 @section Unregistering Code
34843
34844 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34845
34846 @itemize @bullet
34847 @item
34848 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34849
34850 @item
34851 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34852
34853 @item
34854 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34855 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34856 @end itemize
34857
34858 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34859 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34860
34861 @node Custom Debug Info
34862 @section Custom Debug Info
34863 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34864 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34865
34866 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34867 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34868 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34869 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34870 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34871 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34872 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34873 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34874 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34875
34876 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34877 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34878 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34879 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34880 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34881 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34882 compiler.
34883
34884 @menu
34885 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34886 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34887 @end menu
34888
34889 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34890 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34891 @kindex jit-reader-load
34892 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34893
34894 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34895 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34896
34897 @table @code
34898 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34899 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34900 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34901 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34902 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34903 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34904 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34905
34906 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34907 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34908 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34909 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34910 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34911
34912 @item jit-reader-unload
34913 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34914
34915 @end table
34916
34917 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34918 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34919 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34920
34921 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34922 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34923
34924 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34925 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34926 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34927 the system include directory.
34928
34929 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34930 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34931 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34932
34933 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34934 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34935
34936 @findex gdb_init_reader
34937 @smallexample
34938 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34939 @end smallexample
34940
34941 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34942
34943 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34944 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34945 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34946 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34947 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34948 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34949
34950 @smallexample
34951 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34952 @{
34953 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34954 int reader_version;
34955
34956 /* For use by the reader. */
34957 void *priv_data;
34958
34959 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34960 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34961 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34962 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34963 @};
34964 @end smallexample
34965
34966 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34967 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34968
34969 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34970 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34971 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34972 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34973 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34974 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34975 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34976 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34977 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34978 target's address space.
34979
34980 @node In-Process Agent
34981 @chapter In-Process Agent
34982 @cindex debugging agent
34983 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34984 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34985 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34986 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34987 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34988 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34989 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34990 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34991 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34992 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34993 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34994 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34995 behavior without interrupting it.
34996
34997 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34998 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34999 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
35000 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
35001 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
35002 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
35003 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
35004 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
35005 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
35006
35007 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
35008 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
35009 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
35010 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
35011
35012 @anchor{Control Agent}
35013 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
35014 debugging with the following commands:
35015
35016 @table @code
35017 @kindex set agent on
35018 @item set agent on
35019 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
35020 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
35021 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
35022 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
35023 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
35024 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
35025
35026 @kindex set agent off
35027 @item set agent off
35028 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
35029 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
35030
35031 @kindex show agent
35032 @item show agent
35033 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
35034 the in-process agent.
35035 @end table
35036
35037 @menu
35038 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
35039 @end menu
35040
35041 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
35042 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
35043 @cindex in-process agent protocol
35044
35045 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
35046 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
35047 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
35048 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
35049 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
35050 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
35051 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
35052 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
35053 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
35054
35055 @menu
35056 * IPA Protocol Objects::
35057 * IPA Protocol Commands::
35058 @end menu
35059
35060 @node IPA Protocol Objects
35061 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
35062 @cindex ipa protocol objects
35063
35064 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
35065 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
35066
35067 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
35068 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
35069 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
35070 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
35071
35072 @enumerate
35073 @item
35074 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
35075 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
35076 @item
35077 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
35078 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
35079 the other one.
35080 @end enumerate
35081
35082 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
35083
35084 @enumerate
35085 @item
35086 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
35087 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
35088 @anchor{agent expression object}
35089 @item
35090 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
35091 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
35092 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
35093 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
35094 @item
35095 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
35096 @anchor{tracepoint object}
35097
35098 @end enumerate
35099
35100 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
35101 object:
35102
35103 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
35104 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
35105 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
35106 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
35107 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
35108 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
35109 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35110 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
35111 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
35112 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
35113 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
35114 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
35115 memory address for collecting.
35116 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
35117 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35118 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
35119 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35120 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
35121 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35122 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
35123 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
35124 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
35125 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
35126 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
35127 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
35128 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
35129 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
35130 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
35131 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
35132 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
35133 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
35134 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
35135 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
35136 @ref{agent expression object}
35137 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
35138 @ref{agent expression object}
35139 @item actions @tab variable
35140 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
35141 @end multitable
35142
35143 @node IPA Protocol Commands
35144 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
35145 @cindex ipa protocol commands
35146
35147 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
35148 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
35149
35150 @table @samp
35151
35152 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
35153 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
35154 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
35155 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
35156 in IPA finally.
35157
35158 Replies:
35159 @table @samp
35160 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
35161 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
35162 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
35163 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
35164 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
35165 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
35166 @item E @var{NN}
35167 for an error
35168
35169 @end table
35170
35171 @item close
35172 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
35173 is about to kill inferiors.
35174
35175 @item qTfSTM
35176 @xref{qTfSTM}.
35177 @item qTsSTM
35178 @xref{qTsSTM}.
35179 @item qTSTMat
35180 @xref{qTSTMat}.
35181 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
35182 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
35183
35184 Replies:
35185 @table @samp
35186 @item E @var{NN}
35187 for an error
35188 @end table
35189 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
35190 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
35191 @end table
35192
35193 @node GDB Bugs
35194 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
35195 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
35196 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
35197
35198 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
35199
35200 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
35201 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
35202 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
35203 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
35204
35205 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
35206 information that enables us to fix the bug.
35207
35208 @menu
35209 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
35210 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
35211 @end menu
35212
35213 @node Bug Criteria
35214 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35215 @cindex bug criteria
35216
35217 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35218
35219 @itemize @bullet
35220 @cindex fatal signal
35221 @cindex debugger crash
35222 @cindex crash of debugger
35223 @item
35224 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35225 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35226
35227 @cindex error on valid input
35228 @item
35229 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35230 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35231 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35232
35233 @cindex invalid input
35234 @item
35235 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35236 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35237 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35238 for traditional practice''.
35239
35240 @item
35241 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35242 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35243 @end itemize
35244
35245 @node Bug Reporting
35246 @section How to Report Bugs
35247 @cindex bug reports
35248 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35249
35250 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35251 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35252 contact that organization first.
35253
35254 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35255 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35256 distribution.
35257 @c should add a web page ref...
35258
35259 @ifset BUGURL
35260 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35261 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35262 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35263 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35264 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35265 be used.
35266
35267 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35268 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35269 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35270 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35271
35272 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35273 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35274 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35275 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35276 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35277 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35278 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35279 bug reports to the mailing list.
35280 @end ifset
35281 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35282 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35283 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35284 @end ifclear
35285 @end ifset
35286
35287 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35288 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35289 fact or leave it out, state it!
35290
35291 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35292 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35293 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35294 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35295 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35296 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35297 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35298 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35299 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35300
35301 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35302 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35303 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35304 self-contained.
35305
35306 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35307 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35308 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35309 bugs properly.
35310
35311 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35312
35313 @itemize @bullet
35314 @item
35315 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35316 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35317 version}.
35318
35319 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35320 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35321
35322 @item
35323 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35324 version number.
35325
35326 @item
35327 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35328 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35329 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35330 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35331
35332 @item
35333 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35334 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35335
35336 @item
35337 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35338 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35339 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35340 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35341 those compilers.
35342
35343 @item
35344 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35345 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35346 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35347 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35348
35349 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35350 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35351
35352 @item
35353 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35354 reproduce the bug.
35355
35356 @item
35357 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35358 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35359
35360 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35361 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35362 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35363 a chance to make a mistake.
35364
35365 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35366 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35367 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35368 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35369 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35370 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35371 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35372 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35373
35374 @pindex script
35375 @cindex recording a session script
35376 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35377 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35378 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35379 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35380
35381 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35382 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35383
35384 @item
35385 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35386 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35387 it by context, not by line number.
35388
35389 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35390 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35391
35392 @end itemize
35393
35394 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35395
35396 @itemize @bullet
35397 @item
35398 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35399
35400 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35401 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35402 changes will not affect it.
35403
35404 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35405 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35406 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35407 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35408
35409 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35410 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35411 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35412 less time, and so on.
35413
35414 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35415 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35416
35417 @item
35418 A patch for the bug.
35419
35420 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35421 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35422 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35423 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35424
35425 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35426 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35427 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35428 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35429
35430 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35431 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35432 help us to understand.
35433
35434 @item
35435 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35436
35437 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35438 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35439 @end itemize
35440
35441 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35442 @c and consists of the two following files:
35443 @c rluser.texi
35444 @c hsuser.texi
35445 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35446 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35447 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35448 @include rluser.texi
35449 @include hsuser.texi
35450 @end ifclear
35451
35452 @node In Memoriam
35453 @appendix In Memoriam
35454
35455 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35456 contributors:
35457
35458 @table @code
35459 @item Fred Fish
35460 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35461 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35462 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35463
35464 @item Michael Snyder
35465 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35466 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35467 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35468 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35469 @end table
35470
35471 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35472 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35473
35474 @node Formatting Documentation
35475 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35476
35477 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35478 @cindex reference card
35479 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35480 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35481 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35482 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35483 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35484 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35485
35486 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35487 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35488
35489 @smallexample
35490 make refcard.dvi
35491 @end smallexample
35492
35493 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35494 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35495 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35496 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35497 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35498
35499 @cindex documentation
35500
35501 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35502 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35503 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35504 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35505 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35506 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35507
35508 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35509 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35510 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35511 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35512 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35513 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35514 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35515 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35516
35517 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35518 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35519 @code{makeinfo}.
35520
35521 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35522 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35523 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35524
35525 @smallexample
35526 cd gdb
35527 make gdb.info
35528 @end smallexample
35529
35530 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35531 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35532 Texinfo definitions file.
35533
35534 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35535 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35536 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35537 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35538 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35539 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35540 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35541
35542 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35543 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35544 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35545 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35546 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35547 directory.
35548
35549 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35550 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35551 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35552 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35553
35554 @smallexample
35555 make gdb.dvi
35556 @end smallexample
35557
35558 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35559
35560 @node Installing GDB
35561 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35562 @cindex installation
35563
35564 @menu
35565 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35566 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35567 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35568 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35569 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35570 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35571 @end menu
35572
35573 @node Requirements
35574 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35575 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35576
35577 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35578 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35579
35580 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35581 @table @asis
35582 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35583 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35584 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35585
35586 @item GNU make
35587 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35588 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35589 @end table
35590
35591 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35592 @table @asis
35593 @item Expat
35594 @anchor{Expat}
35595 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35596 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35597 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35598 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35599 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35600 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35601
35602 Expat is used for:
35603
35604 @itemize @bullet
35605 @item
35606 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35607 @item
35608 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35609 @item
35610 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35611 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35612 @item
35613 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35614 @item
35615 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35616 @item
35617 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35618 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35619 @end itemize
35620
35621 @item Guile
35622 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35623 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35624 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35625 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35626 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35627 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35628
35629 @item iconv
35630 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35631 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35632 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35633 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35634
35635 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35636 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35637 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35638 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35639 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35640
35641 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35642 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35643 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35644 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35645 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35646
35647 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35648 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35649 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35650 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35651 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35652 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35653 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35654 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35655 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35656
35657 @item lzma
35658 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35659 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35660 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35661 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35662 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35663 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35664 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35665
35666 @item MPFR
35667 @anchor{MPFR}
35668 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35669 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35670 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35671 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35672 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35673 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35674 option to specify its location.
35675
35676 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35677 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35678 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35679 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35680
35681 @item Python
35682 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35683 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35684 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35685 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35686 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35687 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35688 installation of Python.
35689
35690 @item zlib
35691 @cindex compressed debug sections
35692 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35693 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35694 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35695 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35696 information in such binaries.
35697
35698 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35699 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35700 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35701 @end table
35702
35703 @node Running Configure
35704 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35705 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35706 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35707 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35708 build the @code{gdb} program.
35709 @iftex
35710 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35711 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35712 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35713 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35714 @end iftex
35715
35716 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35717 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35718 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35719
35720 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35721 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35722
35723 @table @code
35724 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35725 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35726
35727 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35728 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35729
35730 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35731 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35732
35733 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35734 @sc{gnu} include files
35735
35736 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35737 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35738
35739 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35740 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35741
35742 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35743 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35744 @end table
35745
35746 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35747
35748 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35749 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35750 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35751
35752 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35753 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35754 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35755 argument.
35756
35757 For example:
35758
35759 @smallexample
35760 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35761 ./configure
35762 make
35763 @end smallexample
35764
35765 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35766 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35767 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35768 directories.
35769
35770 @need 750
35771 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35772 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35773 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35774
35775 @smallexample
35776 sh configure
35777 @end smallexample
35778
35779 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35780 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35781 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35782 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35783 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35784 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35785 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35786 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35787 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35788
35789 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35790 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35791 install it with @code{make install}.
35792
35793 @node Separate Objdir
35794 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35795
35796 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35797 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35798 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35799 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35800 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35801 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35802 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35803 program specified there.
35804
35805 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35806 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35807 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35808 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35809 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35810 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35811
35812 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35813 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35814
35815 @smallexample
35816 @group
35817 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35818 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35819 cd ../gdb-sun4
35820 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35821 make
35822 @end group
35823 @end smallexample
35824
35825 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35826 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35827 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35828 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35829 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35830 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35831
35832 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35833 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35834 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35835 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35836 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35837
35838 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35839 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35840 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35841 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35842 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35843 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35844
35845 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35846 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35847 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35848
35849 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35850 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35851 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35852 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35853 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35854
35855 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35856 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35857 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35858 with each other.
35859
35860 @node Config Names
35861 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35862
35863 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35864 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35865 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35866 of information in the following pattern:
35867
35868 @smallexample
35869 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35870 @end smallexample
35871
35872 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35873 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35874 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35875
35876 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35877 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35878 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35879 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35880 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35881 abbreviations---for example:
35882
35883 @smallexample
35884 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35885 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35886 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35887 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35888 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35889 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35890 % sh config.sub sun4
35891 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35892 % sh config.sub sun3
35893 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35894 % sh config.sub i986v
35895 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35896 @end smallexample
35897
35898 @noindent
35899 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35900 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35901
35902 @node Configure Options
35903 @section @file{configure} Options
35904
35905 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35906 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35907 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35908 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35909 explanation of @file{configure}.
35910
35911 @smallexample
35912 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35913 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35914 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35915 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35916 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35917 @end smallexample
35918
35919 @noindent
35920 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35921 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35922 @samp{--}.
35923
35924 @table @code
35925 @item --help
35926 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35927
35928 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35929 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35930 @file{@var{dir}}.
35931
35932 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35933 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35934 @file{@var{dir}}.
35935
35936 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35937 @need 2000
35938 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35939 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35940 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35941 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35942 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35943 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35944 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35945 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35946 @var{dirname}.
35947
35948 @item --target=@var{target}
35949 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35950 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35951 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35952
35953 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35954 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35955 @end table
35956
35957 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35958 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35959 options not described here.
35960
35961 @table @code
35962 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35963 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35964 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35965 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35966 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35967
35968 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35969 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35970 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35971 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35972 @code{--datadir}).
35973
35974 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35975 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35976 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35977 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35978 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
35979 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
35980 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
35981 after it is built.
35982
35983 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
35984 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
35985
35986 @item --disable-gdbmi
35987 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
35988 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35989
35990 @item --enable-tui
35991 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
35992 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
35993 supported).
35994
35995 @item --with-curses
35996 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
35997 terminal operations.
35998
35999 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
36000 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
36001 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
36002 details.
36003
36004 @item --with-system-readline
36005 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
36006 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36007
36008 @item --with-system-zlib
36009 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
36010 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36011
36012 @item --with-expat
36013 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
36014 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
36015 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
36016 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
36017 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
36018 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
36019 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
36020 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
36021
36022 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
36023
36024 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
36025 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
36026 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
36027 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
36028 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
36029
36030 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
36031 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
36032
36033 @item --with-lzma
36034 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
36035 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
36036 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
36037 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
36038 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
36039 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
36040
36041 @item --with-mpfr
36042 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
36043 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
36044 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
36045 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
36046 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
36047 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
36048 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
36049 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
36050 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
36051
36052 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
36053 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
36054 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
36055 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
36056 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
36057 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
36058 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
36059 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
36060 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
36061 Python is installed.
36062
36063 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
36064 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
36065 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
36066 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
36067 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
36068 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
36069 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
36070 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
36071 compile and link against Guile.
36072
36073 @item --without-included-regex
36074 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
36075 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
36076 the GNU C library.
36077
36078 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
36079 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
36080 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
36081 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
36082 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
36083 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
36084 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
36085 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
36086
36087 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36088 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
36089 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
36090 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
36091 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
36092 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
36093
36094 @item --enable-build-warnings
36095 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
36096 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
36097 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
36098 compiler you are using.
36099
36100 @item --enable-werror
36101 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
36102 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
36103 outputs any warning messages.
36104
36105 @item --enable-ubsan
36106 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
36107 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
36108 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
36109 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
36110 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
36111 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
36112 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
36113 @end table
36114
36115 @node System-wide configuration
36116 @section System-wide configuration and settings
36117 @cindex system-wide init file
36118
36119 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
36120 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
36121 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
36122
36123 Here is the corresponding configure option:
36124
36125 @table @code
36126 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36127 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
36128 @var{file}.
36129 @end table
36130
36131 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
36132 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
36133
36134 @itemize @bullet
36135 @item
36136 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
36137 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
36138 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
36139 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
36140 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
36141 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
36142
36143 @item
36144 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
36145 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
36146 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36147 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36148 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
36149 @end itemize
36150
36151 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
36152 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
36153 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
36154 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
36155 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
36156 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
36157 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
36158 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
36159 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
36160 reread.
36161
36162 @menu
36163 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36164 @end menu
36165
36166 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
36167 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36168 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
36169
36170 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
36171 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
36172 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
36173 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
36174 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
36175 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
36176
36177 The following scripts are currently available:
36178 @itemize @bullet
36179
36180 @item @file{elinos.py}
36181 @pindex elinos.py
36182 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
36183 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
36184 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
36185 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
36186 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
36187 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
36188
36189 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
36190 @pindex wrs-linux.py
36191 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
36192 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
36193 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
36194 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
36195
36196 @end itemize
36197
36198 @node Maintenance Commands
36199 @appendix Maintenance Commands
36200 @cindex maintenance commands
36201 @cindex internal commands
36202
36203 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
36204 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
36205 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
36206 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
36207 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
36208
36209 @table @code
36210 @kindex maint agent
36211 @kindex maint agent-eval
36212 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36213 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36214 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36215 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36216 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36217 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36218 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36219 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36220 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36221 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36222 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36223 addition and return the sum.
36224 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36225 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36226
36227 @kindex maint agent-printf
36228 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36229 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36230 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36231 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36232 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36233
36234 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36235 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36236 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36237 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36238 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36239 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36240 is shown:
36241
36242 @table @code
36243 @item breakpoint
36244 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36245
36246 @item watchpoint
36247 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36248
36249 @item longjmp
36250 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36251 @code{longjmp} calls.
36252
36253 @item longjmp resume
36254 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36255
36256 @item until
36257 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36258
36259 @item finish
36260 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36261
36262 @item shlib events
36263 Shared library events.
36264
36265 @end table
36266
36267 @kindex maint info btrace
36268 @item maint info btrace
36269 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36270
36271 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36272 @item maint btrace packet-history
36273 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36274 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36275 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36276 recording format.
36277
36278 @table @code
36279 @item bts
36280 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36281 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36282
36283 @table @asis
36284 @item Block number
36285 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36286 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36287 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36288 @end table
36289
36290 @item pt
36291 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36292 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36293 information is printed:
36294
36295 @table @asis
36296 @item Packet number
36297 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36298 @item Trace offset
36299 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36300 @item Packet opcode and payload
36301 @end table
36302 @end table
36303
36304 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36305 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36306 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36307 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36308 needed.
36309
36310 @kindex maint btrace clear
36311 @item maint btrace clear
36312 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36313 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36314
36315 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36316 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36317 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36318 buffer.
36319
36320 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36321 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36322 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36323 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36324 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36325 packet history.
36326
36327 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36328 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36329 @cindex displaced stepping support
36330 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36331 @item set displaced-stepping
36332 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36333 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36334 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36335 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36336 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36337 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36338
36339 @table @code
36340 @item set displaced-stepping on
36341 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36342 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36343
36344 @item set displaced-stepping off
36345 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36346 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36347
36348 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36349 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36350 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36351 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36352 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36353 @end table
36354
36355 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36356 @item maint check-psymtabs
36357 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36358 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36359
36360 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36361 @item maint check-symtabs
36362 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36363
36364 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36365 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36366 Expand symbol tables.
36367 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36368 names matching @var{regexp}.
36369
36370 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36371 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36372 @cindex demangler crashes
36373 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36374 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36375 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36376 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36377 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36378 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36379 option to terminate the current session.
36380
36381 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36382 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36383 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36384
36385 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36386 @item maint cplus namespace
36387 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36388
36389 @kindex maint deprecate
36390 @kindex maint undeprecate
36391 @cindex deprecated commands
36392 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36393 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36394 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36395 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36396 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36397 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36398 the replacement as part of the warning.
36399
36400 @kindex maint dump-me
36401 @item maint dump-me
36402 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36403 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36404 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36405 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36406
36407 @kindex maint internal-error
36408 @kindex maint internal-warning
36409 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36410 @cindex demangler crashes
36411 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36412 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36413 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36414
36415 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36416 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36417 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36418 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36419 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36420 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36421 @value{GDBN} session.
36422
36423 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36424 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36425
36426 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36427
36428 @smallexample
36429 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36430 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36431 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36432 debugging may prove unreliable.
36433 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36434 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36435 (@value{GDBP})
36436 @end smallexample
36437
36438 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36439 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36440 @cindex demangler crashes
36441
36442 @kindex maint set internal-error
36443 @kindex maint show internal-error
36444 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36445 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36446 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36447 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36448 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36449 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36450 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36451 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36452 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36453 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36454 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36455 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36456 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36457 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36458 described in the table below.
36459
36460 @table @samp
36461 @item quit
36462 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36463 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36464
36465 @item corefile
36466 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36467 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36468 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36469 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36470 disabled.
36471 @end table
36472
36473 @kindex maint packet
36474 @item maint packet @var{text}
36475 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36476 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36477 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36478 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36479 checksum.
36480
36481 @kindex maint print architecture
36482 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36483 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36484 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36485
36486 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36487 @item maint print c-tdesc
36488 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36489 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36490 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36491 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36492 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36493 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36494 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36495 modify XML target descriptions.
36496
36497 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36498 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36499 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36500 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36501
36502 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36503 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36504 @item maint check libthread-db
36505 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36506 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36507 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36508 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36509 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36510 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36511
36512 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36513 @item maint print dummy-frames
36514 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36515
36516 @smallexample
36517 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36518 @dots{}
36519 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36520 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36521 58 return (a + b);
36522 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36523 @dots{}
36524 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36525 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36526 (@value{GDBP})
36527 @end smallexample
36528
36529 Takes an optional file parameter.
36530
36531 @kindex maint print registers
36532 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36533 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36534 @kindex maint print register-groups
36535 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36536 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36537 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36538 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36539 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36540 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36541 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36542
36543 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36544 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36545 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36546 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36547 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36548 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36549 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36550 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36551
36552 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36553 write the information.
36554
36555 @kindex maint print reggroups
36556 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36557 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36558 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36559 information.
36560
36561 The register groups info looks like this:
36562
36563 @smallexample
36564 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36565 Group Type
36566 general user
36567 float user
36568 all user
36569 vector user
36570 system user
36571 save internal
36572 restore internal
36573 @end smallexample
36574
36575 @kindex flushregs
36576 @item flushregs
36577 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36578
36579 @kindex maint print objfiles
36580 @cindex info for known object files
36581 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36582 Print a dump of all known object files.
36583 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36584 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36585 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36586
36587 @kindex maint print user-registers
36588 @cindex user registers
36589 @item maint print user-registers
36590 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36591 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36592 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36593 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36594 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36595 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36596 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36597
36598 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36599 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36600 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36601 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36602 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36603 matching @var{regexp}.
36604 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36605 and the full path if known.
36606 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36607
36608 @kindex maint print statistics
36609 @cindex bcache statistics
36610 @item maint print statistics
36611 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36612 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36613 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36614 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36615 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36616 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36617 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36618 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36619 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36620 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36621 lengths.
36622
36623 @kindex maint print target-stack
36624 @cindex target stack description
36625 @item maint print target-stack
36626 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36627 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36628 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36629 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36630 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36631 address.
36632
36633 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36634 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36635
36636 @kindex maint print type
36637 @cindex type chain of a data type
36638 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36639 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36640 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36641 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36642 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36643 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36644
36645 @kindex maint selftest
36646 @cindex self tests
36647 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36648 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36649 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36650 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36651 name will by ran.
36652
36653 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36654 @cindex self tests
36655 @item maint info selftests
36656 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36657
36658 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36659 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36660 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36661 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36662 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36663 information.
36664
36665 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36666 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36667 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36668 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36669 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36670 always see the disassembly form.
36671
36672 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36673
36674 @smallexample
36675 (gdb) info addr argc
36676 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36677 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36678 @end smallexample
36679
36680 For more information on these expressions, see
36681 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36682
36683 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36684 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36685 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36686 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36687 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36688
36689 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36690 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36691 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36692 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36693 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36694 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36695 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36696 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36697 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36698
36699 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36700 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36701 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36702 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36703 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36704
36705 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36706 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36707 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36708 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36709 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36710 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36711
36712 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36713 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36714 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36715
36716 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36717 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36718 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36719 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36720
36721 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36722 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36723 @kindex maint set profile
36724 @kindex maint show profile
36725 @cindex profiling GDB
36726 @item maint set profile
36727 @itemx maint show profile
36728 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36729
36730 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36731 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36732 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36733 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36734 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36735 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36736 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36737
36738 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36739 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36740
36741 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36742 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36743 @cindex hardware debug registers
36744 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36745 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36746 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36747 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36748 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36749 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36750 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36751
36752 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36753 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36754 @item maint set show-all-tib
36755 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36756 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36757 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36758 command.
36759
36760 @kindex maint set target-async
36761 @kindex maint show target-async
36762 @item maint set target-async
36763 @itemx maint show target-async
36764 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36765 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36766 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36767 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36768
36769 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36770 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36771 @item maint set target-non-stop
36772 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36773
36774 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36775 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36776 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36777 if supported by the target.
36778
36779 @table @code
36780 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36781 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36782 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36783
36784 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36785 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36786 does not indicate support.
36787
36788 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36789 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36790 target supports it.
36791 @end table
36792
36793 @kindex maint set per-command
36794 @kindex maint show per-command
36795 @item maint set per-command
36796 @itemx maint show per-command
36797 @cindex resources used by commands
36798
36799 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36800 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36801
36802 @table @code
36803 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36804 @itemx maint show per-command space
36805 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36806 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36807 took, following the command's own output.
36808 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36809 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36810
36811 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36812 @itemx maint show per-command time
36813 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36814 for each command.
36815 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36816 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36817 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36818 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36819 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36820 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36821 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36822 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36823 spent by the program been debugged.
36824 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36825 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36826
36827 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36828 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36829 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36830 for each command.
36831 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36832
36833 @enumerate a
36834 @item
36835 number of symbol tables
36836 @item
36837 number of primary symbol tables
36838 @item
36839 number of blocks in the blockvector
36840 @end enumerate
36841 @end table
36842
36843 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36844 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36845 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36846 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36847 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36848 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36849 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36850 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36851 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36852 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36853
36854 @kindex maint space
36855 @cindex memory used by commands
36856 @item maint space @var{value}
36857 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36858 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36859
36860 @kindex maint time
36861 @cindex time of command execution
36862 @item maint time @var{value}
36863 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36864 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36865
36866 @kindex maint translate-address
36867 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36868 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36869 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36870 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36871 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36872 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36873 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36874
36875 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36876 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36877 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36878
36879 @end table
36880
36881 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36882 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36883
36884 @table @code
36885 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36886 @kindex set watchdog
36887 @cindex watchdog timer
36888 @cindex timeout for commands
36889 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36890 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36891 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36892
36893 @item show watchdog
36894 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36895 @end table
36896
36897 @node Remote Protocol
36898 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36899
36900 @menu
36901 * Overview::
36902 * Packets::
36903 * Stop Reply Packets::
36904 * General Query Packets::
36905 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36906 * Tracepoint Packets::
36907 * Host I/O Packets::
36908 * Interrupts::
36909 * Notification Packets::
36910 * Remote Non-Stop::
36911 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36912 * Examples::
36913 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36914 * Library List Format::
36915 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36916 * Memory Map Format::
36917 * Thread List Format::
36918 * Traceframe Info Format::
36919 * Branch Trace Format::
36920 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36921 @end menu
36922
36923 @node Overview
36924 @section Overview
36925
36926 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36927 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36928 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36929 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36930
36931 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36932 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36933
36934 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36935 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36936 @cindex remote serial protocol
36937 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36938 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36939 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36940 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36941 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36942
36943 @smallexample
36944 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36945 @end smallexample
36946 @noindent
36947
36948 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36949 @noindent
36950 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36951 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36952 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36953
36954 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36955 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36956
36957 @smallexample
36958 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36959 @end smallexample
36960
36961 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36962 @noindent
36963 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36964 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36965 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36966
36967 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36968 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36969 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36970 retransmission):
36971
36972 @smallexample
36973 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36974 <- @code{+}
36975 @end smallexample
36976 @noindent
36977
36978 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36979 once a connection is established.
36980 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36981
36982 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36983 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36984 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36985 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36986 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36987 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36988 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36989
36990 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36991 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36992 exceptions).
36993
36994 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36995 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36996 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36997 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36998
36999 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37000 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37001 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
37002
37003 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
37004 @anchor{Binary Data}
37005 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
37006 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
37007 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
37008 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
37009 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
37010 binary data.
37011
37012 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
37013 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
37014 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
37015 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
37016 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
37017 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
37018 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
37019 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
37020 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
37021 (described next).
37022
37023 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
37024 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
37025 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
37026 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
37027 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
37028 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
37029 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
37030 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
37031 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
37032 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
37033 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
37034 3}} more times.
37035
37036 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
37037 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
37038 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
37039 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
37040 @samp{0*"00}.
37041
37042 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
37043 error number. That number is not well defined.
37044
37045 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
37046 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
37047 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
37048 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
37049 on that response.
37050
37051 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
37052 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
37053 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
37054 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
37055 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
37056 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
37057
37058 @node Packets
37059 @section Packets
37060
37061 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
37062 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
37063 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
37064 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
37065
37066 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
37067 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
37068 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
37069 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
37070 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
37071 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
37072 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
37073 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
37074 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
37075 @var{baz}.
37076
37077 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
37078 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
37079 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
37080 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
37081 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
37082 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
37083 pick any thread.
37084
37085 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
37086 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
37087 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
37088 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
37089 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
37090 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
37091 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
37092 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
37093 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
37094 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
37095 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
37096 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
37097 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
37098
37099 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
37100 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
37101 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
37102 more information.
37103
37104 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
37105 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
37106
37107 Here are the packet descriptions.
37108
37109 @table @samp
37110
37111 @item !
37112 @cindex @samp{!} packet
37113 @anchor{extended mode}
37114 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
37115 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
37116 debugged.
37117
37118 Reply:
37119 @table @samp
37120 @item OK
37121 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
37122 @end table
37123
37124 @item ?
37125 @cindex @samp{?} packet
37126 @anchor{? packet}
37127 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
37128 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
37129 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37130
37131 Reply:
37132 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37133
37134 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
37135 @cindex @samp{A} packet
37136 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
37137 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
37138 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
37139
37140 Reply:
37141 @table @samp
37142 @item OK
37143 The arguments were set.
37144 @item E @var{NN}
37145 An error occurred.
37146 @end table
37147
37148 @item b @var{baud}
37149 @cindex @samp{b} packet
37150 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
37151 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
37152
37153 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
37154 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
37155 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
37156
37157 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
37158 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
37159 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
37160 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
37161 of view, nothing actually happened.}
37162
37163 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
37164 @cindex @samp{B} packet
37165 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
37166 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
37167
37168 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
37169 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
37170
37171 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
37172 @anchor{bc}
37173 @item bc
37174 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
37175 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37176
37177 Reply:
37178 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37179
37180 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
37181 @anchor{bs}
37182 @item bs
37183 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
37184 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37185
37186 Reply:
37187 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37188
37189 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37190 @cindex @samp{c} packet
37191 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
37192 is omitted, resume at current address.
37193
37194 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37195 packet}.
37196
37197 Reply:
37198 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37199
37200 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37201 @cindex @samp{C} packet
37202 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
37203 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
37204
37205 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37206 packet}.
37207
37208 Reply:
37209 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37210
37211 @item d
37212 @cindex @samp{d} packet
37213 Toggle debug flag.
37214
37215 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37216 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37217
37218 @item D
37219 @itemx D;@var{pid}
37220 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37221 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37222 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37223 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37224
37225 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37226 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37227 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37228 big-endian hex string.
37229
37230 Reply:
37231 @table @samp
37232 @item OK
37233 for success
37234 @item E @var{NN}
37235 for an error
37236 @end table
37237
37238 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37239 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37240 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37241 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37242 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37243
37244 @item g
37245 @anchor{read registers packet}
37246 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37247 Read general registers.
37248
37249 Reply:
37250 @table @samp
37251 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37252 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37253 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37254 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37255 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37256 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
37257
37258 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37259 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37260 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37261 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37262 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37263 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37264 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37265 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37266
37267 @smallexample
37268 -> @code{g}
37269 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37270 @end smallexample
37271
37272 @item E @var{NN}
37273 for an error.
37274 @end table
37275
37276 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37277 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37278 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37279 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37280
37281 Reply:
37282 @table @samp
37283 @item OK
37284 for success
37285 @item E @var{NN}
37286 for an error
37287 @end table
37288
37289 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37290 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37291 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37292 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37293 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37294 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37295 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37296 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37297 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37298
37299 Reply:
37300 @table @samp
37301 @item OK
37302 for success
37303 @item E @var{NN}
37304 for an error
37305 @end table
37306
37307 @c FIXME: JTC:
37308 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37309 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37310 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37311 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37312 @c described. For example:
37313 @c
37314 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37315 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37316 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37317 @c
37318 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37319 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37320 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37321
37322 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37323 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37324 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37325 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37326 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37327 step starting at that address.
37328
37329 @item I
37330 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37331 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37332 step packet}.
37333
37334 @item k
37335 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37336 Kill request.
37337
37338 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37339
37340 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37341 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37342
37343 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37344
37345 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37346 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37347 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37348
37349 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37350 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37351 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37352
37353 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37354 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37355 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37356 (@pxref{? packet}).
37357
37358 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37359 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37360 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37361 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37362 any particular boundary.
37363
37364 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37365 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37366 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37367 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37368 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37369 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37370 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37371 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37372
37373 Reply:
37374 @table @samp
37375 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37376 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37377 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37378 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37379 @item E @var{NN}
37380 @var{NN} is errno
37381 @end table
37382
37383 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37384 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37385 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37386 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37387 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37388
37389 Reply:
37390 @table @samp
37391 @item OK
37392 for success
37393 @item E @var{NN}
37394 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37395 written).
37396 @end table
37397
37398 @item p @var{n}
37399 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37400 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37401 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37402 register value is encoded.
37403
37404 Reply:
37405 @table @samp
37406 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37407 the register's value
37408 @item E @var{NN}
37409 for an error
37410 @item @w{}
37411 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37412 @end table
37413
37414 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37415 @anchor{write register packet}
37416 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37417 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37418 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37419 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37420
37421 Reply:
37422 @table @samp
37423 @item OK
37424 for success
37425 @item E @var{NN}
37426 for an error
37427 @end table
37428
37429 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37430 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37431 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37432 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37433 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37434 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37435
37436 @item r
37437 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37438 Reset the entire system.
37439
37440 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37441
37442 @item R @var{XX}
37443 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37444 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37445 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37446
37447 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37448
37449 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37450 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37451 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37452 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37453
37454 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37455 packet}.
37456
37457 Reply:
37458 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37459
37460 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37461 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37462 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37463 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37464 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37465
37466 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37467 packet}.
37468
37469 Reply:
37470 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37471
37472 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37473 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37474 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37475 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37476 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37477
37478 @item T @var{thread-id}
37479 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37480 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37481
37482 Reply:
37483 @table @samp
37484 @item OK
37485 thread is still alive
37486 @item E @var{NN}
37487 thread is dead
37488 @end table
37489
37490 @item v
37491 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37492 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37493
37494 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37495 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37496 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37497 The process ID is a
37498 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37499 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37500 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37501
37502 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37503 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37504 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37505 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37506 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37507 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37508 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37509 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37510
37511 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37512
37513 Reply:
37514 @table @samp
37515 @item E @var{nn}
37516 for an error
37517 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37518 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37519 @item OK
37520 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37521 @end table
37522
37523 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37524 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37525 @anchor{vCont packet}
37526 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37527
37528 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37529 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37530 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37531 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37532 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37533 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37534 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37535 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37536 error.
37537
37538 Currently supported actions are:
37539
37540 @table @samp
37541 @item c
37542 Continue.
37543 @item C @var{sig}
37544 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37545 @item s
37546 Step.
37547 @item S @var{sig}
37548 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37549 @item t
37550 Stop.
37551 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37552 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37553 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37554 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37555 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37556 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37557
37558 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37559 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37560 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37561 jumps to @var{start}).
37562
37563 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37564 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37565 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37566
37567 @end table
37568
37569 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37570 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37571 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37572
37573 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37574 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37575 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37576 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37577 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37578 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37579 as an implementation detail.
37580
37581 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37582 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37583 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37584 stopped.
37585
37586 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37587 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37588 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37589
37590 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37591 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37592
37593 Reply:
37594 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37595
37596 @item vCont?
37597 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37598 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37599
37600 Reply:
37601 @table @samp
37602 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37603 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37604 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37605 @item @w{}
37606 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37607 @end table
37608
37609 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37610 @item vCtrlC
37611 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37612 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37613 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37614 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37615 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37616 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37617 variant.
37618
37619 Reply:
37620 @table @samp
37621 @item E @var{nn}
37622 for an error
37623 @item OK
37624 for success
37625 @end table
37626
37627 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37628 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37629 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37630 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37631
37632 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37633 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37634 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37635 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37636 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37637 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37638 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37639 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37640 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37641 packet is received.
37642
37643 Reply:
37644 @table @samp
37645 @item OK
37646 for success
37647 @item E @var{NN}
37648 for an error
37649 @end table
37650
37651 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37652 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37653 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37654 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37655 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37656 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37657 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37658 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37659 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37660 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37661 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37662 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37663
37664
37665 Reply:
37666 @table @samp
37667 @item OK
37668 for success
37669 @item E.memtype
37670 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37671 @item E @var{NN}
37672 for an error
37673 @end table
37674
37675 @item vFlashDone
37676 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37677 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37678 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37679 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37680 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37681 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37682 request is completed.
37683
37684 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37685 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37686 @anchor{vKill packet}
37687 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37688 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37689 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37690 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37691
37692 Reply:
37693 @table @samp
37694 @item E @var{nn}
37695 for an error
37696 @item OK
37697 for success
37698 @end table
37699
37700 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37701 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37702 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37703 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37704 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37705
37706 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37707 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37708 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37709 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37710 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37711 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37712
37713 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37714 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37715 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37716 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37717 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37718 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37719 state.
37720
37721 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37722
37723 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37724
37725 Reply:
37726 @table @samp
37727 @item E @var{nn}
37728 for an error
37729 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37730 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37731 @end table
37732
37733 @item vStopped
37734 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37735 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37736
37737 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37738 @anchor{X packet}
37739 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37740 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37741 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37742 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37743 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37744
37745 Reply:
37746 @table @samp
37747 @item OK
37748 for success
37749 @item E @var{NN}
37750 for an error
37751 @end table
37752
37753 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37754 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37755 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37756 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37757 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37758 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37759 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37760
37761 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37762 separately.
37763
37764 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37765 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37766 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37767 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37768 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37769 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37770
37771 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37772 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37773 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37774 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37775 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37776 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37777
37778 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37779 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37780 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37781 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37782 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37783 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37784 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37785 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37786 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37787 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37788 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37789 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37790 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37791
37792 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37793 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37794
37795 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37796 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37797
37798 @table @samp
37799
37800 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37801 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37802 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37803
37804 @end table
37805
37806 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37807 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37808 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37809 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37810 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37811 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37812 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37813
37814 @table @samp
37815
37816 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37817 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37818 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37819
37820 @end table
37821
37822 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37823 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37824 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37825 target, is not defined.}
37826
37827 Reply:
37828 @table @samp
37829 @item OK
37830 success
37831 @item @w{}
37832 not supported
37833 @item E @var{NN}
37834 for an error
37835 @end table
37836
37837 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37838 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37839 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37840 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37841 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37842 address @var{addr}.
37843
37844 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37845 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37846 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37847 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37848
37849 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37850 movement.}
37851
37852 Reply:
37853 @table @samp
37854 @item OK
37855 success
37856 @item @w{}
37857 not supported
37858 @item E @var{NN}
37859 for an error
37860 @end table
37861
37862 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37863 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37864 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37865 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37866 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37867 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37868
37869 Reply:
37870 @table @samp
37871 @item OK
37872 success
37873 @item @w{}
37874 not supported
37875 @item E @var{NN}
37876 for an error
37877 @end table
37878
37879 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37880 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37881 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37882 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37883 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37884 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37885
37886 Reply:
37887 @table @samp
37888 @item OK
37889 success
37890 @item @w{}
37891 not supported
37892 @item E @var{NN}
37893 for an error
37894 @end table
37895
37896 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37897 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37898 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37899 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37900 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37901 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37902
37903 Reply:
37904 @table @samp
37905 @item OK
37906 success
37907 @item @w{}
37908 not supported
37909 @item E @var{NN}
37910 for an error
37911 @end table
37912
37913 @end table
37914
37915 @node Stop Reply Packets
37916 @section Stop Reply Packets
37917 @cindex stop reply packets
37918
37919 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37920 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37921 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37922 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37923 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37924 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37925 @value{GDBN} source code.
37926
37927 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37928 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37929 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37930
37931 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37932 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37933 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37934 components.
37935
37936 @table @samp
37937
37938 @item S @var{AA}
37939 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37940 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37941 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37942
37943 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37944 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37945 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37946 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37947 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37948 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37949 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37950 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37951
37952 @itemize @bullet
37953 @item
37954 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37955 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37956 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37957 two-digit hex number.
37958
37959 @item
37960 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37961 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37962
37963 @item
37964 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37965 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37966
37967 @item
37968 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37969 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37970 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37971 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37972
37973 @item
37974 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37975 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37976 future.
37977 @end itemize
37978
37979 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37980
37981 @table @samp
37982 @item watch
37983 @itemx rwatch
37984 @itemx awatch
37985 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37986 hex.
37987
37988 @item syscall_entry
37989 @itemx syscall_return
37990 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37991 syscall number, in hex.
37992
37993 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37994 @item library
37995 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37996 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37997 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37998
37999 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
38000 @item replaylog
38001 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
38002 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
38003 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
38004 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
38005 for more information.
38006
38007 @item swbreak
38008 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
38009 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
38010 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
38011 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
38012 part must be left empty.
38013
38014 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
38015 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
38016 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
38017 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
38018 address.
38019
38020 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38021 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38022 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38023 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38024 indicating support.
38025
38026 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
38027
38028 @item hwbreak
38029 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
38030 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
38031
38032 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
38033 apply.
38034
38035 @cindex fork events, remote reply
38036 @item fork
38037 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
38038 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38039 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38040 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38041 fork events.
38042
38043 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38044 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38045 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38046 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38047 indicating support.
38048
38049 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
38050 @item vfork
38051 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
38052 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38053 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38054 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38055 vfork events.
38056
38057 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38058 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38059 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38060 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38061 indicating support.
38062
38063 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
38064 @item vforkdone
38065 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
38066 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
38067 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
38068 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
38069 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
38070
38071 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38072 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38073 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38074 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38075 indicating support.
38076
38077 @cindex exec events, remote reply
38078 @item exec
38079 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
38080 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
38081 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
38082
38083 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38084 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38085 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38086 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38087 indicating support.
38088
38089 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
38090 @anchor{thread create event}
38091 @item create
38092 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
38093 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
38094 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
38095 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
38096 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
38097 @var{r} part is ignored.
38098
38099 @end table
38100
38101 @item W @var{AA}
38102 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38103 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
38104 applicable to certain targets.
38105
38106 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38107 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38108 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38109 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38110 hex strings.
38111
38112 @item X @var{AA}
38113 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38114 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
38115
38116 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38117 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38118 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38119 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38120 hex strings.
38121
38122 @anchor{thread exit event}
38123 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
38124 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
38125
38126 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
38127 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
38128 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
38129 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
38130
38131 @item N
38132 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
38133 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
38134 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
38135 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
38136 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
38137 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
38138 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
38139 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
38140 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
38141 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
38142 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
38143 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
38144 support.
38145
38146 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
38147 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
38148 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
38149 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
38150 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
38151
38152 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
38153 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
38154 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
38155 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
38156 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
38157 system calls.
38158
38159 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
38160 this very system call.
38161
38162 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
38163 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
38164 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
38165 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38166 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
38167 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
38168
38169 @end table
38170
38171 @node General Query Packets
38172 @section General Query Packets
38173 @cindex remote query requests
38174
38175 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
38176 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
38177 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
38178 sending information to and from the stub.
38179
38180 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
38181 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
38182 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
38183 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
38184 conventions:
38185
38186 @itemize @bullet
38187 @item
38188 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
38189 @item
38190 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
38191 letter.
38192 @item
38193 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
38194 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
38195 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
38196 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
38197 @end itemize
38198
38199 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
38200 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
38201 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
38202 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
38203 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
38204 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
38205 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
38206 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
38207 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
38208 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
38209 packet.}.
38210
38211 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
38212 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38213 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38214 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38215 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38216
38217 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38218
38219 @table @samp
38220
38221 @item QAgent:1
38222 @itemx QAgent:0
38223 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38224 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38225
38226 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38227 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38228 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38229 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38230 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38231 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38232 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38233 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38234 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38235 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38236 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38237
38238 @item qC
38239 @cindex current thread, remote request
38240 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38241 Return the current thread ID.
38242
38243 Reply:
38244 @table @samp
38245 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38246 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38247 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38248 @item @r{(anything else)}
38249 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38250 @end table
38251
38252 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38253 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38254 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38255 @anchor{qCRC packet}
38256 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38257 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38258 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38259 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38260
38261 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38262 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38263 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38264 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38265 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38266 detect trailing zeros.
38267
38268 Reply:
38269 @table @samp
38270 @item E @var{NN}
38271 An error (such as memory fault)
38272 @item C @var{crc32}
38273 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38274 @end table
38275
38276 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38277 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38278 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38279 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38280 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38281 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38282 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38283 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38284 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38285 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38286 randomization.
38287
38288 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38289
38290 Reply:
38291 @table @samp
38292 @item OK
38293 The request succeeded.
38294
38295 @item E @var{nn}
38296 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38297
38298 @item @w{}
38299 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38300 by the stub.
38301 @end table
38302
38303 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38304 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38305 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38306 address space randomization.
38307
38308 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38309 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38310 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38311 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38312 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38313 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38314 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38315 inferior using a shell or not.
38316
38317 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38318 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38319 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38320 values are considered an error.
38321
38322 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38323 mode}).
38324
38325 Reply:
38326 @table @samp
38327 @item OK
38328 The request succeeded.
38329
38330 @item E @var{nn}
38331 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38332 @end table
38333
38334 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38335 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38336 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38337 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38338
38339 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38340 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38341
38342 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38343 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38344 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38345 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38346 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38347 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38348 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38349 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38350 environment}).
38351
38352 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38353 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38354 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38355 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38356 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38357 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38358 not be present.
38359
38360 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38361 mode}).
38362
38363 Reply:
38364 @table @samp
38365 @item OK
38366 The request succeeded.
38367 @end table
38368
38369 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38370 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38371 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38372 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38373 inferior.
38374
38375 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38376 @pxref{set environment}.
38377
38378 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38379 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38380 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38381 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38382 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38383 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38384 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38385 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38386
38387 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38388 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38389
38390 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38391 mode}).
38392
38393 Reply:
38394 @table @samp
38395 @item OK
38396 The request succeeded.
38397 @end table
38398
38399 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38400 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38401 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38402 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38403 inferior.
38404
38405 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38406 @pxref{unset environment}.
38407
38408 @item QEnvironmentReset
38409 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38410 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38411 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38412 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38413 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38414 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38415 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38416 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38417 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38418 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38419 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38420
38421 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38422 mode}).
38423
38424 Reply:
38425 @table @samp
38426 @item OK
38427 The request succeeded.
38428 @end table
38429
38430 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38431 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38432 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38433 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38434 inferior.
38435
38436 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38437 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38438 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38439 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38440 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38441 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38442
38443 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38444 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38445 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38446 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38447 directory to its original, empty value.
38448
38449 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38450 mode}).
38451
38452 Reply:
38453 @table @samp
38454 @item OK
38455 The request succeeded.
38456 @end table
38457
38458 @item qfThreadInfo
38459 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38460 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38461 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38462 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38463 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38464 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38465 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38466 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38467 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38468 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38469
38470 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38471
38472 Reply:
38473 @table @samp
38474 @item m @var{thread-id}
38475 A single thread ID
38476 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38477 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38478 @item l
38479 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38480 @end table
38481
38482 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38483 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38484 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38485 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38486 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38487 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38488 fields.
38489
38490 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38491 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38492 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38493 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38494 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38495
38496 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38497 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38498 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38499 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38500 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38501
38502 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38503 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38504
38505 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38506 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38507 information associated with the variable.)
38508
38509 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38510 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38511 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38512 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38513 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38514 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38515
38516 Reply:
38517 @table @samp
38518 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38519 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38520 local storage requested.
38521
38522 @item E @var{nn}
38523 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38524
38525 @item @w{}
38526 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38527 @end table
38528
38529 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38530 @cindex get thread information block address
38531 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38532 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38533
38534 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38535
38536 Reply:
38537 @table @samp
38538 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38539 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38540 thread information block.
38541
38542 @item E @var{nn}
38543 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38544 address could not be retrieved.
38545
38546 @item @w{}
38547 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38548 @end table
38549
38550 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38551 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38552 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38553 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38554 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38555 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38556 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38557
38558 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38559
38560 Reply:
38561 @table @samp
38562 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38563 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38564 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38565 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38566 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38567 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38568 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38569 @end table
38570
38571 @item qOffsets
38572 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38573 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38574 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38575 image.
38576
38577 Reply:
38578 @table @samp
38579 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38580 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38581 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38582 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38583 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38584 segments by the supplied offsets.
38585
38586 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38587 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38588 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38589
38590 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38591 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38592 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38593 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38594 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38595 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38596 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38597 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38598 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38599 @end table
38600
38601 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38602 @cindex thread information, remote request
38603 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38604 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38605 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38606 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38607
38608 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38609 (see below).
38610
38611 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38612
38613 @item QNonStop:1
38614 @itemx QNonStop:0
38615 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38616 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38617 @anchor{QNonStop}
38618 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38619 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38620
38621 Reply:
38622 @table @samp
38623 @item OK
38624 The request succeeded.
38625
38626 @item E @var{nn}
38627 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38628
38629 @item @w{}
38630 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38631 the stub.
38632 @end table
38633
38634 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38635 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38636 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38637 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38638
38639 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38640 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38641 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38642 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38643 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38644 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38645 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38646
38647 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38648 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38649 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38650
38651 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38652 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38653 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38654 report the requested syscalls.
38655
38656 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38657 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38658
38659 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38660 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38661 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38662 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38663
38664 Reply:
38665 @table @samp
38666 @item OK
38667 The request succeeded.
38668
38669 @item E @var{nn}
38670 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38671
38672 @item @w{}
38673 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38674 the stub.
38675 @end table
38676
38677 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38678 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38679 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38680 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38681
38682 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38683 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38684 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38685 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38686 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38687 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38688 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38689 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38690 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38691 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38692 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38693 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38694 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38695
38696 Reply:
38697 @table @samp
38698 @item OK
38699 The request succeeded.
38700
38701 @item E @var{nn}
38702 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38703
38704 @item @w{}
38705 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38706 the stub.
38707 @end table
38708
38709 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38710 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38711 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38712 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38713
38714 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38715 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38716 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38717 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38718 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38719 Others should be silently discarded.
38720
38721 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38722 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38723 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38724 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38725 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38726 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38727 signals.
38728
38729 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38730 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38731
38732 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38733 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38734 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38735 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38736 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38737
38738 Reply:
38739 @table @samp
38740 @item OK
38741 The request succeeded.
38742
38743 @item E @var{nn}
38744 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38745
38746 @item @w{}
38747 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38748 by the stub.
38749 @end table
38750
38751 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38752 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38753 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38754 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38755
38756 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38757 @item QThreadEvents:1
38758 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38759 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38760 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38761
38762 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38763 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38764 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38765 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38766 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38767 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38768 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38769 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38770 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38771 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38772
38773 Reply:
38774 @table @samp
38775 @item OK
38776 The request succeeded.
38777
38778 @item E @var{nn}
38779 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38780
38781 @item @w{}
38782 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38783 the stub.
38784 @end table
38785
38786 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38787 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38788
38789 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38790 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38791 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38792 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38793 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38794 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38795 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38796 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38797 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38798
38799 Reply:
38800 @table @samp
38801 @item OK
38802 A command response with no output.
38803 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38804 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38805 @item E @var{NN}
38806 Indicate a badly formed request.
38807 @item @w{}
38808 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38809 @end table
38810
38811 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38812 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38813 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38814 packets.)
38815
38816 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38817 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38818 @ifnotinfo
38819 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38820 @end ifnotinfo
38821 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38822 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38823 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38824 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38825 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38826
38827 Reply:
38828 @table @samp
38829 @item 0
38830 The pattern was not found.
38831 @item 1,address
38832 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38833 @item E @var{NN}
38834 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38835 @item @w{}
38836 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38837 @end table
38838
38839 @item QStartNoAckMode
38840 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38841 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38842 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38843 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38844
38845 Reply:
38846 @table @samp
38847 @item OK
38848 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38849 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38850 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38851 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38852 @item @w{}
38853 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38854 @end table
38855
38856 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38857 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38858 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38859 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38860 @anchor{qSupported}
38861 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38862 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38863 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38864 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38865 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38866 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38867 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38868 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38869 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38870 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38871 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38872 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38873 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38874 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38875
38876 Reply:
38877 @table @samp
38878 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38879 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38880 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38881 possible forms).
38882 @item @w{}
38883 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38884 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38885 @end table
38886
38887 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38888 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38889 are:
38890
38891 @table @samp
38892 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38893 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38894 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38895 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38896 @item @var{name}+
38897 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38898 need an associated value.
38899 @item @var{name}-
38900 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38901 @item @var{name}?
38902 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38903 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38904 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38905 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38906 @end table
38907
38908 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38909 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38910 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38911 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38912 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38913
38914 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38915 are defined:
38916
38917 @table @samp
38918 @item multiprocess
38919 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38920 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38921 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38922 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38923 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38924
38925 @item xmlRegisters
38926 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38927 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38928 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38929 description.
38930
38931 @item qRelocInsn
38932 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38933 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38934 instruction reply packet}).
38935
38936 @item swbreak
38937 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38938 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38939
38940 @item hwbreak
38941 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38942 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38943
38944 @item fork-events
38945 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38946 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38947 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38948 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38949
38950 @item vfork-events
38951 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38952 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38953 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38954 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38955
38956 @item exec-events
38957 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38958 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38959 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38960 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38961
38962 @item vContSupported
38963 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38964 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38965 @end table
38966
38967 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38968 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38969 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38970 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38971 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38972 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38973 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38974 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38975 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38976 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38977 all the features it supports.
38978
38979 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38980 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38981
38982 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38983 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38984 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38985 form response.
38986
38987 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38988 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38989 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38990 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38991
38992 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38993 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38994 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38995 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38996 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38997
38998 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38999
39000 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
39001 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
39002 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
39003 @item Feature Name
39004 @tab Value Required
39005 @tab Default
39006 @tab Probe Allowed
39007
39008 @item @samp{PacketSize}
39009 @tab Yes
39010 @tab @samp{-}
39011 @tab No
39012
39013 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
39014 @tab No
39015 @tab @samp{-}
39016 @tab Yes
39017
39018 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39019 @tab No
39020 @tab @samp{-}
39021 @tab Yes
39022
39023 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39024 @tab No
39025 @tab @samp{-}
39026 @tab Yes
39027
39028 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
39029 @tab No
39030 @tab @samp{-}
39031 @tab Yes
39032
39033 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
39034 @tab No
39035 @tab @samp{-}
39036 @tab Yes
39037
39038 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39039 @tab No
39040 @tab @samp{-}
39041 @tab Yes
39042
39043 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
39044 @tab No
39045 @tab @samp{-}
39046 @tab Yes
39047
39048 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
39049 @tab No
39050 @tab @samp{-}
39051 @tab No
39052
39053 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39054 @tab No
39055 @tab @samp{-}
39056 @tab Yes
39057
39058 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
39059 @tab No
39060 @tab @samp{-}
39061 @tab Yes
39062
39063 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
39064 @tab No
39065 @tab @samp{-}
39066 @tab Yes
39067
39068 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
39069 @tab No
39070 @tab @samp{-}
39071 @tab Yes
39072
39073 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
39074 @tab No
39075 @tab @samp{-}
39076 @tab Yes
39077
39078 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
39079 @tab No
39080 @tab @samp{-}
39081 @tab Yes
39082
39083 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
39084 @tab No
39085 @tab @samp{-}
39086 @tab Yes
39087
39088 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39089 @tab No
39090 @tab @samp{-}
39091 @tab Yes
39092
39093 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39094 @tab No
39095 @tab @samp{-}
39096 @tab Yes
39097
39098 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39099 @tab No
39100 @tab @samp{-}
39101 @tab Yes
39102
39103 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
39104 @tab Yes
39105 @tab @samp{-}
39106 @tab Yes
39107
39108 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
39109 @tab Yes
39110 @tab @samp{-}
39111 @tab Yes
39112
39113 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
39114 @tab Yes
39115 @tab @samp{-}
39116 @tab Yes
39117
39118 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
39119 @tab Yes
39120 @tab @samp{-}
39121 @tab Yes
39122
39123 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
39124 @tab Yes
39125 @tab @samp{-}
39126 @tab Yes
39127
39128 @item @samp{QNonStop}
39129 @tab No
39130 @tab @samp{-}
39131 @tab Yes
39132
39133 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
39134 @tab No
39135 @tab @samp{-}
39136 @tab Yes
39137
39138 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
39139 @tab No
39140 @tab @samp{-}
39141 @tab Yes
39142
39143 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
39144 @tab No
39145 @tab @samp{-}
39146 @tab Yes
39147
39148 @item @samp{multiprocess}
39149 @tab No
39150 @tab @samp{-}
39151 @tab No
39152
39153 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
39154 @tab No
39155 @tab @samp{-}
39156 @tab No
39157
39158 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
39159 @tab No
39160 @tab @samp{-}
39161 @tab No
39162
39163 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
39164 @tab No
39165 @tab @samp{-}
39166 @tab No
39167
39168 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
39169 @tab No
39170 @tab @samp{-}
39171 @tab No
39172
39173 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
39174 @tab No
39175 @tab @samp{-}
39176 @tab No
39177
39178 @item @samp{QAgent}
39179 @tab No
39180 @tab @samp{-}
39181 @tab No
39182
39183 @item @samp{QAllow}
39184 @tab No
39185 @tab @samp{-}
39186 @tab No
39187
39188 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
39189 @tab No
39190 @tab @samp{-}
39191 @tab No
39192
39193 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
39194 @tab No
39195 @tab @samp{-}
39196 @tab No
39197
39198 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
39199 @tab No
39200 @tab @samp{-}
39201 @tab No
39202
39203 @item @samp{tracenz}
39204 @tab No
39205 @tab @samp{-}
39206 @tab No
39207
39208 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
39209 @tab No
39210 @tab @samp{-}
39211 @tab No
39212
39213 @item @samp{swbreak}
39214 @tab No
39215 @tab @samp{-}
39216 @tab No
39217
39218 @item @samp{hwbreak}
39219 @tab No
39220 @tab @samp{-}
39221 @tab No
39222
39223 @item @samp{fork-events}
39224 @tab No
39225 @tab @samp{-}
39226 @tab No
39227
39228 @item @samp{vfork-events}
39229 @tab No
39230 @tab @samp{-}
39231 @tab No
39232
39233 @item @samp{exec-events}
39234 @tab No
39235 @tab @samp{-}
39236 @tab No
39237
39238 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
39239 @tab No
39240 @tab @samp{-}
39241 @tab No
39242
39243 @item @samp{no-resumed}
39244 @tab No
39245 @tab @samp{-}
39246 @tab No
39247
39248 @end multitable
39249
39250 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39251
39252 @table @samp
39253 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39254 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39255 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39256 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39257 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39258 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39259 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39260 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39261 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39262 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39263
39264 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39265 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39266 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39267
39268 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39269 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39270 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39271
39272 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39273 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39274 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39275
39276 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39277 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39278 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39279
39280 @item qXfer:features:read
39281 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39282 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39283
39284 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39285 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39286 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39287
39288 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39289 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39290 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39291
39292 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39293 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39294 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39295 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39296
39297 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39298 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39299 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39300
39301 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39302 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39303 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39304
39305 @item qXfer:spu:read
39306 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39307 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39308
39309 @item qXfer:spu:write
39310 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39311 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39312
39313 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39314 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39315 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39316
39317 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39318 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39319 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39320
39321 @item qXfer:threads:read
39322 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39323 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39324
39325 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39326 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39327 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39328
39329 @item qXfer:uib:read
39330 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39331 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39332
39333 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39334 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39335 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39336
39337 @item QNonStop
39338 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39339 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39340
39341 @item QCatchSyscalls
39342 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39343 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39344
39345 @item QPassSignals
39346 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39347 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39348
39349 @item QStartNoAckMode
39350 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39351 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39352
39353 @item multiprocess
39354 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39355 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39356 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39357 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39358 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39359 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39360 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39361 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39362 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39363 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39364 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39365
39366 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39367 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39368 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39369
39370 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39371 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39372 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39373 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39374
39375 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39376 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39377 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39378
39379 @item ReverseContinue
39380 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39381 (@pxref{bc}).
39382
39383 @item ReverseStep
39384 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39385 (@pxref{bs}).
39386
39387 @item TracepointSource
39388 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39389 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39390
39391 @item QAgent
39392 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39393
39394 @item QAllow
39395 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39396
39397 @item QDisableRandomization
39398 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39399
39400 @item StaticTracepoint
39401 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39402 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39403
39404 @item InstallInTrace
39405 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39406 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39407
39408 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39409 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39410 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39411 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39412
39413 @item QTBuffer:size
39414 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39415 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39416
39417 @item tracenz
39418 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39419 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39420 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39421
39422 @item BreakpointCommands
39423 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39424 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39425 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39426
39427 @item Qbtrace:off
39428 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39429
39430 @item Qbtrace:bts
39431 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39432
39433 @item Qbtrace:pt
39434 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39435
39436 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39437 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39438
39439 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39440 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39441
39442 @item swbreak
39443 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39444 breakpoints.
39445
39446 @item hwbreak
39447 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39448 breakpoints.
39449
39450 @item fork-events
39451 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39452
39453 @item vfork-events
39454 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39455 and vforkdone events.
39456
39457 @item exec-events
39458 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39459
39460 @item vContSupported
39461 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39462 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39463
39464 @item QThreadEvents
39465 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39466
39467 @item no-resumed
39468 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39469
39470 @end table
39471
39472 @item qSymbol::
39473 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39474 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39475 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39476 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39477
39478 Reply:
39479 @table @samp
39480 @item OK
39481 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39482 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39483 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39484 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39485 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39486 below.
39487 @end table
39488
39489 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39490 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39491
39492 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39493 target has previously requested.
39494
39495 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39496 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39497 will be empty.
39498
39499 Reply:
39500 @table @samp
39501 @item OK
39502 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39503 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39504 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39505 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39506 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39507 @end table
39508
39509 @item qTBuffer
39510 @itemx QTBuffer
39511 @itemx QTDisconnected
39512 @itemx QTDP
39513 @itemx QTDPsrc
39514 @itemx QTDV
39515 @itemx qTfP
39516 @itemx qTfV
39517 @itemx QTFrame
39518 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39519
39520 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39521
39522 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39523 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39524 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39525 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39526 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39527 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39528 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39529 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39530 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39531 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39532 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39533
39534 Reply:
39535 @table @samp
39536 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39537 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39538 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39539 the thread's attributes.
39540 @end table
39541
39542 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39543 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39544 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39545 packets.)
39546
39547 @item QTNotes
39548 @itemx qTP
39549 @itemx QTSave
39550 @itemx qTsP
39551 @itemx qTsV
39552 @itemx QTStart
39553 @itemx QTStop
39554 @itemx QTEnable
39555 @itemx QTDisable
39556 @itemx QTinit
39557 @itemx QTro
39558 @itemx qTStatus
39559 @itemx qTV
39560 @itemx qTfSTM
39561 @itemx qTsSTM
39562 @itemx qTSTMat
39563 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39564
39565 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39566 @cindex read special object, remote request
39567 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39568 @anchor{qXfer read}
39569 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39570 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39571 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39572 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39573 additional details about what data to access.
39574
39575 Reply:
39576 @table @samp
39577 @item m @var{data}
39578 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39579 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39580 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39581 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39582 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39583 request.
39584
39585 @item l @var{data}
39586 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39587 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39588 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39589
39590 @item l
39591 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39592 There is no more data to be read.
39593
39594 @item E00
39595 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39596
39597 @item E @var{nn}
39598 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39599 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39600
39601 @item @w{}
39602 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39603 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39604 @end table
39605
39606 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39607 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39608 formats, listed above.
39609
39610 @table @samp
39611 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39612 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39613 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39614 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39615
39616 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39617 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39618
39619 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39620 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39621
39622 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39623 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39624 packet may have one of the following values:
39625
39626 @table @code
39627 @item all
39628 Returns all available branch trace.
39629
39630 @item new
39631 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39632 the last read request.
39633
39634 @item delta
39635 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39636 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39637 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39638 used to stitch traces together.
39639
39640 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39641 @end table
39642
39643 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39644 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39645
39646 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39647 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39648
39649 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39650 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39651
39652 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39653 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39654
39655 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39656 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39657 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39658 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39659 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39660 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39661 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39662
39663 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39664 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39665
39666 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39667 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39668 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39669 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39670 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39671
39672 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39673 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39674
39675 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39676 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39677 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39678 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39679 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39680
39681 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39682 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39683 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39684
39685 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39686 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39687
39688 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39689 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39690 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39691 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39692 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39693 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39694 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39695 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39696
39697 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39698 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39699
39700 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39701 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39702
39703 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39704 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39705 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39706 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39707
39708 @table @code
39709 @item start=@var{address}
39710 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39711 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39712 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39713 chosen as the starting point.
39714
39715 @item prev=@var{address}
39716 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39717 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39718 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39719 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39720 exists prior to the starting point.
39721
39722 @end table
39723
39724 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39725 ignored.
39726
39727 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39728 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39729 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39730 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39731 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39732
39733 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39734 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39735
39736 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39737 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39738
39739 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39740 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39741 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39742 Action Lists}.
39743
39744 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39745 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39746 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39747
39748 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39749 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39750 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39751 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39752 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39753
39754 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39755 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39756 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39757
39758 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39759 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39760 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39761 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39762 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39763 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39764 in that context to be accessed.
39765
39766 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39767 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39768 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39769
39770 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39771 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39772 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39773 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39774 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39775
39776 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39777 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39778
39779 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39780 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39781
39782 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39783 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39784 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39785
39786 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39787 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39788
39789 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39790 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39791
39792 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39793 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39794
39795 This packet is not probed by default.
39796
39797 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39798 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39799 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39800 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39801 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39802
39803 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39804 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39805
39806 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39807 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39808 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39809 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39810
39811 @end table
39812
39813 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39814 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39815 @anchor{qXfer write}
39816 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39817 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39818 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39819 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39820 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39821 to access.
39822
39823 Reply:
39824 @table @samp
39825 @item @var{nn}
39826 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39827 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39828
39829 @item E00
39830 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39831
39832 @item E @var{nn}
39833 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39834 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39835
39836 @item @w{}
39837 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39838 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39839 @end table
39840
39841 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39842 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39843 formats, listed above.
39844
39845 @table @samp
39846 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39847 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39848 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39849 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39850 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39851
39852 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39853 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39854 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39855
39856 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39857 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39858 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39859 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39860 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39861 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39862 in that context to be accessed.
39863
39864 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39865 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39866 @end table
39867
39868 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39869 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39870 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39871 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39872 must respond with an empty packet.
39873
39874 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39875 @cindex query attached, remote request
39876 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39877 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39878 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39879 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39880 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39881 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39882 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39883
39884 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39885 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39886 the @code{quit} command.
39887
39888 Reply:
39889 @table @samp
39890 @item 1
39891 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39892 @item 0
39893 The remote server created a new process.
39894 @item E @var{NN}
39895 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39896 @end table
39897
39898 @item Qbtrace:bts
39899 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39900
39901 Reply:
39902 @table @samp
39903 @item OK
39904 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39905 @item E.errtext
39906 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39907 @end table
39908
39909 @item Qbtrace:pt
39910 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39911
39912 Reply:
39913 @table @samp
39914 @item OK
39915 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39916 @item E.errtext
39917 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39918 @end table
39919
39920 @item Qbtrace:off
39921 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39922
39923 Reply:
39924 @table @samp
39925 @item OK
39926 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39927 @item E.errtext
39928 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39929 @end table
39930
39931 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39932 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39933 btrace recording method in bts format.
39934
39935 Reply:
39936 @table @samp
39937 @item OK
39938 The ring buffer size has been set.
39939 @item E.errtext
39940 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39941 @end table
39942
39943 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39944 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39945 btrace recording method in pt format.
39946
39947 Reply:
39948 @table @samp
39949 @item OK
39950 The ring buffer size has been set.
39951 @item E.errtext
39952 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39953 @end table
39954
39955 @end table
39956
39957 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39958 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39959
39960 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39961 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39962 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39963
39964 @menu
39965 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39966 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39967 @end menu
39968
39969 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39970 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39971
39972 @menu
39973 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39974 @end menu
39975
39976 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39977 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39978 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39979
39980 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39981
39982 @table @r
39983
39984 @item 2
39985 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39986
39987 @item 3
39988 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39989
39990 @item 4
39991 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39992
39993 @end table
39994
39995 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39996 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39997
39998 @menu
39999 * MIPS Register packet Format::
40000 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
40001 @end menu
40002
40003 @node MIPS Register packet Format
40004 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
40005 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
40006
40007 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
40008 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
40009 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
40010 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
40011 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
40012 most-significant -- least-significant.
40013
40014 @table @r
40015
40016 @item MIPS32
40017 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
40018 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
40019 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
40020
40021 @item MIPS64
40022 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
40023 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
40024 as @code{MIPS32}.
40025
40026 @end table
40027
40028 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
40029 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
40030 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
40031
40032 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40033
40034 @table @r
40035
40036 @item 2
40037 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
40038
40039 @item 3
40040 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40041
40042 @item 4
40043 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
40044
40045 @item 5
40046 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40047
40048 @end table
40049
40050 @node Tracepoint Packets
40051 @section Tracepoint Packets
40052 @cindex tracepoint packets
40053 @cindex packets, tracepoint
40054
40055 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
40056 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
40057
40058 @table @samp
40059
40060 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
40061 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
40062 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
40063 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
40064 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
40065 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
40066 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
40067 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
40068 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
40069 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
40070 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
40071 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
40072 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
40073 actions.
40074
40075 Replies:
40076 @table @samp
40077 @item OK
40078 The packet was understood and carried out.
40079 @item qRelocInsn
40080 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40081 @item @w{}
40082 The packet was not recognized.
40083 @end table
40084
40085 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
40086 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
40087 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
40088 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
40089 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
40090 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
40091 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
40092
40093 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
40094 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
40095 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
40096 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
40097 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
40098 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
40099 tracepoint actions.
40100
40101 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
40102 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
40103 following forms:
40104
40105 @table @samp
40106
40107 @item R @var{mask}
40108 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
40109 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
40110 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
40111 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
40112 not fit in a 32-bit word.
40113
40114 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
40115 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
40116 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
40117 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
40118 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
40119 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
40120 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
40121
40122 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40123 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
40124 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
40125 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
40126 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
40127 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
40128 packet).
40129
40130 @end table
40131
40132 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
40133 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
40134 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
40135 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
40136 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
40137 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
40138 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
40139 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
40140
40141 Replies:
40142 @table @samp
40143 @item OK
40144 The packet was understood and carried out.
40145 @item qRelocInsn
40146 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40147 @item @w{}
40148 The packet was not recognized.
40149 @end table
40150
40151 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
40152 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
40153 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
40154 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
40155 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
40156 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
40157 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
40158 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
40159
40160 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
40161 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
40162 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
40163 fit in a single packet.
40164 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
40165 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
40166
40167 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
40168 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
40169 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
40170 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
40171
40172 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
40173 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
40174 query packets.
40175
40176 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
40177 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
40178 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
40179 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
40180 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
40181 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
40182 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
40183 be found.
40184
40185 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
40186 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
40187 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
40188 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
40189 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
40190 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
40191 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
40192 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
40193 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
40194 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
40195 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
40196 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
40197 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
40198 variable.
40199
40200 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
40201 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
40202 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
40203 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
40204 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
40205
40206 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
40207 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
40208 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
40209 one of the following forms:
40210
40211 @table @samp
40212 @item F @var{f}
40213 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40214 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40215 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40216
40217 @item T @var{t}
40218 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40219 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40220
40221 @end table
40222
40223 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40224 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40225 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40226 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40227
40228 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40229 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40230 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40231 is a hexadecimal number.
40232
40233 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40234 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40235 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40236 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40237 numbers.
40238
40239 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40240 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40241 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40242
40243 @item qTMinFTPILen
40244 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40245 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40246 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40247 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40248 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40249 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40250 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40251 arrange for that.
40252
40253 Replies:
40254
40255 @table @samp
40256 @item 0
40257 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40258 @item @var{length}
40259 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
40260 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
40261 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
40262 regardless of size.
40263 @item E
40264 An error has occurred.
40265 @item @w{}
40266 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40267 @end table
40268
40269 @item QTStart
40270 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40271 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40272 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40273 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40274 instruction reply packet}).
40275
40276 @item QTStop
40277 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40278 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40279
40280 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40281 @anchor{QTEnable}
40282 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40283 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40284 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40285 of data from it will resume.
40286
40287 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40288 @anchor{QTDisable}
40289 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40290 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40291 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40292 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40293
40294 @item QTinit
40295 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40296 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40297
40298 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40299 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40300 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40301 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40302 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40303
40304 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40305 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40306 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40307 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40308
40309 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40310 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40311 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40312 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40313 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40314 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40315
40316 @item qTStatus
40317 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40318 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40319
40320 The reply has the form:
40321
40322 @table @samp
40323
40324 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40325 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40326 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40327 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40328
40329 @end table
40330
40331 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40332 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40333
40334 @table @samp
40335
40336 @item tnotrun:0
40337 No trace has been run yet.
40338
40339 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40340 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40341 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40342 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40343 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40344
40345 @item tfull:0
40346 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40347
40348 @item tdisconnected:0
40349 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40350
40351 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40352 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40353
40354 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40355 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40356 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40357 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40358 is hex encoded.
40359
40360 @item tunknown:0
40361 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40362
40363 @end table
40364
40365 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40366 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40367 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40368 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40369 trace.
40370
40371 @table @samp
40372
40373 @item tframes:@var{n}
40374 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40375
40376 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40377 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40378 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40379
40380 @item tsize:@var{n}
40381 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40382
40383 @item tfree:@var{n}
40384 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40385
40386 @item circular:@var{n}
40387 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40388 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40389 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40390 and may fill up.
40391
40392 @item disconn:@var{n}
40393 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40394 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40395 that the trace run will stop.
40396
40397 @end table
40398
40399 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40400 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40401 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40402 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40403 address @var{addr}.
40404
40405 Replies:
40406 @table @samp
40407 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40408 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40409 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40410 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40411 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40412
40413 @end table
40414
40415 @item qTV:@var{var}
40416 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40417 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40418 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40419
40420 Replies:
40421 @table @samp
40422 @item V@var{value}
40423 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40424 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40425 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40426 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40427 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40428 program is running.
40429
40430 @item U
40431 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40432 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40433 was not collected.
40434 @end table
40435
40436 @item qTfP
40437 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40438 @itemx qTsP
40439 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40440 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40441 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40442 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40443 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40444 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40445
40446 @item qTfV
40447 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40448 @itemx qTsV
40449 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40450 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40451 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40452 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40453 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40454 trace state variables.
40455
40456 @item qTfSTM
40457 @itemx qTsSTM
40458 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40459 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40460 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40461 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40462 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40463 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40464 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40465 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40466
40467 Reply:
40468 @table @samp
40469 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40470 A single marker
40471 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40472 a comma-separated list of markers
40473 @item l
40474 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40475 @item E @var{nn}
40476 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40477 @item @w{}
40478 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40479 stub.
40480 @end table
40481
40482 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40483 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40484
40485 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40486 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40487 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40488 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40489 @dfn{last}).
40490
40491 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40492 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40493 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40494 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40495 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40496 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40497 tracepoint markers.
40498
40499 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40500 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40501 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40502 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40503 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40504 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40505
40506 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40507 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40508 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40509 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40510 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40511 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40512 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40513 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40514 available.
40515
40516 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40517 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40518 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40519
40520 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40521 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40522 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40523 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40524 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40525 use whatever size it prefers.
40526
40527 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40528 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40529 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40530 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40531 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40532
40533 @end table
40534
40535 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40536 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40537 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40538 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40539 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40540 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40541 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40542 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40543 it had executed in the original location.
40544
40545 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40546 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40547 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40548 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40549 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40550 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40551 format of the request is:
40552
40553 @table @samp
40554 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40555
40556 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40557 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40558 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40559 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40560 memory starting at @var{to}.
40561 @end table
40562
40563 Replies:
40564 @table @samp
40565 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40566 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40567 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40568 @item E @var{NN}
40569 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40570 relocating the instruction.
40571 @end table
40572
40573 @node Host I/O Packets
40574 @section Host I/O Packets
40575 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40576 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40577
40578 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40579 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40580 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40581 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40582 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40583 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40584 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40585 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40586 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40587 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40588
40589 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40590 its arguments. They have this format:
40591
40592 @table @samp
40593
40594 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40595 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40596 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40597 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40598 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40599 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40600 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40601 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40602 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40603
40604 @end table
40605
40606 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40607
40608 @table @samp
40609
40610 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40611 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40612 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40613 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40614 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40615 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40616 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40617 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40618 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40619 @var{attachment}.
40620
40621 @item @w{}
40622 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40623
40624 @end table
40625
40626 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40627
40628 @table @samp
40629 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40630 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40631 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40632 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40633 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40634 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40635 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40636
40637 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40638 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40639 -1 if an error occurs.
40640
40641 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40642 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40643 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40644 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40645 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40646 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40647 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40648 @var{count} was zero.
40649
40650 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40651 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40652 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40653 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40654 some characters were escaped.
40655
40656 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40657 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40658 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40659 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40660 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40661 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40662 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40663 error occurred.
40664
40665 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40666 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40667 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40668 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40669 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40670 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40671
40672 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40673 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40674 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40675
40676 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40677 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40678 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40679
40680 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40681 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40682 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40683 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40684 some characters were escaped.
40685
40686 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40687 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40688 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40689 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40690 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40691 inferior(s).
40692
40693 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40694 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40695 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40696 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40697 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40698 operation.
40699
40700 @end table
40701
40702 @node Interrupts
40703 @section Interrupts
40704 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40705 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40706
40707 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40708 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40709 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40710 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40711
40712 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40713 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40714 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40715 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40716 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40717
40718 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40719 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40720 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40721 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40722 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40723 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40724 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40725 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40726
40727 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40728 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40729 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40730
40731 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40732 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40733 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40734 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40735 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40736 @code{0x03}.
40737
40738 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40739 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40740 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40741 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40742 currently-executing threads and processes.
40743 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40744 running program, it should send one of the stop
40745 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40746 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40747 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40748 Interrupts received while the
40749 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40750 it is resumed next time.
40751
40752 @node Notification Packets
40753 @section Notification Packets
40754 @cindex notification packets
40755 @cindex packets, notification
40756
40757 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40758 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40759 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40760 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40761 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40762 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40763 is not a problem.
40764
40765 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40766 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40767 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40768 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40769 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40770 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40771 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40772
40773 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40774 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40775
40776 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40777 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40778 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40779 not they understand it.
40780
40781 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40782 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40783 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40784 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40785 recipients.
40786
40787 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40788 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40789 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40790 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40791 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40792
40793 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40794 @table @samp
40795 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40796 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40797 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40798 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40799 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40800 @item @var{ack}
40801 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40802 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40803 @end table
40804
40805 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40806 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40807
40808 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40809 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40810 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40811 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40812 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40813 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40814 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40815 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40816 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40817 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40818
40819 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40820 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40821 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40822 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40823 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40824 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40825
40826 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40827 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40828 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40829 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40830 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40831
40832 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40833 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40834 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40835 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40836 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40837 normally.
40838
40839 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40840 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40841 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40842 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40843 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40844 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40845 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40846 the process shall be repeated.
40847
40848 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40849 following example:
40850 @smallexample
40851 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40852 @code{...}
40853 -> @code{vStopped}
40854 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40855 -> @code{vStopped}
40856 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40857 -> @code{vStopped}
40858 <- @code{OK}
40859 @end smallexample
40860
40861 The following notifications are defined:
40862 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40863
40864 @item Notification
40865 @tab Ack
40866 @tab Event
40867 @tab Description
40868
40869 @item Stop
40870 @tab vStopped
40871 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40872 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40873 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40874 @value{GDBN}.
40875 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40876
40877 @end multitable
40878
40879 @node Remote Non-Stop
40880 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40881
40882 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40883 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40884 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40885 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40886
40887 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40888 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40889 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40890 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40891 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40892 probe the target state after a mode change.
40893
40894 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40895 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40896 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40897 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40898 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40899 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40900 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40901 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40902 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40903 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40904 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40905
40906 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40907 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40908 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40909 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40910 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40911 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40912 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40913 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40914 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40915 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40916 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40917 @samp{OK}.
40918
40919 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40920 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40921 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40922 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40923 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40924 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40925 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40926 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40927 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40928 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40929 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40930 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40931 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40932
40933 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40934 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40935
40936 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40937 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40938 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40939 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40940 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40941 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40942 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40943
40944 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40945 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40946 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40947 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40948 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40949
40950 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40951 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40952 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40953 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40954
40955 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40956 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40957 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40958 @pxref{qSupported}.
40959 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40960 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40961 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40962 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40963 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40964 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40965 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40966
40967 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40968 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40969 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40970 connection.
40971 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40972 new connection is established,
40973 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40974 for the current connection, once disabled.
40975
40976 @node Examples
40977 @section Examples
40978
40979 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40980 does not get any direct output:
40981
40982 @smallexample
40983 -> @code{R00}
40984 <- @code{+}
40985 @emph{target restarts}
40986 -> @code{?}
40987 <- @code{+}
40988 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40989 -> @code{+}
40990 @end smallexample
40991
40992 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40993
40994 @smallexample
40995 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40996 <- @code{+}
40997 -> @code{s}
40998 <- @code{+}
40999 @emph{time passes}
41000 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41001 -> @code{+}
41002 -> @code{g}
41003 <- @code{+}
41004 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
41005 -> @code{+}
41006 @end smallexample
41007
41008 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41009 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41010 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
41011
41012 @menu
41013 * File-I/O Overview::
41014 * Protocol Basics::
41015 * The F Request Packet::
41016 * The F Reply Packet::
41017 * The Ctrl-C Message::
41018 * Console I/O::
41019 * List of Supported Calls::
41020 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
41021 * Constants::
41022 * File-I/O Examples::
41023 @end menu
41024
41025 @node File-I/O Overview
41026 @subsection File-I/O Overview
41027 @cindex file-i/o overview
41028
41029 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
41030 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
41031 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
41032 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
41033 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
41034 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
41035
41036 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
41037 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
41038 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
41039 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
41040 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
41041
41042 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
41043 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
41044 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
41045 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
41046 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
41047 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
41048 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
41049
41050 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
41051 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
41052 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
41053 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
41054 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
41055
41056 @smallexample
41057 (@value{GDBP}) continue
41058 <- target requests 'system call X'
41059 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
41060 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
41061 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
41062 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
41063 @end smallexample
41064
41065 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
41066 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
41067 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
41068 system are not supported by this protocol.
41069
41070 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
41071
41072 @node Protocol Basics
41073 @subsection Protocol Basics
41074 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
41075
41076 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
41077 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
41078 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
41079 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
41080 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
41081 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
41082 to call the appropriate host system call:
41083
41084 @itemize @bullet
41085 @item
41086 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
41087
41088 @item
41089 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
41090 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
41091 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
41092 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
41093
41094 @end itemize
41095
41096 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
41097
41098 @itemize @bullet
41099 @item
41100 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
41101 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
41102 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
41103 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
41104 packet.
41105
41106 @item
41107 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
41108 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
41109
41110 @item
41111 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
41112
41113 @item
41114 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
41115
41116 @item
41117 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
41118 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
41119 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
41120 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
41121 packet.
41122
41123 @end itemize
41124
41125 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
41126 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
41127
41128 @itemize @bullet
41129 @item
41130 Return value.
41131
41132 @item
41133 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
41134
41135 @item
41136 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
41137
41138 @end itemize
41139
41140 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
41141 the latest continue or step action.
41142
41143 @node The F Request Packet
41144 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
41145 @cindex file-i/o request packet
41146 @cindex @code{F} request packet
41147
41148 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
41149
41150 @table @samp
41151 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
41152
41153 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
41154 This is just the name of the function.
41155
41156 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
41157 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
41158 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
41159 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
41160 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
41161 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
41162 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
41163
41164 @end table
41165
41166
41167
41168 @node The F Reply Packet
41169 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
41170 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
41171 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
41172
41173 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
41174
41175 @table @samp
41176
41177 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
41178
41179 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
41180
41181 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
41182 representation.
41183 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
41184
41185 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
41186 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
41187 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
41188
41189 @smallexample
41190 F0,0,C
41191 @end smallexample
41192
41193 @noindent
41194 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
41195
41196 @smallexample
41197 F-1,4,C
41198 @end smallexample
41199
41200 @noindent
41201 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
41202
41203 @end table
41204
41205
41206 @node The Ctrl-C Message
41207 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
41208 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
41209
41210 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
41211 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
41212 the target should behave as if it had
41213 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41214 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41215 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41216 packet.
41217
41218 It's important for the target to know in which
41219 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41220
41221 @itemize @bullet
41222 @item
41223 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41224
41225 @item
41226 The system call on the host has been finished.
41227
41228 @end itemize
41229
41230 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41231 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41232 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41233 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41234 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41235 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41236
41237 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41238 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41239 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41240 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41241 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41242 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41243 or the full action has been completed.
41244
41245 @node Console I/O
41246 @subsection Console I/O
41247 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41248
41249 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41250 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41251 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41252 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41253 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41254 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41255 conditions is met:
41256
41257 @itemize @bullet
41258 @item
41259 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41260 @code{read}
41261 system call is treated as finished.
41262
41263 @item
41264 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41265 newline.
41266
41267 @item
41268 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41269 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41270
41271 @end itemize
41272
41273 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41274 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41275 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41276 is stopped at the user's request.
41277
41278
41279 @node List of Supported Calls
41280 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41281 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41282
41283 @menu
41284 * open::
41285 * close::
41286 * read::
41287 * write::
41288 * lseek::
41289 * rename::
41290 * unlink::
41291 * stat/fstat::
41292 * gettimeofday::
41293 * isatty::
41294 * system::
41295 @end menu
41296
41297 @node open
41298 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41299 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41300
41301 @table @asis
41302 @item Synopsis:
41303 @smallexample
41304 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41305 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41306 @end smallexample
41307
41308 @item Request:
41309 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41310
41311 @noindent
41312 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41313
41314 @table @code
41315 @item O_CREAT
41316 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41317 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41318 are concerned.
41319
41320 @item O_EXCL
41321 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41322 an error and open() fails.
41323
41324 @item O_TRUNC
41325 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41326 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41327 truncated to zero length.
41328
41329 @item O_APPEND
41330 The file is opened in append mode.
41331
41332 @item O_RDONLY
41333 The file is opened for reading only.
41334
41335 @item O_WRONLY
41336 The file is opened for writing only.
41337
41338 @item O_RDWR
41339 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41340 @end table
41341
41342 @noindent
41343 Other bits are silently ignored.
41344
41345
41346 @noindent
41347 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41348
41349 @table @code
41350 @item S_IRUSR
41351 User has read permission.
41352
41353 @item S_IWUSR
41354 User has write permission.
41355
41356 @item S_IRGRP
41357 Group has read permission.
41358
41359 @item S_IWGRP
41360 Group has write permission.
41361
41362 @item S_IROTH
41363 Others have read permission.
41364
41365 @item S_IWOTH
41366 Others have write permission.
41367 @end table
41368
41369 @noindent
41370 Other bits are silently ignored.
41371
41372
41373 @item Return value:
41374 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41375 occurred.
41376
41377 @item Errors:
41378
41379 @table @code
41380 @item EEXIST
41381 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41382
41383 @item EISDIR
41384 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41385
41386 @item EACCES
41387 The requested access is not allowed.
41388
41389 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41390 @var{pathname} was too long.
41391
41392 @item ENOENT
41393 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41394
41395 @item ENODEV
41396 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41397
41398 @item EROFS
41399 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41400 write access was requested.
41401
41402 @item EFAULT
41403 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41404
41405 @item ENOSPC
41406 No space on device to create the file.
41407
41408 @item EMFILE
41409 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41410
41411 @item ENFILE
41412 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41413 has been reached.
41414
41415 @item EINTR
41416 The call was interrupted by the user.
41417 @end table
41418
41419 @end table
41420
41421 @node close
41422 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41423 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41424
41425 @table @asis
41426 @item Synopsis:
41427 @smallexample
41428 int close(int fd);
41429 @end smallexample
41430
41431 @item Request:
41432 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41433
41434 @item Return value:
41435 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41436
41437 @item Errors:
41438
41439 @table @code
41440 @item EBADF
41441 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41442
41443 @item EINTR
41444 The call was interrupted by the user.
41445 @end table
41446
41447 @end table
41448
41449 @node read
41450 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41451 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41452
41453 @table @asis
41454 @item Synopsis:
41455 @smallexample
41456 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41457 @end smallexample
41458
41459 @item Request:
41460 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41461
41462 @item Return value:
41463 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41464 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41465 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41466
41467 @item Errors:
41468
41469 @table @code
41470 @item EBADF
41471 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41472 reading.
41473
41474 @item EFAULT
41475 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41476
41477 @item EINTR
41478 The call was interrupted by the user.
41479 @end table
41480
41481 @end table
41482
41483 @node write
41484 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41485 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41486
41487 @table @asis
41488 @item Synopsis:
41489 @smallexample
41490 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41491 @end smallexample
41492
41493 @item Request:
41494 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41495
41496 @item Return value:
41497 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41498 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41499 is returned.
41500
41501 @item Errors:
41502
41503 @table @code
41504 @item EBADF
41505 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41506 writing.
41507
41508 @item EFAULT
41509 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41510
41511 @item EFBIG
41512 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41513 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41514
41515 @item ENOSPC
41516 No space on device to write the data.
41517
41518 @item EINTR
41519 The call was interrupted by the user.
41520 @end table
41521
41522 @end table
41523
41524 @node lseek
41525 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41526 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41527
41528 @table @asis
41529 @item Synopsis:
41530 @smallexample
41531 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41532 @end smallexample
41533
41534 @item Request:
41535 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41536
41537 @var{flag} is one of:
41538
41539 @table @code
41540 @item SEEK_SET
41541 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41542
41543 @item SEEK_CUR
41544 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41545 bytes.
41546
41547 @item SEEK_END
41548 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41549 bytes.
41550 @end table
41551
41552 @item Return value:
41553 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41554 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41555 value of -1 is returned.
41556
41557 @item Errors:
41558
41559 @table @code
41560 @item EBADF
41561 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41562
41563 @item ESPIPE
41564 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41565
41566 @item EINVAL
41567 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41568
41569 @item EINTR
41570 The call was interrupted by the user.
41571 @end table
41572
41573 @end table
41574
41575 @node rename
41576 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41577 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41578
41579 @table @asis
41580 @item Synopsis:
41581 @smallexample
41582 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41583 @end smallexample
41584
41585 @item Request:
41586 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41587
41588 @item Return value:
41589 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41590
41591 @item Errors:
41592
41593 @table @code
41594 @item EISDIR
41595 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41596 directory.
41597
41598 @item EEXIST
41599 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41600
41601 @item EBUSY
41602 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41603 process.
41604
41605 @item EINVAL
41606 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41607 of itself.
41608
41609 @item ENOTDIR
41610 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41611 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41612 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41613
41614 @item EFAULT
41615 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41616
41617 @item EACCES
41618 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41619
41620 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41621
41622 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41623
41624 @item ENOENT
41625 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41626
41627 @item EROFS
41628 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41629
41630 @item ENOSPC
41631 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41632 directory entry.
41633
41634 @item EINTR
41635 The call was interrupted by the user.
41636 @end table
41637
41638 @end table
41639
41640 @node unlink
41641 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41642 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41643
41644 @table @asis
41645 @item Synopsis:
41646 @smallexample
41647 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41648 @end smallexample
41649
41650 @item Request:
41651 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41652
41653 @item Return value:
41654 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41655
41656 @item Errors:
41657
41658 @table @code
41659 @item EACCES
41660 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41661
41662 @item EPERM
41663 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41664
41665 @item EBUSY
41666 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41667 being used by another process.
41668
41669 @item EFAULT
41670 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41671
41672 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41673 @var{pathname} was too long.
41674
41675 @item ENOENT
41676 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41677
41678 @item ENOTDIR
41679 A component of the path is not a directory.
41680
41681 @item EROFS
41682 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41683
41684 @item EINTR
41685 The call was interrupted by the user.
41686 @end table
41687
41688 @end table
41689
41690 @node stat/fstat
41691 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41692 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41693 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41694
41695 @table @asis
41696 @item Synopsis:
41697 @smallexample
41698 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41699 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41700 @end smallexample
41701
41702 @item Request:
41703 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41704 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41705
41706 @item Return value:
41707 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41708
41709 @item Errors:
41710
41711 @table @code
41712 @item EBADF
41713 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41714
41715 @item ENOENT
41716 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41717 path is an empty string.
41718
41719 @item ENOTDIR
41720 A component of the path is not a directory.
41721
41722 @item EFAULT
41723 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41724
41725 @item EACCES
41726 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41727
41728 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41729 @var{pathname} was too long.
41730
41731 @item EINTR
41732 The call was interrupted by the user.
41733 @end table
41734
41735 @end table
41736
41737 @node gettimeofday
41738 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41739 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41740
41741 @table @asis
41742 @item Synopsis:
41743 @smallexample
41744 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41745 @end smallexample
41746
41747 @item Request:
41748 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41749
41750 @item Return value:
41751 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41752
41753 @item Errors:
41754
41755 @table @code
41756 @item EINVAL
41757 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41758
41759 @item EFAULT
41760 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41761 @end table
41762
41763 @end table
41764
41765 @node isatty
41766 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41767 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41768
41769 @table @asis
41770 @item Synopsis:
41771 @smallexample
41772 int isatty(int fd);
41773 @end smallexample
41774
41775 @item Request:
41776 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41777
41778 @item Return value:
41779 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41780
41781 @item Errors:
41782
41783 @table @code
41784 @item EINTR
41785 The call was interrupted by the user.
41786 @end table
41787
41788 @end table
41789
41790 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41791 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41792 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41793 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41794 needed.
41795
41796
41797 @node system
41798 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41799 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41800
41801 @table @asis
41802 @item Synopsis:
41803 @smallexample
41804 int system(const char *command);
41805 @end smallexample
41806
41807 @item Request:
41808 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41809
41810 @item Return value:
41811 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41812 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41813 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41814 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41815 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41816 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41817 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41818
41819 @item Errors:
41820
41821 @table @code
41822 @item EINTR
41823 The call was interrupted by the user.
41824 @end table
41825
41826 @end table
41827
41828 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41829 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41830 the host is simplified before it's returned
41831 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41832 is discarded, and the return value consists
41833 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41834
41835 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41836 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41837 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41838
41839 @table @code
41840 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41841 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41842 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41843 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41844
41845 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41846 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41847 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41848 protocol.
41849 @end table
41850
41851 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41852 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41853 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41854
41855 @menu
41856 * Integral Datatypes::
41857 * Pointer Values::
41858 * Memory Transfer::
41859 * struct stat::
41860 * struct timeval::
41861 @end menu
41862
41863 @node Integral Datatypes
41864 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41865 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41866
41867 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41868 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41869 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41870
41871 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41872 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41873
41874 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41875
41876 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41877 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41878
41879 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41880
41881 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41882 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41883 byte order.
41884
41885 @node Pointer Values
41886 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41887 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41888
41889 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41890 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41891 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41892 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41893
41894 @smallexample
41895 @code{1aaf/12}
41896 @end smallexample
41897
41898 @noindent
41899 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41900 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41901 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41902 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41903
41904 @smallexample
41905 @code{123456/d}
41906 @end smallexample
41907
41908 @node Memory Transfer
41909 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41910 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41911
41912 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41913 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41914 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41915 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41916 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41917 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41918 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41919
41920
41921 @node struct stat
41922 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41923 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41924
41925 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41926 is defined as follows:
41927
41928 @smallexample
41929 struct stat @{
41930 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41931 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41932 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41933 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41934 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41935 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41936 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41937 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41938 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41939 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41940 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41941 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41942 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41943 @};
41944 @end smallexample
41945
41946 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41947 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41948 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41949
41950 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41951 range of values.
41952
41953 @table @code
41954
41955 @item st_dev
41956 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41957
41958 @item st_ino
41959 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41960
41961 @item st_mode
41962 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41963 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41964
41965 @item st_uid
41966 @itemx st_gid
41967 @itemx st_rdev
41968 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41969
41970 @item st_atime
41971 @itemx st_mtime
41972 @itemx st_ctime
41973 These values have a host and file system dependent
41974 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41975 support exact timing values.
41976 @end table
41977
41978 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41979 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41980 continuing.
41981
41982 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41983 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41984 get truncated on the target.
41985
41986 @node struct timeval
41987 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41988 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41989
41990 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41991 is defined as follows:
41992
41993 @smallexample
41994 struct timeval @{
41995 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41996 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41997 @};
41998 @end smallexample
41999
42000 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42001 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42002 structure is of size 8 bytes.
42003
42004 @node Constants
42005 @subsection Constants
42006 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
42007
42008 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
42009 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
42010 values before and after the call as needed.
42011
42012 @menu
42013 * Open Flags::
42014 * mode_t Values::
42015 * Errno Values::
42016 * Lseek Flags::
42017 * Limits::
42018 @end menu
42019
42020 @node Open Flags
42021 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
42022 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
42023
42024 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
42025
42026 @smallexample
42027 O_RDONLY 0x0
42028 O_WRONLY 0x1
42029 O_RDWR 0x2
42030 O_APPEND 0x8
42031 O_CREAT 0x200
42032 O_TRUNC 0x400
42033 O_EXCL 0x800
42034 @end smallexample
42035
42036 @node mode_t Values
42037 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
42038 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
42039
42040 All values are given in octal representation.
42041
42042 @smallexample
42043 S_IFREG 0100000
42044 S_IFDIR 040000
42045 S_IRUSR 0400
42046 S_IWUSR 0200
42047 S_IXUSR 0100
42048 S_IRGRP 040
42049 S_IWGRP 020
42050 S_IXGRP 010
42051 S_IROTH 04
42052 S_IWOTH 02
42053 S_IXOTH 01
42054 @end smallexample
42055
42056 @node Errno Values
42057 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
42058 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
42059
42060 All values are given in decimal representation.
42061
42062 @smallexample
42063 EPERM 1
42064 ENOENT 2
42065 EINTR 4
42066 EBADF 9
42067 EACCES 13
42068 EFAULT 14
42069 EBUSY 16
42070 EEXIST 17
42071 ENODEV 19
42072 ENOTDIR 20
42073 EISDIR 21
42074 EINVAL 22
42075 ENFILE 23
42076 EMFILE 24
42077 EFBIG 27
42078 ENOSPC 28
42079 ESPIPE 29
42080 EROFS 30
42081 ENAMETOOLONG 91
42082 EUNKNOWN 9999
42083 @end smallexample
42084
42085 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
42086 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
42087
42088 @node Lseek Flags
42089 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
42090 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
42091
42092 @smallexample
42093 SEEK_SET 0
42094 SEEK_CUR 1
42095 SEEK_END 2
42096 @end smallexample
42097
42098 @node Limits
42099 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
42100 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
42101
42102 All values are given in decimal representation.
42103
42104 @smallexample
42105 INT_MIN -2147483648
42106 INT_MAX 2147483647
42107 UINT_MAX 4294967295
42108 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
42109 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
42110 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
42111 @end smallexample
42112
42113 @node File-I/O Examples
42114 @subsection File-I/O Examples
42115 @cindex file-i/o examples
42116
42117 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42118 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
42119
42120 @smallexample
42121 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
42122 @emph{request memory read from target}
42123 -> @code{m1234,6}
42124 <- XXXXXX
42125 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
42126 -> @code{F6}
42127 @end smallexample
42128
42129 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42130 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
42131
42132 @smallexample
42133 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42134 @emph{request memory write to target}
42135 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42136 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
42137 -> @code{F6}
42138 @end smallexample
42139
42140 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
42141 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
42142
42143 @smallexample
42144 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42145 -> @code{F-1,9}
42146 @end smallexample
42147
42148 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
42149 host is called:
42150
42151 @smallexample
42152 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42153 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
42154 <- @code{T02}
42155 @end smallexample
42156
42157 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
42158 host is called:
42159
42160 @smallexample
42161 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42162 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42163 <- @code{T02}
42164 @end smallexample
42165
42166 @node Library List Format
42167 @section Library List Format
42168 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42169
42170 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
42171 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
42172 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
42173 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
42174 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
42175 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
42176 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
42177 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
42178 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
42179 are loaded.
42180
42181 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
42182 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
42183 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
42184 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
42185
42186 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
42187 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
42188 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
42189 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
42190 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
42191 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
42192
42193 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42194 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42195
42196 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
42197 offset, looks like this:
42198
42199 @smallexample
42200 <library-list>
42201 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
42202 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
42203 </library>
42204 </library-list>
42205 @end smallexample
42206
42207 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
42208 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
42209
42210 @smallexample
42211 <library-list>
42212 <library name="sharedlib.o">
42213 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42214 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42215 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42216 </library>
42217 </library-list>
42218 @end smallexample
42219
42220 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42221
42222 @smallexample
42223 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42224 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42225 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42226 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42227 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42228 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42229 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42230 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42231 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42232 @end smallexample
42233
42234 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42235 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42236 section for each library.
42237
42238 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42239 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42240 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42241
42242 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42243 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42244 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42245 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42246
42247 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42248 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42249 target, the following parameters are reported:
42250
42251 @itemize @minus
42252 @item
42253 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42254 @code{struct link_map}.
42255 @item
42256 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42257 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42258 @item
42259 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42260 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42261 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42262 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42263 @item
42264 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42265 @end itemize
42266
42267 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42268 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42269 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42270
42271 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42272 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42273
42274 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42275 looks like this:
42276
42277 @smallexample
42278 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42279 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42280 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42281 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42282 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42283 </library-list-svr>
42284 @end smallexample
42285
42286 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42287
42288 @smallexample
42289 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42290 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42291 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42292 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42293 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42294 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42295 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42296 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42297 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42298 @end smallexample
42299
42300 @node Memory Map Format
42301 @section Memory Map Format
42302 @cindex memory map format
42303
42304 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42305 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42306 memory map.
42307
42308 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42309 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42310 lists memory regions.
42311
42312 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42313 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42314
42315 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42316
42317 @smallexample
42318 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42319 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42320 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42321 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42322 <memory-map>
42323 region...
42324 </memory-map>
42325 @end smallexample
42326
42327 Each region can be either:
42328
42329 @itemize
42330
42331 @item
42332 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42333 bytes from there:
42334
42335 @smallexample
42336 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42337 @end smallexample
42338
42339
42340 @item
42341 A region of read-only memory:
42342
42343 @smallexample
42344 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42345 @end smallexample
42346
42347
42348 @item
42349 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42350 bytes in length:
42351
42352 @smallexample
42353 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42354 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42355 </memory>
42356 @end smallexample
42357
42358 @end itemize
42359
42360 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42361 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42362 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42363
42364 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42365
42366 @smallexample
42367 <!-- ................................................... -->
42368 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42369 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42370 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42371 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42372 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42373 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42374 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42375 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42376 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42377 and its type, or device. -->
42378 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42379 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42380 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42381 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42382 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42383 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42384 @end smallexample
42385
42386 @node Thread List Format
42387 @section Thread List Format
42388 @cindex thread list format
42389
42390 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42391 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42392 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42393 the following structure:
42394
42395 @smallexample
42396 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42397 <threads>
42398 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42399 ... description ...
42400 </thread>
42401 </threads>
42402 @end smallexample
42403
42404 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42405 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42406 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42407 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42408 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42409 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42410 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42411 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42412
42413
42414 @node Traceframe Info Format
42415 @section Traceframe Info Format
42416 @cindex traceframe info format
42417
42418 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42419 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42420 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42421 collected in a traceframe.
42422
42423 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42424 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42425
42426 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42427 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42428
42429 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42430
42431 @smallexample
42432 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42433 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42434 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42435 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42436 <traceframe-info>
42437 block...
42438 </traceframe-info>
42439 @end smallexample
42440
42441 Each traceframe block can be either:
42442
42443 @itemize
42444
42445 @item
42446 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42447 @var{length} bytes from there:
42448
42449 @smallexample
42450 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42451 @end smallexample
42452
42453 @item
42454 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42455 collected:
42456
42457 @smallexample
42458 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42459 @end smallexample
42460
42461 @end itemize
42462
42463 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42464
42465 @smallexample
42466 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42467 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42468
42469 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42470 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42471 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42472 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42473 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42474 @end smallexample
42475
42476 @node Branch Trace Format
42477 @section Branch Trace Format
42478 @cindex branch trace format
42479
42480 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42481 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42482 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42483 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42484
42485 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42486 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42487
42488 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42489 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42490
42491 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42492
42493 @smallexample
42494 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42495 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42496 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42497 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42498 <btrace>
42499 block...
42500 </btrace>
42501 @end smallexample
42502
42503 @itemize
42504
42505 @item
42506 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42507 and ending at @var{end}:
42508
42509 @smallexample
42510 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42511 @end smallexample
42512
42513 @end itemize
42514
42515 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42516
42517 @smallexample
42518 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42519 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42520
42521 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42522 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42523 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42524
42525 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42526
42527 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42528
42529 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42530 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42531 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42532 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42533 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42534
42535 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42536 @end smallexample
42537
42538 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42539 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42540 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42541
42542 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42543 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42544 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42545
42546 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42547 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42548
42549 @table @code
42550 @item bts
42551 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42552 @table @code
42553 @item size
42554 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42555 @end table
42556 @item pt
42557 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42558 PT}) format.
42559 @table @code
42560 @item size
42561 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42562 @end table
42563 @end table
42564
42565 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42566 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42567
42568 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42569
42570 @smallexample
42571 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42572 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42573
42574 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42575 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42576
42577 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42578 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42579 @end smallexample
42580
42581 @include agentexpr.texi
42582
42583 @node Target Descriptions
42584 @appendix Target Descriptions
42585 @cindex target descriptions
42586
42587 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42588 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42589 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42590 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42591 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42592 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42593 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42594
42595 @itemize @bullet
42596 @item
42597 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42598 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42599 @item
42600 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42601 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42602 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42603 @item
42604 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42605 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42606 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42607 @end itemize
42608
42609 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42610 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42611 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42612 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42613 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42614
42615 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42616 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42617
42618 @menu
42619 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42620 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42621 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42622 descriptions.
42623 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42624 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42625 @end menu
42626
42627 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42628 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42629
42630 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42631 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42632 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42633 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42634 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42635 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42636 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42637 Format}.
42638
42639 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42640 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42641 specify a file are:
42642
42643 @table @code
42644 @cindex set tdesc filename
42645 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42646 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42647
42648 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42649 @item unset tdesc filename
42650 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42651 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42652
42653 @cindex show tdesc filename
42654 @item show tdesc filename
42655 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42656 @end table
42657
42658
42659 @node Target Description Format
42660 @section Target Description Format
42661 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42662
42663 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42664 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42665 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42666 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42667 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42668 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42669 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42670
42671 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42672 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42673 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42674 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42675 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42676
42677 Here is a simple target description:
42678
42679 @smallexample
42680 <target version="1.0">
42681 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42682 </target>
42683 @end smallexample
42684
42685 @noindent
42686 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42687 the x86-64 architecture.
42688
42689 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42690 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42691 are explained further below.
42692
42693 @smallexample
42694 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42695 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42696 <target version="1.0">
42697 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42698 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42699 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42700 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42701 </target>
42702 @end smallexample
42703
42704 @noindent
42705 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42706 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42707 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42708 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42709 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42710 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42711 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42712 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42713 the version mismatch.
42714
42715 @subsection Inclusion
42716 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42717 @cindex XInclude
42718 @ifnotinfo
42719 @cindex <xi:include>
42720 @end ifnotinfo
42721
42722 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42723 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42724 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42725 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42726 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42727
42728 @smallexample
42729 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42730 @end smallexample
42731
42732 @noindent
42733 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42734 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42735 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42736 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42737 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42738 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42739 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42740 original description.
42741
42742 @subsection Architecture
42743 @cindex <architecture>
42744
42745 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42746
42747 @smallexample
42748 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42749 @end smallexample
42750
42751 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42752 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42753
42754 @subsection OS ABI
42755 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42756
42757 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42758 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42759
42760 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42761
42762 @smallexample
42763 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42764 @end smallexample
42765
42766 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42767 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42768
42769 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42770 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42771
42772 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42773 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42774
42775 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42776
42777 @smallexample
42778 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42779 @end smallexample
42780
42781 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42782 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42783
42784 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42785 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42786 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42787 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42788 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42789 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42790 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42791
42792 @smallexample
42793 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42794 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42795 @end smallexample
42796
42797 @subsection Features
42798 @cindex <feature>
42799
42800 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42801 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42802 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42803 has this form:
42804
42805 @smallexample
42806 <feature name="@var{name}">
42807 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42808 @var{reg}@dots{}
42809 </feature>
42810 @end smallexample
42811
42812 @noindent
42813 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42814 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42815 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42816 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42817
42818 @subsection Types
42819
42820 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42821 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42822 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42823 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42824 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42825 and enum types.
42826
42827 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42828 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42829 Types must be defined before they are used.
42830
42831 @cindex <vector>
42832 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42833 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42834 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42835 @var{count}:
42836
42837 @smallexample
42838 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42839 @end smallexample
42840
42841 @cindex <union>
42842 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42843 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42844 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42845 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42846
42847 @smallexample
42848 <union id="@var{id}">
42849 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42850 @dots{}
42851 </union>
42852 @end smallexample
42853
42854 @cindex <struct>
42855 @cindex <flags>
42856 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42857 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42858 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42859 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42860 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42861 specified.
42862
42863 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42864
42865 @smallexample
42866 <struct id="@var{id}">
42867 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42868 @dots{}
42869 </struct>
42870 @end smallexample
42871
42872 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42873 No implicit padding is added.
42874
42875 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42876
42877 @smallexample
42878 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42879 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42880 @dots{}
42881 </struct>
42882 @end smallexample
42883
42884 @smallexample
42885 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42886 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42887 @dots{}
42888 </flags>
42889 @end smallexample
42890
42891 The @var{name} value is required.
42892 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42893 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42894 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42895
42896 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42897 is optional.
42898 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42899 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42900
42901 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42902 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42903
42904 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42905
42906 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42907 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42908
42909 @itemize @bullet
42910 @item
42911 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42912 @item
42913 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42914 @end itemize
42915
42916 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42917 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42918
42919 @itemize @bullet
42920 @item
42921 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42922
42923 @smallexample
42924 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42925 $1 = 42
42926 @end smallexample
42927
42928 @end itemize
42929
42930 @subsection Registers
42931 @cindex <reg>
42932
42933 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42934
42935 @smallexample
42936 <reg name="@var{name}"
42937 bitsize="@var{size}"
42938 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42939 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42940 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42941 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42942 @end smallexample
42943
42944 @noindent
42945 The components are as follows:
42946
42947 @table @var
42948
42949 @item name
42950 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42951
42952 @item bitsize
42953 The register's size, in bits.
42954
42955 @item regnum
42956 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42957 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42958 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42959 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42960 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42961 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42962 in order of increasing register number.
42963
42964 @item save-restore
42965 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42966 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42967 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42968 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42969 ABI.
42970
42971 @item type
42972 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42973 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42974 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42975 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42976 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42977 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42978
42979 @item group
42980 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42981 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42982 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42983 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42984 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42985 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42986 @code{info registers}.
42987
42988 @end table
42989
42990 @node Predefined Target Types
42991 @section Predefined Target Types
42992 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42993
42994 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42995 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42996 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42997 types. The currently supported types are:
42998
42999 @table @code
43000
43001 @item bool
43002 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
43003
43004 @item int8
43005 @itemx int16
43006 @itemx int24
43007 @itemx int32
43008 @itemx int64
43009 @itemx int128
43010 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43011
43012 @item uint8
43013 @itemx uint16
43014 @itemx uint24
43015 @itemx uint32
43016 @itemx uint64
43017 @itemx uint128
43018 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43019
43020 @item code_ptr
43021 @itemx data_ptr
43022 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
43023 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
43024 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
43025 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
43026 may be marked as data pointers.
43027
43028 @item ieee_single
43029 Single precision IEEE floating point.
43030
43031 @item ieee_double
43032 Double precision IEEE floating point.
43033
43034 @item arm_fpa_ext
43035 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
43036
43037 @item i387_ext
43038 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
43039
43040 @item i386_eflags
43041 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
43042
43043 @item i386_mxcsr
43044 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
43045
43046 @end table
43047
43048 @node Enum Target Types
43049 @section Enum Target Types
43050 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
43051
43052 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
43053 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
43054
43055 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
43056
43057 @smallexample
43058 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43059 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
43060 @dots{}
43061 </enum>
43062 @end smallexample
43063
43064 Enums must be defined before they are used.
43065
43066 @smallexample
43067 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
43068 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
43069 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
43070 </enum>
43071 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
43072 <field name="X" start="0"/>
43073 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
43074 </flags>
43075 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
43076 @end smallexample
43077
43078 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
43079 would be printed as:
43080
43081 @smallexample
43082 (gdb) info register flags
43083 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
43084 @end smallexample
43085
43086 @node Standard Target Features
43087 @section Standard Target Features
43088 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
43089
43090 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
43091 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
43092 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
43093 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
43094 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
43095 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
43096 can recognize them.
43097
43098 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
43099 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
43100 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
43101 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
43102 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
43103 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
43104 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
43105 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
43106
43107 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
43108 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
43109 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
43110
43111 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
43112 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
43113 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
43114 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
43115
43116 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
43117 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
43118 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
43119
43120 @menu
43121 * AArch64 Features::
43122 * ARC Features::
43123 * ARM Features::
43124 * i386 Features::
43125 * MicroBlaze Features::
43126 * MIPS Features::
43127 * M68K Features::
43128 * NDS32 Features::
43129 * Nios II Features::
43130 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
43131 * PowerPC Features::
43132 * RISC-V Features::
43133 * S/390 and System z Features::
43134 * Sparc Features::
43135 * TIC6x Features::
43136 @end menu
43137
43138
43139 @node AArch64 Features
43140 @subsection AArch64 Features
43141 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
43142
43143 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
43144 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
43145 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43146
43147 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43148 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
43149 and @samp{fpcr}.
43150
43151 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
43152 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
43153 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
43154
43155 @node ARC Features
43156 @subsection ARC Features
43157 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
43158
43159 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
43160 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
43161 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
43162 that one of the core registers features is present.
43163 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
43164
43165 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
43166 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43167 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43168 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
43169 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43170 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
43171 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
43172
43173 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
43174 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
43175 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
43176 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
43177 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
43178 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43179
43180 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
43181 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43182 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43183 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
43184 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
43185 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
43186 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
43187 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
43188 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
43189 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
43190
43191 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
43192 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
43193
43194 @node ARM Features
43195 @subsection ARM Features
43196 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
43197
43198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
43199 ARM targets.
43200 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
43201 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43202
43203 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
43204 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
43205 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
43206 and @samp{xpsr}.
43207
43208 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
43209 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
43210
43211 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
43212 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
43213 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
43214 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43215
43216 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43217 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43218 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43219 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43220 halves of the double-precision registers.
43221
43222 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43223 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43224 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43225 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43226 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43227 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43228
43229 @node i386 Features
43230 @subsection i386 Features
43231 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43232
43233 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43234 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43235
43236 @itemize @minus
43237 @item
43238 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43239 @item
43240 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43241 @item
43242 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43243 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43244 @item
43245 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43246 @item
43247 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43248 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43249 @end itemize
43250
43251 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43252
43253 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43254 describe registers:
43255
43256 @itemize @minus
43257 @item
43258 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43259 @item
43260 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43261 @item
43262 @samp{mxcsr}
43263 @end itemize
43264
43265 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43266 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43267 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43268
43269 @itemize @minus
43270 @item
43271 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43272 @item
43273 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43274 @end itemize
43275
43276 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43277 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43278
43279 @itemize @minus
43280 @item
43281 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43282 @item
43283 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43284 @end itemize
43285
43286 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43287 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43288
43289 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43290 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43291
43292 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43293 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43294 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43295
43296 @itemize @minus
43297 @item
43298 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43299 @end itemize
43300
43301 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43302
43303 @itemize @minus
43304 @item
43305 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43306 @end itemize
43307
43308 It should
43309 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43310
43311 @itemize @minus
43312 @item
43313 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43314 @item
43315 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43316 @end itemize
43317
43318 It should
43319 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43320
43321 @itemize @minus
43322 @item
43323 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43324 @end itemize
43325
43326 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43327 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43328 valid for i386 and amd64.
43329
43330 @node MicroBlaze Features
43331 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43332 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43333
43334 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43335 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43336 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43337 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43338 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43339
43340 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43341 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43342
43343 @node MIPS Features
43344 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43345 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43346
43347 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43348 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43349 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43350 on the target.
43351
43352 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43353 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43354 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43355
43356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43357 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43358 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43359 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43360
43361 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43362 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43363 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43364 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43365
43366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43367 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43368 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43369
43370 @node M68K Features
43371 @subsection M68K Features
43372 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43373
43374 @table @code
43375 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43376 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43377 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43378 One of those features must be always present.
43379 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43380 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43381 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43382 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43383
43384 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43385 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43386 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43387 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43388 @end table
43389
43390 @node NDS32 Features
43391 @subsection NDS32 Features
43392 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43393
43394 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43395 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43396 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43397 and @samp{pc}.
43398
43399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43400 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43401 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43402 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43403
43404 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43405 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43406 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43407 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43408 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43409 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43410 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43411
43412 @node Nios II Features
43413 @subsection Nios II Features
43414 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43415
43416 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43417 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43418 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43419 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43420 @samp{mpuacc}).
43421
43422 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43423 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43424 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43425
43426 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43427 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43428 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43429
43430 @node PowerPC Features
43431 @subsection PowerPC Features
43432 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43433
43434 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43435 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43436 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43437 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43438
43439 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43440 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43441
43442 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43443 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
43444 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
43445 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
43446 registers.
43447
43448 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43449 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
43450 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
43451 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
43452 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
43453 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
43454 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
43455 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
43456
43457 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43458 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43459 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43460 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43461 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43462 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43463 user.
43464
43465 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43466 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43467
43468 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43469 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43470
43471 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43472 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43473
43474 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43475 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43476 64-bit wide.
43477
43478 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43479 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43480 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43481 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43482
43483 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43484 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43485 64-bit wide.
43486
43487 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43488 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43489 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43490 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43491 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43492 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43493 wide.
43494
43495 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43496 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43497 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43498 @samp{cfpscr}.
43499
43500 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43501 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43502 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43503 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43504 wide.
43505
43506 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43507 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43508 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43509 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43510 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43511 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43512 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43513 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43514 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43515
43516 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43517 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43518
43519 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43520 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43521
43522 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43523 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43524
43525
43526 @node RISC-V Features
43527 @subsection RISC-V Features
43528 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
43529
43530 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
43531 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
43532 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
43533 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
43534 etc).
43535
43536 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
43537 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
43538 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
43539 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
43540
43541 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
43542 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
43543 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
43544 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
43545 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
43546 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
43547 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
43548 least significant two bits.
43549
43550 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
43551 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
43552 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
43553 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
43554 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
43555 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
43556 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
43557 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
43558 other floating point hardware.
43559
43560 @node S/390 and System z Features
43561 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43562 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43563 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43564
43565 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43566 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43567 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43568 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43569 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43570 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43571 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43572 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43573 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43574
43575 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43576 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43577 @samp{fpc}.
43578
43579 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43580 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43581
43582 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43583 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43584 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43585 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43586 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43587 32-bit wide.
43588
43589 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43590 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43591 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43592
43593 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43594 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43595 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43596 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43597 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43598 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43599 @samp{v31}.
43600
43601 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43602 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43603 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43604
43605 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43606 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43607 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43608
43609 @node Sparc Features
43610 @subsection Sparc Features
43611 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43612 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43613 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43614 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43615
43616 @itemize @minus
43617 @item
43618 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43619 @item
43620 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43621 @item
43622 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43623 @item
43624 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43625 @end itemize
43626
43627 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43628
43629 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43630 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43631
43632 @itemize @minus
43633 @item
43634 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43635 @item
43636 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43637 @end itemize
43638
43639 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43640 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43641
43642 @itemize @minus
43643 @item
43644 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43645 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43646 @item
43647 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43648 for sparc64
43649 @end itemize
43650
43651 @node TIC6x Features
43652 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43653 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43654 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43655 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43656 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43657 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43658
43659 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43660 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43661 through @samp{B31}.
43662
43663 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43664 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43665
43666 @node Operating System Information
43667 @appendix Operating System Information
43668 @cindex operating system information
43669
43670 @menu
43671 * Process list::
43672 @end menu
43673
43674 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43675 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43676 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43677 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43678 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43679 on a different aspect of target.
43680
43681 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43682 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43683 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43684 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43685
43686 @node Process list
43687 @appendixsection Process list
43688 @cindex operating system information, process list
43689
43690 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43691 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43692 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43693 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43694
43695 An example document is:
43696
43697 @smallexample
43698 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43699 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43700 <osdata type="processes">
43701 <item>
43702 <column name="pid">1</column>
43703 <column name="user">root</column>
43704 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43705 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43706 </item>
43707 </osdata>
43708 @end smallexample
43709
43710 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43711 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43712 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43713 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43714 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43715 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43716 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43717
43718 @node Trace File Format
43719 @appendix Trace File Format
43720 @cindex trace file format
43721
43722 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43723 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43724
43725 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43726 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43727 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43728 in the future.
43729
43730 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43731 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43732 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43733 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43734 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43735 of this section.
43736
43737 @table @code
43738 @item R @var{size}
43739 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43740 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43741 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43742 a single trace file.
43743
43744 @item status @var{status}
43745 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43746 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43747 file.
43748
43749 @item tp @var{payload}
43750 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43751 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43752 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43753 reply packets.
43754
43755 @item tsv @var{payload}
43756 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43757 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43758 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43759 reply packets.
43760
43761 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43762 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43763 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43764 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43765 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43766 file. Includes are not allowed.
43767
43768 @end table
43769
43770 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43771 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43772 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43773 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43774 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43775 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43776 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43777 endianness.
43778
43779 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43780
43781 @table @code
43782 @item R @var{bytes}
43783 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43784 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43785 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43786
43787 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43788 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43789 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43790 @var{length} bytes.
43791
43792 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43793 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43794 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43795
43796 @end table
43797
43798 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43799 of blocks.
43800
43801 @node Index Section Format
43802 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43803 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43804 @cindex index section format
43805
43806 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43807 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43808 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43809 description.
43810
43811 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43812 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43813 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43814 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43815 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43816 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43817
43818 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43819
43820 @enumerate
43821 @item
43822 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43823 unless otherwise noted:
43824
43825 @enumerate
43826 @item
43827 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43828 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43829 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43830 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43831 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43832 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43833 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43834
43835 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43836 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43837 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43838 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43839
43840 @item
43841 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43842
43843 @item
43844 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43845 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43846 to the next offset.
43847
43848 @item
43849 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43850
43851 @item
43852 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43853
43854 @item
43855 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43856 @end enumerate
43857
43858 @item
43859 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43860 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43861 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43862 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43863 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43864 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43865 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43866 CU indices.
43867
43868 @item
43869 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43870 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43871 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43872 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43873
43874 @item
43875 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43876 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43877
43878 @enumerate
43879 @item
43880 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43881
43882 @item
43883 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43884 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43885
43886 @item
43887 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43888 @end enumerate
43889
43890 @item
43891 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43892 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43893
43894 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43895 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43896 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43897 constant pool.
43898
43899 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43900 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43901 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43902
43903 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43904 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43905 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43906 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43907 index version:
43908
43909 @table @asis
43910 @item Version 4
43911 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43912
43913 @item Versions 5 to 7
43914 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43915 @end table
43916
43917 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43918
43919 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43920 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43921 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43922 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43923 collision.
43924
43925 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43926 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43927 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43928 the code.
43929
43930 @item
43931 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43932 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43933 strings.
43934
43935 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43936 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43937 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43938 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43939 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43940 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43941
43942 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43943 @end enumerate
43944
43945 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43946 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43947 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43948
43949 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43950 (bit 0 = LSB):
43951
43952 @table @asis
43953
43954 @item Bits 0-23
43955 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43956 @item Bits 24-27
43957 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43958 @item Bits 28-30
43959 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43960
43961 @table @asis
43962 @item 0
43963 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43964 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43965 with previous versions of the index.
43966 @item 1
43967 The symbol is a type.
43968 @item 2
43969 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43970 @item 3
43971 The symbol is a function.
43972 @item 4
43973 Any other kind of symbol.
43974 @item 5,6,7
43975 These values are reserved.
43976 @end table
43977
43978 @item Bit 31
43979 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43980
43981 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43982 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43983 @value{GDBN} sources.
43984
43985 @end table
43986
43987 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43988 global/static attributes in the index.
43989
43990 @smallexample
43991 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43992 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43993 switch (die->tag)
43994 @{
43995 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43996 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43997 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43998 kind = TYPE;
43999 is_static = 1;
44000 break;
44001 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
44002 kind = VARIABLE;
44003 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44004 break;
44005 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
44006 kind = FUNCTION;
44007 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
44008 break;
44009 case DW_TAG_constant:
44010 kind = VARIABLE;
44011 is_static = ! is_external;
44012 break;
44013 case DW_TAG_variable:
44014 kind = VARIABLE;
44015 is_static = ! is_external;
44016 break;
44017 case DW_TAG_namespace:
44018 kind = TYPE;
44019 is_static = 0;
44020 break;
44021 case DW_TAG_class_type:
44022 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
44023 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
44024 case DW_TAG_union_type:
44025 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
44026 kind = TYPE;
44027 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44028 break;
44029 default:
44030 assert (0);
44031 @}
44032 @end smallexample
44033
44034 @node Man Pages
44035 @appendix Manual pages
44036 @cindex Man pages
44037
44038 @menu
44039 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
44040 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
44041 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
44042 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
44043 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
44044 @end menu
44045
44046 @node gdb man
44047 @heading gdb man
44048
44049 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
44050
44051 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
44052 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
44053 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
44054 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
44055 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
44056 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
44057 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
44058 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
44059 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
44060 @c man end
44061
44062 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
44063 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
44064 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
44065 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
44066
44067 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
44068 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
44069
44070 @itemize @bullet
44071 @item
44072 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
44073
44074 @item
44075 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
44076
44077 @item
44078 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
44079
44080 @item
44081 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
44082 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
44083 @end itemize
44084
44085 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
44086 Modula-2.
44087
44088 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
44089 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
44090 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
44091 by using the command @code{help}.
44092
44093 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
44094 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
44095 executable program as the argument:
44096
44097 @smallexample
44098 gdb program
44099 @end smallexample
44100
44101 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
44102
44103 @smallexample
44104 gdb program core
44105 @end smallexample
44106
44107 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
44108 to debug a running process:
44109
44110 @smallexample
44111 gdb program 1234
44112 gdb -p 1234
44113 @end smallexample
44114
44115 @noindent
44116 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
44117 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
44118 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
44119
44120 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
44121
44122 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
44123 @table @env
44124 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44125 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
44126
44127 @item run [@var{arglist}]
44128 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
44129
44130 @item bt
44131 Backtrace: display the program stack.
44132
44133 @item print @var{expr}
44134 Display the value of an expression.
44135
44136 @item c
44137 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
44138
44139 @item next
44140 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
44141 function calls in the line.
44142
44143 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44144 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
44145
44146 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44147 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
44148
44149 @item step
44150 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
44151 function calls in the line.
44152
44153 @item help [@var{name}]
44154 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
44155 about using @value{GDBN}.
44156
44157 @item quit
44158 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
44159 @end table
44160
44161 @ifset man
44162 For full details on @value{GDBN},
44163 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44164 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
44165 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
44166 @end ifset
44167 @c man end
44168
44169 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
44170 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
44171 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
44172 encountered with no
44173 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
44174 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
44175 Many options have
44176 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
44177 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
44178 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
44179 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
44180 more usual convention.)
44181
44182 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
44183 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
44184 option is used.
44185
44186 @table @env
44187 @item -help
44188 @itemx -h
44189 List all options, with brief explanations.
44190
44191 @item -symbols=@var{file}
44192 @itemx -s @var{file}
44193 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
44194
44195 @item -write
44196 Enable writing into executable and core files.
44197
44198 @item -exec=@var{file}
44199 @itemx -e @var{file}
44200 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
44201 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
44202 dump.
44203
44204 @item -se=@var{file}
44205 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
44206 file.
44207
44208 @item -core=@var{file}
44209 @itemx -c @var{file}
44210 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
44211
44212 @item -command=@var{file}
44213 @itemx -x @var{file}
44214 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
44215
44216 @item -ex @var{command}
44217 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
44218
44219 @item -directory=@var{directory}
44220 @itemx -d @var{directory}
44221 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
44222
44223 @item -nh
44224 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
44225
44226 @item -nx
44227 @itemx -n
44228 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
44229
44230 @item -quiet
44231 @itemx -q
44232 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
44233 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
44234
44235 @item -batch
44236 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
44237 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
44238 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
44239 commands in the command files.
44240
44241 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
44242 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
44243 more useful, the message
44244
44245 @smallexample
44246 Program exited normally.
44247 @end smallexample
44248
44249 @noindent
44250 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
44251 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
44252
44253 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44254 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44255 instead of the current directory.
44256
44257 @item -fullname
44258 @itemx -f
44259 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44260 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44261 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44262 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44263 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44264 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44265 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44266 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44267
44268 @item -b @var{bps}
44269 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44270 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44271
44272 @item -tty=@var{device}
44273 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44274 @end table
44275 @c man end
44276
44277 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44278 @ifset man
44279 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44280 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44281 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44282
44283 @smallexample
44284 info gdb
44285 @end smallexample
44286
44287 @noindent
44288 should give you access to the complete manual.
44289
44290 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44291 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44292 @end ifset
44293 @c man end
44294
44295 @node gdbserver man
44296 @heading gdbserver man
44297
44298 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44299 @format
44300 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44301 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44302
44303 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44304
44305 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44306 @c man end
44307 @end format
44308
44309 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44310 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44311 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44312
44313 @ifclear man
44314 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44315 @end ifclear
44316 @ifset man
44317 Usage (server (target) side):
44318 @end ifset
44319
44320 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44321 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44322 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44323 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44324
44325 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44326 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44327 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44328
44329 @smallexample
44330 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44331 @end smallexample
44332
44333 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44334
44335 @smallexample
44336 @ifset man
44337 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44338 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44339 @end ifset
44340 @ifclear man
44341 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44342 @end ifclear
44343 @end smallexample
44344
44345 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44346 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44347 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44348
44349 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44350
44351 @smallexample
44352 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44353 @end smallexample
44354
44355 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44356 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44357 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44358 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44359 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44360 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44361 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44362 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44363 print an error message and exit.
44364
44365 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44366 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44367
44368 @smallexample
44369 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44370 @end smallexample
44371
44372 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44373 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44374
44375 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44376 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44377 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44378 the program you want to debug.
44379
44380 @smallexample
44381 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44382 @end smallexample
44383
44384 @ifclear man
44385 @subheading Usage (host side)
44386 @end ifclear
44387 @ifset man
44388 Usage (host side):
44389 @end ifset
44390
44391 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44392 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44393 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44394 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44395 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44396 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44397 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44398 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44399 descriptor. For example:
44400
44401 @smallexample
44402 @ifset man
44403 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44404 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44405 @end ifset
44406 @ifclear man
44407 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44408 @end ifclear
44409 @end smallexample
44410
44411 @noindent
44412 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44413
44414 @smallexample
44415 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44416 @end smallexample
44417
44418 @noindent
44419 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44420 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44421 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44422 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44423 `Connection refused'.
44424
44425 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44426 described in
44427 @ifset man
44428 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44429 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44430 @end ifset
44431 @ifclear man
44432 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44433 @end ifclear
44434 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44435
44436 @smallexample
44437 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44438 @end smallexample
44439
44440 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44441 case.
44442 @c man end
44443
44444 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44445 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44446
44447 @itemize @bullet
44448
44449 @item
44450 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44451
44452 @smallexample
44453 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44454 @end smallexample
44455
44456 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44457 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44458 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44459 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44460 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44461 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44462 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44463
44464 @item
44465 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44466 program:
44467
44468 @smallexample
44469 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44470 @end smallexample
44471
44472 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44473 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44474 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44475 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44476
44477 @item
44478 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44479
44480 @smallexample
44481 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44482 @end smallexample
44483
44484 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44485 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44486 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44487 debug several processes in the same session.
44488 @end itemize
44489
44490 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44491
44492 @table @env
44493
44494 @item --help
44495 List all options, with brief explanations.
44496
44497 @item --version
44498 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44499
44500 @item --attach
44501 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44502
44503 @smallexample
44504 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44505 @end smallexample
44506
44507 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44508 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44509
44510 @item --multi
44511 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44512 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44513 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44514 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44515
44516 @smallexample
44517 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44518 @end smallexample
44519
44520 @item --debug
44521 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44522 process.
44523 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44524 the developers.
44525
44526 @item --remote-debug
44527 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44528 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44529 the developers.
44530
44531 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44532 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44533 of debugging output.
44534 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44535
44536 @item --wrapper
44537 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44538 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44539 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44540 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44541
44542 @item --once
44543 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44544 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44545 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44546 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44547
44548 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44549
44550 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44551 @c QDisableRandomization.
44552
44553 @end table
44554 @c man end
44555
44556 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44557 @ifset man
44558 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44559 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44560 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44561
44562 @smallexample
44563 info gdb
44564 @end smallexample
44565
44566 should give you access to the complete manual.
44567
44568 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44569 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44570 @end ifset
44571 @c man end
44572
44573 @node gcore man
44574 @heading gcore
44575
44576 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44577
44578 @format
44579 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44580 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44581 @c man end
44582 @end format
44583
44584 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44585 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44586 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44587 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44588 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44589 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44590 its job the program remains running without any change.
44591 @c man end
44592
44593 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44594 @table @env
44595 @item -a
44596 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44597 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44598 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44599 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44600 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44601
44602 @item -o @var{prefix}
44603 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44604 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44605 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44606 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44607 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44608 @end table
44609 @c man end
44610
44611 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44612 @ifset man
44613 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44614 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44615 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44616
44617 @smallexample
44618 info gdb
44619 @end smallexample
44620
44621 @noindent
44622 should give you access to the complete manual.
44623
44624 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44625 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44626 @end ifset
44627 @c man end
44628
44629 @node gdbinit man
44630 @heading gdbinit
44631
44632 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44633
44634 @format
44635 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44636 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44637 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44638 @end ifset
44639
44640 ~/.gdbinit
44641
44642 ./.gdbinit
44643 @c man end
44644 @end format
44645
44646 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44647 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44648 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44649 described in
44650 @ifset man
44651 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44652 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44653 @end ifset
44654 @ifclear man
44655 @ref{Sequences}.
44656 @end ifclear
44657
44658 Please read more in
44659 @ifset man
44660 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44661 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44662 @end ifset
44663 @ifclear man
44664 @ref{Startup}.
44665 @end ifclear
44666
44667 @table @env
44668 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44669 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44670 @end ifset
44671 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44672 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44673 @end ifclear
44674 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44675 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44676 See more in
44677 @ifset man
44678 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44679 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44680 @end ifset
44681 @ifclear man
44682 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44683 @end ifclear
44684
44685 @item ~/.gdbinit
44686 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44687 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44688
44689 @item ./.gdbinit
44690 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44691 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44692 See more in
44693 @ifset man
44694 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44695 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44696 @end ifset
44697 @ifclear man
44698 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44699 @end ifclear
44700 @end table
44701 @c man end
44702
44703 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44704 @ifset man
44705 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44706
44707 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44708 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44709 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44710
44711 @smallexample
44712 info gdb
44713 @end smallexample
44714
44715 should give you access to the complete manual.
44716
44717 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44718 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44719 @end ifset
44720 @c man end
44721
44722 @node gdb-add-index man
44723 @heading gdb-add-index
44724 @pindex gdb-add-index
44725 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44726
44727 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44728
44729 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44730 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44731 @c man end
44732
44733 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44734 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44735 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44736 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44737 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44738 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44739
44740 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44741 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44742 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44743 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44744 named @code{.debug_*}).
44745
44746 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44747 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44748 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44749 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44750
44751 See more in
44752 @ifset man
44753 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44754 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44755 @end ifset
44756 @ifclear man
44757 @ref{Index Files}.
44758 @end ifclear
44759 @c man end
44760
44761 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44762 @ifset man
44763 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44764 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44765 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44766
44767 @smallexample
44768 info gdb
44769 @end smallexample
44770
44771 should give you access to the complete manual.
44772
44773 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44774 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44775 @end ifset
44776 @c man end
44777
44778 @include gpl.texi
44779
44780 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44781 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44782 @include fdl.texi
44783
44784 @node Concept Index
44785 @unnumbered Concept Index
44786
44787 @printindex cp
44788
44789 @node Command and Variable Index
44790 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44791
44792 @printindex fn
44793
44794 @tex
44795 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44796 % meantime:
44797 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44798 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44799 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44800 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44801 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44802 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44803 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44804 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44805 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44806 \page\colophon
44807 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44808 @end tex
44809
44810 @bye
This page took 1.007845 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.